Merge from emacs-24; up to 2012-12-27T20:09:45Z!juri@jurta.org
[bpt/emacs.git] / doc / lispintro / emacs-lisp-intro.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @comment %**start of header
3 @setfilename ../../info/eintr
4 @c setfilename emacs-lisp-intro.info
5 @c sethtmlfilename emacs-lisp-intro.html
6 @settitle Programming in Emacs Lisp
7 @syncodeindex vr cp
8 @syncodeindex fn cp
9 @finalout
10
11 @include emacsver.texi
12
13 @c ---------
14 @c <<<< For hard copy printing, this file is now
15 @c set for smallbook, which works for all sizes
16 @c of paper, and with PostScript figures >>>>
17 @set smallbook
18 @ifset smallbook
19 @smallbook
20 @clear largebook
21 @end ifset
22 @set print-postscript-figures
23 @c set largebook
24 @c clear print-postscript-figures
25 @c ---------
26
27 @comment %**end of header
28
29 @c per rms and peterb, use 10pt fonts for the main text, mostly to
30 @c save on paper cost.
31 @c Do this inside @tex for now, so current makeinfo does not complain.
32 @tex
33 @ifset smallbook
34 @fonttextsize 10
35
36 @end ifset
37 \global\hbadness=6666 % don't worry about not-too-underfull boxes
38 @end tex
39
40 @c These refer to the printed book sold by the FSF.
41 @set edition-number 3.10
42 @set update-date 28 October 2009
43
44 @c ================ Included Figures ================
45
46 @c Set print-postscript-figures if you print PostScript figures.
47 @c If you clear this, the ten figures will be printed as ASCII diagrams.
48 @c (This is not relevant to Info, since Info only handles ASCII.)
49 @c Your site may require editing changes to print PostScript; in this
50 @c case, search for `print-postscript-figures' and make appropriate changes.
51
52 @c ================ How to Print a Book in Various Sizes ================
53
54 @c This book can be printed in any of three different sizes.
55 @c In the above header, set @-commands appropriately.
56
57 @c 7 by 9.25 inches:
58 @c @smallbook
59 @c @clear largebook
60
61 @c 8.5 by 11 inches:
62 @c @c smallbook
63 @c @set largebook
64
65 @c European A4 size paper:
66 @c @c smallbook
67 @c @afourpaper
68 @c @set largebook
69
70 @c (Note: if you edit the book so as to change the length of the
71 @c table of contents, you may have to change the value of `pageno' below.)
72
73 @c ================ End of Formatting Sections ================
74
75 @c For next or subsequent edition:
76 @c create function using with-output-to-temp-buffer
77 @c create a major mode, with keymaps
78 @c run an asynchronous process, like grep or diff
79
80 @c For 8.5 by 11 inch format: do not use such a small amount of
81 @c whitespace between paragraphs as smallbook format
82 @ifset largebook
83 @tex
84 \global\parskip 6pt plus 1pt
85 @end tex
86 @end ifset
87
88 @c For all sized formats: print within-book cross
89 @c reference with ``...'' rather than [...]
90
91 @c This works with the texinfo.tex file, version 2003-05-04.08,
92 @c in the Texinfo version 4.6 of the 2003 Jun 13 distribution.
93
94 @tex
95 \if \xrefprintnodename
96 \global\def\xrefprintnodename#1{\unskip, ``#1''}
97 \else
98 \global\def\xrefprintnodename#1{ ``#1''}
99 \fi
100 % \global\def\xrefprintnodename#1{, ``#1''}
101 @end tex
102
103 @c ----------------------------------------------------
104
105 @dircategory GNU Emacs Lisp
106 @direntry
107 * Emacs Lisp Intro: (eintr).
108 A simple introduction to Emacs Lisp programming.
109 @end direntry
110
111 @copying
112 This is an @cite{Introduction to Programming in Emacs Lisp}, for
113 people who are not programmers.
114 @sp 1
115 @iftex
116 Edition @value{edition-number}, @value{update-date}
117 @end iftex
118 @ifnottex
119 Distributed with Emacs version @value{EMACSVER}.
120 @end ifnottex
121 @ifset WWW_GNU_ORG
122 @html
123 <p>The homepage for GNU Emacs is at
124 <a href="http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/">http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/</a>.
125 <br>To view this manual in other formats, click
126 <a href="/software/emacs/emacs-lisp-intro/emacs-lisp-intro.html">here</a>.
127 @end html
128 @end ifset
129 @sp 1
130 Copyright @copyright{} 1990--1995, 1997, 2001--2013 Free Software
131 Foundation, Inc.
132 @sp 1
133
134 @iftex
135 Published by the:@*
136
137 GNU Press, @hfill @uref{http://www.fsf.org/licensing/gnu-press/}@*
138 a division of the @hfill email: @email{sales@@fsf.org}@*
139 Free Software Foundation, Inc. @hfill Tel: +1 (617) 542-5942@*
140 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor @hfill Fax: +1 (617) 542-2652@*
141 Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
142 @end iftex
143
144 @ifnottex
145 Printed copies available from @uref{http://shop.fsf.org/}. Published by:
146
147 @example
148 GNU Press, http://www.fsf.org/licensing/gnu-press/
149 a division of the email: sales@@fsf.org
150 Free Software Foundation, Inc. Tel: +1 (617) 542-5942
151 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor Fax: +1 (617) 542-2652
152 Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
153 @end example
154 @end ifnottex
155
156 @sp 1
157 ISBN 1-882114-43-4
158
159 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
160 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
161 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; there
162 being no Invariant Section, with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU
163 Manual'', and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of
164 the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
165 Documentation License''.
166
167 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to
168 copy and modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF
169 supports it in developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
170 @end copying
171
172 @c half title; two lines here, so do not use `shorttitlepage'
173 @tex
174 {\begingroup%
175 \hbox{}\vskip 1.5in \chaprm \centerline{An Introduction to}%
176 \endgroup}%
177 {\begingroup\hbox{}\vskip 0.25in \chaprm%
178 \centerline{Programming in Emacs Lisp}%
179 \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page}
180 @end tex
181
182 @titlepage
183 @sp 6
184 @center @titlefont{An Introduction to}
185 @sp 2
186 @center @titlefont{Programming in Emacs Lisp}
187 @sp 2
188 @center Revised Third Edition
189 @sp 4
190 @center by Robert J. Chassell
191
192 @page
193 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
194 @insertcopying
195 @end titlepage
196
197 @iftex
198 @headings off
199 @evenheading @thispage @| @| @thischapter
200 @oddheading @thissection @| @| @thispage
201 @end iftex
202
203 @ifnothtml
204 @c Keep T.O.C. short by tightening up for largebook
205 @ifset largebook
206 @tex
207 \global\parskip 2pt plus 1pt
208 \global\advance\baselineskip by -1pt
209 @end tex
210 @end ifset
211 @end ifnothtml
212
213 @shortcontents
214 @contents
215
216 @ifnottex
217 @node Top
218 @top An Introduction to Programming in Emacs Lisp
219
220 @insertcopying
221
222 This master menu first lists each chapter and index; then it lists
223 every node in every chapter.
224 @end ifnottex
225
226 @c >>>> Set pageno appropriately <<<<
227
228 @c The first page of the Preface is a roman numeral; it is the first
229 @c right handed page after the Table of Contents; hence the following
230 @c setting must be for an odd negative number.
231
232 @c iftex
233 @c global@pageno = -11
234 @c end iftex
235
236 @set COUNT-WORDS count-words-example
237 @c Length of variable name chosen so that things still line up when expanded.
238
239 @menu
240 * Preface:: What to look for.
241 * List Processing:: What is Lisp?
242 * Practicing Evaluation:: Running several programs.
243 * Writing Defuns:: How to write function definitions.
244 * Buffer Walk Through:: Exploring a few buffer-related functions.
245 * More Complex:: A few, even more complex functions.
246 * Narrowing & Widening:: Restricting your and Emacs attention to
247 a region.
248 * car cdr & cons:: Fundamental functions in Lisp.
249 * Cutting & Storing Text:: Removing text and saving it.
250 * List Implementation:: How lists are implemented in the computer.
251 * Yanking:: Pasting stored text.
252 * Loops & Recursion:: How to repeat a process.
253 * Regexp Search:: Regular expression searches.
254 * Counting Words:: A review of repetition and regexps.
255 * Words in a defun:: Counting words in a @code{defun}.
256 * Readying a Graph:: A prototype graph printing function.
257 * Emacs Initialization:: How to write a @file{.emacs} file.
258 * Debugging:: How to run the Emacs Lisp debuggers.
259 * Conclusion:: Now you have the basics.
260 * the-the:: An appendix: how to find reduplicated words.
261 * Kill Ring:: An appendix: how the kill ring works.
262 * Full Graph:: How to create a graph with labeled axes.
263 * Free Software and Free Manuals::
264 * GNU Free Documentation License::
265 * Index::
266 * About the Author::
267
268 @detailmenu
269 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
270
271 Preface
272
273 * Why:: Why learn Emacs Lisp?
274 * On Reading this Text:: Read, gain familiarity, pick up habits....
275 * Who You Are:: For whom this is written.
276 * Lisp History::
277 * Note for Novices:: You can read this as a novice.
278 * Thank You::
279
280 List Processing
281
282 * Lisp Lists:: What are lists?
283 * Run a Program:: Any list in Lisp is a program ready to run.
284 * Making Errors:: Generating an error message.
285 * Names & Definitions:: Names of symbols and function definitions.
286 * Lisp Interpreter:: What the Lisp interpreter does.
287 * Evaluation:: Running a program.
288 * Variables:: Returning a value from a variable.
289 * Arguments:: Passing information to a function.
290 * set & setq:: Setting the value of a variable.
291 * Summary:: The major points.
292 * Error Message Exercises::
293
294 Lisp Lists
295
296 * Numbers Lists:: List have numbers, other lists, in them.
297 * Lisp Atoms:: Elemental entities.
298 * Whitespace in Lists:: Formatting lists to be readable.
299 * Typing Lists:: How GNU Emacs helps you type lists.
300
301 The Lisp Interpreter
302
303 * Complications:: Variables, Special forms, Lists within.
304 * Byte Compiling:: Specially processing code for speed.
305
306 Evaluation
307
308 * How the Interpreter Acts:: Returns and Side Effects...
309 * Evaluating Inner Lists:: Lists within lists...
310
311 Variables
312
313 * fill-column Example::
314 * Void Function:: The error message for a symbol
315 without a function.
316 * Void Variable:: The error message for a symbol without a value.
317
318 Arguments
319
320 * Data types:: Types of data passed to a function.
321 * Args as Variable or List:: An argument can be the value
322 of a variable or list.
323 * Variable Number of Arguments:: Some functions may take a
324 variable number of arguments.
325 * Wrong Type of Argument:: Passing an argument of the wrong type
326 to a function.
327 * message:: A useful function for sending messages.
328
329 Setting the Value of a Variable
330
331 * Using set:: Setting values.
332 * Using setq:: Setting a quoted value.
333 * Counting:: Using @code{setq} to count.
334
335 Practicing Evaluation
336
337 * How to Evaluate:: Typing editing commands or @kbd{C-x C-e}
338 causes evaluation.
339 * Buffer Names:: Buffers and files are different.
340 * Getting Buffers:: Getting a buffer itself, not merely its name.
341 * Switching Buffers:: How to change to another buffer.
342 * Buffer Size & Locations:: Where point is located and the size of
343 the buffer.
344 * Evaluation Exercise::
345
346 How To Write Function Definitions
347
348 * Primitive Functions::
349 * defun:: The @code{defun} macro.
350 * Install:: Install a function definition.
351 * Interactive:: Making a function interactive.
352 * Interactive Options:: Different options for @code{interactive}.
353 * Permanent Installation:: Installing code permanently.
354 * let:: Creating and initializing local variables.
355 * if:: What if?
356 * else:: If--then--else expressions.
357 * Truth & Falsehood:: What Lisp considers false and true.
358 * save-excursion:: Keeping track of point, mark, and buffer.
359 * Review::
360 * defun Exercises::
361
362 Install a Function Definition
363
364 * Effect of installation::
365 * Change a defun:: How to change a function definition.
366
367 Make a Function Interactive
368
369 * Interactive multiply-by-seven:: An overview.
370 * multiply-by-seven in detail:: The interactive version.
371
372 @code{let}
373
374 * Prevent confusion::
375 * Parts of let Expression::
376 * Sample let Expression::
377 * Uninitialized let Variables::
378
379 The @code{if} Special Form
380
381 * if in more detail::
382 * type-of-animal in detail:: An example of an @code{if} expression.
383
384 Truth and Falsehood in Emacs Lisp
385
386 * nil explained:: @code{nil} has two meanings.
387
388 @code{save-excursion}
389
390 * Point and mark:: A review of various locations.
391 * Template for save-excursion::
392
393 A Few Buffer--Related Functions
394
395 * Finding More:: How to find more information.
396 * simplified-beginning-of-buffer:: Shows @code{goto-char},
397 @code{point-min}, and @code{push-mark}.
398 * mark-whole-buffer:: Almost the same as @code{beginning-of-buffer}.
399 * append-to-buffer:: Uses @code{save-excursion} and
400 @code{insert-buffer-substring}.
401 * Buffer Related Review:: Review.
402 * Buffer Exercises::
403
404 The Definition of @code{mark-whole-buffer}
405
406 * mark-whole-buffer overview::
407 * Body of mark-whole-buffer:: Only three lines of code.
408
409 The Definition of @code{append-to-buffer}
410
411 * append-to-buffer overview::
412 * append interactive:: A two part interactive expression.
413 * append-to-buffer body:: Incorporates a @code{let} expression.
414 * append save-excursion:: How the @code{save-excursion} works.
415
416 A Few More Complex Functions
417
418 * copy-to-buffer:: With @code{set-buffer}, @code{get-buffer-create}.
419 * insert-buffer:: Read-only, and with @code{or}.
420 * beginning-of-buffer:: Shows @code{goto-char},
421 @code{point-min}, and @code{push-mark}.
422 * Second Buffer Related Review::
423 * optional Exercise::
424
425 The Definition of @code{insert-buffer}
426
427 * insert-buffer code::
428 * insert-buffer interactive:: When you can read, but not write.
429 * insert-buffer body:: The body has an @code{or} and a @code{let}.
430 * if & or:: Using an @code{if} instead of an @code{or}.
431 * Insert or:: How the @code{or} expression works.
432 * Insert let:: Two @code{save-excursion} expressions.
433 * New insert-buffer::
434
435 The Interactive Expression in @code{insert-buffer}
436
437 * Read-only buffer:: When a buffer cannot be modified.
438 * b for interactive:: An existing buffer or else its name.
439
440 Complete Definition of @code{beginning-of-buffer}
441
442 * Optional Arguments::
443 * beginning-of-buffer opt arg:: Example with optional argument.
444 * beginning-of-buffer complete::
445
446 @code{beginning-of-buffer} with an Argument
447
448 * Disentangle beginning-of-buffer::
449 * Large buffer case::
450 * Small buffer case::
451
452 Narrowing and Widening
453
454 * Narrowing advantages:: The advantages of narrowing
455 * save-restriction:: The @code{save-restriction} special form.
456 * what-line:: The number of the line that point is on.
457 * narrow Exercise::
458
459 @code{car}, @code{cdr}, @code{cons}: Fundamental Functions
460
461 * Strange Names:: An historical aside: why the strange names?
462 * car & cdr:: Functions for extracting part of a list.
463 * cons:: Constructing a list.
464 * nthcdr:: Calling @code{cdr} repeatedly.
465 * nth::
466 * setcar:: Changing the first element of a list.
467 * setcdr:: Changing the rest of a list.
468 * cons Exercise::
469
470 @code{cons}
471
472 * Build a list::
473 * length:: How to find the length of a list.
474
475 Cutting and Storing Text
476
477 * Storing Text:: Text is stored in a list.
478 * zap-to-char:: Cutting out text up to a character.
479 * kill-region:: Cutting text out of a region.
480 * copy-region-as-kill:: A definition for copying text.
481 * Digression into C:: Minor note on C programming language macros.
482 * defvar:: How to give a variable an initial value.
483 * cons & search-fwd Review::
484 * search Exercises::
485
486 @code{zap-to-char}
487
488 * Complete zap-to-char:: The complete implementation.
489 * zap-to-char interactive:: A three part interactive expression.
490 * zap-to-char body:: A short overview.
491 * search-forward:: How to search for a string.
492 * progn:: The @code{progn} special form.
493 * Summing up zap-to-char:: Using @code{point} and @code{search-forward}.
494
495 @code{kill-region}
496
497 * Complete kill-region:: The function definition.
498 * condition-case:: Dealing with a problem.
499 * Lisp macro::
500
501 @code{copy-region-as-kill}
502
503 * Complete copy-region-as-kill:: The complete function definition.
504 * copy-region-as-kill body:: The body of @code{copy-region-as-kill}.
505
506 The Body of @code{copy-region-as-kill}
507
508 * last-command & this-command::
509 * kill-append function::
510 * kill-new function::
511
512 Initializing a Variable with @code{defvar}
513
514 * See variable current value::
515 * defvar and asterisk::
516
517 How Lists are Implemented
518
519 * Lists diagrammed::
520 * Symbols as Chest:: Exploring a powerful metaphor.
521 * List Exercise::
522
523 Yanking Text Back
524
525 * Kill Ring Overview::
526 * kill-ring-yank-pointer:: The kill ring is a list.
527 * yank nthcdr Exercises:: The @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} variable.
528
529 Loops and Recursion
530
531 * while:: Causing a stretch of code to repeat.
532 * dolist dotimes::
533 * Recursion:: Causing a function to call itself.
534 * Looping exercise::
535
536 @code{while}
537
538 * Looping with while:: Repeat so long as test returns true.
539 * Loop Example:: A @code{while} loop that uses a list.
540 * print-elements-of-list:: Uses @code{while}, @code{car}, @code{cdr}.
541 * Incrementing Loop:: A loop with an incrementing counter.
542 * Incrementing Loop Details::
543 * Decrementing Loop:: A loop with a decrementing counter.
544
545 Details of an Incrementing Loop
546
547 * Incrementing Example:: Counting pebbles in a triangle.
548 * Inc Example parts:: The parts of the function definition.
549 * Inc Example altogether:: Putting the function definition together.
550
551 Loop with a Decrementing Counter
552
553 * Decrementing Example:: More pebbles on the beach.
554 * Dec Example parts:: The parts of the function definition.
555 * Dec Example altogether:: Putting the function definition together.
556
557 Save your time: @code{dolist} and @code{dotimes}
558
559 * dolist::
560 * dotimes::
561
562 Recursion
563
564 * Building Robots:: Same model, different serial number ...
565 * Recursive Definition Parts:: Walk until you stop ...
566 * Recursion with list:: Using a list as the test whether to recurse.
567 * Recursive triangle function::
568 * Recursion with cond::
569 * Recursive Patterns:: Often used templates.
570 * No Deferment:: Don't store up work ...
571 * No deferment solution::
572
573 Recursion in Place of a Counter
574
575 * Recursive Example arg of 1 or 2::
576 * Recursive Example arg of 3 or 4::
577
578 Recursive Patterns
579
580 * Every::
581 * Accumulate::
582 * Keep::
583
584 Regular Expression Searches
585
586 * sentence-end:: The regular expression for @code{sentence-end}.
587 * re-search-forward:: Very similar to @code{search-forward}.
588 * forward-sentence:: A straightforward example of regexp search.
589 * forward-paragraph:: A somewhat complex example.
590 * etags:: How to create your own @file{TAGS} table.
591 * Regexp Review::
592 * re-search Exercises::
593
594 @code{forward-sentence}
595
596 * Complete forward-sentence::
597 * fwd-sentence while loops:: Two @code{while} loops.
598 * fwd-sentence re-search:: A regular expression search.
599
600 @code{forward-paragraph}: a Goldmine of Functions
601
602 * forward-paragraph in brief:: Key parts of the function definition.
603 * fwd-para let:: The @code{let*} expression.
604 * fwd-para while:: The forward motion @code{while} loop.
605
606 Counting: Repetition and Regexps
607
608 * Why Count Words::
609 * @value{COUNT-WORDS}:: Use a regexp, but find a problem.
610 * recursive-count-words:: Start with case of no words in region.
611 * Counting Exercise::
612
613 The @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}} Function
614
615 * Design @value{COUNT-WORDS}:: The definition using a @code{while} loop.
616 * Whitespace Bug:: The Whitespace Bug in @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}}.
617
618 Counting Words in a @code{defun}
619
620 * Divide and Conquer::
621 * Words and Symbols:: What to count?
622 * Syntax:: What constitutes a word or symbol?
623 * count-words-in-defun:: Very like @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}}.
624 * Several defuns:: Counting several defuns in a file.
625 * Find a File:: Do you want to look at a file?
626 * lengths-list-file:: A list of the lengths of many definitions.
627 * Several files:: Counting in definitions in different files.
628 * Several files recursively:: Recursively counting in different files.
629 * Prepare the data:: Prepare the data for display in a graph.
630
631 Count Words in @code{defuns} in Different Files
632
633 * lengths-list-many-files:: Return a list of the lengths of defuns.
634 * append:: Attach one list to another.
635
636 Prepare the Data for Display in a Graph
637
638 * Data for Display in Detail::
639 * Sorting:: Sorting lists.
640 * Files List:: Making a list of files.
641 * Counting function definitions::
642
643 Readying a Graph
644
645 * Columns of a graph::
646 * graph-body-print:: How to print the body of a graph.
647 * recursive-graph-body-print::
648 * Printed Axes::
649 * Line Graph Exercise::
650
651 Your @file{.emacs} File
652
653 * Default Configuration::
654 * Site-wide Init:: You can write site-wide init files.
655 * defcustom:: Emacs will write code for you.
656 * Beginning a .emacs File:: How to write a @code{.emacs file}.
657 * Text and Auto-fill:: Automatically wrap lines.
658 * Mail Aliases:: Use abbreviations for email addresses.
659 * Indent Tabs Mode:: Don't use tabs with @TeX{}
660 * Keybindings:: Create some personal keybindings.
661 * Keymaps:: More about key binding.
662 * Loading Files:: Load (i.e., evaluate) files automatically.
663 * Autoload:: Make functions available.
664 * Simple Extension:: Define a function; bind it to a key.
665 * X11 Colors:: Colors in X.
666 * Miscellaneous::
667 * Mode Line:: How to customize your mode line.
668
669 Debugging
670
671 * debug:: How to use the built-in debugger.
672 * debug-on-entry:: Start debugging when you call a function.
673 * debug-on-quit:: Start debugging when you quit with @kbd{C-g}.
674 * edebug:: How to use Edebug, a source level debugger.
675 * Debugging Exercises::
676
677 Handling the Kill Ring
678
679 * What the Kill Ring Does::
680 * current-kill::
681 * yank:: Paste a copy of a clipped element.
682 * yank-pop:: Insert element pointed to.
683 * ring file::
684
685 The @code{current-kill} Function
686
687 * Code for current-kill::
688 * Understanding current-kill::
689
690 @code{current-kill} in Outline
691
692 * Body of current-kill::
693 * Digression concerning error:: How to mislead humans, but not computers.
694 * Determining the Element::
695
696 A Graph with Labeled Axes
697
698 * Labeled Example::
699 * print-graph Varlist:: @code{let} expression in @code{print-graph}.
700 * print-Y-axis:: Print a label for the vertical axis.
701 * print-X-axis:: Print a horizontal label.
702 * Print Whole Graph:: The function to print a complete graph.
703
704 The @code{print-Y-axis} Function
705
706 * print-Y-axis in Detail::
707 * Height of label:: What height for the Y axis?
708 * Compute a Remainder:: How to compute the remainder of a division.
709 * Y Axis Element:: Construct a line for the Y axis.
710 * Y-axis-column:: Generate a list of Y axis labels.
711 * print-Y-axis Penultimate:: A not quite final version.
712
713 The @code{print-X-axis} Function
714
715 * Similarities differences:: Much like @code{print-Y-axis}, but not exactly.
716 * X Axis Tic Marks:: Create tic marks for the horizontal axis.
717
718 Printing the Whole Graph
719
720 * The final version:: A few changes.
721 * Test print-graph:: Run a short test.
722 * Graphing words in defuns:: Executing the final code.
723 * lambda:: How to write an anonymous function.
724 * mapcar:: Apply a function to elements of a list.
725 * Another Bug:: Yet another bug @dots{} most insidious.
726 * Final printed graph:: The graph itself!
727
728 @end detailmenu
729 @end menu
730
731 @node Preface
732 @unnumbered Preface
733
734 Most of the GNU Emacs integrated environment is written in the programming
735 language called Emacs Lisp. The code written in this programming
736 language is the software---the sets of instructions---that tell the
737 computer what to do when you give it commands. Emacs is designed so
738 that you can write new code in Emacs Lisp and easily install it as an
739 extension to the editor.
740
741 (GNU Emacs is sometimes called an ``extensible editor'', but it does
742 much more than provide editing capabilities. It is better to refer to
743 Emacs as an ``extensible computing environment''. However, that
744 phrase is quite a mouthful. It is easier to refer to Emacs simply as
745 an editor. Moreover, everything you do in Emacs---find the Mayan date
746 and phases of the moon, simplify polynomials, debug code, manage
747 files, read letters, write books---all these activities are kinds of
748 editing in the most general sense of the word.)
749
750 @menu
751 * Why:: Why learn Emacs Lisp?
752 * On Reading this Text:: Read, gain familiarity, pick up habits....
753 * Who You Are:: For whom this is written.
754 * Lisp History::
755 * Note for Novices:: You can read this as a novice.
756 * Thank You::
757 @end menu
758
759 @ifnottex
760 @node Why
761 @unnumberedsec Why Study Emacs Lisp?
762 @end ifnottex
763
764 Although Emacs Lisp is usually thought of in association only with Emacs,
765 it is a full computer programming language. You can use Emacs Lisp as
766 you would any other programming language.
767
768 Perhaps you want to understand programming; perhaps you want to extend
769 Emacs; or perhaps you want to become a programmer. This introduction to
770 Emacs Lisp is designed to get you started: to guide you in learning the
771 fundamentals of programming, and more importantly, to show you how you
772 can teach yourself to go further.
773
774 @node On Reading this Text
775 @unnumberedsec On Reading this Text
776
777 All through this document, you will see little sample programs you can
778 run inside of Emacs. If you read this document in Info inside of GNU
779 Emacs, you can run the programs as they appear. (This is easy to do and
780 is explained when the examples are presented.) Alternatively, you can
781 read this introduction as a printed book while sitting beside a computer
782 running Emacs. (This is what I like to do; I like printed books.) If
783 you don't have a running Emacs beside you, you can still read this book,
784 but in this case, it is best to treat it as a novel or as a travel guide
785 to a country not yet visited: interesting, but not the same as being
786 there.
787
788 Much of this introduction is dedicated to walkthroughs or guided tours
789 of code used in GNU Emacs. These tours are designed for two purposes:
790 first, to give you familiarity with real, working code (code you use
791 every day); and, second, to give you familiarity with the way Emacs
792 works. It is interesting to see how a working environment is
793 implemented.
794 Also, I
795 hope that you will pick up the habit of browsing through source code.
796 You can learn from it and mine it for ideas. Having GNU Emacs is like
797 having a dragon's cave of treasures.
798
799 In addition to learning about Emacs as an editor and Emacs Lisp as a
800 programming language, the examples and guided tours will give you an
801 opportunity to get acquainted with Emacs as a Lisp programming
802 environment. GNU Emacs supports programming and provides tools that
803 you will want to become comfortable using, such as @kbd{M-.} (the key
804 which invokes the @code{find-tag} command). You will also learn about
805 buffers and other objects that are part of the environment.
806 Learning about these features of Emacs is like learning new routes
807 around your home town.
808
809 @ignore
810 In addition, I have written several programs as extended examples.
811 Although these are examples, the programs are real. I use them.
812 Other people use them. You may use them. Beyond the fragments of
813 programs used for illustrations, there is very little in here that is
814 `just for teaching purposes'; what you see is used. This is a great
815 advantage of Emacs Lisp: it is easy to learn to use it for work.
816 @end ignore
817
818 Finally, I hope to convey some of the skills for using Emacs to
819 learn aspects of programming that you don't know. You can often use
820 Emacs to help you understand what puzzles you or to find out how to do
821 something new. This self-reliance is not only a pleasure, but an
822 advantage.
823
824 @node Who You Are
825 @unnumberedsec For Whom This is Written
826
827 This text is written as an elementary introduction for people who are
828 not programmers. If you are a programmer, you may not be satisfied with
829 this primer. The reason is that you may have become expert at reading
830 reference manuals and be put off by the way this text is organized.
831
832 An expert programmer who reviewed this text said to me:
833
834 @quotation
835 @i{I prefer to learn from reference manuals. I ``dive into'' each
836 paragraph, and ``come up for air'' between paragraphs.}
837
838 @i{When I get to the end of a paragraph, I assume that that subject is
839 done, finished, that I know everything I need (with the
840 possible exception of the case when the next paragraph starts talking
841 about it in more detail). I expect that a well written reference manual
842 will not have a lot of redundancy, and that it will have excellent
843 pointers to the (one) place where the information I want is.}
844 @end quotation
845
846 This introduction is not written for this person!
847
848 Firstly, I try to say everything at least three times: first, to
849 introduce it; second, to show it in context; and third, to show it in a
850 different context, or to review it.
851
852 Secondly, I hardly ever put all the information about a subject in one
853 place, much less in one paragraph. To my way of thinking, that imposes
854 too heavy a burden on the reader. Instead I try to explain only what
855 you need to know at the time. (Sometimes I include a little extra
856 information so you won't be surprised later when the additional
857 information is formally introduced.)
858
859 When you read this text, you are not expected to learn everything the
860 first time. Frequently, you need only make, as it were, a `nodding
861 acquaintance' with some of the items mentioned. My hope is that I have
862 structured the text and given you enough hints that you will be alert to
863 what is important, and concentrate on it.
864
865 You will need to ``dive into'' some paragraphs; there is no other way
866 to read them. But I have tried to keep down the number of such
867 paragraphs. This book is intended as an approachable hill, rather than
868 as a daunting mountain.
869
870 This introduction to @cite{Programming in Emacs Lisp} has a companion
871 document,
872 @iftex
873 @cite{The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}.
874 @end iftex
875 @ifnottex
876 @ref{Top, , The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual, elisp, The GNU
877 Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}.
878 @end ifnottex
879 The reference manual has more detail than this introduction. In the
880 reference manual, all the information about one topic is concentrated
881 in one place. You should turn to it if you are like the programmer
882 quoted above. And, of course, after you have read this
883 @cite{Introduction}, you will find the @cite{Reference Manual} useful
884 when you are writing your own programs.
885
886 @node Lisp History
887 @unnumberedsec Lisp History
888 @cindex Lisp history
889
890 Lisp was first developed in the late 1950s at the Massachusetts
891 Institute of Technology for research in artificial intelligence. The
892 great power of the Lisp language makes it superior for other purposes as
893 well, such as writing editor commands and integrated environments.
894
895 @cindex Maclisp
896 @cindex Common Lisp
897 GNU Emacs Lisp is largely inspired by Maclisp, which was written at MIT
898 in the 1960s. It is somewhat inspired by Common Lisp, which became a
899 standard in the 1980s. However, Emacs Lisp is much simpler than Common
900 Lisp. (The standard Emacs distribution contains an optional extensions
901 file, @file{cl.el}, that adds many Common Lisp features to Emacs Lisp.)
902
903 @node Note for Novices
904 @unnumberedsec A Note for Novices
905
906 If you don't know GNU Emacs, you can still read this document
907 profitably. However, I recommend you learn Emacs, if only to learn to
908 move around your computer screen. You can teach yourself how to use
909 Emacs with the on-line tutorial. To use it, type @kbd{C-h t}. (This
910 means you press and release the @key{CTRL} key and the @kbd{h} at the
911 same time, and then press and release @kbd{t}.)
912
913 Also, I often refer to one of Emacs's standard commands by listing the
914 keys which you press to invoke the command and then giving the name of
915 the command in parentheses, like this: @kbd{M-C-\}
916 (@code{indent-region}). What this means is that the
917 @code{indent-region} command is customarily invoked by typing
918 @kbd{M-C-\}. (You can, if you wish, change the keys that are typed to
919 invoke the command; this is called @dfn{rebinding}. @xref{Keymaps, ,
920 Keymaps}.) The abbreviation @kbd{M-C-\} means that you type your
921 @key{META} key, @key{CTRL} key and @key{\} key all at the same time.
922 (On many modern keyboards the @key{META} key is labeled
923 @key{ALT}.)
924 Sometimes a combination like this is called a keychord, since it is
925 similar to the way you play a chord on a piano. If your keyboard does
926 not have a @key{META} key, the @key{ESC} key prefix is used in place
927 of it. In this case, @kbd{M-C-\} means that you press and release your
928 @key{ESC} key and then type the @key{CTRL} key and the @key{\} key at
929 the same time. But usually @kbd{M-C-\} means press the @key{CTRL} key
930 along with the key that is labeled @key{ALT} and, at the same time,
931 press the @key{\} key.
932
933 In addition to typing a lone keychord, you can prefix what you type
934 with @kbd{C-u}, which is called the `universal argument'. The
935 @kbd{C-u} keychord passes an argument to the subsequent command.
936 Thus, to indent a region of plain text by 6 spaces, mark the region,
937 and then type @w{@kbd{C-u 6 M-C-\}}. (If you do not specify a number,
938 Emacs either passes the number 4 to the command or otherwise runs the
939 command differently than it would otherwise.) @xref{Arguments, ,
940 Numeric Arguments, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}.
941
942 If you are reading this in Info using GNU Emacs, you can read through
943 this whole document just by pressing the space bar, @key{SPC}.
944 (To learn about Info, type @kbd{C-h i} and then select Info.)
945
946 A note on terminology: when I use the word Lisp alone, I often am
947 referring to the various dialects of Lisp in general, but when I speak
948 of Emacs Lisp, I am referring to GNU Emacs Lisp in particular.
949
950 @node Thank You
951 @unnumberedsec Thank You
952
953 My thanks to all who helped me with this book. My especial thanks to
954 @r{Jim Blandy}, @r{Noah Friedman}, @w{Jim Kingdon}, @r{Roland
955 McGrath}, @w{Frank Ritter}, @w{Randy Smith}, @w{Richard M.
956 Stallman}, and @w{Melissa Weisshaus}. My thanks also go to both
957 @w{Philip Johnson} and @w{David Stampe} for their patient
958 encouragement. My mistakes are my own.
959
960 @flushright
961 Robert J. Chassell
962 @email{bob@@gnu.org}
963 @end flushright
964
965 @c ================ Beginning of main text ================
966
967 @c Start main text on right-hand (verso) page
968
969 @tex
970 \par\vfill\supereject
971 \headings off
972 \ifodd\pageno
973 \par\vfill\supereject
974 \else
975 \par\vfill\supereject
976 \page\hbox{}\page
977 \par\vfill\supereject
978 \fi
979 @end tex
980
981 @c Note: this resetting of the page number back to 1 causes TeX to gripe
982 @c about already having seen page numbers 1-4 before (in the preface):
983 @c pdfTeX warning (ext4): destination with the same identifier (name{1})
984 @c has been already used, duplicate ignored
985 @c I guess that is harmless (what happens if a later part of the text
986 @c makes a link to something in the first 4 pages though?).
987 @c E.g., note that the Emacs manual has a preface, but does not bother
988 @c resetting the page numbers back to 1 after that.
989 @iftex
990 @headings off
991 @evenheading @thispage @| @| @thischapter
992 @oddheading @thissection @| @| @thispage
993 @global@pageno = 1
994 @end iftex
995
996 @node List Processing
997 @chapter List Processing
998
999 To the untutored eye, Lisp is a strange programming language. In Lisp
1000 code there are parentheses everywhere. Some people even claim that
1001 the name stands for `Lots of Isolated Silly Parentheses'. But the
1002 claim is unwarranted. Lisp stands for LISt Processing, and the
1003 programming language handles @emph{lists} (and lists of lists) by
1004 putting them between parentheses. The parentheses mark the boundaries
1005 of the list. Sometimes a list is preceded by a single apostrophe or
1006 quotation mark, @samp{'}@footnote{The single apostrophe or quotation
1007 mark is an abbreviation for the function @code{quote}; you need not
1008 think about functions now; functions are defined in @ref{Making
1009 Errors, , Generate an Error Message}.} Lists are the basis of Lisp.
1010
1011 @menu
1012 * Lisp Lists:: What are lists?
1013 * Run a Program:: Any list in Lisp is a program ready to run.
1014 * Making Errors:: Generating an error message.
1015 * Names & Definitions:: Names of symbols and function definitions.
1016 * Lisp Interpreter:: What the Lisp interpreter does.
1017 * Evaluation:: Running a program.
1018 * Variables:: Returning a value from a variable.
1019 * Arguments:: Passing information to a function.
1020 * set & setq:: Setting the value of a variable.
1021 * Summary:: The major points.
1022 * Error Message Exercises::
1023 @end menu
1024
1025 @node Lisp Lists
1026 @section Lisp Lists
1027 @cindex Lisp Lists
1028
1029 In Lisp, a list looks like this: @code{'(rose violet daisy buttercup)}.
1030 This list is preceded by a single apostrophe. It could just as well be
1031 written as follows, which looks more like the kind of list you are likely
1032 to be familiar with:
1033
1034 @smallexample
1035 @group
1036 '(rose
1037 violet
1038 daisy
1039 buttercup)
1040 @end group
1041 @end smallexample
1042
1043 @noindent
1044 The elements of this list are the names of the four different flowers,
1045 separated from each other by whitespace and surrounded by parentheses,
1046 like flowers in a field with a stone wall around them.
1047 @cindex Flowers in a field
1048
1049 @menu
1050 * Numbers Lists:: List have numbers, other lists, in them.
1051 * Lisp Atoms:: Elemental entities.
1052 * Whitespace in Lists:: Formatting lists to be readable.
1053 * Typing Lists:: How GNU Emacs helps you type lists.
1054 @end menu
1055
1056 @ifnottex
1057 @node Numbers Lists
1058 @unnumberedsubsec Numbers, Lists inside of Lists
1059 @end ifnottex
1060
1061 Lists can also have numbers in them, as in this list: @code{(+ 2 2)}.
1062 This list has a plus-sign, @samp{+}, followed by two @samp{2}s, each
1063 separated by whitespace.
1064
1065 In Lisp, both data and programs are represented the same way; that is,
1066 they are both lists of words, numbers, or other lists, separated by
1067 whitespace and surrounded by parentheses. (Since a program looks like
1068 data, one program may easily serve as data for another; this is a very
1069 powerful feature of Lisp.) (Incidentally, these two parenthetical
1070 remarks are @emph{not} Lisp lists, because they contain @samp{;} and
1071 @samp{.} as punctuation marks.)
1072
1073 @need 1200
1074 Here is another list, this time with a list inside of it:
1075
1076 @smallexample
1077 '(this list has (a list inside of it))
1078 @end smallexample
1079
1080 The components of this list are the words @samp{this}, @samp{list},
1081 @samp{has}, and the list @samp{(a list inside of it)}. The interior
1082 list is made up of the words @samp{a}, @samp{list}, @samp{inside},
1083 @samp{of}, @samp{it}.
1084
1085 @node Lisp Atoms
1086 @subsection Lisp Atoms
1087 @cindex Lisp Atoms
1088
1089 In Lisp, what we have been calling words are called @dfn{atoms}. This
1090 term comes from the historical meaning of the word atom, which means
1091 `indivisible'. As far as Lisp is concerned, the words we have been
1092 using in the lists cannot be divided into any smaller parts and still
1093 mean the same thing as part of a program; likewise with numbers and
1094 single character symbols like @samp{+}. On the other hand, unlike an
1095 ancient atom, a list can be split into parts. (@xref{car cdr & cons,
1096 , @code{car} @code{cdr} & @code{cons} Fundamental Functions}.)
1097
1098 In a list, atoms are separated from each other by whitespace. They can be
1099 right next to a parenthesis.
1100
1101 @cindex @samp{empty list} defined
1102 Technically speaking, a list in Lisp consists of parentheses surrounding
1103 atoms separated by whitespace or surrounding other lists or surrounding
1104 both atoms and other lists. A list can have just one atom in it or
1105 have nothing in it at all. A list with nothing in it looks like this:
1106 @code{()}, and is called the @dfn{empty list}. Unlike anything else, an
1107 empty list is considered both an atom and a list at the same time.
1108
1109 @cindex Symbolic expressions, introduced
1110 @cindex @samp{expression} defined
1111 @cindex @samp{form} defined
1112 The printed representation of both atoms and lists are called
1113 @dfn{symbolic expressions} or, more concisely, @dfn{s-expressions}.
1114 The word @dfn{expression} by itself can refer to either the printed
1115 representation, or to the atom or list as it is held internally in the
1116 computer. Often, people use the term @dfn{expression}
1117 indiscriminately. (Also, in many texts, the word @dfn{form} is used
1118 as a synonym for expression.)
1119
1120 Incidentally, the atoms that make up our universe were named such when
1121 they were thought to be indivisible; but it has been found that physical
1122 atoms are not indivisible. Parts can split off an atom or it can
1123 fission into two parts of roughly equal size. Physical atoms were named
1124 prematurely, before their truer nature was found. In Lisp, certain
1125 kinds of atom, such as an array, can be separated into parts; but the
1126 mechanism for doing this is different from the mechanism for splitting a
1127 list. As far as list operations are concerned, the atoms of a list are
1128 unsplittable.
1129
1130 As in English, the meanings of the component letters of a Lisp atom
1131 are different from the meaning the letters make as a word. For
1132 example, the word for the South American sloth, the @samp{ai}, is
1133 completely different from the two words, @samp{a}, and @samp{i}.
1134
1135 There are many kinds of atom in nature but only a few in Lisp: for
1136 example, @dfn{numbers}, such as 37, 511, or 1729, and @dfn{symbols}, such
1137 as @samp{+}, @samp{foo}, or @samp{forward-line}. The words we have
1138 listed in the examples above are all symbols. In everyday Lisp
1139 conversation, the word ``atom'' is not often used, because programmers
1140 usually try to be more specific about what kind of atom they are dealing
1141 with. Lisp programming is mostly about symbols (and sometimes numbers)
1142 within lists. (Incidentally, the preceding three word parenthetical
1143 remark is a proper list in Lisp, since it consists of atoms, which in
1144 this case are symbols, separated by whitespace and enclosed by
1145 parentheses, without any non-Lisp punctuation.)
1146
1147 @need 1250
1148 Text between double quotation marks---even sentences or
1149 paragraphs---is also an atom. Here is an example:
1150 @cindex Text between double quotation marks
1151
1152 @smallexample
1153 '(this list includes "text between quotation marks.")
1154 @end smallexample
1155
1156 @cindex @samp{string} defined
1157 @noindent
1158 In Lisp, all of the quoted text including the punctuation mark and the
1159 blank spaces is a single atom. This kind of atom is called a
1160 @dfn{string} (for `string of characters') and is the sort of thing that
1161 is used for messages that a computer can print for a human to read.
1162 Strings are a different kind of atom than numbers or symbols and are
1163 used differently.
1164
1165 @node Whitespace in Lists
1166 @subsection Whitespace in Lists
1167 @cindex Whitespace in lists
1168
1169 @need 1200
1170 The amount of whitespace in a list does not matter. From the point of view
1171 of the Lisp language,
1172
1173 @smallexample
1174 @group
1175 '(this list
1176 looks like this)
1177 @end group
1178 @end smallexample
1179
1180 @need 800
1181 @noindent
1182 is exactly the same as this:
1183
1184 @smallexample
1185 '(this list looks like this)
1186 @end smallexample
1187
1188 Both examples show what to Lisp is the same list, the list made up of
1189 the symbols @samp{this}, @samp{list}, @samp{looks}, @samp{like}, and
1190 @samp{this} in that order.
1191
1192 Extra whitespace and newlines are designed to make a list more readable
1193 by humans. When Lisp reads the expression, it gets rid of all the extra
1194 whitespace (but it needs to have at least one space between atoms in
1195 order to tell them apart.)
1196
1197 Odd as it seems, the examples we have seen cover almost all of what Lisp
1198 lists look like! Every other list in Lisp looks more or less like one
1199 of these examples, except that the list may be longer and more complex.
1200 In brief, a list is between parentheses, a string is between quotation
1201 marks, a symbol looks like a word, and a number looks like a number.
1202 (For certain situations, square brackets, dots and a few other special
1203 characters may be used; however, we will go quite far without them.)
1204
1205 @node Typing Lists
1206 @subsection GNU Emacs Helps You Type Lists
1207 @cindex Help typing lists
1208 @cindex Formatting help
1209
1210 When you type a Lisp expression in GNU Emacs using either Lisp
1211 Interaction mode or Emacs Lisp mode, you have available to you several
1212 commands to format the Lisp expression so it is easy to read. For
1213 example, pressing the @key{TAB} key automatically indents the line the
1214 cursor is on by the right amount. A command to properly indent the
1215 code in a region is customarily bound to @kbd{M-C-\}. Indentation is
1216 designed so that you can see which elements of a list belong to which
1217 list---elements of a sub-list are indented more than the elements of
1218 the enclosing list.
1219
1220 In addition, when you type a closing parenthesis, Emacs momentarily
1221 jumps the cursor back to the matching opening parenthesis, so you can
1222 see which one it is. This is very useful, since every list you type
1223 in Lisp must have its closing parenthesis match its opening
1224 parenthesis. (@xref{Major Modes, , Major Modes, emacs, The GNU Emacs
1225 Manual}, for more information about Emacs's modes.)
1226
1227 @node Run a Program
1228 @section Run a Program
1229 @cindex Run a program
1230 @cindex Program, running one
1231
1232 @cindex @samp{evaluate} defined
1233 A list in Lisp---any list---is a program ready to run. If you run it
1234 (for which the Lisp jargon is @dfn{evaluate}), the computer will do one
1235 of three things: do nothing except return to you the list itself; send
1236 you an error message; or, treat the first symbol in the list as a
1237 command to do something. (Usually, of course, it is the last of these
1238 three things that you really want!)
1239
1240 @c use code for the single apostrophe, not samp.
1241 The single apostrophe, @code{'}, that I put in front of some of the
1242 example lists in preceding sections is called a @dfn{quote}; when it
1243 precedes a list, it tells Lisp to do nothing with the list, other than
1244 take it as it is written. But if there is no quote preceding a list,
1245 the first item of the list is special: it is a command for the computer
1246 to obey. (In Lisp, these commands are called @emph{functions}.) The list
1247 @code{(+ 2 2)} shown above did not have a quote in front of it, so Lisp
1248 understands that the @code{+} is an instruction to do something with the
1249 rest of the list: add the numbers that follow.
1250
1251 @need 1250
1252 If you are reading this inside of GNU Emacs in Info, here is how you can
1253 evaluate such a list: place your cursor immediately after the right
1254 hand parenthesis of the following list and then type @kbd{C-x C-e}:
1255
1256 @smallexample
1257 (+ 2 2)
1258 @end smallexample
1259
1260 @c use code for the number four, not samp.
1261 @noindent
1262 You will see the number @code{4} appear in the echo area. (In the
1263 jargon, what you have just done is ``evaluate the list.'' The echo area
1264 is the line at the bottom of the screen that displays or ``echoes''
1265 text.) Now try the same thing with a quoted list: place the cursor
1266 right after the following list and type @kbd{C-x C-e}:
1267
1268 @smallexample
1269 '(this is a quoted list)
1270 @end smallexample
1271
1272 @noindent
1273 You will see @code{(this is a quoted list)} appear in the echo area.
1274
1275 @cindex Lisp interpreter, explained
1276 @cindex Interpreter, Lisp, explained
1277 In both cases, what you are doing is giving a command to the program
1278 inside of GNU Emacs called the @dfn{Lisp interpreter}---giving the
1279 interpreter a command to evaluate the expression. The name of the Lisp
1280 interpreter comes from the word for the task done by a human who comes
1281 up with the meaning of an expression---who ``interprets'' it.
1282
1283 You can also evaluate an atom that is not part of a list---one that is
1284 not surrounded by parentheses; again, the Lisp interpreter translates
1285 from the humanly readable expression to the language of the computer.
1286 But before discussing this (@pxref{Variables}), we will discuss what the
1287 Lisp interpreter does when you make an error.
1288
1289 @node Making Errors
1290 @section Generate an Error Message
1291 @cindex Generate an error message
1292 @cindex Error message generation
1293
1294 Partly so you won't worry if you do it accidentally, we will now give
1295 a command to the Lisp interpreter that generates an error message.
1296 This is a harmless activity; and indeed, we will often try to generate
1297 error messages intentionally. Once you understand the jargon, error
1298 messages can be informative. Instead of being called ``error''
1299 messages, they should be called ``help'' messages. They are like
1300 signposts to a traveler in a strange country; deciphering them can be
1301 hard, but once understood, they can point the way.
1302
1303 The error message is generated by a built-in GNU Emacs debugger. We
1304 will `enter the debugger'. You get out of the debugger by typing @code{q}.
1305
1306 What we will do is evaluate a list that is not quoted and does not
1307 have a meaningful command as its first element. Here is a list almost
1308 exactly the same as the one we just used, but without the single-quote
1309 in front of it. Position the cursor right after it and type @kbd{C-x
1310 C-e}:
1311
1312 @smallexample
1313 (this is an unquoted list)
1314 @end smallexample
1315
1316 @ignore
1317 @noindent
1318 What you see depends on which version of Emacs you are running. GNU
1319 Emacs version 22 provides more information than version 20 and before.
1320 First, the more recent result of generating an error; then the
1321 earlier, version 20 result.
1322
1323 @need 1250
1324 @noindent
1325 In GNU Emacs version 22, a @file{*Backtrace*} window will open up and
1326 you will see the following in it:
1327 @end ignore
1328
1329 A @file{*Backtrace*} window will open up and you should see the
1330 following in it:
1331
1332 @smallexample
1333 @group
1334 ---------- Buffer: *Backtrace* ----------
1335 Debugger entered--Lisp error: (void-function this)
1336 (this is an unquoted list)
1337 eval((this is an unquoted list))
1338 eval-last-sexp-1(nil)
1339 eval-last-sexp(nil)
1340 call-interactively(eval-last-sexp)
1341 ---------- Buffer: *Backtrace* ----------
1342 @end group
1343 @end smallexample
1344
1345 @need 1200
1346 @noindent
1347 Your cursor will be in this window (you may have to wait a few seconds
1348 before it becomes visible). To quit the debugger and make the
1349 debugger window go away, type:
1350
1351 @smallexample
1352 q
1353 @end smallexample
1354
1355 @noindent
1356 Please type @kbd{q} right now, so you become confident that you can
1357 get out of the debugger. Then, type @kbd{C-x C-e} again to re-enter
1358 it.
1359
1360 @cindex @samp{function} defined
1361 Based on what we already know, we can almost read this error message.
1362
1363 You read the @file{*Backtrace*} buffer from the bottom up; it tells
1364 you what Emacs did. When you typed @kbd{C-x C-e}, you made an
1365 interactive call to the command @code{eval-last-sexp}. @code{eval} is
1366 an abbreviation for `evaluate' and @code{sexp} is an abbreviation for
1367 `symbolic expression'. The command means `evaluate last symbolic
1368 expression', which is the expression just before your cursor.
1369
1370 Each line above tells you what the Lisp interpreter evaluated next.
1371 The most recent action is at the top. The buffer is called the
1372 @file{*Backtrace*} buffer because it enables you to track Emacs
1373 backwards.
1374
1375 @need 800
1376 At the top of the @file{*Backtrace*} buffer, you see the line:
1377
1378 @smallexample
1379 Debugger entered--Lisp error: (void-function this)
1380 @end smallexample
1381
1382 @noindent
1383 The Lisp interpreter tried to evaluate the first atom of the list, the
1384 word @samp{this}. It is this action that generated the error message
1385 @samp{void-function this}.
1386
1387 The message contains the words @samp{void-function} and @samp{this}.
1388
1389 @cindex @samp{function} defined
1390 The word @samp{function} was mentioned once before. It is a very
1391 important word. For our purposes, we can define it by saying that a
1392 @dfn{function} is a set of instructions to the computer that tell the
1393 computer to do something.
1394
1395 Now we can begin to understand the error message: @samp{void-function
1396 this}. The function (that is, the word @samp{this}) does not have a
1397 definition of any set of instructions for the computer to carry out.
1398
1399 The slightly odd word, @samp{void-function}, is designed to cover the
1400 way Emacs Lisp is implemented, which is that when a symbol does not
1401 have a function definition attached to it, the place that should
1402 contain the instructions is `void'.
1403
1404 On the other hand, since we were able to add 2 plus 2 successfully, by
1405 evaluating @code{(+ 2 2)}, we can infer that the symbol @code{+} must
1406 have a set of instructions for the computer to obey and those
1407 instructions must be to add the numbers that follow the @code{+}.
1408
1409 It is possible to prevent Emacs entering the debugger in cases like
1410 this. We do not explain how to do that here, but we will mention what
1411 the result looks like, because you may encounter a similar situation
1412 if there is a bug in some Emacs code that you are using. In such
1413 cases, you will see only one line of error message; it will appear in
1414 the echo area and look like this:
1415
1416 @smallexample
1417 Symbol's function definition is void:@: this
1418 @end smallexample
1419
1420 @noindent
1421 @ignore
1422 (Also, your terminal may beep at you---some do, some don't; and others
1423 blink. This is just a device to get your attention.)
1424 @end ignore
1425 The message goes away as soon as you type a key, even just to
1426 move the cursor.
1427
1428 We know the meaning of the word @samp{Symbol}. It refers to the first
1429 atom of the list, the word @samp{this}. The word @samp{function}
1430 refers to the instructions that tell the computer what to do.
1431 (Technically, the symbol tells the computer where to find the
1432 instructions, but this is a complication we can ignore for the
1433 moment.)
1434
1435 The error message can be understood: @samp{Symbol's function
1436 definition is void:@: this}. The symbol (that is, the word
1437 @samp{this}) lacks instructions for the computer to carry out.
1438
1439 @node Names & Definitions
1440 @section Symbol Names and Function Definitions
1441 @cindex Symbol names
1442
1443 We can articulate another characteristic of Lisp based on what we have
1444 discussed so far---an important characteristic: a symbol, like
1445 @code{+}, is not itself the set of instructions for the computer to
1446 carry out. Instead, the symbol is used, perhaps temporarily, as a way
1447 of locating the definition or set of instructions. What we see is the
1448 name through which the instructions can be found. Names of people
1449 work the same way. I can be referred to as @samp{Bob}; however, I am
1450 not the letters @samp{B}, @samp{o}, @samp{b} but am, or was, the
1451 consciousness consistently associated with a particular life-form.
1452 The name is not me, but it can be used to refer to me.
1453
1454 In Lisp, one set of instructions can be attached to several names.
1455 For example, the computer instructions for adding numbers can be
1456 linked to the symbol @code{plus} as well as to the symbol @code{+}
1457 (and are in some dialects of Lisp). Among humans, I can be referred
1458 to as @samp{Robert} as well as @samp{Bob} and by other words as well.
1459
1460 On the other hand, a symbol can have only one function definition
1461 attached to it at a time. Otherwise, the computer would be confused as
1462 to which definition to use. If this were the case among people, only
1463 one person in the world could be named @samp{Bob}. However, the function
1464 definition to which the name refers can be changed readily.
1465 (@xref{Install, , Install a Function Definition}.)
1466
1467 Since Emacs Lisp is large, it is customary to name symbols in a way
1468 that identifies the part of Emacs to which the function belongs.
1469 Thus, all the names for functions that deal with Texinfo start with
1470 @samp{texinfo-} and those for functions that deal with reading mail
1471 start with @samp{rmail-}.
1472
1473 @node Lisp Interpreter
1474 @section The Lisp Interpreter
1475 @cindex Lisp interpreter, what it does
1476 @cindex Interpreter, what it does
1477
1478 Based on what we have seen, we can now start to figure out what the
1479 Lisp interpreter does when we command it to evaluate a list.
1480 First, it looks to see whether there is a quote before the list; if
1481 there is, the interpreter just gives us the list. On the other
1482 hand, if there is no quote, the interpreter looks at the first element
1483 in the list and sees whether it has a function definition. If it does,
1484 the interpreter carries out the instructions in the function definition.
1485 Otherwise, the interpreter prints an error message.
1486
1487 This is how Lisp works. Simple. There are added complications which we
1488 will get to in a minute, but these are the fundamentals. Of course, to
1489 write Lisp programs, you need to know how to write function definitions
1490 and attach them to names, and how to do this without confusing either
1491 yourself or the computer.
1492
1493 @menu
1494 * Complications:: Variables, Special forms, Lists within.
1495 * Byte Compiling:: Specially processing code for speed.
1496 @end menu
1497
1498 @ifnottex
1499 @node Complications
1500 @unnumberedsubsec Complications
1501 @end ifnottex
1502
1503 Now, for the first complication. In addition to lists, the Lisp
1504 interpreter can evaluate a symbol that is not quoted and does not have
1505 parentheses around it. The Lisp interpreter will attempt to determine
1506 the symbol's value as a @dfn{variable}. This situation is described
1507 in the section on variables. (@xref{Variables}.)
1508
1509 @cindex Special form
1510 The second complication occurs because some functions are unusual and
1511 do not work in the usual manner. Those that don't are called
1512 @dfn{special forms}. They are used for special jobs, like defining a
1513 function, and there are not many of them. In the next few chapters,
1514 you will be introduced to several of the more important special forms.
1515
1516 As well as special forms, there are also @dfn{macros}. A macro
1517 is a construct defined in Lisp, which differs from a function in that it
1518 translates a Lisp expression into another expression that is to be
1519 evaluated in place of the original expression. (@xref{Lisp macro}.)
1520
1521 For the purposes of this introduction, you do not need to worry too much
1522 about whether something is a special form, macro, or ordinary function.
1523 For example, @code{if} is a special form (@pxref{if}), but @code{when}
1524 is a macro (@pxref{Lisp macro}). In earlier versions of Emacs,
1525 @code{defun} was a special form, but now it is a macro (@pxref{defun}).
1526 It still behaves in the same way.
1527
1528 The final complication is this: if the function that the
1529 Lisp interpreter is looking at is not a special form, and if it is part
1530 of a list, the Lisp interpreter looks to see whether the list has a list
1531 inside of it. If there is an inner list, the Lisp interpreter first
1532 figures out what it should do with the inside list, and then it works on
1533 the outside list. If there is yet another list embedded inside the
1534 inner list, it works on that one first, and so on. It always works on
1535 the innermost list first. The interpreter works on the innermost list
1536 first, to evaluate the result of that list. The result may be
1537 used by the enclosing expression.
1538
1539 Otherwise, the interpreter works left to right, from one expression to
1540 the next.
1541
1542 @node Byte Compiling
1543 @subsection Byte Compiling
1544 @cindex Byte compiling
1545
1546 One other aspect of interpreting: the Lisp interpreter is able to
1547 interpret two kinds of entity: humanly readable code, on which we will
1548 focus exclusively, and specially processed code, called @dfn{byte
1549 compiled} code, which is not humanly readable. Byte compiled code
1550 runs faster than humanly readable code.
1551
1552 You can transform humanly readable code into byte compiled code by
1553 running one of the compile commands such as @code{byte-compile-file}.
1554 Byte compiled code is usually stored in a file that ends with a
1555 @file{.elc} extension rather than a @file{.el} extension. You will
1556 see both kinds of file in the @file{emacs/lisp} directory; the files
1557 to read are those with @file{.el} extensions.
1558
1559 As a practical matter, for most things you might do to customize or
1560 extend Emacs, you do not need to byte compile; and I will not discuss
1561 the topic here. @xref{Byte Compilation, , Byte Compilation, elisp,
1562 The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}, for a full description of byte
1563 compilation.
1564
1565 @node Evaluation
1566 @section Evaluation
1567 @cindex Evaluation
1568
1569 When the Lisp interpreter works on an expression, the term for the
1570 activity is called @dfn{evaluation}. We say that the interpreter
1571 `evaluates the expression'. I've used this term several times before.
1572 The word comes from its use in everyday language, `to ascertain the
1573 value or amount of; to appraise', according to @cite{Webster's New
1574 Collegiate Dictionary}.
1575
1576 @menu
1577 * How the Interpreter Acts:: Returns and Side Effects...
1578 * Evaluating Inner Lists:: Lists within lists...
1579 @end menu
1580
1581 @ifnottex
1582 @node How the Interpreter Acts
1583 @unnumberedsubsec How the Lisp Interpreter Acts
1584 @end ifnottex
1585
1586 @cindex @samp{returned value} explained
1587 After evaluating an expression, the Lisp interpreter will most likely
1588 @dfn{return} the value that the computer produces by carrying out the
1589 instructions it found in the function definition, or perhaps it will
1590 give up on that function and produce an error message. (The interpreter
1591 may also find itself tossed, so to speak, to a different function or it
1592 may attempt to repeat continually what it is doing for ever and ever in
1593 what is called an `infinite loop'. These actions are less common; and
1594 we can ignore them.) Most frequently, the interpreter returns a value.
1595
1596 @cindex @samp{side effect} defined
1597 At the same time the interpreter returns a value, it may do something
1598 else as well, such as move a cursor or copy a file; this other kind of
1599 action is called a @dfn{side effect}. Actions that we humans think are
1600 important, such as printing results, are often ``side effects'' to the
1601 Lisp interpreter. The jargon can sound peculiar, but it turns out that
1602 it is fairly easy to learn to use side effects.
1603
1604 In summary, evaluating a symbolic expression most commonly causes the
1605 Lisp interpreter to return a value and perhaps carry out a side effect;
1606 or else produce an error.
1607
1608 @node Evaluating Inner Lists
1609 @subsection Evaluating Inner Lists
1610 @cindex Inner list evaluation
1611 @cindex Evaluating inner lists
1612
1613 If evaluation applies to a list that is inside another list, the outer
1614 list may use the value returned by the first evaluation as information
1615 when the outer list is evaluated. This explains why inner expressions
1616 are evaluated first: the values they return are used by the outer
1617 expressions.
1618
1619 @need 1250
1620 We can investigate this process by evaluating another addition example.
1621 Place your cursor after the following expression and type @kbd{C-x C-e}:
1622
1623 @smallexample
1624 (+ 2 (+ 3 3))
1625 @end smallexample
1626
1627 @noindent
1628 The number 8 will appear in the echo area.
1629
1630 What happens is that the Lisp interpreter first evaluates the inner
1631 expression, @code{(+ 3 3)}, for which the value 6 is returned; then it
1632 evaluates the outer expression as if it were written @code{(+ 2 6)}, which
1633 returns the value 8. Since there are no more enclosing expressions to
1634 evaluate, the interpreter prints that value in the echo area.
1635
1636 Now it is easy to understand the name of the command invoked by the
1637 keystrokes @kbd{C-x C-e}: the name is @code{eval-last-sexp}. The
1638 letters @code{sexp} are an abbreviation for `symbolic expression', and
1639 @code{eval} is an abbreviation for `evaluate'. The command means
1640 `evaluate last symbolic expression'.
1641
1642 As an experiment, you can try evaluating the expression by putting the
1643 cursor at the beginning of the next line immediately following the
1644 expression, or inside the expression.
1645
1646 @need 800
1647 Here is another copy of the expression:
1648
1649 @smallexample
1650 (+ 2 (+ 3 3))
1651 @end smallexample
1652
1653 @noindent
1654 If you place the cursor at the beginning of the blank line that
1655 immediately follows the expression and type @kbd{C-x C-e}, you will
1656 still get the value 8 printed in the echo area. Now try putting the
1657 cursor inside the expression. If you put it right after the next to
1658 last parenthesis (so it appears to sit on top of the last parenthesis),
1659 you will get a 6 printed in the echo area! This is because the command
1660 evaluates the expression @code{(+ 3 3)}.
1661
1662 Now put the cursor immediately after a number. Type @kbd{C-x C-e} and
1663 you will get the number itself. In Lisp, if you evaluate a number, you
1664 get the number itself---this is how numbers differ from symbols. If you
1665 evaluate a list starting with a symbol like @code{+}, you will get a
1666 value returned that is the result of the computer carrying out the
1667 instructions in the function definition attached to that name. If a
1668 symbol by itself is evaluated, something different happens, as we will
1669 see in the next section.
1670
1671 @node Variables
1672 @section Variables
1673 @cindex Variables
1674
1675 In Emacs Lisp, a symbol can have a value attached to it just as it can
1676 have a function definition attached to it. The two are different.
1677 The function definition is a set of instructions that a computer will
1678 obey. A value, on the other hand, is something, such as number or a
1679 name, that can vary (which is why such a symbol is called a variable).
1680 The value of a symbol can be any expression in Lisp, such as a symbol,
1681 number, list, or string. A symbol that has a value is often called a
1682 @dfn{variable}.
1683
1684 A symbol can have both a function definition and a value attached to
1685 it at the same time. Or it can have just one or the other.
1686 The two are separate. This is somewhat similar
1687 to the way the name Cambridge can refer to the city in Massachusetts
1688 and have some information attached to the name as well, such as
1689 ``great programming center''.
1690
1691 @ignore
1692 (Incidentally, in Emacs Lisp, a symbol can have two
1693 other things attached to it, too: a property list and a documentation
1694 string; these are discussed later.)
1695 @end ignore
1696
1697 Another way to think about this is to imagine a symbol as being a chest
1698 of drawers. The function definition is put in one drawer, the value in
1699 another, and so on. What is put in the drawer holding the value can be
1700 changed without affecting the contents of the drawer holding the
1701 function definition, and vice-verse.
1702
1703 @menu
1704 * fill-column Example::
1705 * Void Function:: The error message for a symbol
1706 without a function.
1707 * Void Variable:: The error message for a symbol without a value.
1708 @end menu
1709
1710 @ifnottex
1711 @node fill-column Example
1712 @unnumberedsubsec @code{fill-column}, an Example Variable
1713 @end ifnottex
1714
1715 @findex fill-column, @r{an example variable}
1716 @cindex Example variable, @code{fill-column}
1717 @cindex Variable, example of, @code{fill-column}
1718 The variable @code{fill-column} illustrates a symbol with a value
1719 attached to it: in every GNU Emacs buffer, this symbol is set to some
1720 value, usually 72 or 70, but sometimes to some other value. To find the
1721 value of this symbol, evaluate it by itself. If you are reading this in
1722 Info inside of GNU Emacs, you can do this by putting the cursor after
1723 the symbol and typing @kbd{C-x C-e}:
1724
1725 @smallexample
1726 fill-column
1727 @end smallexample
1728
1729 @noindent
1730 After I typed @kbd{C-x C-e}, Emacs printed the number 72 in my echo
1731 area. This is the value for which @code{fill-column} is set for me as I
1732 write this. It may be different for you in your Info buffer. Notice
1733 that the value returned as a variable is printed in exactly the same way
1734 as the value returned by a function carrying out its instructions. From
1735 the point of view of the Lisp interpreter, a value returned is a value
1736 returned. What kind of expression it came from ceases to matter once
1737 the value is known.
1738
1739 A symbol can have any value attached to it or, to use the jargon, we can
1740 @dfn{bind} the variable to a value: to a number, such as 72; to a
1741 string, @code{"such as this"}; to a list, such as @code{(spruce pine
1742 oak)}; we can even bind a variable to a function definition.
1743
1744 A symbol can be bound to a value in several ways. @xref{set & setq, ,
1745 Setting the Value of a Variable}, for information about one way to do
1746 this.
1747
1748 @node Void Function
1749 @subsection Error Message for a Symbol Without a Function
1750 @cindex Symbol without function error
1751 @cindex Error for symbol without function
1752
1753 When we evaluated @code{fill-column} to find its value as a variable,
1754 we did not place parentheses around the word. This is because we did
1755 not intend to use it as a function name.
1756
1757 If @code{fill-column} were the first or only element of a list, the
1758 Lisp interpreter would attempt to find the function definition
1759 attached to it. But @code{fill-column} has no function definition.
1760 Try evaluating this:
1761
1762 @smallexample
1763 (fill-column)
1764 @end smallexample
1765
1766 @need 1250
1767 @noindent
1768 You will create a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer that says:
1769
1770 @smallexample
1771 @group
1772 ---------- Buffer: *Backtrace* ----------
1773 Debugger entered--Lisp error: (void-function fill-column)
1774 (fill-column)
1775 eval((fill-column))
1776 eval-last-sexp-1(nil)
1777 eval-last-sexp(nil)
1778 call-interactively(eval-last-sexp)
1779 ---------- Buffer: *Backtrace* ----------
1780 @end group
1781 @end smallexample
1782
1783 @noindent
1784 (Remember, to quit the debugger and make the debugger window go away,
1785 type @kbd{q} in the @file{*Backtrace*} buffer.)
1786
1787 @ignore
1788 @need 800
1789 In GNU Emacs 20 and before, you will produce an error message that says:
1790
1791 @smallexample
1792 Symbol's function definition is void:@: fill-column
1793 @end smallexample
1794
1795 @noindent
1796 (The message will go away as soon as you move the cursor or type
1797 another key.)
1798 @end ignore
1799
1800 @node Void Variable
1801 @subsection Error Message for a Symbol Without a Value
1802 @cindex Symbol without value error
1803 @cindex Error for symbol without value
1804
1805 If you attempt to evaluate a symbol that does not have a value bound to
1806 it, you will receive an error message. You can see this by
1807 experimenting with our 2 plus 2 addition. In the following expression,
1808 put your cursor right after the @code{+}, before the first number 2,
1809 type @kbd{C-x C-e}:
1810
1811 @smallexample
1812 (+ 2 2)
1813 @end smallexample
1814
1815 @need 1500
1816 @noindent
1817 In GNU Emacs 22, you will create a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer that
1818 says:
1819
1820 @smallexample
1821 @group
1822 ---------- Buffer: *Backtrace* ----------
1823 Debugger entered--Lisp error: (void-variable +)
1824 eval(+)
1825 eval-last-sexp-1(nil)
1826 eval-last-sexp(nil)
1827 call-interactively(eval-last-sexp)
1828 ---------- Buffer: *Backtrace* ----------
1829 @end group
1830 @end smallexample
1831
1832 @noindent
1833 (Again, you can quit the debugger by
1834 typing @kbd{q} in the @file{*Backtrace*} buffer.)
1835
1836 This backtrace is different from the very first error message we saw,
1837 which said, @samp{Debugger entered--Lisp error: (void-function this)}.
1838 In this case, the function does not have a value as a variable; while
1839 in the other error message, the function (the word `this') did not
1840 have a definition.
1841
1842 In this experiment with the @code{+}, what we did was cause the Lisp
1843 interpreter to evaluate the @code{+} and look for the value of the
1844 variable instead of the function definition. We did this by placing the
1845 cursor right after the symbol rather than after the parenthesis of the
1846 enclosing list as we did before. As a consequence, the Lisp interpreter
1847 evaluated the preceding s-expression, which in this case was
1848 @code{+} by itself.
1849
1850 Since @code{+} does not have a value bound to it, just the function
1851 definition, the error message reported that the symbol's value as a
1852 variable was void.
1853
1854 @ignore
1855 @need 800
1856 In GNU Emacs version 20 and before, your error message will say:
1857
1858 @example
1859 Symbol's value as variable is void:@: +
1860 @end example
1861
1862 @noindent
1863 The meaning is the same as in GNU Emacs 22.
1864 @end ignore
1865
1866 @node Arguments
1867 @section Arguments
1868 @cindex Arguments
1869 @cindex Passing information to functions
1870
1871 To see how information is passed to functions, let's look again at
1872 our old standby, the addition of two plus two. In Lisp, this is written
1873 as follows:
1874
1875 @smallexample
1876 (+ 2 2)
1877 @end smallexample
1878
1879 If you evaluate this expression, the number 4 will appear in your echo
1880 area. What the Lisp interpreter does is add the numbers that follow
1881 the @code{+}.
1882
1883 @cindex @samp{argument} defined
1884 The numbers added by @code{+} are called the @dfn{arguments} of the
1885 function @code{+}. These numbers are the information that is given to
1886 or @dfn{passed} to the function.
1887
1888 The word `argument' comes from the way it is used in mathematics and
1889 does not refer to a disputation between two people; instead it refers to
1890 the information presented to the function, in this case, to the
1891 @code{+}. In Lisp, the arguments to a function are the atoms or lists
1892 that follow the function. The values returned by the evaluation of
1893 these atoms or lists are passed to the function. Different functions
1894 require different numbers of arguments; some functions require none at
1895 all.@footnote{It is curious to track the path by which the word `argument'
1896 came to have two different meanings, one in mathematics and the other in
1897 everyday English. According to the @cite{Oxford English Dictionary},
1898 the word derives from the Latin for @samp{to make clear, prove}; thus it
1899 came to mean, by one thread of derivation, `the evidence offered as
1900 proof', which is to say, `the information offered', which led to its
1901 meaning in Lisp. But in the other thread of derivation, it came to mean
1902 `to assert in a manner against which others may make counter
1903 assertions', which led to the meaning of the word as a disputation.
1904 (Note here that the English word has two different definitions attached
1905 to it at the same time. By contrast, in Emacs Lisp, a symbol cannot
1906 have two different function definitions at the same time.)}
1907
1908 @menu
1909 * Data types:: Types of data passed to a function.
1910 * Args as Variable or List:: An argument can be the value
1911 of a variable or list.
1912 * Variable Number of Arguments:: Some functions may take a
1913 variable number of arguments.
1914 * Wrong Type of Argument:: Passing an argument of the wrong type
1915 to a function.
1916 * message:: A useful function for sending messages.
1917 @end menu
1918
1919 @node Data types
1920 @subsection Arguments' Data Types
1921 @cindex Data types
1922 @cindex Types of data
1923 @cindex Arguments' data types
1924
1925 The type of data that should be passed to a function depends on what
1926 kind of information it uses. The arguments to a function such as
1927 @code{+} must have values that are numbers, since @code{+} adds numbers.
1928 Other functions use different kinds of data for their arguments.
1929
1930 @need 1250
1931 @findex concat
1932 For example, the @code{concat} function links together or unites two or
1933 more strings of text to produce a string. The arguments are strings.
1934 Concatenating the two character strings @code{abc}, @code{def} produces
1935 the single string @code{abcdef}. This can be seen by evaluating the
1936 following:
1937
1938 @smallexample
1939 (concat "abc" "def")
1940 @end smallexample
1941
1942 @noindent
1943 The value produced by evaluating this expression is @code{"abcdef"}.
1944
1945 A function such as @code{substring} uses both a string and numbers as
1946 arguments. The function returns a part of the string, a substring of
1947 the first argument. This function takes three arguments. Its first
1948 argument is the string of characters, the second and third arguments are
1949 numbers that indicate the beginning and end of the substring. The
1950 numbers are a count of the number of characters (including spaces and
1951 punctuation) from the beginning of the string.
1952
1953 @need 800
1954 For example, if you evaluate the following:
1955
1956 @smallexample
1957 (substring "The quick brown fox jumped." 16 19)
1958 @end smallexample
1959
1960 @noindent
1961 you will see @code{"fox"} appear in the echo area. The arguments are the
1962 string and the two numbers.
1963
1964 Note that the string passed to @code{substring} is a single atom even
1965 though it is made up of several words separated by spaces. Lisp counts
1966 everything between the two quotation marks as part of the string,
1967 including the spaces. You can think of the @code{substring} function as
1968 a kind of `atom smasher' since it takes an otherwise indivisible atom
1969 and extracts a part. However, @code{substring} is only able to extract
1970 a substring from an argument that is a string, not from another type of
1971 atom such as a number or symbol.
1972
1973 @node Args as Variable or List
1974 @subsection An Argument as the Value of a Variable or List
1975
1976 An argument can be a symbol that returns a value when it is evaluated.
1977 For example, when the symbol @code{fill-column} by itself is evaluated,
1978 it returns a number. This number can be used in an addition.
1979
1980 @need 1250
1981 Position the cursor after the following expression and type @kbd{C-x
1982 C-e}:
1983
1984 @smallexample
1985 (+ 2 fill-column)
1986 @end smallexample
1987
1988 @noindent
1989 The value will be a number two more than what you get by evaluating
1990 @code{fill-column} alone. For me, this is 74, because my value of
1991 @code{fill-column} is 72.
1992
1993 As we have just seen, an argument can be a symbol that returns a value
1994 when evaluated. In addition, an argument can be a list that returns a
1995 value when it is evaluated. For example, in the following expression,
1996 the arguments to the function @code{concat} are the strings
1997 @w{@code{"The "}} and @w{@code{" red foxes."}} and the list
1998 @code{(number-to-string (+ 2 fill-column))}.
1999
2000 @c For GNU Emacs 22, need number-to-string
2001 @smallexample
2002 (concat "The " (number-to-string (+ 2 fill-column)) " red foxes.")
2003 @end smallexample
2004
2005 @noindent
2006 If you evaluate this expression---and if, as with my Emacs,
2007 @code{fill-column} evaluates to 72---@code{"The 74 red foxes."} will
2008 appear in the echo area. (Note that you must put spaces after the
2009 word @samp{The} and before the word @samp{red} so they will appear in
2010 the final string. The function @code{number-to-string} converts the
2011 integer that the addition function returns to a string.
2012 @code{number-to-string} is also known as @code{int-to-string}.)
2013
2014 @node Variable Number of Arguments
2015 @subsection Variable Number of Arguments
2016 @cindex Variable number of arguments
2017 @cindex Arguments, variable number of
2018
2019 Some functions, such as @code{concat}, @code{+} or @code{*}, take any
2020 number of arguments. (The @code{*} is the symbol for multiplication.)
2021 This can be seen by evaluating each of the following expressions in
2022 the usual way. What you will see in the echo area is printed in this
2023 text after @samp{@result{}}, which you may read as `evaluates to'.
2024
2025 @need 1250
2026 In the first set, the functions have no arguments:
2027
2028 @smallexample
2029 @group
2030 (+) @result{} 0
2031
2032 (*) @result{} 1
2033 @end group
2034 @end smallexample
2035
2036 @need 1250
2037 In this set, the functions have one argument each:
2038
2039 @smallexample
2040 @group
2041 (+ 3) @result{} 3
2042
2043 (* 3) @result{} 3
2044 @end group
2045 @end smallexample
2046
2047 @need 1250
2048 In this set, the functions have three arguments each:
2049
2050 @smallexample
2051 @group
2052 (+ 3 4 5) @result{} 12
2053
2054 (* 3 4 5) @result{} 60
2055 @end group
2056 @end smallexample
2057
2058 @node Wrong Type of Argument
2059 @subsection Using the Wrong Type Object as an Argument
2060 @cindex Wrong type of argument
2061 @cindex Argument, wrong type of
2062
2063 When a function is passed an argument of the wrong type, the Lisp
2064 interpreter produces an error message. For example, the @code{+}
2065 function expects the values of its arguments to be numbers. As an
2066 experiment we can pass it the quoted symbol @code{hello} instead of a
2067 number. Position the cursor after the following expression and type
2068 @kbd{C-x C-e}:
2069
2070 @smallexample
2071 (+ 2 'hello)
2072 @end smallexample
2073
2074 @noindent
2075 When you do this you will generate an error message. What has happened
2076 is that @code{+} has tried to add the 2 to the value returned by
2077 @code{'hello}, but the value returned by @code{'hello} is the symbol
2078 @code{hello}, not a number. Only numbers can be added. So @code{+}
2079 could not carry out its addition.
2080
2081 @need 1250
2082 You will create and enter a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer that says:
2083
2084 @noindent
2085 @smallexample
2086 @group
2087 ---------- Buffer: *Backtrace* ----------
2088 Debugger entered--Lisp error:
2089 (wrong-type-argument number-or-marker-p hello)
2090 +(2 hello)
2091 eval((+ 2 (quote hello)))
2092 eval-last-sexp-1(nil)
2093 eval-last-sexp(nil)
2094 call-interactively(eval-last-sexp)
2095 ---------- Buffer: *Backtrace* ----------
2096 @end group
2097 @end smallexample
2098
2099 @need 1250
2100 As usual, the error message tries to be helpful and makes sense after you
2101 learn how to read it.@footnote{@code{(quote hello)} is an expansion of
2102 the abbreviation @code{'hello}.}
2103
2104 The first part of the error message is straightforward; it says
2105 @samp{wrong type argument}. Next comes the mysterious jargon word
2106 @w{@samp{number-or-marker-p}}. This word is trying to tell you what
2107 kind of argument the @code{+} expected.
2108
2109 The symbol @code{number-or-marker-p} says that the Lisp interpreter is
2110 trying to determine whether the information presented it (the value of
2111 the argument) is a number or a marker (a special object representing a
2112 buffer position). What it does is test to see whether the @code{+} is
2113 being given numbers to add. It also tests to see whether the
2114 argument is something called a marker, which is a specific feature of
2115 Emacs Lisp. (In Emacs, locations in a buffer are recorded as markers.
2116 When the mark is set with the @kbd{C-@@} or @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} command,
2117 its position is kept as a marker. The mark can be considered a
2118 number---the number of characters the location is from the beginning
2119 of the buffer.) In Emacs Lisp, @code{+} can be used to add the
2120 numeric value of marker positions as numbers.
2121
2122 The @samp{p} of @code{number-or-marker-p} is the embodiment of a
2123 practice started in the early days of Lisp programming. The @samp{p}
2124 stands for `predicate'. In the jargon used by the early Lisp
2125 researchers, a predicate refers to a function to determine whether some
2126 property is true or false. So the @samp{p} tells us that
2127 @code{number-or-marker-p} is the name of a function that determines
2128 whether it is true or false that the argument supplied is a number or
2129 a marker. Other Lisp symbols that end in @samp{p} include @code{zerop},
2130 a function that tests whether its argument has the value of zero, and
2131 @code{listp}, a function that tests whether its argument is a list.
2132
2133 Finally, the last part of the error message is the symbol @code{hello}.
2134 This is the value of the argument that was passed to @code{+}. If the
2135 addition had been passed the correct type of object, the value passed
2136 would have been a number, such as 37, rather than a symbol like
2137 @code{hello}. But then you would not have got the error message.
2138
2139 @ignore
2140 @need 1250
2141 In GNU Emacs version 20 and before, the echo area displays an error
2142 message that says:
2143
2144 @smallexample
2145 Wrong type argument:@: number-or-marker-p, hello
2146 @end smallexample
2147
2148 This says, in different words, the same as the top line of the
2149 @file{*Backtrace*} buffer.
2150 @end ignore
2151
2152 @node message
2153 @subsection The @code{message} Function
2154 @findex message
2155
2156 Like @code{+}, the @code{message} function takes a variable number of
2157 arguments. It is used to send messages to the user and is so useful
2158 that we will describe it here.
2159
2160 @need 1250
2161 A message is printed in the echo area. For example, you can print a
2162 message in your echo area by evaluating the following list:
2163
2164 @smallexample
2165 (message "This message appears in the echo area!")
2166 @end smallexample
2167
2168 The whole string between double quotation marks is a single argument
2169 and is printed @i{in toto}. (Note that in this example, the message
2170 itself will appear in the echo area within double quotes; that is
2171 because you see the value returned by the @code{message} function. In
2172 most uses of @code{message} in programs that you write, the text will
2173 be printed in the echo area as a side-effect, without the quotes.
2174 @xref{multiply-by-seven in detail, , @code{multiply-by-seven} in
2175 detail}, for an example of this.)
2176
2177 However, if there is a @samp{%s} in the quoted string of characters, the
2178 @code{message} function does not print the @samp{%s} as such, but looks
2179 to the argument that follows the string. It evaluates the second
2180 argument and prints the value at the location in the string where the
2181 @samp{%s} is.
2182
2183 @need 1250
2184 You can see this by positioning the cursor after the following
2185 expression and typing @kbd{C-x C-e}:
2186
2187 @smallexample
2188 (message "The name of this buffer is: %s." (buffer-name))
2189 @end smallexample
2190
2191 @noindent
2192 In Info, @code{"The name of this buffer is: *info*."} will appear in the
2193 echo area. The function @code{buffer-name} returns the name of the
2194 buffer as a string, which the @code{message} function inserts in place
2195 of @code{%s}.
2196
2197 To print a value as an integer, use @samp{%d} in the same way as
2198 @samp{%s}. For example, to print a message in the echo area that
2199 states the value of the @code{fill-column}, evaluate the following:
2200
2201 @smallexample
2202 (message "The value of fill-column is %d." fill-column)
2203 @end smallexample
2204
2205 @noindent
2206 On my system, when I evaluate this list, @code{"The value of
2207 fill-column is 72."} appears in my echo area@footnote{Actually, you
2208 can use @code{%s} to print a number. It is non-specific. @code{%d}
2209 prints only the part of a number left of a decimal point, and not
2210 anything that is not a number.}.
2211
2212 If there is more than one @samp{%s} in the quoted string, the value of
2213 the first argument following the quoted string is printed at the
2214 location of the first @samp{%s} and the value of the second argument is
2215 printed at the location of the second @samp{%s}, and so on.
2216
2217 @need 1250
2218 For example, if you evaluate the following,
2219
2220 @smallexample
2221 @group
2222 (message "There are %d %s in the office!"
2223 (- fill-column 14) "pink elephants")
2224 @end group
2225 @end smallexample
2226
2227 @noindent
2228 a rather whimsical message will appear in your echo area. On my system
2229 it says, @code{"There are 58 pink elephants in the office!"}.
2230
2231 The expression @code{(- fill-column 14)} is evaluated and the resulting
2232 number is inserted in place of the @samp{%d}; and the string in double
2233 quotes, @code{"pink elephants"}, is treated as a single argument and
2234 inserted in place of the @samp{%s}. (That is to say, a string between
2235 double quotes evaluates to itself, like a number.)
2236
2237 Finally, here is a somewhat complex example that not only illustrates
2238 the computation of a number, but also shows how you can use an
2239 expression within an expression to generate the text that is substituted
2240 for @samp{%s}:
2241
2242 @smallexample
2243 @group
2244 (message "He saw %d %s"
2245 (- fill-column 32)
2246 (concat "red "
2247 (substring
2248 "The quick brown foxes jumped." 16 21)
2249 " leaping."))
2250 @end group
2251 @end smallexample
2252
2253 In this example, @code{message} has three arguments: the string,
2254 @code{"He saw %d %s"}, the expression, @code{(- fill-column 32)}, and
2255 the expression beginning with the function @code{concat}. The value
2256 resulting from the evaluation of @code{(- fill-column 32)} is inserted
2257 in place of the @samp{%d}; and the value returned by the expression
2258 beginning with @code{concat} is inserted in place of the @samp{%s}.
2259
2260 When your fill column is 70 and you evaluate the expression, the
2261 message @code{"He saw 38 red foxes leaping."} appears in your echo
2262 area.
2263
2264 @node set & setq
2265 @section Setting the Value of a Variable
2266 @cindex Variable, setting value
2267 @cindex Setting value of variable
2268
2269 @cindex @samp{bind} defined
2270 There are several ways by which a variable can be given a value. One of
2271 the ways is to use either the function @code{set} or the function
2272 @code{setq}. Another way is to use @code{let} (@pxref{let}). (The
2273 jargon for this process is to @dfn{bind} a variable to a value.)
2274
2275 The following sections not only describe how @code{set} and @code{setq}
2276 work but also illustrate how arguments are passed.
2277
2278 @menu
2279 * Using set:: Setting values.
2280 * Using setq:: Setting a quoted value.
2281 * Counting:: Using @code{setq} to count.
2282 @end menu
2283
2284 @node Using set
2285 @subsection Using @code{set}
2286 @findex set
2287
2288 To set the value of the symbol @code{flowers} to the list @code{'(rose
2289 violet daisy buttercup)}, evaluate the following expression by
2290 positioning the cursor after the expression and typing @kbd{C-x C-e}.
2291
2292 @smallexample
2293 (set 'flowers '(rose violet daisy buttercup))
2294 @end smallexample
2295
2296 @noindent
2297 The list @code{(rose violet daisy buttercup)} will appear in the echo
2298 area. This is what is @emph{returned} by the @code{set} function. As a
2299 side effect, the symbol @code{flowers} is bound to the list; that is,
2300 the symbol @code{flowers}, which can be viewed as a variable, is given
2301 the list as its value. (This process, by the way, illustrates how a
2302 side effect to the Lisp interpreter, setting the value, can be the
2303 primary effect that we humans are interested in. This is because every
2304 Lisp function must return a value if it does not get an error, but it
2305 will only have a side effect if it is designed to have one.)
2306
2307 After evaluating the @code{set} expression, you can evaluate the symbol
2308 @code{flowers} and it will return the value you just set. Here is the
2309 symbol. Place your cursor after it and type @kbd{C-x C-e}.
2310
2311 @smallexample
2312 flowers
2313 @end smallexample
2314
2315 @noindent
2316 When you evaluate @code{flowers}, the list
2317 @code{(rose violet daisy buttercup)} appears in the echo area.
2318
2319 Incidentally, if you evaluate @code{'flowers}, the variable with a quote
2320 in front of it, what you will see in the echo area is the symbol itself,
2321 @code{flowers}. Here is the quoted symbol, so you can try this:
2322
2323 @smallexample
2324 'flowers
2325 @end smallexample
2326
2327 Note also, that when you use @code{set}, you need to quote both
2328 arguments to @code{set}, unless you want them evaluated. Since we do
2329 not want either argument evaluated, neither the variable
2330 @code{flowers} nor the list @code{(rose violet daisy buttercup)}, both
2331 are quoted. (When you use @code{set} without quoting its first
2332 argument, the first argument is evaluated before anything else is
2333 done. If you did this and @code{flowers} did not have a value
2334 already, you would get an error message that the @samp{Symbol's value
2335 as variable is void}; on the other hand, if @code{flowers} did return
2336 a value after it was evaluated, the @code{set} would attempt to set
2337 the value that was returned. There are situations where this is the
2338 right thing for the function to do; but such situations are rare.)
2339
2340 @node Using setq
2341 @subsection Using @code{setq}
2342 @findex setq
2343
2344 As a practical matter, you almost always quote the first argument to
2345 @code{set}. The combination of @code{set} and a quoted first argument
2346 is so common that it has its own name: the special form @code{setq}.
2347 This special form is just like @code{set} except that the first argument
2348 is quoted automatically, so you don't need to type the quote mark
2349 yourself. Also, as an added convenience, @code{setq} permits you to set
2350 several different variables to different values, all in one expression.
2351
2352 To set the value of the variable @code{carnivores} to the list
2353 @code{'(lion tiger leopard)} using @code{setq}, the following expression
2354 is used:
2355
2356 @smallexample
2357 (setq carnivores '(lion tiger leopard))
2358 @end smallexample
2359
2360 @noindent
2361 This is exactly the same as using @code{set} except the first argument
2362 is automatically quoted by @code{setq}. (The @samp{q} in @code{setq}
2363 means @code{quote}.)
2364
2365 @need 1250
2366 With @code{set}, the expression would look like this:
2367
2368 @smallexample
2369 (set 'carnivores '(lion tiger leopard))
2370 @end smallexample
2371
2372 Also, @code{setq} can be used to assign different values to
2373 different variables. The first argument is bound to the value
2374 of the second argument, the third argument is bound to the value of the
2375 fourth argument, and so on. For example, you could use the following to
2376 assign a list of trees to the symbol @code{trees} and a list of herbivores
2377 to the symbol @code{herbivores}:
2378
2379 @smallexample
2380 @group
2381 (setq trees '(pine fir oak maple)
2382 herbivores '(gazelle antelope zebra))
2383 @end group
2384 @end smallexample
2385
2386 @noindent
2387 (The expression could just as well have been on one line, but it might
2388 not have fit on a page; and humans find it easier to read nicely
2389 formatted lists.)
2390
2391 Although I have been using the term `assign', there is another way of
2392 thinking about the workings of @code{set} and @code{setq}; and that is to
2393 say that @code{set} and @code{setq} make the symbol @emph{point} to the
2394 list. This latter way of thinking is very common and in forthcoming
2395 chapters we shall come upon at least one symbol that has `pointer' as
2396 part of its name. The name is chosen because the symbol has a value,
2397 specifically a list, attached to it; or, expressed another way,
2398 the symbol is set to ``point'' to the list.
2399
2400 @node Counting
2401 @subsection Counting
2402 @cindex Counting
2403
2404 Here is an example that shows how to use @code{setq} in a counter. You
2405 might use this to count how many times a part of your program repeats
2406 itself. First set a variable to zero; then add one to the number each
2407 time the program repeats itself. To do this, you need a variable that
2408 serves as a counter, and two expressions: an initial @code{setq}
2409 expression that sets the counter variable to zero; and a second
2410 @code{setq} expression that increments the counter each time it is
2411 evaluated.
2412
2413 @smallexample
2414 @group
2415 (setq counter 0) ; @r{Let's call this the initializer.}
2416
2417 (setq counter (+ counter 1)) ; @r{This is the incrementer.}
2418
2419 counter ; @r{This is the counter.}
2420 @end group
2421 @end smallexample
2422
2423 @noindent
2424 (The text following the @samp{;} are comments. @xref{Change a
2425 defun, , Change a Function Definition}.)
2426
2427 If you evaluate the first of these expressions, the initializer,
2428 @code{(setq counter 0)}, and then evaluate the third expression,
2429 @code{counter}, the number @code{0} will appear in the echo area. If
2430 you then evaluate the second expression, the incrementer, @code{(setq
2431 counter (+ counter 1))}, the counter will get the value 1. So if you
2432 again evaluate @code{counter}, the number @code{1} will appear in the
2433 echo area. Each time you evaluate the second expression, the value of
2434 the counter will be incremented.
2435
2436 When you evaluate the incrementer, @code{(setq counter (+ counter 1))},
2437 the Lisp interpreter first evaluates the innermost list; this is the
2438 addition. In order to evaluate this list, it must evaluate the variable
2439 @code{counter} and the number @code{1}. When it evaluates the variable
2440 @code{counter}, it receives its current value. It passes this value and
2441 the number @code{1} to the @code{+} which adds them together. The sum
2442 is then returned as the value of the inner list and passed to the
2443 @code{setq} which sets the variable @code{counter} to this new value.
2444 Thus, the value of the variable, @code{counter}, is changed.
2445
2446 @node Summary
2447 @section Summary
2448
2449 Learning Lisp is like climbing a hill in which the first part is the
2450 steepest. You have now climbed the most difficult part; what remains
2451 becomes easier as you progress onwards.
2452
2453 @need 1000
2454 In summary,
2455
2456 @itemize @bullet
2457
2458 @item
2459 Lisp programs are made up of expressions, which are lists or single atoms.
2460
2461 @item
2462 Lists are made up of zero or more atoms or inner lists, separated by whitespace and
2463 surrounded by parentheses. A list can be empty.
2464
2465 @item
2466 Atoms are multi-character symbols, like @code{forward-paragraph}, single
2467 character symbols like @code{+}, strings of characters between double
2468 quotation marks, or numbers.
2469
2470 @item
2471 A number evaluates to itself.
2472
2473 @item
2474 A string between double quotes also evaluates to itself.
2475
2476 @item
2477 When you evaluate a symbol by itself, its value is returned.
2478
2479 @item
2480 When you evaluate a list, the Lisp interpreter looks at the first symbol
2481 in the list and then at the function definition bound to that symbol.
2482 Then the instructions in the function definition are carried out.
2483
2484 @item
2485 A single quotation mark,
2486 @ifinfo
2487 '
2488 @end ifinfo
2489 @ifnotinfo
2490 @code{'}
2491 @end ifnotinfo
2492 , tells the Lisp interpreter that it should
2493 return the following expression as written, and not evaluate it as it
2494 would if the quote were not there.
2495
2496 @item
2497 Arguments are the information passed to a function. The arguments to a
2498 function are computed by evaluating the rest of the elements of the list
2499 of which the function is the first element.
2500
2501 @item
2502 A function always returns a value when it is evaluated (unless it gets
2503 an error); in addition, it may also carry out some action called a
2504 ``side effect''. In many cases, a function's primary purpose is to
2505 create a side effect.
2506 @end itemize
2507
2508 @node Error Message Exercises
2509 @section Exercises
2510
2511 A few simple exercises:
2512
2513 @itemize @bullet
2514 @item
2515 Generate an error message by evaluating an appropriate symbol that is
2516 not within parentheses.
2517
2518 @item
2519 Generate an error message by evaluating an appropriate symbol that is
2520 between parentheses.
2521
2522 @item
2523 Create a counter that increments by two rather than one.
2524
2525 @item
2526 Write an expression that prints a message in the echo area when
2527 evaluated.
2528 @end itemize
2529
2530 @node Practicing Evaluation
2531 @chapter Practicing Evaluation
2532 @cindex Practicing evaluation
2533 @cindex Evaluation practice
2534
2535 Before learning how to write a function definition in Emacs Lisp, it is
2536 useful to spend a little time evaluating various expressions that have
2537 already been written. These expressions will be lists with the
2538 functions as their first (and often only) element. Since some of the
2539 functions associated with buffers are both simple and interesting, we
2540 will start with those. In this section, we will evaluate a few of
2541 these. In another section, we will study the code of several other
2542 buffer-related functions, to see how they were written.
2543
2544 @menu
2545 * How to Evaluate:: Typing editing commands or @kbd{C-x C-e}
2546 causes evaluation.
2547 * Buffer Names:: Buffers and files are different.
2548 * Getting Buffers:: Getting a buffer itself, not merely its name.
2549 * Switching Buffers:: How to change to another buffer.
2550 * Buffer Size & Locations:: Where point is located and the size of
2551 the buffer.
2552 * Evaluation Exercise::
2553 @end menu
2554
2555 @ifnottex
2556 @node How to Evaluate
2557 @unnumberedsec How to Evaluate
2558 @end ifnottex
2559
2560 @i{Whenever you give an editing command} to Emacs Lisp, such as the
2561 command to move the cursor or to scroll the screen, @i{you are evaluating
2562 an expression,} the first element of which is a function. @i{This is
2563 how Emacs works.}
2564
2565 @cindex @samp{interactive function} defined
2566 @cindex @samp{command} defined
2567 When you type keys, you cause the Lisp interpreter to evaluate an
2568 expression and that is how you get your results. Even typing plain text
2569 involves evaluating an Emacs Lisp function, in this case, one that uses
2570 @code{self-insert-command}, which simply inserts the character you
2571 typed. The functions you evaluate by typing keystrokes are called
2572 @dfn{interactive} functions, or @dfn{commands}; how you make a function
2573 interactive will be illustrated in the chapter on how to write function
2574 definitions. @xref{Interactive, , Making a Function Interactive}.
2575
2576 In addition to typing keyboard commands, we have seen a second way to
2577 evaluate an expression: by positioning the cursor after a list and
2578 typing @kbd{C-x C-e}. This is what we will do in the rest of this
2579 section. There are other ways to evaluate an expression as well; these
2580 will be described as we come to them.
2581
2582 Besides being used for practicing evaluation, the functions shown in the
2583 next few sections are important in their own right. A study of these
2584 functions makes clear the distinction between buffers and files, how to
2585 switch to a buffer, and how to determine a location within it.
2586
2587 @node Buffer Names
2588 @section Buffer Names
2589 @findex buffer-name
2590 @findex buffer-file-name
2591
2592 The two functions, @code{buffer-name} and @code{buffer-file-name}, show
2593 the difference between a file and a buffer. When you evaluate the
2594 following expression, @code{(buffer-name)}, the name of the buffer
2595 appears in the echo area. When you evaluate @code{(buffer-file-name)},
2596 the name of the file to which the buffer refers appears in the echo
2597 area. Usually, the name returned by @code{(buffer-name)} is the same as
2598 the name of the file to which it refers, and the name returned by
2599 @code{(buffer-file-name)} is the full path-name of the file.
2600
2601 A file and a buffer are two different entities. A file is information
2602 recorded permanently in the computer (unless you delete it). A buffer,
2603 on the other hand, is information inside of Emacs that will vanish at
2604 the end of the editing session (or when you kill the buffer). Usually,
2605 a buffer contains information that you have copied from a file; we say
2606 the buffer is @dfn{visiting} that file. This copy is what you work on
2607 and modify. Changes to the buffer do not change the file, until you
2608 save the buffer. When you save the buffer, the buffer is copied to the file
2609 and is thus saved permanently.
2610
2611 @need 1250
2612 If you are reading this in Info inside of GNU Emacs, you can evaluate
2613 each of the following expressions by positioning the cursor after it and
2614 typing @kbd{C-x C-e}.
2615
2616 @example
2617 @group
2618 (buffer-name)
2619
2620 (buffer-file-name)
2621 @end group
2622 @end example
2623
2624 @noindent
2625 When I do this in Info, the value returned by evaluating
2626 @code{(buffer-name)} is @file{"*info*"}, and the value returned by
2627 evaluating @code{(buffer-file-name)} is @file{nil}.
2628
2629 On the other hand, while I am writing this document, the value
2630 returned by evaluating @code{(buffer-name)} is
2631 @file{"introduction.texinfo"}, and the value returned by evaluating
2632 @code{(buffer-file-name)} is
2633 @file{"/gnu/work/intro/introduction.texinfo"}.
2634
2635 @cindex @code{nil}, history of word
2636 The former is the name of the buffer and the latter is the name of the
2637 file. In Info, the buffer name is @file{"*info*"}. Info does not
2638 point to any file, so the result of evaluating
2639 @code{(buffer-file-name)} is @file{nil}. The symbol @code{nil} is
2640 from the Latin word for `nothing'; in this case, it means that the
2641 buffer is not associated with any file. (In Lisp, @code{nil} is also
2642 used to mean `false' and is a synonym for the empty list, @code{()}.)
2643
2644 When I am writing, the name of my buffer is
2645 @file{"introduction.texinfo"}. The name of the file to which it
2646 points is @file{"/gnu/work/intro/introduction.texinfo"}.
2647
2648 (In the expressions, the parentheses tell the Lisp interpreter to
2649 treat @w{@code{buffer-name}} and @w{@code{buffer-file-name}} as
2650 functions; without the parentheses, the interpreter would attempt to
2651 evaluate the symbols as variables. @xref{Variables}.)
2652
2653 In spite of the distinction between files and buffers, you will often
2654 find that people refer to a file when they mean a buffer and vice-verse.
2655 Indeed, most people say, ``I am editing a file,'' rather than saying,
2656 ``I am editing a buffer which I will soon save to a file.'' It is
2657 almost always clear from context what people mean. When dealing with
2658 computer programs, however, it is important to keep the distinction in mind,
2659 since the computer is not as smart as a person.
2660
2661 @cindex Buffer, history of word
2662 The word `buffer', by the way, comes from the meaning of the word as a
2663 cushion that deadens the force of a collision. In early computers, a
2664 buffer cushioned the interaction between files and the computer's
2665 central processing unit. The drums or tapes that held a file and the
2666 central processing unit were pieces of equipment that were very
2667 different from each other, working at their own speeds, in spurts. The
2668 buffer made it possible for them to work together effectively.
2669 Eventually, the buffer grew from being an intermediary, a temporary
2670 holding place, to being the place where work is done. This
2671 transformation is rather like that of a small seaport that grew into a
2672 great city: once it was merely the place where cargo was warehoused
2673 temporarily before being loaded onto ships; then it became a business
2674 and cultural center in its own right.
2675
2676 Not all buffers are associated with files. For example, a
2677 @file{*scratch*} buffer does not visit any file. Similarly, a
2678 @file{*Help*} buffer is not associated with any file.
2679
2680 In the old days, when you lacked a @file{~/.emacs} file and started an
2681 Emacs session by typing the command @code{emacs} alone, without naming
2682 any files, Emacs started with the @file{*scratch*} buffer visible.
2683 Nowadays, you will see a splash screen. You can follow one of the
2684 commands suggested on the splash screen, visit a file, or press the
2685 spacebar to reach the @file{*scratch*} buffer.
2686
2687 If you switch to the @file{*scratch*} buffer, type
2688 @code{(buffer-name)}, position the cursor after it, and then type
2689 @kbd{C-x C-e} to evaluate the expression. The name @code{"*scratch*"}
2690 will be returned and will appear in the echo area. @code{"*scratch*"}
2691 is the name of the buffer. When you type @code{(buffer-file-name)} in
2692 the @file{*scratch*} buffer and evaluate that, @code{nil} will appear
2693 in the echo area, just as it does when you evaluate
2694 @code{(buffer-file-name)} in Info.
2695
2696 Incidentally, if you are in the @file{*scratch*} buffer and want the
2697 value returned by an expression to appear in the @file{*scratch*}
2698 buffer itself rather than in the echo area, type @kbd{C-u C-x C-e}
2699 instead of @kbd{C-x C-e}. This causes the value returned to appear
2700 after the expression. The buffer will look like this:
2701
2702 @smallexample
2703 (buffer-name)"*scratch*"
2704 @end smallexample
2705
2706 @noindent
2707 You cannot do this in Info since Info is read-only and it will not allow
2708 you to change the contents of the buffer. But you can do this in any
2709 buffer you can edit; and when you write code or documentation (such as
2710 this book), this feature is very useful.
2711
2712 @node Getting Buffers
2713 @section Getting Buffers
2714 @findex current-buffer
2715 @findex other-buffer
2716 @cindex Getting a buffer
2717
2718 The @code{buffer-name} function returns the @emph{name} of the buffer;
2719 to get the buffer @emph{itself}, a different function is needed: the
2720 @code{current-buffer} function. If you use this function in code, what
2721 you get is the buffer itself.
2722
2723 A name and the object or entity to which the name refers are different
2724 from each other. You are not your name. You are a person to whom
2725 others refer by name. If you ask to speak to George and someone hands you
2726 a card with the letters @samp{G}, @samp{e}, @samp{o}, @samp{r},
2727 @samp{g}, and @samp{e} written on it, you might be amused, but you would
2728 not be satisfied. You do not want to speak to the name, but to the
2729 person to whom the name refers. A buffer is similar: the name of the
2730 scratch buffer is @file{*scratch*}, but the name is not the buffer. To
2731 get a buffer itself, you need to use a function such as
2732 @code{current-buffer}.
2733
2734 However, there is a slight complication: if you evaluate
2735 @code{current-buffer} in an expression on its own, as we will do here,
2736 what you see is a printed representation of the name of the buffer
2737 without the contents of the buffer. Emacs works this way for two
2738 reasons: the buffer may be thousands of lines long---too long to be
2739 conveniently displayed; and, another buffer may have the same contents
2740 but a different name, and it is important to distinguish between them.
2741
2742 @need 800
2743 Here is an expression containing the function:
2744
2745 @smallexample
2746 (current-buffer)
2747 @end smallexample
2748
2749 @noindent
2750 If you evaluate this expression in Info in Emacs in the usual way,
2751 @file{#<buffer *info*>} will appear in the echo area. The special
2752 format indicates that the buffer itself is being returned, rather than
2753 just its name.
2754
2755 Incidentally, while you can type a number or symbol into a program, you
2756 cannot do that with the printed representation of a buffer: the only way
2757 to get a buffer itself is with a function such as @code{current-buffer}.
2758
2759 A related function is @code{other-buffer}. This returns the most
2760 recently selected buffer other than the one you are in currently, not
2761 a printed representation of its name. If you have recently switched
2762 back and forth from the @file{*scratch*} buffer, @code{other-buffer}
2763 will return that buffer.
2764
2765 @need 800
2766 You can see this by evaluating the expression:
2767
2768 @smallexample
2769 (other-buffer)
2770 @end smallexample
2771
2772 @noindent
2773 You should see @file{#<buffer *scratch*>} appear in the echo area, or
2774 the name of whatever other buffer you switched back from most
2775 recently@footnote{Actually, by default, if the buffer from which you
2776 just switched is visible to you in another window, @code{other-buffer}
2777 will choose the most recent buffer that you cannot see; this is a
2778 subtlety that I often forget.}.
2779
2780 @node Switching Buffers
2781 @section Switching Buffers
2782 @findex switch-to-buffer
2783 @findex set-buffer
2784 @cindex Switching to a buffer
2785
2786 The @code{other-buffer} function actually provides a buffer when it is
2787 used as an argument to a function that requires one. We can see this
2788 by using @code{other-buffer} and @code{switch-to-buffer} to switch to a
2789 different buffer.
2790
2791 But first, a brief introduction to the @code{switch-to-buffer}
2792 function. When you switched back and forth from Info to the
2793 @file{*scratch*} buffer to evaluate @code{(buffer-name)}, you most
2794 likely typed @kbd{C-x b} and then typed @file{*scratch*}@footnote{Or
2795 rather, to save typing, you probably only typed @kbd{RET} if the
2796 default buffer was @file{*scratch*}, or if it was different, then you
2797 typed just part of the name, such as @code{*sc}, pressed your
2798 @kbd{TAB} key to cause it to expand to the full name, and then typed
2799 @kbd{RET}.} when prompted in the minibuffer for the name of
2800 the buffer to which you wanted to switch. The keystrokes, @kbd{C-x
2801 b}, cause the Lisp interpreter to evaluate the interactive function
2802 @code{switch-to-buffer}. As we said before, this is how Emacs works:
2803 different keystrokes call or run different functions. For example,
2804 @kbd{C-f} calls @code{forward-char}, @kbd{M-e} calls
2805 @code{forward-sentence}, and so on.
2806
2807 By writing @code{switch-to-buffer} in an expression, and giving it a
2808 buffer to switch to, we can switch buffers just the way @kbd{C-x b}
2809 does:
2810
2811 @smallexample
2812 (switch-to-buffer (other-buffer))
2813 @end smallexample
2814
2815 @noindent
2816 The symbol @code{switch-to-buffer} is the first element of the list,
2817 so the Lisp interpreter will treat it as a function and carry out the
2818 instructions that are attached to it. But before doing that, the
2819 interpreter will note that @code{other-buffer} is inside parentheses
2820 and work on that symbol first. @code{other-buffer} is the first (and
2821 in this case, the only) element of this list, so the Lisp interpreter
2822 calls or runs the function. It returns another buffer. Next, the
2823 interpreter runs @code{switch-to-buffer}, passing to it, as an
2824 argument, the other buffer, which is what Emacs will switch to. If
2825 you are reading this in Info, try this now. Evaluate the expression.
2826 (To get back, type @kbd{C-x b @key{RET}}.)@footnote{Remember, this
2827 expression will move you to your most recent other buffer that you
2828 cannot see. If you really want to go to your most recently selected
2829 buffer, even if you can still see it, you need to evaluate the
2830 following more complex expression:
2831
2832 @smallexample
2833 (switch-to-buffer (other-buffer (current-buffer) t))
2834 @end smallexample
2835
2836 @c noindent
2837 In this case, the first argument to @code{other-buffer} tells it which
2838 buffer to skip---the current one---and the second argument tells
2839 @code{other-buffer} it is OK to switch to a visible buffer.
2840 In regular use, @code{switch-to-buffer} takes you to an invisible
2841 window since you would most likely use @kbd{C-x o} (@code{other-window})
2842 to go to another visible buffer.}
2843
2844 In the programming examples in later sections of this document, you will
2845 see the function @code{set-buffer} more often than
2846 @code{switch-to-buffer}. This is because of a difference between
2847 computer programs and humans: humans have eyes and expect to see the
2848 buffer on which they are working on their computer terminals. This is
2849 so obvious, it almost goes without saying. However, programs do not
2850 have eyes. When a computer program works on a buffer, that buffer does
2851 not need to be visible on the screen.
2852
2853 @code{switch-to-buffer} is designed for humans and does two different
2854 things: it switches the buffer to which Emacs's attention is directed; and
2855 it switches the buffer displayed in the window to the new buffer.
2856 @code{set-buffer}, on the other hand, does only one thing: it switches
2857 the attention of the computer program to a different buffer. The buffer
2858 on the screen remains unchanged (of course, normally nothing happens
2859 there until the command finishes running).
2860
2861 @cindex @samp{call} defined
2862 Also, we have just introduced another jargon term, the word @dfn{call}.
2863 When you evaluate a list in which the first symbol is a function, you
2864 are calling that function. The use of the term comes from the notion of
2865 the function as an entity that can do something for you if you `call'
2866 it---just as a plumber is an entity who can fix a leak if you call him
2867 or her.
2868
2869 @node Buffer Size & Locations
2870 @section Buffer Size and the Location of Point
2871 @cindex Size of buffer
2872 @cindex Buffer size
2873 @cindex Point location
2874 @cindex Location of point
2875
2876 Finally, let's look at several rather simple functions,
2877 @code{buffer-size}, @code{point}, @code{point-min}, and
2878 @code{point-max}. These give information about the size of a buffer and
2879 the location of point within it.
2880
2881 The function @code{buffer-size} tells you the size of the current
2882 buffer; that is, the function returns a count of the number of
2883 characters in the buffer.
2884
2885 @smallexample
2886 (buffer-size)
2887 @end smallexample
2888
2889 @noindent
2890 You can evaluate this in the usual way, by positioning the
2891 cursor after the expression and typing @kbd{C-x C-e}.
2892
2893 @cindex @samp{point} defined
2894 In Emacs, the current position of the cursor is called @dfn{point}.
2895 The expression @code{(point)} returns a number that tells you where the
2896 cursor is located as a count of the number of characters from the
2897 beginning of the buffer up to point.
2898
2899 @need 1250
2900 You can see the character count for point in this buffer by evaluating
2901 the following expression in the usual way:
2902
2903 @smallexample
2904 (point)
2905 @end smallexample
2906
2907 @noindent
2908 As I write this, the value of @code{point} is 65724. The @code{point}
2909 function is frequently used in some of the examples later in this
2910 book.
2911
2912 @need 1250
2913 The value of point depends, of course, on its location within the
2914 buffer. If you evaluate point in this spot, the number will be larger:
2915
2916 @smallexample
2917 (point)
2918 @end smallexample
2919
2920 @noindent
2921 For me, the value of point in this location is 66043, which means that
2922 there are 319 characters (including spaces) between the two
2923 expressions. (Doubtless, you will see different numbers, since I will
2924 have edited this since I first evaluated point.)
2925
2926 @cindex @samp{narrowing} defined
2927 The function @code{point-min} is somewhat similar to @code{point}, but
2928 it returns the value of the minimum permissible value of point in the
2929 current buffer. This is the number 1 unless @dfn{narrowing} is in
2930 effect. (Narrowing is a mechanism whereby you can restrict yourself,
2931 or a program, to operations on just a part of a buffer.
2932 @xref{Narrowing & Widening, , Narrowing and Widening}.) Likewise, the
2933 function @code{point-max} returns the value of the maximum permissible
2934 value of point in the current buffer.
2935
2936 @node Evaluation Exercise
2937 @section Exercise
2938
2939 Find a file with which you are working and move towards its middle.
2940 Find its buffer name, file name, length, and your position in the file.
2941
2942 @node Writing Defuns
2943 @chapter How To Write Function Definitions
2944 @cindex Definition writing
2945 @cindex Function definition writing
2946 @cindex Writing a function definition
2947
2948 When the Lisp interpreter evaluates a list, it looks to see whether the
2949 first symbol on the list has a function definition attached to it; or,
2950 put another way, whether the symbol points to a function definition. If
2951 it does, the computer carries out the instructions in the definition. A
2952 symbol that has a function definition is called, simply, a function
2953 (although, properly speaking, the definition is the function and the
2954 symbol refers to it.)
2955
2956 @menu
2957 * Primitive Functions::
2958 * defun:: The @code{defun} macro.
2959 * Install:: Install a function definition.
2960 * Interactive:: Making a function interactive.
2961 * Interactive Options:: Different options for @code{interactive}.
2962 * Permanent Installation:: Installing code permanently.
2963 * let:: Creating and initializing local variables.
2964 * if:: What if?
2965 * else:: If--then--else expressions.
2966 * Truth & Falsehood:: What Lisp considers false and true.
2967 * save-excursion:: Keeping track of point, mark, and buffer.
2968 * Review::
2969 * defun Exercises::
2970 @end menu
2971
2972 @ifnottex
2973 @node Primitive Functions
2974 @unnumberedsec An Aside about Primitive Functions
2975 @end ifnottex
2976 @cindex Primitive functions
2977 @cindex Functions, primitive
2978
2979 @cindex C language primitives
2980 @cindex Primitives written in C
2981 All functions are defined in terms of other functions, except for a few
2982 @dfn{primitive} functions that are written in the C programming
2983 language. When you write functions' definitions, you will write them in
2984 Emacs Lisp and use other functions as your building blocks. Some of the
2985 functions you will use will themselves be written in Emacs Lisp (perhaps
2986 by you) and some will be primitives written in C@. The primitive
2987 functions are used exactly like those written in Emacs Lisp and behave
2988 like them. They are written in C so we can easily run GNU Emacs on any
2989 computer that has sufficient power and can run C.
2990
2991 Let me re-emphasize this: when you write code in Emacs Lisp, you do not
2992 distinguish between the use of functions written in C and the use of
2993 functions written in Emacs Lisp. The difference is irrelevant. I
2994 mention the distinction only because it is interesting to know. Indeed,
2995 unless you investigate, you won't know whether an already-written
2996 function is written in Emacs Lisp or C.
2997
2998 @node defun
2999 @section The @code{defun} Macro
3000 @findex defun
3001
3002 @cindex @samp{function definition} defined
3003 In Lisp, a symbol such as @code{mark-whole-buffer} has code attached to
3004 it that tells the computer what to do when the function is called.
3005 This code is called the @dfn{function definition} and is created by
3006 evaluating a Lisp expression that starts with the symbol @code{defun}
3007 (which is an abbreviation for @emph{define function}).
3008
3009 In subsequent sections, we will look at function definitions from the
3010 Emacs source code, such as @code{mark-whole-buffer}. In this section,
3011 we will describe a simple function definition so you can see how it
3012 looks. This function definition uses arithmetic because it makes for a
3013 simple example. Some people dislike examples using arithmetic; however,
3014 if you are such a person, do not despair. Hardly any of the code we
3015 will study in the remainder of this introduction involves arithmetic or
3016 mathematics. The examples mostly involve text in one way or another.
3017
3018 A function definition has up to five parts following the word
3019 @code{defun}:
3020
3021 @enumerate
3022 @item
3023 The name of the symbol to which the function definition should be
3024 attached.
3025
3026 @item
3027 A list of the arguments that will be passed to the function. If no
3028 arguments will be passed to the function, this is an empty list,
3029 @code{()}.
3030
3031 @item
3032 Documentation describing the function. (Technically optional, but
3033 strongly recommended.)
3034
3035 @item
3036 Optionally, an expression to make the function interactive so you can
3037 use it by typing @kbd{M-x} and then the name of the function; or by
3038 typing an appropriate key or keychord.
3039
3040 @cindex @samp{body} defined
3041 @item
3042 The code that instructs the computer what to do: the @dfn{body} of the
3043 function definition.
3044 @end enumerate
3045
3046 It is helpful to think of the five parts of a function definition as
3047 being organized in a template, with slots for each part:
3048
3049 @smallexample
3050 @group
3051 (defun @var{function-name} (@var{arguments}@dots{})
3052 "@var{optional-documentation}@dots{}"
3053 (interactive @var{argument-passing-info}) ; @r{optional}
3054 @var{body}@dots{})
3055 @end group
3056 @end smallexample
3057
3058 As an example, here is the code for a function that multiplies its
3059 argument by 7. (This example is not interactive. @xref{Interactive,
3060 , Making a Function Interactive}, for that information.)
3061
3062 @smallexample
3063 @group
3064 (defun multiply-by-seven (number)
3065 "Multiply NUMBER by seven."
3066 (* 7 number))
3067 @end group
3068 @end smallexample
3069
3070 This definition begins with a parenthesis and the symbol @code{defun},
3071 followed by the name of the function.
3072
3073 @cindex @samp{argument list} defined
3074 The name of the function is followed by a list that contains the
3075 arguments that will be passed to the function. This list is called
3076 the @dfn{argument list}. In this example, the list has only one
3077 element, the symbol, @code{number}. When the function is used, the
3078 symbol will be bound to the value that is used as the argument to the
3079 function.
3080
3081 Instead of choosing the word @code{number} for the name of the argument,
3082 I could have picked any other name. For example, I could have chosen
3083 the word @code{multiplicand}. I picked the word `number' because it
3084 tells what kind of value is intended for this slot; but I could just as
3085 well have chosen the word `multiplicand' to indicate the role that the
3086 value placed in this slot will play in the workings of the function. I
3087 could have called it @code{foogle}, but that would have been a bad
3088 choice because it would not tell humans what it means. The choice of
3089 name is up to the programmer and should be chosen to make the meaning of
3090 the function clear.
3091
3092 Indeed, you can choose any name you wish for a symbol in an argument
3093 list, even the name of a symbol used in some other function: the name
3094 you use in an argument list is private to that particular definition.
3095 In that definition, the name refers to a different entity than any use
3096 of the same name outside the function definition. Suppose you have a
3097 nick-name `Shorty' in your family; when your family members refer to
3098 `Shorty', they mean you. But outside your family, in a movie, for
3099 example, the name `Shorty' refers to someone else. Because a name in an
3100 argument list is private to the function definition, you can change the
3101 value of such a symbol inside the body of a function without changing
3102 its value outside the function. The effect is similar to that produced
3103 by a @code{let} expression. (@xref{let, , @code{let}}.)
3104
3105 @ignore
3106 Note also that we discuss the word `number' in two different ways: as a
3107 symbol that appears in the code, and as the name of something that will
3108 be replaced by a something else during the evaluation of the function.
3109 In the first case, @code{number} is a symbol, not a number; it happens
3110 that within the function, it is a variable who value is the number in
3111 question, but our primary interest in it is as a symbol. On the other
3112 hand, when we are talking about the function, our interest is that we
3113 will substitute a number for the word @var{number}. To keep this
3114 distinction clear, we use different typography for the two
3115 circumstances. When we talk about this function, or about how it works,
3116 we refer to this number by writing @var{number}. In the function
3117 itself, we refer to it by writing @code{number}.
3118 @end ignore
3119
3120 The argument list is followed by the documentation string that
3121 describes the function. This is what you see when you type
3122 @w{@kbd{C-h f}} and the name of a function. Incidentally, when you
3123 write a documentation string like this, you should make the first line
3124 a complete sentence since some commands, such as @code{apropos}, print
3125 only the first line of a multi-line documentation string. Also, you
3126 should not indent the second line of a documentation string, if you
3127 have one, because that looks odd when you use @kbd{C-h f}
3128 (@code{describe-function}). The documentation string is optional, but
3129 it is so useful, it should be included in almost every function you
3130 write.
3131
3132 @findex * @r{(multiplication)}
3133 The third line of the example consists of the body of the function
3134 definition. (Most functions' definitions, of course, are longer than
3135 this.) In this function, the body is the list, @code{(* 7 number)}, which
3136 says to multiply the value of @var{number} by 7. (In Emacs Lisp,
3137 @code{*} is the function for multiplication, just as @code{+} is the
3138 function for addition.)
3139
3140 When you use the @code{multiply-by-seven} function, the argument
3141 @code{number} evaluates to the actual number you want used. Here is an
3142 example that shows how @code{multiply-by-seven} is used; but don't try
3143 to evaluate this yet!
3144
3145 @smallexample
3146 (multiply-by-seven 3)
3147 @end smallexample
3148
3149 @noindent
3150 The symbol @code{number}, specified in the function definition in the
3151 next section, is given or ``bound to'' the value 3 in the actual use of
3152 the function. Note that although @code{number} was inside parentheses
3153 in the function definition, the argument passed to the
3154 @code{multiply-by-seven} function is not in parentheses. The
3155 parentheses are written in the function definition so the computer can
3156 figure out where the argument list ends and the rest of the function
3157 definition begins.
3158
3159 If you evaluate this example, you are likely to get an error message.
3160 (Go ahead, try it!) This is because we have written the function
3161 definition, but not yet told the computer about the definition---we have
3162 not yet installed (or `loaded') the function definition in Emacs.
3163 Installing a function is the process that tells the Lisp interpreter the
3164 definition of the function. Installation is described in the next
3165 section.
3166
3167 @node Install
3168 @section Install a Function Definition
3169 @cindex Install a Function Definition
3170 @cindex Definition installation
3171 @cindex Function definition installation
3172
3173 If you are reading this inside of Info in Emacs, you can try out the
3174 @code{multiply-by-seven} function by first evaluating the function
3175 definition and then evaluating @code{(multiply-by-seven 3)}. A copy of
3176 the function definition follows. Place the cursor after the last
3177 parenthesis of the function definition and type @kbd{C-x C-e}. When you
3178 do this, @code{multiply-by-seven} will appear in the echo area. (What
3179 this means is that when a function definition is evaluated, the value it
3180 returns is the name of the defined function.) At the same time, this
3181 action installs the function definition.
3182
3183 @smallexample
3184 @group
3185 (defun multiply-by-seven (number)
3186 "Multiply NUMBER by seven."
3187 (* 7 number))
3188 @end group
3189 @end smallexample
3190
3191 @noindent
3192 By evaluating this @code{defun}, you have just installed
3193 @code{multiply-by-seven} in Emacs. The function is now just as much a
3194 part of Emacs as @code{forward-word} or any other editing function you
3195 use. (@code{multiply-by-seven} will stay installed until you quit
3196 Emacs. To reload code automatically whenever you start Emacs, see
3197 @ref{Permanent Installation, , Installing Code Permanently}.)
3198
3199 @menu
3200 * Effect of installation::
3201 * Change a defun:: How to change a function definition.
3202 @end menu
3203
3204 @ifnottex
3205 @node Effect of installation
3206 @unnumberedsubsec The effect of installation
3207 @end ifnottex
3208
3209 You can see the effect of installing @code{multiply-by-seven} by
3210 evaluating the following sample. Place the cursor after the following
3211 expression and type @kbd{C-x C-e}. The number 21 will appear in the
3212 echo area.
3213
3214 @smallexample
3215 (multiply-by-seven 3)
3216 @end smallexample
3217
3218 If you wish, you can read the documentation for the function by typing
3219 @kbd{C-h f} (@code{describe-function}) and then the name of the
3220 function, @code{multiply-by-seven}. When you do this, a
3221 @file{*Help*} window will appear on your screen that says:
3222
3223 @smallexample
3224 @group
3225 multiply-by-seven is a Lisp function.
3226 (multiply-by-seven NUMBER)
3227
3228 Multiply NUMBER by seven.
3229 @end group
3230 @end smallexample
3231
3232 @noindent
3233 (To return to a single window on your screen, type @kbd{C-x 1}.)
3234
3235 @node Change a defun
3236 @subsection Change a Function Definition
3237 @cindex Changing a function definition
3238 @cindex Function definition, how to change
3239 @cindex Definition, how to change
3240
3241 If you want to change the code in @code{multiply-by-seven}, just rewrite
3242 it. To install the new version in place of the old one, evaluate the
3243 function definition again. This is how you modify code in Emacs. It is
3244 very simple.
3245
3246 As an example, you can change the @code{multiply-by-seven} function to
3247 add the number to itself seven times instead of multiplying the number
3248 by seven. It produces the same answer, but by a different path. At
3249 the same time, we will add a comment to the code; a comment is text
3250 that the Lisp interpreter ignores, but that a human reader may find
3251 useful or enlightening. The comment is that this is the ``second
3252 version''.
3253
3254 @smallexample
3255 @group
3256 (defun multiply-by-seven (number) ; @r{Second version.}
3257 "Multiply NUMBER by seven."
3258 (+ number number number number number number number))
3259 @end group
3260 @end smallexample
3261
3262 @cindex Comments in Lisp code
3263 The comment follows a semicolon, @samp{;}. In Lisp, everything on a
3264 line that follows a semicolon is a comment. The end of the line is the
3265 end of the comment. To stretch a comment over two or more lines, begin
3266 each line with a semicolon.
3267
3268 @xref{Beginning a .emacs File, , Beginning a @file{.emacs}
3269 File}, and @ref{Comments, , Comments, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
3270 Reference Manual}, for more about comments.
3271
3272 You can install this version of the @code{multiply-by-seven} function by
3273 evaluating it in the same way you evaluated the first function: place
3274 the cursor after the last parenthesis and type @kbd{C-x C-e}.
3275
3276 In summary, this is how you write code in Emacs Lisp: you write a
3277 function; install it; test it; and then make fixes or enhancements and
3278 install it again.
3279
3280 @node Interactive
3281 @section Make a Function Interactive
3282 @cindex Interactive functions
3283 @findex interactive
3284
3285 You make a function interactive by placing a list that begins with
3286 the special form @code{interactive} immediately after the
3287 documentation. A user can invoke an interactive function by typing
3288 @kbd{M-x} and then the name of the function; or by typing the keys to
3289 which it is bound, for example, by typing @kbd{C-n} for
3290 @code{next-line} or @kbd{C-x h} for @code{mark-whole-buffer}.
3291
3292 Interestingly, when you call an interactive function interactively,
3293 the value returned is not automatically displayed in the echo area.
3294 This is because you often call an interactive function for its side
3295 effects, such as moving forward by a word or line, and not for the
3296 value returned. If the returned value were displayed in the echo area
3297 each time you typed a key, it would be very distracting.
3298
3299 @menu
3300 * Interactive multiply-by-seven:: An overview.
3301 * multiply-by-seven in detail:: The interactive version.
3302 @end menu
3303
3304 @ifnottex
3305 @node Interactive multiply-by-seven
3306 @unnumberedsubsec An Interactive @code{multiply-by-seven}, An Overview
3307 @end ifnottex
3308
3309 Both the use of the special form @code{interactive} and one way to
3310 display a value in the echo area can be illustrated by creating an
3311 interactive version of @code{multiply-by-seven}.
3312
3313 @need 1250
3314 Here is the code:
3315
3316 @smallexample
3317 @group
3318 (defun multiply-by-seven (number) ; @r{Interactive version.}
3319 "Multiply NUMBER by seven."
3320 (interactive "p")
3321 (message "The result is %d" (* 7 number)))
3322 @end group
3323 @end smallexample
3324
3325 @noindent
3326 You can install this code by placing your cursor after it and typing
3327 @kbd{C-x C-e}. The name of the function will appear in your echo area.
3328 Then, you can use this code by typing @kbd{C-u} and a number and then
3329 typing @kbd{M-x multiply-by-seven} and pressing @key{RET}. The phrase
3330 @samp{The result is @dots{}} followed by the product will appear in the
3331 echo area.
3332
3333 Speaking more generally, you invoke a function like this in either of two
3334 ways:
3335
3336 @enumerate
3337 @item
3338 By typing a prefix argument that contains the number to be passed, and
3339 then typing @kbd{M-x} and the name of the function, as with
3340 @kbd{C-u 3 M-x forward-sentence}; or,
3341
3342 @item
3343 By typing whatever key or keychord the function is bound to, as with
3344 @kbd{C-u 3 M-e}.
3345 @end enumerate
3346
3347 @noindent
3348 Both the examples just mentioned work identically to move point forward
3349 three sentences. (Since @code{multiply-by-seven} is not bound to a key,
3350 it could not be used as an example of key binding.)
3351
3352 (@xref{Keybindings, , Some Keybindings}, to learn how to bind a command
3353 to a key.)
3354
3355 A prefix argument is passed to an interactive function by typing the
3356 @key{META} key followed by a number, for example, @kbd{M-3 M-e}, or by
3357 typing @kbd{C-u} and then a number, for example, @kbd{C-u 3 M-e} (if you
3358 type @kbd{C-u} without a number, it defaults to 4).
3359
3360 @node multiply-by-seven in detail
3361 @subsection An Interactive @code{multiply-by-seven}
3362
3363 Let's look at the use of the special form @code{interactive} and then at
3364 the function @code{message} in the interactive version of
3365 @code{multiply-by-seven}. You will recall that the function definition
3366 looks like this:
3367
3368 @smallexample
3369 @group
3370 (defun multiply-by-seven (number) ; @r{Interactive version.}
3371 "Multiply NUMBER by seven."
3372 (interactive "p")
3373 (message "The result is %d" (* 7 number)))
3374 @end group
3375 @end smallexample
3376
3377 In this function, the expression, @code{(interactive "p")}, is a list of
3378 two elements. The @code{"p"} tells Emacs to pass the prefix argument to
3379 the function and use its value for the argument of the function.
3380
3381 @need 1000
3382 The argument will be a number. This means that the symbol
3383 @code{number} will be bound to a number in the line:
3384
3385 @smallexample
3386 (message "The result is %d" (* 7 number))
3387 @end smallexample
3388
3389 @need 1250
3390 @noindent
3391 For example, if your prefix argument is 5, the Lisp interpreter will
3392 evaluate the line as if it were:
3393
3394 @smallexample
3395 (message "The result is %d" (* 7 5))
3396 @end smallexample
3397
3398 @noindent
3399 (If you are reading this in GNU Emacs, you can evaluate this expression
3400 yourself.) First, the interpreter will evaluate the inner list, which
3401 is @code{(* 7 5)}. This returns a value of 35. Next, it
3402 will evaluate the outer list, passing the values of the second and
3403 subsequent elements of the list to the function @code{message}.
3404
3405 As we have seen, @code{message} is an Emacs Lisp function especially
3406 designed for sending a one line message to a user. (@xref{message, ,
3407 The @code{message} function}.) In summary, the @code{message}
3408 function prints its first argument in the echo area as is, except for
3409 occurrences of @samp{%d} or @samp{%s} (and various other %-sequences
3410 which we have not mentioned). When it sees a control sequence, the
3411 function looks to the second or subsequent arguments and prints the
3412 value of the argument in the location in the string where the control
3413 sequence is located.
3414
3415 In the interactive @code{multiply-by-seven} function, the control string
3416 is @samp{%d}, which requires a number, and the value returned by
3417 evaluating @code{(* 7 5)} is the number 35. Consequently, the number 35
3418 is printed in place of the @samp{%d} and the message is @samp{The result
3419 is 35}.
3420
3421 (Note that when you call the function @code{multiply-by-seven}, the
3422 message is printed without quotes, but when you call @code{message}, the
3423 text is printed in double quotes. This is because the value returned by
3424 @code{message} is what appears in the echo area when you evaluate an
3425 expression whose first element is @code{message}; but when embedded in a
3426 function, @code{message} prints the text as a side effect without
3427 quotes.)
3428
3429 @node Interactive Options
3430 @section Different Options for @code{interactive}
3431 @cindex Options for @code{interactive}
3432 @cindex Interactive options
3433
3434 In the example, @code{multiply-by-seven} used @code{"p"} as the
3435 argument to @code{interactive}. This argument told Emacs to interpret
3436 your typing either @kbd{C-u} followed by a number or @key{META}
3437 followed by a number as a command to pass that number to the function
3438 as its argument. Emacs has more than twenty characters predefined for
3439 use with @code{interactive}. In almost every case, one of these
3440 options will enable you to pass the right information interactively to
3441 a function. (@xref{Interactive Codes, , Code Characters for
3442 @code{interactive}, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}.)
3443
3444 @need 1250
3445 Consider the function @code{zap-to-char}. Its interactive expression
3446 is
3447
3448 @smallexample
3449 (interactive "p\ncZap to char: ")
3450 @end smallexample
3451
3452 The first part of the argument to @code{interactive} is @samp{p}, with
3453 which you are already familiar. This argument tells Emacs to
3454 interpret a `prefix', as a number to be passed to the function. You
3455 can specify a prefix either by typing @kbd{C-u} followed by a number
3456 or by typing @key{META} followed by a number. The prefix is the
3457 number of specified characters. Thus, if your prefix is three and the
3458 specified character is @samp{x}, then you will delete all the text up
3459 to and including the third next @samp{x}. If you do not set a prefix,
3460 then you delete all the text up to and including the specified
3461 character, but no more.
3462
3463 The @samp{c} tells the function the name of the character to which to delete.
3464
3465 More formally, a function with two or more arguments can have
3466 information passed to each argument by adding parts to the string that
3467 follows @code{interactive}. When you do this, the information is
3468 passed to each argument in the same order it is specified in the
3469 @code{interactive} list. In the string, each part is separated from
3470 the next part by a @samp{\n}, which is a newline. For example, you
3471 can follow @samp{p} with a @samp{\n} and an @samp{cZap to char:@: }.
3472 This causes Emacs to pass the value of the prefix argument (if there
3473 is one) and the character.
3474
3475 In this case, the function definition looks like the following, where
3476 @code{arg} and @code{char} are the symbols to which @code{interactive}
3477 binds the prefix argument and the specified character:
3478
3479 @smallexample
3480 @group
3481 (defun @var{name-of-function} (arg char)
3482 "@var{documentation}@dots{}"
3483 (interactive "p\ncZap to char: ")
3484 @var{body-of-function}@dots{})
3485 @end group
3486 @end smallexample
3487
3488 @noindent
3489 (The space after the colon in the prompt makes it look better when you
3490 are prompted. @xref{copy-to-buffer, , The Definition of
3491 @code{copy-to-buffer}}, for an example.)
3492
3493 When a function does not take arguments, @code{interactive} does not
3494 require any. Such a function contains the simple expression
3495 @code{(interactive)}. The @code{mark-whole-buffer} function is like
3496 this.
3497
3498 Alternatively, if the special letter-codes are not right for your
3499 application, you can pass your own arguments to @code{interactive} as
3500 a list.
3501
3502 @xref{append-to-buffer, , The Definition of @code{append-to-buffer}},
3503 for an example. @xref{Using Interactive, , Using @code{Interactive},
3504 elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}, for a more complete
3505 explanation about this technique.
3506
3507 @node Permanent Installation
3508 @section Install Code Permanently
3509 @cindex Install code permanently
3510 @cindex Permanent code installation
3511 @cindex Code installation
3512
3513 When you install a function definition by evaluating it, it will stay
3514 installed until you quit Emacs. The next time you start a new session
3515 of Emacs, the function will not be installed unless you evaluate the
3516 function definition again.
3517
3518 At some point, you may want to have code installed automatically
3519 whenever you start a new session of Emacs. There are several ways of
3520 doing this:
3521
3522 @itemize @bullet
3523 @item
3524 If you have code that is just for yourself, you can put the code for the
3525 function definition in your @file{.emacs} initialization file. When you
3526 start Emacs, your @file{.emacs} file is automatically evaluated and all
3527 the function definitions within it are installed.
3528 @xref{Emacs Initialization, , Your @file{.emacs} File}.
3529
3530 @item
3531 Alternatively, you can put the function definitions that you want
3532 installed in one or more files of their own and use the @code{load}
3533 function to cause Emacs to evaluate and thereby install each of the
3534 functions in the files.
3535 @xref{Loading Files, , Loading Files}.
3536
3537 @item
3538 Thirdly, if you have code that your whole site will use, it is usual
3539 to put it in a file called @file{site-init.el} that is loaded when
3540 Emacs is built. This makes the code available to everyone who uses
3541 your machine. (See the @file{INSTALL} file that is part of the Emacs
3542 distribution.)
3543 @end itemize
3544
3545 Finally, if you have code that everyone who uses Emacs may want, you
3546 can post it on a computer network or send a copy to the Free Software
3547 Foundation. (When you do this, please license the code and its
3548 documentation under a license that permits other people to run, copy,
3549 study, modify, and redistribute the code and which protects you from
3550 having your work taken from you.) If you send a copy of your code to
3551 the Free Software Foundation, and properly protect yourself and
3552 others, it may be included in the next release of Emacs. In large
3553 part, this is how Emacs has grown over the past years, by donations.
3554
3555 @node let
3556 @section @code{let}
3557 @findex let
3558
3559 The @code{let} expression is a special form in Lisp that you will need
3560 to use in most function definitions.
3561
3562 @code{let} is used to attach or bind a symbol to a value in such a way
3563 that the Lisp interpreter will not confuse the variable with a
3564 variable of the same name that is not part of the function.
3565
3566 To understand why the @code{let} special form is necessary, consider
3567 the situation in which you own a home that you generally refer to as
3568 `the house', as in the sentence, ``The house needs painting.'' If you
3569 are visiting a friend and your host refers to `the house', he is
3570 likely to be referring to @emph{his} house, not yours, that is, to a
3571 different house.
3572
3573 If your friend is referring to his house and you think he is referring
3574 to your house, you may be in for some confusion. The same thing could
3575 happen in Lisp if a variable that is used inside of one function has
3576 the same name as a variable that is used inside of another function,
3577 and the two are not intended to refer to the same value. The
3578 @code{let} special form prevents this kind of confusion.
3579
3580 @menu
3581 * Prevent confusion::
3582 * Parts of let Expression::
3583 * Sample let Expression::
3584 * Uninitialized let Variables::
3585 @end menu
3586
3587 @ifnottex
3588 @node Prevent confusion
3589 @unnumberedsubsec @code{let} Prevents Confusion
3590 @end ifnottex
3591
3592 @cindex @samp{local variable} defined
3593 @cindex @samp{variable, local}, defined
3594 The @code{let} special form prevents confusion. @code{let} creates a
3595 name for a @dfn{local variable} that overshadows any use of the same
3596 name outside the @code{let} expression. This is like understanding
3597 that whenever your host refers to `the house', he means his house, not
3598 yours. (Symbols used in argument lists work the same way.
3599 @xref{defun, , The @code{defun} Macro}.)
3600
3601 Local variables created by a @code{let} expression retain their value
3602 @emph{only} within the @code{let} expression itself (and within
3603 expressions called within the @code{let} expression); the local
3604 variables have no effect outside the @code{let} expression.
3605
3606 Another way to think about @code{let} is that it is like a @code{setq}
3607 that is temporary and local. The values set by @code{let} are
3608 automatically undone when the @code{let} is finished. The setting
3609 only affects expressions that are inside the bounds of the @code{let}
3610 expression. In computer science jargon, we would say ``the binding of
3611 a symbol is visible only in functions called in the @code{let} form;
3612 in Emacs Lisp, scoping is dynamic, not lexical.''
3613
3614 @code{let} can create more than one variable at once. Also,
3615 @code{let} gives each variable it creates an initial value, either a
3616 value specified by you, or @code{nil}. (In the jargon, this is called
3617 `binding the variable to the value'.) After @code{let} has created
3618 and bound the variables, it executes the code in the body of the
3619 @code{let}, and returns the value of the last expression in the body,
3620 as the value of the whole @code{let} expression. (`Execute' is a jargon
3621 term that means to evaluate a list; it comes from the use of the word
3622 meaning `to give practical effect to' (@cite{Oxford English
3623 Dictionary}). Since you evaluate an expression to perform an action,
3624 `execute' has evolved as a synonym to `evaluate'.)
3625
3626 @node Parts of let Expression
3627 @subsection The Parts of a @code{let} Expression
3628 @cindex @code{let} expression, parts of
3629 @cindex Parts of @code{let} expression
3630
3631 @cindex @samp{varlist} defined
3632 A @code{let} expression is a list of three parts. The first part is
3633 the symbol @code{let}. The second part is a list, called a
3634 @dfn{varlist}, each element of which is either a symbol by itself or a
3635 two-element list, the first element of which is a symbol. The third
3636 part of the @code{let} expression is the body of the @code{let}. The
3637 body usually consists of one or more lists.
3638
3639 @need 800
3640 A template for a @code{let} expression looks like this:
3641
3642 @smallexample
3643 (let @var{varlist} @var{body}@dots{})
3644 @end smallexample
3645
3646 @noindent
3647 The symbols in the varlist are the variables that are given initial
3648 values by the @code{let} special form. Symbols by themselves are given
3649 the initial value of @code{nil}; and each symbol that is the first
3650 element of a two-element list is bound to the value that is returned
3651 when the Lisp interpreter evaluates the second element.
3652
3653 Thus, a varlist might look like this: @code{(thread (needles 3))}. In
3654 this case, in a @code{let} expression, Emacs binds the symbol
3655 @code{thread} to an initial value of @code{nil}, and binds the symbol
3656 @code{needles} to an initial value of 3.
3657
3658 When you write a @code{let} expression, what you do is put the
3659 appropriate expressions in the slots of the @code{let} expression
3660 template.
3661
3662 If the varlist is composed of two-element lists, as is often the case,
3663 the template for the @code{let} expression looks like this:
3664
3665 @smallexample
3666 @group
3667 (let ((@var{variable} @var{value})
3668 (@var{variable} @var{value})
3669 @dots{})
3670 @var{body}@dots{})
3671 @end group
3672 @end smallexample
3673
3674 @node Sample let Expression
3675 @subsection Sample @code{let} Expression
3676 @cindex Sample @code{let} expression
3677 @cindex @code{let} expression sample
3678
3679 The following expression creates and gives initial values
3680 to the two variables @code{zebra} and @code{tiger}. The body of the
3681 @code{let} expression is a list which calls the @code{message} function.
3682
3683 @smallexample
3684 @group
3685 (let ((zebra 'stripes)
3686 (tiger 'fierce))
3687 (message "One kind of animal has %s and another is %s."
3688 zebra tiger))
3689 @end group
3690 @end smallexample
3691
3692 Here, the varlist is @code{((zebra 'stripes) (tiger 'fierce))}.
3693
3694 The two variables are @code{zebra} and @code{tiger}. Each variable is
3695 the first element of a two-element list and each value is the second
3696 element of its two-element list. In the varlist, Emacs binds the
3697 variable @code{zebra} to the value @code{stripes}@footnote{According
3698 to Jared Diamond in @cite{Guns, Germs, and Steel}, ``@dots{} zebras
3699 become impossibly dangerous as they grow older'' but the claim here is
3700 that they do not become fierce like a tiger. (1997, W. W. Norton and
3701 Co., ISBN 0-393-03894-2, page 171)}, and binds the
3702 variable @code{tiger} to the value @code{fierce}. In this example,
3703 both values are symbols preceded by a quote. The values could just as
3704 well have been another list or a string. The body of the @code{let}
3705 follows after the list holding the variables. In this example, the
3706 body is a list that uses the @code{message} function to print a string
3707 in the echo area.
3708
3709 @need 1500
3710 You may evaluate the example in the usual fashion, by placing the
3711 cursor after the last parenthesis and typing @kbd{C-x C-e}. When you do
3712 this, the following will appear in the echo area:
3713
3714 @smallexample
3715 "One kind of animal has stripes and another is fierce."
3716 @end smallexample
3717
3718 As we have seen before, the @code{message} function prints its first
3719 argument, except for @samp{%s}. In this example, the value of the variable
3720 @code{zebra} is printed at the location of the first @samp{%s} and the
3721 value of the variable @code{tiger} is printed at the location of the
3722 second @samp{%s}.
3723
3724 @node Uninitialized let Variables
3725 @subsection Uninitialized Variables in a @code{let} Statement
3726 @cindex Uninitialized @code{let} variables
3727 @cindex @code{let} variables uninitialized
3728
3729 If you do not bind the variables in a @code{let} statement to specific
3730 initial values, they will automatically be bound to an initial value of
3731 @code{nil}, as in the following expression:
3732
3733 @smallexample
3734 @group
3735 (let ((birch 3)
3736 pine
3737 fir
3738 (oak 'some))
3739 (message
3740 "Here are %d variables with %s, %s, and %s value."
3741 birch pine fir oak))
3742 @end group
3743 @end smallexample
3744
3745 @noindent
3746 Here, the varlist is @code{((birch 3) pine fir (oak 'some))}.
3747
3748 @need 1250
3749 If you evaluate this expression in the usual way, the following will
3750 appear in your echo area:
3751
3752 @smallexample
3753 "Here are 3 variables with nil, nil, and some value."
3754 @end smallexample
3755
3756 @noindent
3757 In this example, Emacs binds the symbol @code{birch} to the number 3,
3758 binds the symbols @code{pine} and @code{fir} to @code{nil}, and binds
3759 the symbol @code{oak} to the value @code{some}.
3760
3761 Note that in the first part of the @code{let}, the variables @code{pine}
3762 and @code{fir} stand alone as atoms that are not surrounded by
3763 parentheses; this is because they are being bound to @code{nil}, the
3764 empty list. But @code{oak} is bound to @code{some} and so is a part of
3765 the list @code{(oak 'some)}. Similarly, @code{birch} is bound to the
3766 number 3 and so is in a list with that number. (Since a number
3767 evaluates to itself, the number does not need to be quoted. Also, the
3768 number is printed in the message using a @samp{%d} rather than a
3769 @samp{%s}.) The four variables as a group are put into a list to
3770 delimit them from the body of the @code{let}.
3771
3772 @node if
3773 @section The @code{if} Special Form
3774 @findex if
3775 @cindex Conditional with @code{if}
3776
3777 A third special form, in addition to @code{defun} and @code{let}, is the
3778 conditional @code{if}. This form is used to instruct the computer to
3779 make decisions. You can write function definitions without using
3780 @code{if}, but it is used often enough, and is important enough, to be
3781 included here. It is used, for example, in the code for the
3782 function @code{beginning-of-buffer}.
3783
3784 The basic idea behind an @code{if}, is that ``@emph{if} a test is true,
3785 @emph{then} an expression is evaluated.'' If the test is not true, the
3786 expression is not evaluated. For example, you might make a decision
3787 such as, ``if it is warm and sunny, then go to the beach!''
3788
3789 @menu
3790 * if in more detail::
3791 * type-of-animal in detail:: An example of an @code{if} expression.
3792 @end menu
3793
3794 @ifnottex
3795 @node if in more detail
3796 @unnumberedsubsec @code{if} in more detail
3797 @end ifnottex
3798
3799 @cindex @samp{if-part} defined
3800 @cindex @samp{then-part} defined
3801 An @code{if} expression written in Lisp does not use the word `then';
3802 the test and the action are the second and third elements of the list
3803 whose first element is @code{if}. Nonetheless, the test part of an
3804 @code{if} expression is often called the @dfn{if-part} and the second
3805 argument is often called the @dfn{then-part}.
3806
3807 Also, when an @code{if} expression is written, the true-or-false-test
3808 is usually written on the same line as the symbol @code{if}, but the
3809 action to carry out if the test is true, the ``then-part'', is written
3810 on the second and subsequent lines. This makes the @code{if}
3811 expression easier to read.
3812
3813 @smallexample
3814 @group
3815 (if @var{true-or-false-test}
3816 @var{action-to-carry-out-if-test-is-true})
3817 @end group
3818 @end smallexample
3819
3820 @noindent
3821 The true-or-false-test will be an expression that
3822 is evaluated by the Lisp interpreter.
3823
3824 Here is an example that you can evaluate in the usual manner. The test
3825 is whether the number 5 is greater than the number 4. Since it is, the
3826 message @samp{5 is greater than 4!} will be printed.
3827
3828 @smallexample
3829 @group
3830 (if (> 5 4) ; @r{if-part}
3831 (message "5 is greater than 4!")) ; @r{then-part}
3832 @end group
3833 @end smallexample
3834
3835 @noindent
3836 (The function @code{>} tests whether its first argument is greater than
3837 its second argument and returns true if it is.)
3838 @findex > (greater than)
3839
3840 Of course, in actual use, the test in an @code{if} expression will not
3841 be fixed for all time as it is by the expression @code{(> 5 4)}.
3842 Instead, at least one of the variables used in the test will be bound to
3843 a value that is not known ahead of time. (If the value were known ahead
3844 of time, we would not need to run the test!)
3845
3846 For example, the value may be bound to an argument of a function
3847 definition. In the following function definition, the character of the
3848 animal is a value that is passed to the function. If the value bound to
3849 @code{characteristic} is @code{fierce}, then the message, @samp{It's a
3850 tiger!} will be printed; otherwise, @code{nil} will be returned.
3851
3852 @smallexample
3853 @group
3854 (defun type-of-animal (characteristic)
3855 "Print message in echo area depending on CHARACTERISTIC.
3856 If the CHARACTERISTIC is the symbol `fierce',
3857 then warn of a tiger."
3858 (if (equal characteristic 'fierce)
3859 (message "It's a tiger!")))
3860 @end group
3861 @end smallexample
3862
3863 @need 1500
3864 @noindent
3865 If you are reading this inside of GNU Emacs, you can evaluate the
3866 function definition in the usual way to install it in Emacs, and then you
3867 can evaluate the following two expressions to see the results:
3868
3869 @smallexample
3870 @group
3871 (type-of-animal 'fierce)
3872
3873 (type-of-animal 'zebra)
3874
3875 @end group
3876 @end smallexample
3877
3878 @c Following sentences rewritten to prevent overfull hbox.
3879 @noindent
3880 When you evaluate @code{(type-of-animal 'fierce)}, you will see the
3881 following message printed in the echo area: @code{"It's a tiger!"}; and
3882 when you evaluate @code{(type-of-animal 'zebra)} you will see @code{nil}
3883 printed in the echo area.
3884
3885 @node type-of-animal in detail
3886 @subsection The @code{type-of-animal} Function in Detail
3887
3888 Let's look at the @code{type-of-animal} function in detail.
3889
3890 The function definition for @code{type-of-animal} was written by filling
3891 the slots of two templates, one for a function definition as a whole, and
3892 a second for an @code{if} expression.
3893
3894 @need 1250
3895 The template for every function that is not interactive is:
3896
3897 @smallexample
3898 @group
3899 (defun @var{name-of-function} (@var{argument-list})
3900 "@var{documentation}@dots{}"
3901 @var{body}@dots{})
3902 @end group
3903 @end smallexample
3904
3905 @need 800
3906 The parts of the function that match this template look like this:
3907
3908 @smallexample
3909 @group
3910 (defun type-of-animal (characteristic)
3911 "Print message in echo area depending on CHARACTERISTIC.
3912 If the CHARACTERISTIC is the symbol `fierce',
3913 then warn of a tiger."
3914 @var{body: the} @code{if} @var{expression})
3915 @end group
3916 @end smallexample
3917
3918 The name of function is @code{type-of-animal}; it is passed the value
3919 of one argument. The argument list is followed by a multi-line
3920 documentation string. The documentation string is included in the
3921 example because it is a good habit to write documentation string for
3922 every function definition. The body of the function definition
3923 consists of the @code{if} expression.
3924
3925 @need 800
3926 The template for an @code{if} expression looks like this:
3927
3928 @smallexample
3929 @group
3930 (if @var{true-or-false-test}
3931 @var{action-to-carry-out-if-the-test-returns-true})
3932 @end group
3933 @end smallexample
3934
3935 @need 1250
3936 In the @code{type-of-animal} function, the code for the @code{if}
3937 looks like this:
3938
3939 @smallexample
3940 @group
3941 (if (equal characteristic 'fierce)
3942 (message "It's a tiger!")))
3943 @end group
3944 @end smallexample
3945
3946 @need 800
3947 Here, the true-or-false-test is the expression:
3948
3949 @smallexample
3950 (equal characteristic 'fierce)
3951 @end smallexample
3952
3953 @noindent
3954 In Lisp, @code{equal} is a function that determines whether its first
3955 argument is equal to its second argument. The second argument is the
3956 quoted symbol @code{'fierce} and the first argument is the value of the
3957 symbol @code{characteristic}---in other words, the argument passed to
3958 this function.
3959
3960 In the first exercise of @code{type-of-animal}, the argument
3961 @code{fierce} is passed to @code{type-of-animal}. Since @code{fierce}
3962 is equal to @code{fierce}, the expression, @code{(equal characteristic
3963 'fierce)}, returns a value of true. When this happens, the @code{if}
3964 evaluates the second argument or then-part of the @code{if}:
3965 @code{(message "It's tiger!")}.
3966
3967 On the other hand, in the second exercise of @code{type-of-animal}, the
3968 argument @code{zebra} is passed to @code{type-of-animal}. @code{zebra}
3969 is not equal to @code{fierce}, so the then-part is not evaluated and
3970 @code{nil} is returned by the @code{if} expression.
3971
3972 @node else
3973 @section If--then--else Expressions
3974 @cindex Else
3975
3976 An @code{if} expression may have an optional third argument, called
3977 the @dfn{else-part}, for the case when the true-or-false-test returns
3978 false. When this happens, the second argument or then-part of the
3979 overall @code{if} expression is @emph{not} evaluated, but the third or
3980 else-part @emph{is} evaluated. You might think of this as the cloudy
3981 day alternative for the decision ``if it is warm and sunny, then go to
3982 the beach, else read a book!''.
3983
3984 The word ``else'' is not written in the Lisp code; the else-part of an
3985 @code{if} expression comes after the then-part. In the written Lisp, the
3986 else-part is usually written to start on a line of its own and is
3987 indented less than the then-part:
3988
3989 @smallexample
3990 @group
3991 (if @var{true-or-false-test}
3992 @var{action-to-carry-out-if-the-test-returns-true}
3993 @var{action-to-carry-out-if-the-test-returns-false})
3994 @end group
3995 @end smallexample
3996
3997 For example, the following @code{if} expression prints the message @samp{4
3998 is not greater than 5!} when you evaluate it in the usual way:
3999
4000 @smallexample
4001 @group
4002 (if (> 4 5) ; @r{if-part}
4003 (message "4 falsely greater than 5!") ; @r{then-part}
4004 (message "4 is not greater than 5!")) ; @r{else-part}
4005 @end group
4006 @end smallexample
4007
4008 @noindent
4009 Note that the different levels of indentation make it easy to
4010 distinguish the then-part from the else-part. (GNU Emacs has several
4011 commands that automatically indent @code{if} expressions correctly.
4012 @xref{Typing Lists, , GNU Emacs Helps You Type Lists}.)
4013
4014 We can extend the @code{type-of-animal} function to include an
4015 else-part by simply incorporating an additional part to the @code{if}
4016 expression.
4017
4018 @need 1500
4019 You can see the consequences of doing this if you evaluate the following
4020 version of the @code{type-of-animal} function definition to install it
4021 and then evaluate the two subsequent expressions to pass different
4022 arguments to the function.
4023
4024 @smallexample
4025 @group
4026 (defun type-of-animal (characteristic) ; @r{Second version.}
4027 "Print message in echo area depending on CHARACTERISTIC.
4028 If the CHARACTERISTIC is the symbol `fierce',
4029 then warn of a tiger;
4030 else say it's not fierce."
4031 (if (equal characteristic 'fierce)
4032 (message "It's a tiger!")
4033 (message "It's not fierce!")))
4034 @end group
4035 @end smallexample
4036 @sp 1
4037
4038 @smallexample
4039 @group
4040 (type-of-animal 'fierce)
4041
4042 (type-of-animal 'zebra)
4043
4044 @end group
4045 @end smallexample
4046
4047 @c Following sentence rewritten to prevent overfull hbox.
4048 @noindent
4049 When you evaluate @code{(type-of-animal 'fierce)}, you will see the
4050 following message printed in the echo area: @code{"It's a tiger!"}; but
4051 when you evaluate @code{(type-of-animal 'zebra)}, you will see
4052 @code{"It's not fierce!"}.
4053
4054 (Of course, if the @var{characteristic} were @code{ferocious}, the
4055 message @code{"It's not fierce!"} would be printed; and it would be
4056 misleading! When you write code, you need to take into account the
4057 possibility that some such argument will be tested by the @code{if}
4058 and write your program accordingly.)
4059
4060 @node Truth & Falsehood
4061 @section Truth and Falsehood in Emacs Lisp
4062 @cindex Truth and falsehood in Emacs Lisp
4063 @cindex Falsehood and truth in Emacs Lisp
4064 @findex nil
4065
4066 There is an important aspect to the truth test in an @code{if}
4067 expression. So far, we have spoken of `true' and `false' as values of
4068 predicates as if they were new kinds of Emacs Lisp objects. In fact,
4069 `false' is just our old friend @code{nil}. Anything else---anything
4070 at all---is `true'.
4071
4072 The expression that tests for truth is interpreted as @dfn{true}
4073 if the result of evaluating it is a value that is not @code{nil}. In
4074 other words, the result of the test is considered true if the value
4075 returned is a number such as 47, a string such as @code{"hello"}, or a
4076 symbol (other than @code{nil}) such as @code{flowers}, or a list (so
4077 long as it is not empty), or even a buffer!
4078
4079 @menu
4080 * nil explained:: @code{nil} has two meanings.
4081 @end menu
4082
4083 @ifnottex
4084 @node nil explained
4085 @unnumberedsubsec An explanation of @code{nil}
4086 @end ifnottex
4087
4088 Before illustrating a test for truth, we need an explanation of @code{nil}.
4089
4090 In Emacs Lisp, the symbol @code{nil} has two meanings. First, it means the
4091 empty list. Second, it means false and is the value returned when a
4092 true-or-false-test tests false. @code{nil} can be written as an empty
4093 list, @code{()}, or as @code{nil}. As far as the Lisp interpreter is
4094 concerned, @code{()} and @code{nil} are the same. Humans, however, tend
4095 to use @code{nil} for false and @code{()} for the empty list.
4096
4097 In Emacs Lisp, any value that is not @code{nil}---is not the empty
4098 list---is considered true. This means that if an evaluation returns
4099 something that is not an empty list, an @code{if} expression will test
4100 true. For example, if a number is put in the slot for the test, it
4101 will be evaluated and will return itself, since that is what numbers
4102 do when evaluated. In this conditional, the @code{if} expression will
4103 test true. The expression tests false only when @code{nil}, an empty
4104 list, is returned by evaluating the expression.
4105
4106 You can see this by evaluating the two expressions in the following examples.
4107
4108 In the first example, the number 4 is evaluated as the test in the
4109 @code{if} expression and returns itself; consequently, the then-part
4110 of the expression is evaluated and returned: @samp{true} appears in
4111 the echo area. In the second example, the @code{nil} indicates false;
4112 consequently, the else-part of the expression is evaluated and
4113 returned: @samp{false} appears in the echo area.
4114
4115 @smallexample
4116 @group
4117 (if 4
4118 'true
4119 'false)
4120 @end group
4121
4122 @group
4123 (if nil
4124 'true
4125 'false)
4126 @end group
4127 @end smallexample
4128
4129 @need 1250
4130 Incidentally, if some other useful value is not available for a test that
4131 returns true, then the Lisp interpreter will return the symbol @code{t}
4132 for true. For example, the expression @code{(> 5 4)} returns @code{t}
4133 when evaluated, as you can see by evaluating it in the usual way:
4134
4135 @smallexample
4136 (> 5 4)
4137 @end smallexample
4138
4139 @need 1250
4140 @noindent
4141 On the other hand, this function returns @code{nil} if the test is false.
4142
4143 @smallexample
4144 (> 4 5)
4145 @end smallexample
4146
4147 @node save-excursion
4148 @section @code{save-excursion}
4149 @findex save-excursion
4150 @cindex Region, what it is
4151 @cindex Preserving point, mark, and buffer
4152 @cindex Point, mark, buffer preservation
4153 @findex point
4154 @findex mark
4155
4156 The @code{save-excursion} function is the third and final special form
4157 that we will discuss in this chapter.
4158
4159 In Emacs Lisp programs used for editing, the @code{save-excursion}
4160 function is very common. It saves the location of point and mark,
4161 executes the body of the function, and then restores point and mark to
4162 their previous positions if their locations were changed. Its primary
4163 purpose is to keep the user from being surprised and disturbed by
4164 unexpected movement of point or mark.
4165
4166 @menu
4167 * Point and mark:: A review of various locations.
4168 * Template for save-excursion::
4169 @end menu
4170
4171 @ifnottex
4172 @node Point and mark
4173 @unnumberedsubsec Point and Mark
4174 @end ifnottex
4175
4176 Before discussing @code{save-excursion}, however, it may be useful
4177 first to review what point and mark are in GNU Emacs. @dfn{Point} is
4178 the current location of the cursor. Wherever the cursor
4179 is, that is point. More precisely, on terminals where the cursor
4180 appears to be on top of a character, point is immediately before the
4181 character. In Emacs Lisp, point is an integer. The first character in
4182 a buffer is number one, the second is number two, and so on. The
4183 function @code{point} returns the current position of the cursor as a
4184 number. Each buffer has its own value for point.
4185
4186 The @dfn{mark} is another position in the buffer; its value can be set
4187 with a command such as @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} (@code{set-mark-command}). If
4188 a mark has been set, you can use the command @kbd{C-x C-x}
4189 (@code{exchange-point-and-mark}) to cause the cursor to jump to the mark
4190 and set the mark to be the previous position of point. In addition, if
4191 you set another mark, the position of the previous mark is saved in the
4192 mark ring. Many mark positions can be saved this way. You can jump the
4193 cursor to a saved mark by typing @kbd{C-u C-@key{SPC}} one or more
4194 times.
4195
4196 The part of the buffer between point and mark is called @dfn{the
4197 region}. Numerous commands work on the region, including
4198 @code{center-region}, @code{count-lines-region}, @code{kill-region}, and
4199 @code{print-region}.
4200
4201 The @code{save-excursion} special form saves the locations of point and
4202 mark and restores those positions after the code within the body of the
4203 special form is evaluated by the Lisp interpreter. Thus, if point were
4204 in the beginning of a piece of text and some code moved point to the end
4205 of the buffer, the @code{save-excursion} would put point back to where
4206 it was before, after the expressions in the body of the function were
4207 evaluated.
4208
4209 In Emacs, a function frequently moves point as part of its internal
4210 workings even though a user would not expect this. For example,
4211 @code{count-lines-region} moves point. To prevent the user from being
4212 bothered by jumps that are both unexpected and (from the user's point of
4213 view) unnecessary, @code{save-excursion} is often used to keep point and
4214 mark in the location expected by the user. The use of
4215 @code{save-excursion} is good housekeeping.
4216
4217 To make sure the house stays clean, @code{save-excursion} restores the
4218 values of point and mark even if something goes wrong in the code inside
4219 of it (or, to be more precise and to use the proper jargon, ``in case of
4220 abnormal exit''). This feature is very helpful.
4221
4222 In addition to recording the values of point and mark,
4223 @code{save-excursion} keeps track of the current buffer, and restores
4224 it, too. This means you can write code that will change the buffer and
4225 have @code{save-excursion} switch you back to the original buffer.
4226 This is how @code{save-excursion} is used in @code{append-to-buffer}.
4227 (@xref{append-to-buffer, , The Definition of @code{append-to-buffer}}.)
4228
4229 @node Template for save-excursion
4230 @subsection Template for a @code{save-excursion} Expression
4231
4232 @need 800
4233 The template for code using @code{save-excursion} is simple:
4234
4235 @smallexample
4236 @group
4237 (save-excursion
4238 @var{body}@dots{})
4239 @end group
4240 @end smallexample
4241
4242 @noindent
4243 The body of the function is one or more expressions that will be
4244 evaluated in sequence by the Lisp interpreter. If there is more than
4245 one expression in the body, the value of the last one will be returned
4246 as the value of the @code{save-excursion} function. The other
4247 expressions in the body are evaluated only for their side effects; and
4248 @code{save-excursion} itself is used only for its side effect (which
4249 is restoring the positions of point and mark).
4250
4251 @need 1250
4252 In more detail, the template for a @code{save-excursion} expression
4253 looks like this:
4254
4255 @smallexample
4256 @group
4257 (save-excursion
4258 @var{first-expression-in-body}
4259 @var{second-expression-in-body}
4260 @var{third-expression-in-body}
4261 @dots{}
4262 @var{last-expression-in-body})
4263 @end group
4264 @end smallexample
4265
4266 @noindent
4267 An expression, of course, may be a symbol on its own or a list.
4268
4269 In Emacs Lisp code, a @code{save-excursion} expression often occurs
4270 within the body of a @code{let} expression. It looks like this:
4271
4272 @smallexample
4273 @group
4274 (let @var{varlist}
4275 (save-excursion
4276 @var{body}@dots{}))
4277 @end group
4278 @end smallexample
4279
4280 @node Review
4281 @section Review
4282
4283 In the last few chapters we have introduced a macro and a fair number
4284 of functions and special forms. Here they are described in brief,
4285 along with a few similar functions that have not been mentioned yet.
4286
4287 @table @code
4288 @item eval-last-sexp
4289 Evaluate the last symbolic expression before the current location of
4290 point. The value is printed in the echo area unless the function is
4291 invoked with an argument; in that case, the output is printed in the
4292 current buffer. This command is normally bound to @kbd{C-x C-e}.
4293
4294 @item defun
4295 Define function. This macro has up to five parts: the name, a
4296 template for the arguments that will be passed to the function,
4297 documentation, an optional interactive declaration, and the body of
4298 the definition.
4299
4300 @need 1250
4301 For example, in an early version of Emacs, the function definition was
4302 as follows. (It is slightly more complex now that it seeks the first
4303 non-whitespace character rather than the first visible character.)
4304
4305 @smallexample
4306 @group
4307 (defun back-to-indentation ()
4308 "Move point to first visible character on line."
4309 (interactive)
4310 (beginning-of-line 1)
4311 (skip-chars-forward " \t"))
4312 @end group
4313 @end smallexample
4314
4315 @ignore
4316 In GNU Emacs 22,
4317
4318 (defun backward-to-indentation (&optional arg)
4319 "Move backward ARG lines and position at first nonblank character."
4320 (interactive "p")
4321 (forward-line (- (or arg 1)))
4322 (skip-chars-forward " \t"))
4323
4324 (defun back-to-indentation ()
4325 "Move point to the first non-whitespace character on this line."
4326 (interactive)
4327 (beginning-of-line 1)
4328 (skip-syntax-forward " " (line-end-position))
4329 ;; Move back over chars that have whitespace syntax but have the p flag.
4330 (backward-prefix-chars))
4331 @end ignore
4332
4333 @item interactive
4334 Declare to the interpreter that the function can be used
4335 interactively. This special form may be followed by a string with one
4336 or more parts that pass the information to the arguments of the
4337 function, in sequence. These parts may also tell the interpreter to
4338 prompt for information. Parts of the string are separated by
4339 newlines, @samp{\n}.
4340
4341 @need 1000
4342 Common code characters are:
4343
4344 @table @code
4345 @item b
4346 The name of an existing buffer.
4347
4348 @item f
4349 The name of an existing file.
4350
4351 @item p
4352 The numeric prefix argument. (Note that this `p' is lower case.)
4353
4354 @item r
4355 Point and the mark, as two numeric arguments, smallest first. This
4356 is the only code letter that specifies two successive arguments
4357 rather than one.
4358 @end table
4359
4360 @xref{Interactive Codes, , Code Characters for @samp{interactive},
4361 elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}, for a complete list of
4362 code characters.
4363
4364 @item let
4365 Declare that a list of variables is for use within the body of the
4366 @code{let} and give them an initial value, either @code{nil} or a
4367 specified value; then evaluate the rest of the expressions in the body
4368 of the @code{let} and return the value of the last one. Inside the
4369 body of the @code{let}, the Lisp interpreter does not see the values of
4370 the variables of the same names that are bound outside of the
4371 @code{let}.
4372
4373 @need 1250
4374 For example,
4375
4376 @smallexample
4377 @group
4378 (let ((foo (buffer-name))
4379 (bar (buffer-size)))
4380 (message
4381 "This buffer is %s and has %d characters."
4382 foo bar))
4383 @end group
4384 @end smallexample
4385
4386 @item save-excursion
4387 Record the values of point and mark and the current buffer before
4388 evaluating the body of this special form. Restore the values of point
4389 and mark and buffer afterward.
4390
4391 @need 1250
4392 For example,
4393
4394 @smallexample
4395 @group
4396 (message "We are %d characters into this buffer."
4397 (- (point)
4398 (save-excursion
4399 (goto-char (point-min)) (point))))
4400 @end group
4401 @end smallexample
4402
4403 @item if
4404 Evaluate the first argument to the function; if it is true, evaluate
4405 the second argument; else evaluate the third argument, if there is one.
4406
4407 The @code{if} special form is called a @dfn{conditional}. There are
4408 other conditionals in Emacs Lisp, but @code{if} is perhaps the most
4409 commonly used.
4410
4411 @need 1250
4412 For example,
4413
4414 @smallexample
4415 @group
4416 (if (= 22 emacs-major-version)
4417 (message "This is version 22 Emacs")
4418 (message "This is not version 22 Emacs"))
4419 @end group
4420 @end smallexample
4421
4422 @need 1250
4423 @item <
4424 @itemx >
4425 @itemx <=
4426 @itemx >=
4427 The @code{<} function tests whether its first argument is smaller than
4428 its second argument. A corresponding function, @code{>}, tests whether
4429 the first argument is greater than the second. Likewise, @code{<=}
4430 tests whether the first argument is less than or equal to the second and
4431 @code{>=} tests whether the first argument is greater than or equal to
4432 the second. In all cases, both arguments must be numbers or markers
4433 (markers indicate positions in buffers).
4434
4435 @need 800
4436 @item =
4437 The @code{=} function tests whether two arguments, both numbers or
4438 markers, are equal.
4439
4440 @need 1250
4441 @item equal
4442 @itemx eq
4443 Test whether two objects are the same. @code{equal} uses one meaning
4444 of the word `same' and @code{eq} uses another: @code{equal} returns
4445 true if the two objects have a similar structure and contents, such as
4446 two copies of the same book. On the other hand, @code{eq}, returns
4447 true if both arguments are actually the same object.
4448 @findex equal
4449 @findex eq
4450
4451 @need 1250
4452 @item string<
4453 @itemx string-lessp
4454 @itemx string=
4455 @itemx string-equal
4456 The @code{string-lessp} function tests whether its first argument is
4457 smaller than the second argument. A shorter, alternative name for the
4458 same function (a @code{defalias}) is @code{string<}.
4459
4460 The arguments to @code{string-lessp} must be strings or symbols; the
4461 ordering is lexicographic, so case is significant. The print names of
4462 symbols are used instead of the symbols themselves.
4463
4464 @cindex @samp{empty string} defined
4465 An empty string, @samp{""}, a string with no characters in it, is
4466 smaller than any string of characters.
4467
4468 @code{string-equal} provides the corresponding test for equality. Its
4469 shorter, alternative name is @code{string=}. There are no string test
4470 functions that correspond to @var{>}, @code{>=}, or @code{<=}.
4471
4472 @item message
4473 Print a message in the echo area. The first argument is a string that
4474 can contain @samp{%s}, @samp{%d}, or @samp{%c} to print the value of
4475 arguments that follow the string. The argument used by @samp{%s} must
4476 be a string or a symbol; the argument used by @samp{%d} must be a
4477 number. The argument used by @samp{%c} must be an @sc{ascii} code
4478 number; it will be printed as the character with that @sc{ascii} code.
4479 (Various other %-sequences have not been mentioned.)
4480
4481 @item setq
4482 @itemx set
4483 The @code{setq} function sets the value of its first argument to the
4484 value of the second argument. The first argument is automatically
4485 quoted by @code{setq}. It does the same for succeeding pairs of
4486 arguments. Another function, @code{set}, takes only two arguments and
4487 evaluates both of them before setting the value returned by its first
4488 argument to the value returned by its second argument.
4489
4490 @item buffer-name
4491 Without an argument, return the name of the buffer, as a string.
4492
4493 @item buffer-file-name
4494 Without an argument, return the name of the file the buffer is
4495 visiting.
4496
4497 @item current-buffer
4498 Return the buffer in which Emacs is active; it may not be
4499 the buffer that is visible on the screen.
4500
4501 @item other-buffer
4502 Return the most recently selected buffer (other than the buffer passed
4503 to @code{other-buffer} as an argument and other than the current
4504 buffer).
4505
4506 @item switch-to-buffer
4507 Select a buffer for Emacs to be active in and display it in the current
4508 window so users can look at it. Usually bound to @kbd{C-x b}.
4509
4510 @item set-buffer
4511 Switch Emacs's attention to a buffer on which programs will run. Don't
4512 alter what the window is showing.
4513
4514 @item buffer-size
4515 Return the number of characters in the current buffer.
4516
4517 @item point
4518 Return the value of the current position of the cursor, as an
4519 integer counting the number of characters from the beginning of the
4520 buffer.
4521
4522 @item point-min
4523 Return the minimum permissible value of point in
4524 the current buffer. This is 1, unless narrowing is in effect.
4525
4526 @item point-max
4527 Return the value of the maximum permissible value of point in the
4528 current buffer. This is the end of the buffer, unless narrowing is in
4529 effect.
4530 @end table
4531
4532 @need 1500
4533 @node defun Exercises
4534 @section Exercises
4535
4536 @itemize @bullet
4537 @item
4538 Write a non-interactive function that doubles the value of its
4539 argument, a number. Make that function interactive.
4540
4541 @item
4542 Write a function that tests whether the current value of
4543 @code{fill-column} is greater than the argument passed to the function,
4544 and if so, prints an appropriate message.
4545 @end itemize
4546
4547 @node Buffer Walk Through
4548 @chapter A Few Buffer--Related Functions
4549
4550 In this chapter we study in detail several of the functions used in GNU
4551 Emacs. This is called a ``walk-through''. These functions are used as
4552 examples of Lisp code, but are not imaginary examples; with the
4553 exception of the first, simplified function definition, these functions
4554 show the actual code used in GNU Emacs. You can learn a great deal from
4555 these definitions. The functions described here are all related to
4556 buffers. Later, we will study other functions.
4557
4558 @menu
4559 * Finding More:: How to find more information.
4560 * simplified-beginning-of-buffer:: Shows @code{goto-char},
4561 @code{point-min}, and @code{push-mark}.
4562 * mark-whole-buffer:: Almost the same as @code{beginning-of-buffer}.
4563 * append-to-buffer:: Uses @code{save-excursion} and
4564 @code{insert-buffer-substring}.
4565 * Buffer Related Review:: Review.
4566 * Buffer Exercises::
4567 @end menu
4568
4569 @node Finding More
4570 @section Finding More Information
4571
4572 @findex describe-function, @r{introduced}
4573 @cindex Find function documentation
4574 In this walk-through, I will describe each new function as we come to
4575 it, sometimes in detail and sometimes briefly. If you are interested,
4576 you can get the full documentation of any Emacs Lisp function at any
4577 time by typing @kbd{C-h f} and then the name of the function (and then
4578 @key{RET}). Similarly, you can get the full documentation for a
4579 variable by typing @kbd{C-h v} and then the name of the variable (and
4580 then @key{RET}).
4581
4582 @cindex Find source of function
4583 @c In version 22, tells location both of C and of Emacs Lisp
4584 Also, @code{describe-function} will tell you the location of the
4585 function definition.
4586
4587 Put point into the name of the file that contains the function and
4588 press the @key{RET} key. In this case, @key{RET} means
4589 @code{push-button} rather than `return' or `enter'. Emacs will take
4590 you directly to the function definition.
4591
4592 @ignore
4593 Not In version 22
4594
4595 If you move point over the file name and press
4596 the @key{RET} key, which in this case means @code{help-follow} rather
4597 than `return' or `enter', Emacs will take you directly to the function
4598 definition.
4599 @end ignore
4600
4601 More generally, if you want to see a function in its original source
4602 file, you can use the @code{find-tag} function to jump to it.
4603 @code{find-tag} works with a wide variety of languages, not just
4604 Lisp, and C, and it works with non-programming text as well. For
4605 example, @code{find-tag} will jump to the various nodes in the
4606 Texinfo source file of this document.
4607 The @code{find-tag} function depends on `tags tables' that record
4608 the locations of the functions, variables, and other items to which
4609 @code{find-tag} jumps.
4610
4611 To use the @code{find-tag} command, type @kbd{M-.} (i.e., press the
4612 period key while holding down the @key{META} key, or else type the
4613 @key{ESC} key and then type the period key), and then, at the prompt,
4614 type in the name of the function whose source code you want to see,
4615 such as @code{mark-whole-buffer}, and then type @key{RET}. Emacs will
4616 switch buffers and display the source code for the function on your
4617 screen. To switch back to your current buffer, type @kbd{C-x b
4618 @key{RET}}. (On some keyboards, the @key{META} key is labeled
4619 @key{ALT}.)
4620
4621 @c !!! 22.1.1 tags table location in this paragraph
4622 @cindex TAGS table, specifying
4623 @findex find-tag
4624 Depending on how the initial default values of your copy of Emacs are
4625 set, you may also need to specify the location of your `tags table',
4626 which is a file called @file{TAGS}. For example, if you are
4627 interested in Emacs sources, the tags table you will most likely want,
4628 if it has already been created for you, will be in a subdirectory of
4629 the @file{/usr/local/share/emacs/} directory; thus you would use the
4630 @code{M-x visit-tags-table} command and specify a pathname such as
4631 @file{/usr/local/share/emacs/22.1.1/lisp/TAGS}. If the tags table
4632 has not already been created, you will have to create it yourself. It
4633 will be in a file such as @file{/usr/local/src/emacs/src/TAGS}.
4634
4635 @need 1250
4636 To create a @file{TAGS} file in a specific directory, switch to that
4637 directory in Emacs using @kbd{M-x cd} command, or list the directory
4638 with @kbd{C-x d} (@code{dired}). Then run the compile command, with
4639 @w{@code{etags *.el}} as the command to execute:
4640
4641 @smallexample
4642 M-x compile RET etags *.el RET
4643 @end smallexample
4644
4645 For more information, see @ref{etags, , Create Your Own @file{TAGS} File}.
4646
4647 After you become more familiar with Emacs Lisp, you will find that you will
4648 frequently use @code{find-tag} to navigate your way around source code;
4649 and you will create your own @file{TAGS} tables.
4650
4651 @cindex Library, as term for `file'
4652 Incidentally, the files that contain Lisp code are conventionally
4653 called @dfn{libraries}. The metaphor is derived from that of a
4654 specialized library, such as a law library or an engineering library,
4655 rather than a general library. Each library, or file, contains
4656 functions that relate to a particular topic or activity, such as
4657 @file{abbrev.el} for handling abbreviations and other typing
4658 shortcuts, and @file{help.el} for on-line help. (Sometimes several
4659 libraries provide code for a single activity, as the various
4660 @file{rmail@dots{}} files provide code for reading electronic mail.)
4661 In @cite{The GNU Emacs Manual}, you will see sentences such as ``The
4662 @kbd{C-h p} command lets you search the standard Emacs Lisp libraries
4663 by topic keywords.''
4664
4665 @node simplified-beginning-of-buffer
4666 @section A Simplified @code{beginning-of-buffer} Definition
4667 @findex simplified-beginning-of-buffer
4668
4669 The @code{beginning-of-buffer} command is a good function to start with
4670 since you are likely to be familiar with it and it is easy to
4671 understand. Used as an interactive command, @code{beginning-of-buffer}
4672 moves the cursor to the beginning of the buffer, leaving the mark at the
4673 previous position. It is generally bound to @kbd{M-<}.
4674
4675 In this section, we will discuss a shortened version of the function
4676 that shows how it is most frequently used. This shortened function
4677 works as written, but it does not contain the code for a complex option.
4678 In another section, we will describe the entire function.
4679 (@xref{beginning-of-buffer, , Complete Definition of
4680 @code{beginning-of-buffer}}.)
4681
4682 Before looking at the code, let's consider what the function
4683 definition has to contain: it must include an expression that makes
4684 the function interactive so it can be called by typing @kbd{M-x
4685 beginning-of-buffer} or by typing a keychord such as @kbd{M-<}; it
4686 must include code to leave a mark at the original position in the
4687 buffer; and it must include code to move the cursor to the beginning
4688 of the buffer.
4689
4690 @need 1250
4691 Here is the complete text of the shortened version of the function:
4692
4693 @smallexample
4694 @group
4695 (defun simplified-beginning-of-buffer ()
4696 "Move point to the beginning of the buffer;
4697 leave mark at previous position."
4698 (interactive)
4699 (push-mark)
4700 (goto-char (point-min)))
4701 @end group
4702 @end smallexample
4703
4704 Like all function definitions, this definition has five parts following
4705 the macro @code{defun}:
4706
4707 @enumerate
4708 @item
4709 The name: in this example, @code{simplified-beginning-of-buffer}.
4710
4711 @item
4712 A list of the arguments: in this example, an empty list, @code{()},
4713
4714 @item
4715 The documentation string.
4716
4717 @item
4718 The interactive expression.
4719
4720 @item
4721 The body.
4722 @end enumerate
4723
4724 @noindent
4725 In this function definition, the argument list is empty; this means that
4726 this function does not require any arguments. (When we look at the
4727 definition for the complete function, we will see that it may be passed
4728 an optional argument.)
4729
4730 The interactive expression tells Emacs that the function is intended to
4731 be used interactively. In this example, @code{interactive} does not have
4732 an argument because @code{simplified-beginning-of-buffer} does not
4733 require one.
4734
4735 @need 800
4736 The body of the function consists of the two lines:
4737
4738 @smallexample
4739 @group
4740 (push-mark)
4741 (goto-char (point-min))
4742 @end group
4743 @end smallexample
4744
4745 The first of these lines is the expression, @code{(push-mark)}. When
4746 this expression is evaluated by the Lisp interpreter, it sets a mark at
4747 the current position of the cursor, wherever that may be. The position
4748 of this mark is saved in the mark ring.
4749
4750 The next line is @code{(goto-char (point-min))}. This expression
4751 jumps the cursor to the minimum point in the buffer, that is, to the
4752 beginning of the buffer (or to the beginning of the accessible portion
4753 of the buffer if it is narrowed. @xref{Narrowing & Widening, ,
4754 Narrowing and Widening}.)
4755
4756 The @code{push-mark} command sets a mark at the place where the cursor
4757 was located before it was moved to the beginning of the buffer by the
4758 @code{(goto-char (point-min))} expression. Consequently, you can, if
4759 you wish, go back to where you were originally by typing @kbd{C-x C-x}.
4760
4761 That is all there is to the function definition!
4762
4763 @findex describe-function
4764 When you are reading code such as this and come upon an unfamiliar
4765 function, such as @code{goto-char}, you can find out what it does by
4766 using the @code{describe-function} command. To use this command, type
4767 @kbd{C-h f} and then type in the name of the function and press
4768 @key{RET}. The @code{describe-function} command will print the
4769 function's documentation string in a @file{*Help*} window. For
4770 example, the documentation for @code{goto-char} is:
4771
4772 @smallexample
4773 @group
4774 Set point to POSITION, a number or marker.
4775 Beginning of buffer is position (point-min), end is (point-max).
4776 @end group
4777 @end smallexample
4778
4779 @noindent
4780 The function's one argument is the desired position.
4781
4782 @noindent
4783 (The prompt for @code{describe-function} will offer you the symbol
4784 under or preceding the cursor, so you can save typing by positioning
4785 the cursor right over or after the function and then typing @kbd{C-h f
4786 @key{RET}}.)
4787
4788 The @code{end-of-buffer} function definition is written in the same way as
4789 the @code{beginning-of-buffer} definition except that the body of the
4790 function contains the expression @code{(goto-char (point-max))} in place
4791 of @code{(goto-char (point-min))}.
4792
4793 @node mark-whole-buffer
4794 @section The Definition of @code{mark-whole-buffer}
4795 @findex mark-whole-buffer
4796
4797 The @code{mark-whole-buffer} function is no harder to understand than the
4798 @code{simplified-beginning-of-buffer} function. In this case, however,
4799 we will look at the complete function, not a shortened version.
4800
4801 The @code{mark-whole-buffer} function is not as commonly used as the
4802 @code{beginning-of-buffer} function, but is useful nonetheless: it
4803 marks a whole buffer as a region by putting point at the beginning and
4804 a mark at the end of the buffer. It is generally bound to @kbd{C-x
4805 h}.
4806
4807 @menu
4808 * mark-whole-buffer overview::
4809 * Body of mark-whole-buffer:: Only three lines of code.
4810 @end menu
4811
4812 @ifnottex
4813 @node mark-whole-buffer overview
4814 @unnumberedsubsec An overview of @code{mark-whole-buffer}
4815 @end ifnottex
4816
4817 @need 1250
4818 In GNU Emacs 22, the code for the complete function looks like this:
4819
4820 @smallexample
4821 @group
4822 (defun mark-whole-buffer ()
4823 "Put point at beginning and mark at end of buffer.
4824 You probably should not use this function in Lisp programs;
4825 it is usually a mistake for a Lisp function to use any subroutine
4826 that uses or sets the mark."
4827 (interactive)
4828 (push-mark (point))
4829 (push-mark (point-max) nil t)
4830 (goto-char (point-min)))
4831 @end group
4832 @end smallexample
4833
4834 @need 1250
4835 Like all other functions, the @code{mark-whole-buffer} function fits
4836 into the template for a function definition. The template looks like
4837 this:
4838
4839 @smallexample
4840 @group
4841 (defun @var{name-of-function} (@var{argument-list})
4842 "@var{documentation}@dots{}"
4843 (@var{interactive-expression}@dots{})
4844 @var{body}@dots{})
4845 @end group
4846 @end smallexample
4847
4848 Here is how the function works: the name of the function is
4849 @code{mark-whole-buffer}; it is followed by an empty argument list,
4850 @samp{()}, which means that the function does not require arguments.
4851 The documentation comes next.
4852
4853 The next line is an @code{(interactive)} expression that tells Emacs
4854 that the function will be used interactively. These details are similar
4855 to the @code{simplified-beginning-of-buffer} function described in the
4856 previous section.
4857
4858 @need 1250
4859 @node Body of mark-whole-buffer
4860 @subsection Body of @code{mark-whole-buffer}
4861
4862 The body of the @code{mark-whole-buffer} function consists of three
4863 lines of code:
4864
4865 @c GNU Emacs 22
4866 @smallexample
4867 @group
4868 (push-mark (point))
4869 (push-mark (point-max) nil t)
4870 (goto-char (point-min))
4871 @end group
4872 @end smallexample
4873
4874 The first of these lines is the expression, @code{(push-mark (point))}.
4875
4876 This line does exactly the same job as the first line of the body of
4877 the @code{simplified-beginning-of-buffer} function, which is written
4878 @code{(push-mark)}. In both cases, the Lisp interpreter sets a mark
4879 at the current position of the cursor.
4880
4881 I don't know why the expression in @code{mark-whole-buffer} is written
4882 @code{(push-mark (point))} and the expression in
4883 @code{beginning-of-buffer} is written @code{(push-mark)}. Perhaps
4884 whoever wrote the code did not know that the arguments for
4885 @code{push-mark} are optional and that if @code{push-mark} is not
4886 passed an argument, the function automatically sets mark at the
4887 location of point by default. Or perhaps the expression was written
4888 so as to parallel the structure of the next line. In any case, the
4889 line causes Emacs to determine the position of point and set a mark
4890 there.
4891
4892 In earlier versions of GNU Emacs, the next line of
4893 @code{mark-whole-buffer} was @code{(push-mark (point-max))}. This
4894 expression sets a mark at the point in the buffer that has the highest
4895 number. This will be the end of the buffer (or, if the buffer is
4896 narrowed, the end of the accessible portion of the buffer.
4897 @xref{Narrowing & Widening, , Narrowing and Widening}, for more about
4898 narrowing.) After this mark has been set, the previous mark, the one
4899 set at point, is no longer set, but Emacs remembers its position, just
4900 as all other recent marks are always remembered. This means that you
4901 can, if you wish, go back to that position by typing @kbd{C-u
4902 C-@key{SPC}} twice.
4903
4904 @need 1250
4905 In GNU Emacs 22, the @code{(point-max)} is slightly more complicated.
4906 The line reads
4907
4908 @smallexample
4909 (push-mark (point-max) nil t)
4910 @end smallexample
4911
4912 @noindent
4913 The expression works nearly the same as before. It sets a mark at the
4914 highest numbered place in the buffer that it can. However, in this
4915 version, @code{push-mark} has two additional arguments. The second
4916 argument to @code{push-mark} is @code{nil}. This tells the function
4917 it @emph{should} display a message that says `Mark set' when it pushes
4918 the mark. The third argument is @code{t}. This tells
4919 @code{push-mark} to activate the mark when Transient Mark mode is
4920 turned on. Transient Mark mode highlights the currently active
4921 region. It is often turned off.
4922
4923 Finally, the last line of the function is @code{(goto-char
4924 (point-min)))}. This is written exactly the same way as it is written
4925 in @code{beginning-of-buffer}. The expression moves the cursor to
4926 the minimum point in the buffer, that is, to the beginning of the buffer
4927 (or to the beginning of the accessible portion of the buffer). As a
4928 result of this, point is placed at the beginning of the buffer and mark
4929 is set at the end of the buffer. The whole buffer is, therefore, the
4930 region.
4931
4932 @node append-to-buffer
4933 @section The Definition of @code{append-to-buffer}
4934 @findex append-to-buffer
4935
4936 The @code{append-to-buffer} command is more complex than the
4937 @code{mark-whole-buffer} command. What it does is copy the region
4938 (that is, the part of the buffer between point and mark) from the
4939 current buffer to a specified buffer.
4940
4941 @menu
4942 * append-to-buffer overview::
4943 * append interactive:: A two part interactive expression.
4944 * append-to-buffer body:: Incorporates a @code{let} expression.
4945 * append save-excursion:: How the @code{save-excursion} works.
4946 @end menu
4947
4948 @ifnottex
4949 @node append-to-buffer overview
4950 @unnumberedsubsec An Overview of @code{append-to-buffer}
4951 @end ifnottex
4952
4953 @findex insert-buffer-substring
4954 The @code{append-to-buffer} command uses the
4955 @code{insert-buffer-substring} function to copy the region.
4956 @code{insert-buffer-substring} is described by its name: it takes a
4957 string of characters from part of a buffer, a ``substring'', and
4958 inserts them into another buffer.
4959
4960 Most of @code{append-to-buffer} is
4961 concerned with setting up the conditions for
4962 @code{insert-buffer-substring} to work: the code must specify both the
4963 buffer to which the text will go, the window it comes from and goes
4964 to, and the region that will be copied.
4965
4966 @need 1250
4967 Here is the complete text of the function:
4968
4969 @smallexample
4970 @group
4971 (defun append-to-buffer (buffer start end)
4972 "Append to specified buffer the text of the region.
4973 It is inserted into that buffer before its point.
4974 @end group
4975
4976 @group
4977 When calling from a program, give three arguments:
4978 BUFFER (or buffer name), START and END.
4979 START and END specify the portion of the current buffer to be copied."
4980 (interactive
4981 (list (read-buffer "Append to buffer: " (other-buffer
4982 (current-buffer) t))
4983 (region-beginning) (region-end)))
4984 @end group
4985 @group
4986 (let ((oldbuf (current-buffer)))
4987 (save-excursion
4988 (let* ((append-to (get-buffer-create buffer))
4989 (windows (get-buffer-window-list append-to t t))
4990 point)
4991 (set-buffer append-to)
4992 (setq point (point))
4993 (barf-if-buffer-read-only)
4994 (insert-buffer-substring oldbuf start end)
4995 (dolist (window windows)
4996 (when (= (window-point window) point)
4997 (set-window-point window (point))))))))
4998 @end group
4999 @end smallexample
5000
5001 The function can be understood by looking at it as a series of
5002 filled-in templates.
5003
5004 The outermost template is for the function definition. In this
5005 function, it looks like this (with several slots filled in):
5006
5007 @smallexample
5008 @group
5009 (defun append-to-buffer (buffer start end)
5010 "@var{documentation}@dots{}"
5011 (interactive @dots{})
5012 @var{body}@dots{})
5013 @end group
5014 @end smallexample
5015
5016 The first line of the function includes its name and three arguments.
5017 The arguments are the @code{buffer} to which the text will be copied, and
5018 the @code{start} and @code{end} of the region in the current buffer that
5019 will be copied.
5020
5021 The next part of the function is the documentation, which is clear and
5022 complete. As is conventional, the three arguments are written in
5023 upper case so you will notice them easily. Even better, they are
5024 described in the same order as in the argument list.
5025
5026 Note that the documentation distinguishes between a buffer and its
5027 name. (The function can handle either.)
5028
5029 @node append interactive
5030 @subsection The @code{append-to-buffer} Interactive Expression
5031
5032 Since the @code{append-to-buffer} function will be used interactively,
5033 the function must have an @code{interactive} expression. (For a
5034 review of @code{interactive}, see @ref{Interactive, , Making a
5035 Function Interactive}.) The expression reads as follows:
5036
5037 @smallexample
5038 @group
5039 (interactive
5040 (list (read-buffer
5041 "Append to buffer: "
5042 (other-buffer (current-buffer) t))
5043 (region-beginning)
5044 (region-end)))
5045 @end group
5046 @end smallexample
5047
5048 @noindent
5049 This expression is not one with letters standing for parts, as
5050 described earlier. Instead, it starts a list with these parts:
5051
5052 The first part of the list is an expression to read the name of a
5053 buffer and return it as a string. That is @code{read-buffer}. The
5054 function requires a prompt as its first argument, @samp{"Append to
5055 buffer: "}. Its second argument tells the command what value to
5056 provide if you don't specify anything.
5057
5058 In this case that second argument is an expression containing the
5059 function @code{other-buffer}, an exception, and a @samp{t}, standing
5060 for true.
5061
5062 The first argument to @code{other-buffer}, the exception, is yet
5063 another function, @code{current-buffer}. That is not going to be
5064 returned. The second argument is the symbol for true, @code{t}. that
5065 tells @code{other-buffer} that it may show visible buffers (except in
5066 this case, it will not show the current buffer, which makes sense).
5067
5068 @need 1250
5069 The expression looks like this:
5070
5071 @smallexample
5072 (other-buffer (current-buffer) t)
5073 @end smallexample
5074
5075 The second and third arguments to the @code{list} expression are
5076 @code{(region-beginning)} and @code{(region-end)}. These two
5077 functions specify the beginning and end of the text to be appended.
5078
5079 @need 1250
5080 Originally, the command used the letters @samp{B} and @samp{r}.
5081 The whole @code{interactive} expression looked like this:
5082
5083 @smallexample
5084 (interactive "BAppend to buffer:@: \nr")
5085 @end smallexample
5086
5087 @noindent
5088 But when that was done, the default value of the buffer switched to
5089 was invisible. That was not wanted.
5090
5091 (The prompt was separated from the second argument with a newline,
5092 @samp{\n}. It was followed by an @samp{r} that told Emacs to bind the
5093 two arguments that follow the symbol @code{buffer} in the function's
5094 argument list (that is, @code{start} and @code{end}) to the values of
5095 point and mark. That argument worked fine.)
5096
5097 @node append-to-buffer body
5098 @subsection The Body of @code{append-to-buffer}
5099
5100 @ignore
5101 in GNU Emacs 22 in /usr/local/src/emacs/lisp/simple.el
5102
5103 (defun append-to-buffer (buffer start end)
5104 "Append to specified buffer the text of the region.
5105 It is inserted into that buffer before its point.
5106
5107 When calling from a program, give three arguments:
5108 BUFFER (or buffer name), START and END.
5109 START and END specify the portion of the current buffer to be copied."
5110 (interactive
5111 (list (read-buffer "Append to buffer: " (other-buffer (current-buffer) t))
5112 (region-beginning) (region-end)))
5113 (let ((oldbuf (current-buffer)))
5114 (save-excursion
5115 (let* ((append-to (get-buffer-create buffer))
5116 (windows (get-buffer-window-list append-to t t))
5117 point)
5118 (set-buffer append-to)
5119 (setq point (point))
5120 (barf-if-buffer-read-only)
5121 (insert-buffer-substring oldbuf start end)
5122 (dolist (window windows)
5123 (when (= (window-point window) point)
5124 (set-window-point window (point))))))))
5125 @end ignore
5126
5127 The body of the @code{append-to-buffer} function begins with @code{let}.
5128
5129 As we have seen before (@pxref{let, , @code{let}}), the purpose of a
5130 @code{let} expression is to create and give initial values to one or
5131 more variables that will only be used within the body of the
5132 @code{let}. This means that such a variable will not be confused with
5133 any variable of the same name outside the @code{let} expression.
5134
5135 We can see how the @code{let} expression fits into the function as a
5136 whole by showing a template for @code{append-to-buffer} with the
5137 @code{let} expression in outline:
5138
5139 @smallexample
5140 @group
5141 (defun append-to-buffer (buffer start end)
5142 "@var{documentation}@dots{}"
5143 (interactive @dots{})
5144 (let ((@var{variable} @var{value}))
5145 @var{body}@dots{})
5146 @end group
5147 @end smallexample
5148
5149 The @code{let} expression has three elements:
5150
5151 @enumerate
5152 @item
5153 The symbol @code{let};
5154
5155 @item
5156 A varlist containing, in this case, a single two-element list,
5157 @code{(@var{variable} @var{value})};
5158
5159 @item
5160 The body of the @code{let} expression.
5161 @end enumerate
5162
5163 @need 800
5164 In the @code{append-to-buffer} function, the varlist looks like this:
5165
5166 @smallexample
5167 (oldbuf (current-buffer))
5168 @end smallexample
5169
5170 @noindent
5171 In this part of the @code{let} expression, the one variable,
5172 @code{oldbuf}, is bound to the value returned by the
5173 @code{(current-buffer)} expression. The variable, @code{oldbuf}, is
5174 used to keep track of the buffer in which you are working and from
5175 which you will copy.
5176
5177 The element or elements of a varlist are surrounded by a set of
5178 parentheses so the Lisp interpreter can distinguish the varlist from
5179 the body of the @code{let}. As a consequence, the two-element list
5180 within the varlist is surrounded by a circumscribing set of parentheses.
5181 The line looks like this:
5182
5183 @smallexample
5184 @group
5185 (let ((oldbuf (current-buffer)))
5186 @dots{} )
5187 @end group
5188 @end smallexample
5189
5190 @noindent
5191 The two parentheses before @code{oldbuf} might surprise you if you did
5192 not realize that the first parenthesis before @code{oldbuf} marks the
5193 boundary of the varlist and the second parenthesis marks the beginning
5194 of the two-element list, @code{(oldbuf (current-buffer))}.
5195
5196 @node append save-excursion
5197 @subsection @code{save-excursion} in @code{append-to-buffer}
5198
5199 The body of the @code{let} expression in @code{append-to-buffer}
5200 consists of a @code{save-excursion} expression.
5201
5202 The @code{save-excursion} function saves the locations of point and
5203 mark, and restores them to those positions after the expressions in the
5204 body of the @code{save-excursion} complete execution. In addition,
5205 @code{save-excursion} keeps track of the original buffer, and
5206 restores it. This is how @code{save-excursion} is used in
5207 @code{append-to-buffer}.
5208
5209 @need 1500
5210 @cindex Indentation for formatting
5211 @cindex Formatting convention
5212 Incidentally, it is worth noting here that a Lisp function is normally
5213 formatted so that everything that is enclosed in a multi-line spread is
5214 indented more to the right than the first symbol. In this function
5215 definition, the @code{let} is indented more than the @code{defun}, and
5216 the @code{save-excursion} is indented more than the @code{let}, like
5217 this:
5218
5219 @smallexample
5220 @group
5221 (defun @dots{}
5222 @dots{}
5223 @dots{}
5224 (let@dots{}
5225 (save-excursion
5226 @dots{}
5227 @end group
5228 @end smallexample
5229
5230 @need 1500
5231 @noindent
5232 This formatting convention makes it easy to see that the lines in
5233 the body of the @code{save-excursion} are enclosed by the parentheses
5234 associated with @code{save-excursion}, just as the
5235 @code{save-excursion} itself is enclosed by the parentheses associated
5236 with the @code{let}:
5237
5238 @smallexample
5239 @group
5240 (let ((oldbuf (current-buffer)))
5241 (save-excursion
5242 @dots{}
5243 (set-buffer @dots{})
5244 (insert-buffer-substring oldbuf start end)
5245 @dots{}))
5246 @end group
5247 @end smallexample
5248
5249 @need 1200
5250 The use of the @code{save-excursion} function can be viewed as a process
5251 of filling in the slots of a template:
5252
5253 @smallexample
5254 @group
5255 (save-excursion
5256 @var{first-expression-in-body}
5257 @var{second-expression-in-body}
5258 @dots{}
5259 @var{last-expression-in-body})
5260 @end group
5261 @end smallexample
5262
5263 @need 1200
5264 @noindent
5265 In this function, the body of the @code{save-excursion} contains only
5266 one expression, the @code{let*} expression. You know about a
5267 @code{let} function. The @code{let*} function is different. It has a
5268 @samp{*} in its name. It enables Emacs to set each variable in its
5269 varlist in sequence, one after another.
5270
5271 Its critical feature is that variables later in the varlist can make
5272 use of the values to which Emacs set variables earlier in the varlist.
5273 @xref{fwd-para let, , The @code{let*} expression}.
5274
5275 We will skip functions like @code{let*} and focus on two: the
5276 @code{set-buffer} function and the @code{insert-buffer-substring}
5277 function.
5278
5279 @need 1250
5280 In the old days, the @code{set-buffer} expression was simply
5281
5282 @smallexample
5283 (set-buffer (get-buffer-create buffer))
5284 @end smallexample
5285
5286 @need 1250
5287 @noindent
5288 but now it is
5289
5290 @smallexample
5291 (set-buffer append-to)
5292 @end smallexample
5293
5294 @noindent
5295 @code{append-to} is bound to @code{(get-buffer-create buffer)} earlier
5296 on in the @code{let*} expression. That extra binding would not be
5297 necessary except for that @code{append-to} is used later in the
5298 varlist as an argument to @code{get-buffer-window-list}.
5299
5300 @ignore
5301 in GNU Emacs 22
5302
5303 (let ((oldbuf (current-buffer)))
5304 (save-excursion
5305 (let* ((append-to (get-buffer-create buffer))
5306 (windows (get-buffer-window-list append-to t t))
5307 point)
5308 (set-buffer append-to)
5309 (setq point (point))
5310 (barf-if-buffer-read-only)
5311 (insert-buffer-substring oldbuf start end)
5312 (dolist (window windows)
5313 (when (= (window-point window) point)
5314 (set-window-point window (point))))))))
5315 @end ignore
5316
5317 The @code{append-to-buffer} function definition inserts text from the
5318 buffer in which you are currently to a named buffer. It happens that
5319 @code{insert-buffer-substring} copies text from another buffer to the
5320 current buffer, just the reverse---that is why the
5321 @code{append-to-buffer} definition starts out with a @code{let} that
5322 binds the local symbol @code{oldbuf} to the value returned by
5323 @code{current-buffer}.
5324
5325 @need 1250
5326 The @code{insert-buffer-substring} expression looks like this:
5327
5328 @smallexample
5329 (insert-buffer-substring oldbuf start end)
5330 @end smallexample
5331
5332 @noindent
5333 The @code{insert-buffer-substring} function copies a string
5334 @emph{from} the buffer specified as its first argument and inserts the
5335 string into the present buffer. In this case, the argument to
5336 @code{insert-buffer-substring} is the value of the variable created
5337 and bound by the @code{let}, namely the value of @code{oldbuf}, which
5338 was the current buffer when you gave the @code{append-to-buffer}
5339 command.
5340
5341 After @code{insert-buffer-substring} has done its work,
5342 @code{save-excursion} will restore the action to the original buffer
5343 and @code{append-to-buffer} will have done its job.
5344
5345 @need 800
5346 Written in skeletal form, the workings of the body look like this:
5347
5348 @smallexample
5349 @group
5350 (let (@var{bind-}@code{oldbuf}@var{-to-value-of-}@code{current-buffer})
5351 (save-excursion ; @r{Keep track of buffer.}
5352 @var{change-buffer}
5353 @var{insert-substring-from-}@code{oldbuf}@var{-into-buffer})
5354
5355 @var{change-back-to-original-buffer-when-finished}
5356 @var{let-the-local-meaning-of-}@code{oldbuf}@var{-disappear-when-finished}
5357 @end group
5358 @end smallexample
5359
5360 In summary, @code{append-to-buffer} works as follows: it saves the
5361 value of the current buffer in the variable called @code{oldbuf}. It
5362 gets the new buffer (creating one if need be) and switches Emacs's
5363 attention to it. Using the value of @code{oldbuf}, it inserts the
5364 region of text from the old buffer into the new buffer; and then using
5365 @code{save-excursion}, it brings you back to your original buffer.
5366
5367 In looking at @code{append-to-buffer}, you have explored a fairly
5368 complex function. It shows how to use @code{let} and
5369 @code{save-excursion}, and how to change to and come back from another
5370 buffer. Many function definitions use @code{let},
5371 @code{save-excursion}, and @code{set-buffer} this way.
5372
5373 @node Buffer Related Review
5374 @section Review
5375
5376 Here is a brief summary of the various functions discussed in this chapter.
5377
5378 @table @code
5379 @item describe-function
5380 @itemx describe-variable
5381 Print the documentation for a function or variable.
5382 Conventionally bound to @kbd{C-h f} and @kbd{C-h v}.
5383
5384 @item find-tag
5385 Find the file containing the source for a function or variable and
5386 switch buffers to it, positioning point at the beginning of the item.
5387 Conventionally bound to @kbd{M-.} (that's a period following the
5388 @key{META} key).
5389
5390 @item save-excursion
5391 Save the location of point and mark and restore their values after the
5392 arguments to @code{save-excursion} have been evaluated. Also, remember
5393 the current buffer and return to it.
5394
5395 @item push-mark
5396 Set mark at a location and record the value of the previous mark on the
5397 mark ring. The mark is a location in the buffer that will keep its
5398 relative position even if text is added to or removed from the buffer.
5399
5400 @item goto-char
5401 Set point to the location specified by the value of the argument, which
5402 can be a number, a marker, or an expression that returns the number of
5403 a position, such as @code{(point-min)}.
5404
5405 @item insert-buffer-substring
5406 Copy a region of text from a buffer that is passed to the function as
5407 an argument and insert the region into the current buffer.
5408
5409 @item mark-whole-buffer
5410 Mark the whole buffer as a region. Normally bound to @kbd{C-x h}.
5411
5412 @item set-buffer
5413 Switch the attention of Emacs to another buffer, but do not change the
5414 window being displayed. Used when the program rather than a human is
5415 to work on a different buffer.
5416
5417 @item get-buffer-create
5418 @itemx get-buffer
5419 Find a named buffer or create one if a buffer of that name does not
5420 exist. The @code{get-buffer} function returns @code{nil} if the named
5421 buffer does not exist.
5422 @end table
5423
5424 @need 1500
5425 @node Buffer Exercises
5426 @section Exercises
5427
5428 @itemize @bullet
5429 @item
5430 Write your own @code{simplified-end-of-buffer} function definition;
5431 then test it to see whether it works.
5432
5433 @item
5434 Use @code{if} and @code{get-buffer} to write a function that prints a
5435 message telling you whether a buffer exists.
5436
5437 @item
5438 Using @code{find-tag}, find the source for the @code{copy-to-buffer}
5439 function.
5440 @end itemize
5441
5442 @node More Complex
5443 @chapter A Few More Complex Functions
5444
5445 In this chapter, we build on what we have learned in previous chapters
5446 by looking at more complex functions. The @code{copy-to-buffer}
5447 function illustrates use of two @code{save-excursion} expressions in
5448 one definition, while the @code{insert-buffer} function illustrates
5449 use of an asterisk in an @code{interactive} expression, use of
5450 @code{or}, and the important distinction between a name and the object
5451 to which the name refers.
5452
5453 @menu
5454 * copy-to-buffer:: With @code{set-buffer}, @code{get-buffer-create}.
5455 * insert-buffer:: Read-only, and with @code{or}.
5456 * beginning-of-buffer:: Shows @code{goto-char},
5457 @code{point-min}, and @code{push-mark}.
5458 * Second Buffer Related Review::
5459 * optional Exercise::
5460 @end menu
5461
5462 @node copy-to-buffer
5463 @section The Definition of @code{copy-to-buffer}
5464 @findex copy-to-buffer
5465
5466 After understanding how @code{append-to-buffer} works, it is easy to
5467 understand @code{copy-to-buffer}. This function copies text into a
5468 buffer, but instead of adding to the second buffer, it replaces all the
5469 previous text in the second buffer.
5470
5471 @need 800
5472 The body of @code{copy-to-buffer} looks like this,
5473
5474 @smallexample
5475 @group
5476 @dots{}
5477 (interactive "BCopy to buffer: \nr")
5478 (let ((oldbuf (current-buffer)))
5479 (with-current-buffer (get-buffer-create buffer)
5480 (barf-if-buffer-read-only)
5481 (erase-buffer)
5482 (save-excursion
5483 (insert-buffer-substring oldbuf start end)))))
5484 @end group
5485 @end smallexample
5486
5487 The @code{copy-to-buffer} function has a simpler @code{interactive}
5488 expression than @code{append-to-buffer}.
5489
5490 @need 800
5491 The definition then says
5492
5493 @smallexample
5494 (with-current-buffer (get-buffer-create buffer) @dots{}
5495 @end smallexample
5496
5497 First, look at the earliest inner expression; that is evaluated first.
5498 That expression starts with @code{get-buffer-create buffer}. The
5499 function tells the computer to use the buffer with the name specified
5500 as the one to which you are copying, or if such a buffer does not
5501 exist, to create it. Then, the @code{with-current-buffer} function
5502 evaluates its body with that buffer temporarily current.
5503
5504 (This demonstrates another way to shift the computer's attention but
5505 not the user's. The @code{append-to-buffer} function showed how to do
5506 the same with @code{save-excursion} and @code{set-buffer}.
5507 @code{with-current-buffer} is a newer, and arguably easier,
5508 mechanism.)
5509
5510 The @code{barf-if-buffer-read-only} function sends you an error
5511 message saying the buffer is read-only if you cannot modify it.
5512
5513 The next line has the @code{erase-buffer} function as its sole
5514 contents. That function erases the buffer.
5515
5516 Finally, the last two lines contain the @code{save-excursion}
5517 expression with @code{insert-buffer-substring} as its body.
5518 The @code{insert-buffer-substring} expression copies the text from
5519 the buffer you are in (and you have not seen the computer shift its
5520 attention, so you don't know that that buffer is now called
5521 @code{oldbuf}).
5522
5523 Incidentally, this is what is meant by `replacement'. To replace text,
5524 Emacs erases the previous text and then inserts new text.
5525
5526 @need 1250
5527 In outline, the body of @code{copy-to-buffer} looks like this:
5528
5529 @smallexample
5530 @group
5531 (let (@var{bind-}@code{oldbuf}@var{-to-value-of-}@code{current-buffer})
5532 (@var{with-the-buffer-you-are-copying-to}
5533 (@var{but-do-not-erase-or-copy-to-a-read-only-buffer})
5534 (erase-buffer)
5535 (save-excursion
5536 @var{insert-substring-from-}@code{oldbuf}@var{-into-buffer})))
5537 @end group
5538 @end smallexample
5539
5540 @node insert-buffer
5541 @section The Definition of @code{insert-buffer}
5542 @findex insert-buffer
5543
5544 @code{insert-buffer} is yet another buffer-related function. This
5545 command copies another buffer @emph{into} the current buffer. It is the
5546 reverse of @code{append-to-buffer} or @code{copy-to-buffer}, since they
5547 copy a region of text @emph{from} the current buffer to another buffer.
5548
5549 Here is a discussion based on the original code. The code was
5550 simplified in 2003 and is harder to understand.
5551
5552 (@xref{New insert-buffer, , New Body for @code{insert-buffer}}, to see
5553 a discussion of the new body.)
5554
5555 In addition, this code illustrates the use of @code{interactive} with a
5556 buffer that might be @dfn{read-only} and the important distinction
5557 between the name of an object and the object actually referred to.
5558
5559 @menu
5560 * insert-buffer code::
5561 * insert-buffer interactive:: When you can read, but not write.
5562 * insert-buffer body:: The body has an @code{or} and a @code{let}.
5563 * if & or:: Using an @code{if} instead of an @code{or}.
5564 * Insert or:: How the @code{or} expression works.
5565 * Insert let:: Two @code{save-excursion} expressions.
5566 * New insert-buffer::
5567 @end menu
5568
5569 @ifnottex
5570 @node insert-buffer code
5571 @unnumberedsubsec The Code for @code{insert-buffer}
5572 @end ifnottex
5573
5574 @need 800
5575 Here is the earlier code:
5576
5577 @smallexample
5578 @group
5579 (defun insert-buffer (buffer)
5580 "Insert after point the contents of BUFFER.
5581 Puts mark after the inserted text.
5582 BUFFER may be a buffer or a buffer name."
5583 (interactive "*bInsert buffer:@: ")
5584 @end group
5585 @group
5586 (or (bufferp buffer)
5587 (setq buffer (get-buffer buffer)))
5588 (let (start end newmark)
5589 (save-excursion
5590 (save-excursion
5591 (set-buffer buffer)
5592 (setq start (point-min) end (point-max)))
5593 @end group
5594 @group
5595 (insert-buffer-substring buffer start end)
5596 (setq newmark (point)))
5597 (push-mark newmark)))
5598 @end group
5599 @end smallexample
5600
5601 @need 1200
5602 As with other function definitions, you can use a template to see an
5603 outline of the function:
5604
5605 @smallexample
5606 @group
5607 (defun insert-buffer (buffer)
5608 "@var{documentation}@dots{}"
5609 (interactive "*bInsert buffer:@: ")
5610 @var{body}@dots{})
5611 @end group
5612 @end smallexample
5613
5614 @node insert-buffer interactive
5615 @subsection The Interactive Expression in @code{insert-buffer}
5616 @findex interactive, @r{example use of}
5617
5618 In @code{insert-buffer}, the argument to the @code{interactive}
5619 declaration has two parts, an asterisk, @samp{*}, and @samp{bInsert
5620 buffer:@: }.
5621
5622 @menu
5623 * Read-only buffer:: When a buffer cannot be modified.
5624 * b for interactive:: An existing buffer or else its name.
5625 @end menu
5626
5627 @node Read-only buffer
5628 @unnumberedsubsubsec A Read-only Buffer
5629 @cindex Read-only buffer
5630 @cindex Asterisk for read-only buffer
5631 @findex * @r{for read-only buffer}
5632
5633 The asterisk is for the situation when the current buffer is a
5634 read-only buffer---a buffer that cannot be modified. If
5635 @code{insert-buffer} is called when the current buffer is read-only, a
5636 message to this effect is printed in the echo area and the terminal
5637 may beep or blink at you; you will not be permitted to insert anything
5638 into current buffer. The asterisk does not need to be followed by a
5639 newline to separate it from the next argument.
5640
5641 @node b for interactive
5642 @unnumberedsubsubsec @samp{b} in an Interactive Expression
5643
5644 The next argument in the interactive expression starts with a lower
5645 case @samp{b}. (This is different from the code for
5646 @code{append-to-buffer}, which uses an upper-case @samp{B}.
5647 @xref{append-to-buffer, , The Definition of @code{append-to-buffer}}.)
5648 The lower-case @samp{b} tells the Lisp interpreter that the argument
5649 for @code{insert-buffer} should be an existing buffer or else its
5650 name. (The upper-case @samp{B} option provides for the possibility
5651 that the buffer does not exist.) Emacs will prompt you for the name
5652 of the buffer, offering you a default buffer, with name completion
5653 enabled. If the buffer does not exist, you receive a message that
5654 says ``No match''; your terminal may beep at you as well.
5655
5656 The new and simplified code generates a list for @code{interactive}.
5657 It uses the @code{barf-if-buffer-read-only} and @code{read-buffer}
5658 functions with which we are already familiar and the @code{progn}
5659 special form with which we are not. (It will be described later.)
5660
5661 @node insert-buffer body
5662 @subsection The Body of the @code{insert-buffer} Function
5663
5664 The body of the @code{insert-buffer} function has two major parts: an
5665 @code{or} expression and a @code{let} expression. The purpose of the
5666 @code{or} expression is to ensure that the argument @code{buffer} is
5667 bound to a buffer and not just the name of a buffer. The body of the
5668 @code{let} expression contains the code which copies the other buffer
5669 into the current buffer.
5670
5671 @need 1250
5672 In outline, the two expressions fit into the @code{insert-buffer}
5673 function like this:
5674
5675 @smallexample
5676 @group
5677 (defun insert-buffer (buffer)
5678 "@var{documentation}@dots{}"
5679 (interactive "*bInsert buffer:@: ")
5680 (or @dots{}
5681 @dots{}
5682 @end group
5683 @group
5684 (let (@var{varlist})
5685 @var{body-of-}@code{let}@dots{} )
5686 @end group
5687 @end smallexample
5688
5689 To understand how the @code{or} expression ensures that the argument
5690 @code{buffer} is bound to a buffer and not to the name of a buffer, it
5691 is first necessary to understand the @code{or} function.
5692
5693 Before doing this, let me rewrite this part of the function using
5694 @code{if} so that you can see what is done in a manner that will be familiar.
5695
5696 @node if & or
5697 @subsection @code{insert-buffer} With an @code{if} Instead of an @code{or}
5698
5699 The job to be done is to make sure the value of @code{buffer} is a
5700 buffer itself and not the name of a buffer. If the value is the name,
5701 then the buffer itself must be got.
5702
5703 You can imagine yourself at a conference where an usher is wandering
5704 around holding a list with your name on it and looking for you: the
5705 usher is ``bound'' to your name, not to you; but when the usher finds
5706 you and takes your arm, the usher becomes ``bound'' to you.
5707
5708 @need 800
5709 In Lisp, you might describe this situation like this:
5710
5711 @smallexample
5712 @group
5713 (if (not (holding-on-to-guest))
5714 (find-and-take-arm-of-guest))
5715 @end group
5716 @end smallexample
5717
5718 We want to do the same thing with a buffer---if we do not have the
5719 buffer itself, we want to get it.
5720
5721 @need 1200
5722 Using a predicate called @code{bufferp} that tells us whether we have a
5723 buffer (rather than its name), we can write the code like this:
5724
5725 @smallexample
5726 @group
5727 (if (not (bufferp buffer)) ; @r{if-part}
5728 (setq buffer (get-buffer buffer))) ; @r{then-part}
5729 @end group
5730 @end smallexample
5731
5732 @noindent
5733 Here, the true-or-false-test of the @code{if} expression is
5734 @w{@code{(not (bufferp buffer))}}; and the then-part is the expression
5735 @w{@code{(setq buffer (get-buffer buffer))}}.
5736
5737 In the test, the function @code{bufferp} returns true if its argument is
5738 a buffer---but false if its argument is the name of the buffer. (The
5739 last character of the function name @code{bufferp} is the character
5740 @samp{p}; as we saw earlier, such use of @samp{p} is a convention that
5741 indicates that the function is a predicate, which is a term that means
5742 that the function will determine whether some property is true or false.
5743 @xref{Wrong Type of Argument, , Using the Wrong Type Object as an
5744 Argument}.)
5745
5746 @need 1200
5747 The function @code{not} precedes the expression @code{(bufferp buffer)},
5748 so the true-or-false-test looks like this:
5749
5750 @smallexample
5751 (not (bufferp buffer))
5752 @end smallexample
5753
5754 @noindent
5755 @code{not} is a function that returns true if its argument is false
5756 and false if its argument is true. So if @code{(bufferp buffer)}
5757 returns true, the @code{not} expression returns false and vice-verse:
5758 what is ``not true'' is false and what is ``not false'' is true.
5759
5760 Using this test, the @code{if} expression works as follows: when the
5761 value of the variable @code{buffer} is actually a buffer rather than
5762 its name, the true-or-false-test returns false and the @code{if}
5763 expression does not evaluate the then-part. This is fine, since we do
5764 not need to do anything to the variable @code{buffer} if it really is
5765 a buffer.
5766
5767 On the other hand, when the value of @code{buffer} is not a buffer
5768 itself, but the name of a buffer, the true-or-false-test returns true
5769 and the then-part of the expression is evaluated. In this case, the
5770 then-part is @code{(setq buffer (get-buffer buffer))}. This
5771 expression uses the @code{get-buffer} function to return an actual
5772 buffer itself, given its name. The @code{setq} then sets the variable
5773 @code{buffer} to the value of the buffer itself, replacing its previous
5774 value (which was the name of the buffer).
5775
5776 @node Insert or
5777 @subsection The @code{or} in the Body
5778
5779 The purpose of the @code{or} expression in the @code{insert-buffer}
5780 function is to ensure that the argument @code{buffer} is bound to a
5781 buffer and not just to the name of a buffer. The previous section shows
5782 how the job could have been done using an @code{if} expression.
5783 However, the @code{insert-buffer} function actually uses @code{or}.
5784 To understand this, it is necessary to understand how @code{or} works.
5785
5786 @findex or
5787 An @code{or} function can have any number of arguments. It evaluates
5788 each argument in turn and returns the value of the first of its
5789 arguments that is not @code{nil}. Also, and this is a crucial feature
5790 of @code{or}, it does not evaluate any subsequent arguments after
5791 returning the first non-@code{nil} value.
5792
5793 @need 800
5794 The @code{or} expression looks like this:
5795
5796 @smallexample
5797 @group
5798 (or (bufferp buffer)
5799 (setq buffer (get-buffer buffer)))
5800 @end group
5801 @end smallexample
5802
5803 @noindent
5804 The first argument to @code{or} is the expression @code{(bufferp buffer)}.
5805 This expression returns true (a non-@code{nil} value) if the buffer is
5806 actually a buffer, and not just the name of a buffer. In the @code{or}
5807 expression, if this is the case, the @code{or} expression returns this
5808 true value and does not evaluate the next expression---and this is fine
5809 with us, since we do not want to do anything to the value of
5810 @code{buffer} if it really is a buffer.
5811
5812 On the other hand, if the value of @code{(bufferp buffer)} is @code{nil},
5813 which it will be if the value of @code{buffer} is the name of a buffer,
5814 the Lisp interpreter evaluates the next element of the @code{or}
5815 expression. This is the expression @code{(setq buffer (get-buffer
5816 buffer))}. This expression returns a non-@code{nil} value, which
5817 is the value to which it sets the variable @code{buffer}---and this
5818 value is a buffer itself, not the name of a buffer.
5819
5820 The result of all this is that the symbol @code{buffer} is always
5821 bound to a buffer itself rather than to the name of a buffer. All
5822 this is necessary because the @code{set-buffer} function in a
5823 following line only works with a buffer itself, not with the name to a
5824 buffer.
5825
5826 @need 1250
5827 Incidentally, using @code{or}, the situation with the usher would be
5828 written like this:
5829
5830 @smallexample
5831 (or (holding-on-to-guest) (find-and-take-arm-of-guest))
5832 @end smallexample
5833
5834 @node Insert let
5835 @subsection The @code{let} Expression in @code{insert-buffer}
5836
5837 After ensuring that the variable @code{buffer} refers to a buffer itself
5838 and not just to the name of a buffer, the @code{insert-buffer function}
5839 continues with a @code{let} expression. This specifies three local
5840 variables, @code{start}, @code{end}, and @code{newmark} and binds them
5841 to the initial value @code{nil}. These variables are used inside the
5842 remainder of the @code{let} and temporarily hide any other occurrence of
5843 variables of the same name in Emacs until the end of the @code{let}.
5844
5845 @need 1200
5846 The body of the @code{let} contains two @code{save-excursion}
5847 expressions. First, we will look at the inner @code{save-excursion}
5848 expression in detail. The expression looks like this:
5849
5850 @smallexample
5851 @group
5852 (save-excursion
5853 (set-buffer buffer)
5854 (setq start (point-min) end (point-max)))
5855 @end group
5856 @end smallexample
5857
5858 @noindent
5859 The expression @code{(set-buffer buffer)} changes Emacs's attention
5860 from the current buffer to the one from which the text will copied.
5861 In that buffer, the variables @code{start} and @code{end} are set to
5862 the beginning and end of the buffer, using the commands
5863 @code{point-min} and @code{point-max}. Note that we have here an
5864 illustration of how @code{setq} is able to set two variables in the
5865 same expression. The first argument of @code{setq} is set to the
5866 value of its second, and its third argument is set to the value of its
5867 fourth.
5868
5869 After the body of the inner @code{save-excursion} is evaluated, the
5870 @code{save-excursion} restores the original buffer, but @code{start} and
5871 @code{end} remain set to the values of the beginning and end of the
5872 buffer from which the text will be copied.
5873
5874 @need 1250
5875 The outer @code{save-excursion} expression looks like this:
5876
5877 @smallexample
5878 @group
5879 (save-excursion
5880 (@var{inner-}@code{save-excursion}@var{-expression}
5881 (@var{go-to-new-buffer-and-set-}@code{start}@var{-and-}@code{end})
5882 (insert-buffer-substring buffer start end)
5883 (setq newmark (point)))
5884 @end group
5885 @end smallexample
5886
5887 @noindent
5888 The @code{insert-buffer-substring} function copies the text
5889 @emph{into} the current buffer @emph{from} the region indicated by
5890 @code{start} and @code{end} in @code{buffer}. Since the whole of the
5891 second buffer lies between @code{start} and @code{end}, the whole of
5892 the second buffer is copied into the buffer you are editing. Next,
5893 the value of point, which will be at the end of the inserted text, is
5894 recorded in the variable @code{newmark}.
5895
5896 After the body of the outer @code{save-excursion} is evaluated, point
5897 and mark are relocated to their original places.
5898
5899 However, it is convenient to locate a mark at the end of the newly
5900 inserted text and locate point at its beginning. The @code{newmark}
5901 variable records the end of the inserted text. In the last line of
5902 the @code{let} expression, the @code{(push-mark newmark)} expression
5903 function sets a mark to this location. (The previous location of the
5904 mark is still accessible; it is recorded on the mark ring and you can
5905 go back to it with @kbd{C-u C-@key{SPC}}.) Meanwhile, point is
5906 located at the beginning of the inserted text, which is where it was
5907 before you called the insert function, the position of which was saved
5908 by the first @code{save-excursion}.
5909
5910 @need 1250
5911 The whole @code{let} expression looks like this:
5912
5913 @smallexample
5914 @group
5915 (let (start end newmark)
5916 (save-excursion
5917 (save-excursion
5918 (set-buffer buffer)
5919 (setq start (point-min) end (point-max)))
5920 (insert-buffer-substring buffer start end)
5921 (setq newmark (point)))
5922 (push-mark newmark))
5923 @end group
5924 @end smallexample
5925
5926 Like the @code{append-to-buffer} function, the @code{insert-buffer}
5927 function uses @code{let}, @code{save-excursion}, and
5928 @code{set-buffer}. In addition, the function illustrates one way to
5929 use @code{or}. All these functions are building blocks that we will
5930 find and use again and again.
5931
5932 @node New insert-buffer
5933 @subsection New Body for @code{insert-buffer}
5934 @findex insert-buffer, new version body
5935 @findex new version body for insert-buffer
5936
5937 The body in the GNU Emacs 22 version is more confusing than the original.
5938
5939 @need 1250
5940 It consists of two expressions,
5941
5942 @smallexample
5943 @group
5944 (push-mark
5945 (save-excursion
5946 (insert-buffer-substring (get-buffer buffer))
5947 (point)))
5948
5949 nil
5950 @end group
5951 @end smallexample
5952
5953 @noindent
5954 except, and this is what confuses novices, very important work is done
5955 inside the @code{push-mark} expression.
5956
5957 The @code{get-buffer} function returns a buffer with the name
5958 provided. You will note that the function is @emph{not} called
5959 @code{get-buffer-create}; it does not create a buffer if one does not
5960 already exist. The buffer returned by @code{get-buffer}, an existing
5961 buffer, is passed to @code{insert-buffer-substring}, which inserts the
5962 whole of the buffer (since you did not specify anything else).
5963
5964 The location into which the buffer is inserted is recorded by
5965 @code{push-mark}. Then the function returns @code{nil}, the value of
5966 its last command. Put another way, the @code{insert-buffer} function
5967 exists only to produce a side effect, inserting another buffer, not to
5968 return any value.
5969
5970 @node beginning-of-buffer
5971 @section Complete Definition of @code{beginning-of-buffer}
5972 @findex beginning-of-buffer
5973
5974 The basic structure of the @code{beginning-of-buffer} function has
5975 already been discussed. (@xref{simplified-beginning-of-buffer, , A
5976 Simplified @code{beginning-of-buffer} Definition}.)
5977 This section describes the complex part of the definition.
5978
5979 As previously described, when invoked without an argument,
5980 @code{beginning-of-buffer} moves the cursor to the beginning of the
5981 buffer (in truth, the beginning of the accessible portion of the
5982 buffer), leaving the mark at the previous position. However, when the
5983 command is invoked with a number between one and ten, the function
5984 considers that number to be a fraction of the length of the buffer,
5985 measured in tenths, and Emacs moves the cursor that fraction of the
5986 way from the beginning of the buffer. Thus, you can either call this
5987 function with the key command @kbd{M-<}, which will move the cursor to
5988 the beginning of the buffer, or with a key command such as @kbd{C-u 7
5989 M-<} which will move the cursor to a point 70% of the way through the
5990 buffer. If a number bigger than ten is used for the argument, it
5991 moves to the end of the buffer.
5992
5993 The @code{beginning-of-buffer} function can be called with or without an
5994 argument. The use of the argument is optional.
5995
5996 @menu
5997 * Optional Arguments::
5998 * beginning-of-buffer opt arg:: Example with optional argument.
5999 * beginning-of-buffer complete::
6000 @end menu
6001
6002 @node Optional Arguments
6003 @subsection Optional Arguments
6004
6005 Unless told otherwise, Lisp expects that a function with an argument in
6006 its function definition will be called with a value for that argument.
6007 If that does not happen, you get an error and a message that says
6008 @samp{Wrong number of arguments}.
6009
6010 @cindex Optional arguments
6011 @cindex Keyword
6012 @findex optional
6013 However, optional arguments are a feature of Lisp: a particular
6014 @dfn{keyword} is used to tell the Lisp interpreter that an argument is
6015 optional. The keyword is @code{&optional}. (The @samp{&} in front of
6016 @samp{optional} is part of the keyword.) In a function definition, if
6017 an argument follows the keyword @code{&optional}, no value need be
6018 passed to that argument when the function is called.
6019
6020 @need 1200
6021 The first line of the function definition of @code{beginning-of-buffer}
6022 therefore looks like this:
6023
6024 @smallexample
6025 (defun beginning-of-buffer (&optional arg)
6026 @end smallexample
6027
6028 @need 1250
6029 In outline, the whole function looks like this:
6030
6031 @smallexample
6032 @group
6033 (defun beginning-of-buffer (&optional arg)
6034 "@var{documentation}@dots{}"
6035 (interactive "P")
6036 (or (@var{is-the-argument-a-cons-cell} arg)
6037 (and @var{are-both-transient-mark-mode-and-mark-active-true})
6038 (push-mark))
6039 (let (@var{determine-size-and-set-it})
6040 (goto-char
6041 (@var{if-there-is-an-argument}
6042 @var{figure-out-where-to-go}
6043 @var{else-go-to}
6044 (point-min))))
6045 @var{do-nicety}
6046 @end group
6047 @end smallexample
6048
6049 The function is similar to the @code{simplified-beginning-of-buffer}
6050 function except that the @code{interactive} expression has @code{"P"}
6051 as an argument and the @code{goto-char} function is followed by an
6052 if-then-else expression that figures out where to put the cursor if
6053 there is an argument that is not a cons cell.
6054
6055 (Since I do not explain a cons cell for many more chapters, please
6056 consider ignoring the function @code{consp}. @xref{List
6057 Implementation, , How Lists are Implemented}, and @ref{Cons Cell Type,
6058 , Cons Cell and List Types, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference
6059 Manual}.)
6060
6061 The @code{"P"} in the @code{interactive} expression tells Emacs to
6062 pass a prefix argument, if there is one, to the function in raw form.
6063 A prefix argument is made by typing the @key{META} key followed by a
6064 number, or by typing @kbd{C-u} and then a number. (If you don't type
6065 a number, @kbd{C-u} defaults to a cons cell with a 4. A lowercase
6066 @code{"p"} in the @code{interactive} expression causes the function to
6067 convert a prefix arg to a number.)
6068
6069 The true-or-false-test of the @code{if} expression looks complex, but
6070 it is not: it checks whether @code{arg} has a value that is not
6071 @code{nil} and whether it is a cons cell. (That is what @code{consp}
6072 does; it checks whether its argument is a cons cell.) If @code{arg}
6073 has a value that is not @code{nil} (and is not a cons cell), which
6074 will be the case if @code{beginning-of-buffer} is called with a
6075 numeric argument, then this true-or-false-test will return true and
6076 the then-part of the @code{if} expression will be evaluated. On the
6077 other hand, if @code{beginning-of-buffer} is not called with an
6078 argument, the value of @code{arg} will be @code{nil} and the else-part
6079 of the @code{if} expression will be evaluated. The else-part is
6080 simply @code{point-min}, and when this is the outcome, the whole
6081 @code{goto-char} expression is @code{(goto-char (point-min))}, which
6082 is how we saw the @code{beginning-of-buffer} function in its
6083 simplified form.
6084
6085 @node beginning-of-buffer opt arg
6086 @subsection @code{beginning-of-buffer} with an Argument
6087
6088 When @code{beginning-of-buffer} is called with an argument, an
6089 expression is evaluated which calculates what value to pass to
6090 @code{goto-char}. This expression is rather complicated at first sight.
6091 It includes an inner @code{if} expression and much arithmetic. It looks
6092 like this:
6093
6094 @smallexample
6095 @group
6096 (if (> (buffer-size) 10000)
6097 ;; @r{Avoid overflow for large buffer sizes!}
6098 (* (prefix-numeric-value arg)
6099 (/ size 10))
6100 (/
6101 (+ 10
6102 (*
6103 size (prefix-numeric-value arg))) 10)))
6104 @end group
6105 @end smallexample
6106
6107 @menu
6108 * Disentangle beginning-of-buffer::
6109 * Large buffer case::
6110 * Small buffer case::
6111 @end menu
6112
6113 @ifnottex
6114 @node Disentangle beginning-of-buffer
6115 @unnumberedsubsubsec Disentangle @code{beginning-of-buffer}
6116 @end ifnottex
6117
6118 Like other complex-looking expressions, the conditional expression
6119 within @code{beginning-of-buffer} can be disentangled by looking at it
6120 as parts of a template, in this case, the template for an if-then-else
6121 expression. In skeletal form, the expression looks like this:
6122
6123 @smallexample
6124 @group
6125 (if (@var{buffer-is-large}
6126 @var{divide-buffer-size-by-10-and-multiply-by-arg}
6127 @var{else-use-alternate-calculation}
6128 @end group
6129 @end smallexample
6130
6131 The true-or-false-test of this inner @code{if} expression checks the
6132 size of the buffer. The reason for this is that the old version 18
6133 Emacs used numbers that are no bigger than eight million or so and in
6134 the computation that followed, the programmer feared that Emacs might
6135 try to use over-large numbers if the buffer were large. The term
6136 `overflow', mentioned in the comment, means numbers that are over
6137 large. More recent versions of Emacs use larger numbers, but this
6138 code has not been touched, if only because people now look at buffers
6139 that are far, far larger than ever before.
6140
6141 There are two cases: if the buffer is large and if it is not.
6142
6143 @node Large buffer case
6144 @unnumberedsubsubsec What happens in a large buffer
6145
6146 In @code{beginning-of-buffer}, the inner @code{if} expression tests
6147 whether the size of the buffer is greater than 10,000 characters. To do
6148 this, it uses the @code{>} function and the computation of @code{size}
6149 that comes from the let expression.
6150
6151 In the old days, the function @code{buffer-size} was used. Not only
6152 was that function called several times, it gave the size of the whole
6153 buffer, not the accessible part. The computation makes much more
6154 sense when it handles just the accessible part. (@xref{Narrowing &
6155 Widening, , Narrowing and Widening}, for more information on focusing
6156 attention to an `accessible' part.)
6157
6158 @need 800
6159 The line looks like this:
6160
6161 @smallexample
6162 (if (> size 10000)
6163 @end smallexample
6164
6165 @need 1200
6166 @noindent
6167 When the buffer is large, the then-part of the @code{if} expression is
6168 evaluated. It reads like this (after formatting for easy reading):
6169
6170 @smallexample
6171 @group
6172 (*
6173 (prefix-numeric-value arg)
6174 (/ size 10))
6175 @end group
6176 @end smallexample
6177
6178 @noindent
6179 This expression is a multiplication, with two arguments to the function
6180 @code{*}.
6181
6182 The first argument is @code{(prefix-numeric-value arg)}. When
6183 @code{"P"} is used as the argument for @code{interactive}, the value
6184 passed to the function as its argument is passed a ``raw prefix
6185 argument'', and not a number. (It is a number in a list.) To perform
6186 the arithmetic, a conversion is necessary, and
6187 @code{prefix-numeric-value} does the job.
6188
6189 @findex / @r{(division)}
6190 @cindex Division
6191 The second argument is @code{(/ size 10)}. This expression divides
6192 the numeric value by ten---the numeric value of the size of the
6193 accessible portion of the buffer. This produces a number that tells
6194 how many characters make up one tenth of the buffer size. (In Lisp,
6195 @code{/} is used for division, just as @code{*} is used for
6196 multiplication.)
6197
6198 @need 1200
6199 In the multiplication expression as a whole, this amount is multiplied
6200 by the value of the prefix argument---the multiplication looks like this:
6201
6202 @smallexample
6203 @group
6204 (* @var{numeric-value-of-prefix-arg}
6205 @var{number-of-characters-in-one-tenth-of-the-accessible-buffer})
6206 @end group
6207 @end smallexample
6208
6209 @noindent
6210 If, for example, the prefix argument is @samp{7}, the one-tenth value
6211 will be multiplied by 7 to give a position 70% of the way through.
6212
6213 @need 1200
6214 The result of all this is that if the accessible portion of the buffer
6215 is large, the @code{goto-char} expression reads like this:
6216
6217 @smallexample
6218 @group
6219 (goto-char (* (prefix-numeric-value arg)
6220 (/ size 10)))
6221 @end group
6222 @end smallexample
6223
6224 This puts the cursor where we want it.
6225
6226 @node Small buffer case
6227 @unnumberedsubsubsec What happens in a small buffer
6228
6229 If the buffer contains fewer than 10,000 characters, a slightly
6230 different computation is performed. You might think this is not
6231 necessary, since the first computation could do the job. However, in
6232 a small buffer, the first method may not put the cursor on exactly the
6233 desired line; the second method does a better job.
6234
6235 @need 800
6236 The code looks like this:
6237
6238 @c Keep this on one line.
6239 @smallexample
6240 (/ (+ 10 (* size (prefix-numeric-value arg))) 10))
6241 @end smallexample
6242
6243 @need 1200
6244 @noindent
6245 This is code in which you figure out what happens by discovering how the
6246 functions are embedded in parentheses. It is easier to read if you
6247 reformat it with each expression indented more deeply than its
6248 enclosing expression:
6249
6250 @smallexample
6251 @group
6252 (/
6253 (+ 10
6254 (*
6255 size
6256 (prefix-numeric-value arg)))
6257 10))
6258 @end group
6259 @end smallexample
6260
6261 @need 1200
6262 @noindent
6263 Looking at parentheses, we see that the innermost operation is
6264 @code{(prefix-numeric-value arg)}, which converts the raw argument to
6265 a number. In the following expression, this number is multiplied by
6266 the size of the accessible portion of the buffer:
6267
6268 @smallexample
6269 (* size (prefix-numeric-value arg))
6270 @end smallexample
6271
6272 @noindent
6273 This multiplication creates a number that may be larger than the size of
6274 the buffer---seven times larger if the argument is 7, for example. Ten
6275 is then added to this number and finally the large number is divided by
6276 ten to provide a value that is one character larger than the percentage
6277 position in the buffer.
6278
6279 The number that results from all this is passed to @code{goto-char} and
6280 the cursor is moved to that point.
6281
6282 @need 1500
6283 @node beginning-of-buffer complete
6284 @subsection The Complete @code{beginning-of-buffer}
6285
6286 @need 1000
6287 Here is the complete text of the @code{beginning-of-buffer} function:
6288 @sp 1
6289
6290 @c In GNU Emacs 22
6291 @smallexample
6292 @group
6293 (defun beginning-of-buffer (&optional arg)
6294 "Move point to the beginning of the buffer;
6295 leave mark at previous position.
6296 With \\[universal-argument] prefix,
6297 do not set mark at previous position.
6298 With numeric arg N,
6299 put point N/10 of the way from the beginning.
6300
6301 If the buffer is narrowed,
6302 this command uses the beginning and size
6303 of the accessible part of the buffer.
6304 @end group
6305
6306 @group
6307 Don't use this command in Lisp programs!
6308 \(goto-char (point-min)) is faster
6309 and avoids clobbering the mark."
6310 (interactive "P")
6311 (or (consp arg)
6312 (and transient-mark-mode mark-active)
6313 (push-mark))
6314 @end group
6315 @group
6316 (let ((size (- (point-max) (point-min))))
6317 (goto-char (if (and arg (not (consp arg)))
6318 (+ (point-min)
6319 (if (> size 10000)
6320 ;; Avoid overflow for large buffer sizes!
6321 (* (prefix-numeric-value arg)
6322 (/ size 10))
6323 (/ (+ 10 (* size (prefix-numeric-value arg)))
6324 10)))
6325 (point-min))))
6326 (if arg (forward-line 1)))
6327 @end group
6328 @end smallexample
6329
6330 @ignore
6331 From before GNU Emacs 22
6332 @smallexample
6333 @group
6334 (defun beginning-of-buffer (&optional arg)
6335 "Move point to the beginning of the buffer;
6336 leave mark at previous position.
6337 With arg N, put point N/10 of the way
6338 from the true beginning.
6339 @end group
6340 @group
6341 Don't use this in Lisp programs!
6342 \(goto-char (point-min)) is faster
6343 and does not set the mark."
6344 (interactive "P")
6345 (push-mark)
6346 @end group
6347 @group
6348 (goto-char
6349 (if arg
6350 (if (> (buffer-size) 10000)
6351 ;; @r{Avoid overflow for large buffer sizes!}
6352 (* (prefix-numeric-value arg)
6353 (/ (buffer-size) 10))
6354 @end group
6355 @group
6356 (/ (+ 10 (* (buffer-size)
6357 (prefix-numeric-value arg)))
6358 10))
6359 (point-min)))
6360 (if arg (forward-line 1)))
6361 @end group
6362 @end smallexample
6363 @end ignore
6364
6365 @noindent
6366 Except for two small points, the previous discussion shows how this
6367 function works. The first point deals with a detail in the
6368 documentation string, and the second point concerns the last line of
6369 the function.
6370
6371 @need 800
6372 In the documentation string, there is reference to an expression:
6373
6374 @smallexample
6375 \\[universal-argument]
6376 @end smallexample
6377
6378 @noindent
6379 A @samp{\\} is used before the first square bracket of this
6380 expression. This @samp{\\} tells the Lisp interpreter to substitute
6381 whatever key is currently bound to the @samp{[@dots{}]}. In the case
6382 of @code{universal-argument}, that is usually @kbd{C-u}, but it might
6383 be different. (@xref{Documentation Tips, , Tips for Documentation
6384 Strings, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}, for more
6385 information.)
6386
6387 @need 1200
6388 Finally, the last line of the @code{beginning-of-buffer} command says
6389 to move point to the beginning of the next line if the command is
6390 invoked with an argument:
6391
6392 @smallexample
6393 (if arg (forward-line 1)))
6394 @end smallexample
6395
6396 @noindent
6397 This puts the cursor at the beginning of the first line after the
6398 appropriate tenths position in the buffer. This is a flourish that
6399 means that the cursor is always located @emph{at least} the requested
6400 tenths of the way through the buffer, which is a nicety that is,
6401 perhaps, not necessary, but which, if it did not occur, would be sure
6402 to draw complaints.
6403
6404 On the other hand, it also means that if you specify the command with
6405 a @kbd{C-u}, but without a number, that is to say, if the `raw prefix
6406 argument' is simply a cons cell, then the command puts you at the
6407 beginning of the second line @dots{} I don't know whether this is
6408 intended or whether no one has dealt with the code to avoid this
6409 happening.
6410
6411 @node Second Buffer Related Review
6412 @section Review
6413
6414 Here is a brief summary of some of the topics covered in this chapter.
6415
6416 @table @code
6417 @item or
6418 Evaluate each argument in sequence, and return the value of the first
6419 argument that is not @code{nil}; if none return a value that is not
6420 @code{nil}, return @code{nil}. In brief, return the first true value
6421 of the arguments; return a true value if one @emph{or} any of the
6422 others are true.
6423
6424 @item and
6425 Evaluate each argument in sequence, and if any are @code{nil}, return
6426 @code{nil}; if none are @code{nil}, return the value of the last
6427 argument. In brief, return a true value only if all the arguments are
6428 true; return a true value if one @emph{and} each of the others is
6429 true.
6430
6431 @item &optional
6432 A keyword used to indicate that an argument to a function definition
6433 is optional; this means that the function can be evaluated without the
6434 argument, if desired.
6435
6436 @item prefix-numeric-value
6437 Convert the `raw prefix argument' produced by @code{(interactive
6438 "P")} to a numeric value.
6439
6440 @item forward-line
6441 Move point forward to the beginning of the next line, or if the argument
6442 is greater than one, forward that many lines. If it can't move as far
6443 forward as it is supposed to, @code{forward-line} goes forward as far as
6444 it can and then returns a count of the number of additional lines it was
6445 supposed to move but couldn't.
6446
6447 @item erase-buffer
6448 Delete the entire contents of the current buffer.
6449
6450 @item bufferp
6451 Return @code{t} if its argument is a buffer; otherwise return @code{nil}.
6452 @end table
6453
6454 @node optional Exercise
6455 @section @code{optional} Argument Exercise
6456
6457 Write an interactive function with an optional argument that tests
6458 whether its argument, a number, is greater than or equal to, or else,
6459 less than the value of @code{fill-column}, and tells you which, in a
6460 message. However, if you do not pass an argument to the function, use
6461 56 as a default value.
6462
6463 @node Narrowing & Widening
6464 @chapter Narrowing and Widening
6465 @cindex Focusing attention (narrowing)
6466 @cindex Narrowing
6467 @cindex Widening
6468
6469 Narrowing is a feature of Emacs that makes it possible for you to focus
6470 on a specific part of a buffer, and work without accidentally changing
6471 other parts. Narrowing is normally disabled since it can confuse
6472 novices.
6473
6474 @menu
6475 * Narrowing advantages:: The advantages of narrowing
6476 * save-restriction:: The @code{save-restriction} special form.
6477 * what-line:: The number of the line that point is on.
6478 * narrow Exercise::
6479 @end menu
6480
6481 @ifnottex
6482 @node Narrowing advantages
6483 @unnumberedsec The Advantages of Narrowing
6484 @end ifnottex
6485
6486 With narrowing, the rest of a buffer is made invisible, as if it weren't
6487 there. This is an advantage if, for example, you want to replace a word
6488 in one part of a buffer but not in another: you narrow to the part you want
6489 and the replacement is carried out only in that section, not in the rest
6490 of the buffer. Searches will only work within a narrowed region, not
6491 outside of one, so if you are fixing a part of a document, you can keep
6492 yourself from accidentally finding parts you do not need to fix by
6493 narrowing just to the region you want.
6494 (The key binding for @code{narrow-to-region} is @kbd{C-x n n}.)
6495
6496 However, narrowing does make the rest of the buffer invisible, which
6497 can scare people who inadvertently invoke narrowing and think they
6498 have deleted a part of their file. Moreover, the @code{undo} command
6499 (which is usually bound to @kbd{C-x u}) does not turn off narrowing
6500 (nor should it), so people can become quite desperate if they do not
6501 know that they can return the rest of a buffer to visibility with the
6502 @code{widen} command.
6503 (The key binding for @code{widen} is @kbd{C-x n w}.)
6504
6505 Narrowing is just as useful to the Lisp interpreter as to a human.
6506 Often, an Emacs Lisp function is designed to work on just part of a
6507 buffer; or conversely, an Emacs Lisp function needs to work on all of a
6508 buffer that has been narrowed. The @code{what-line} function, for
6509 example, removes the narrowing from a buffer, if it has any narrowing
6510 and when it has finished its job, restores the narrowing to what it was.
6511 On the other hand, the @code{count-lines} function
6512 uses narrowing to restrict itself to just that portion
6513 of the buffer in which it is interested and then restores the previous
6514 situation.
6515
6516 @node save-restriction
6517 @section The @code{save-restriction} Special Form
6518 @findex save-restriction
6519
6520 In Emacs Lisp, you can use the @code{save-restriction} special form to
6521 keep track of whatever narrowing is in effect, if any. When the Lisp
6522 interpreter meets with @code{save-restriction}, it executes the code
6523 in the body of the @code{save-restriction} expression, and then undoes
6524 any changes to narrowing that the code caused. If, for example, the
6525 buffer is narrowed and the code that follows @code{save-restriction}
6526 gets rid of the narrowing, @code{save-restriction} returns the buffer
6527 to its narrowed region afterwards. In the @code{what-line} command,
6528 any narrowing the buffer may have is undone by the @code{widen}
6529 command that immediately follows the @code{save-restriction} command.
6530 Any original narrowing is restored just before the completion of the
6531 function.
6532
6533 @need 1250
6534 The template for a @code{save-restriction} expression is simple:
6535
6536 @smallexample
6537 @group
6538 (save-restriction
6539 @var{body}@dots{} )
6540 @end group
6541 @end smallexample
6542
6543 @noindent
6544 The body of the @code{save-restriction} is one or more expressions that
6545 will be evaluated in sequence by the Lisp interpreter.
6546
6547 Finally, a point to note: when you use both @code{save-excursion} and
6548 @code{save-restriction}, one right after the other, you should use
6549 @code{save-excursion} outermost. If you write them in reverse order,
6550 you may fail to record narrowing in the buffer to which Emacs switches
6551 after calling @code{save-excursion}. Thus, when written together,
6552 @code{save-excursion} and @code{save-restriction} should be written
6553 like this:
6554
6555 @smallexample
6556 @group
6557 (save-excursion
6558 (save-restriction
6559 @var{body}@dots{}))
6560 @end group
6561 @end smallexample
6562
6563 In other circumstances, when not written together, the
6564 @code{save-excursion} and @code{save-restriction} special forms must
6565 be written in the order appropriate to the function.
6566
6567 @need 1250
6568 For example,
6569
6570 @smallexample
6571 @group
6572 (save-restriction
6573 (widen)
6574 (save-excursion
6575 @var{body}@dots{}))
6576 @end group
6577 @end smallexample
6578
6579 @ignore
6580 Emacs 22
6581 /usr/local/src/emacs/lisp/simple.el
6582
6583 (defun what-line ()
6584 "Print the current buffer line number and narrowed line number of point."
6585 (interactive)
6586 (let ((start (point-min))
6587 (n (line-number-at-pos)))
6588 (if (= start 1)
6589 (message "Line %d" n)
6590 (save-excursion
6591 (save-restriction
6592 (widen)
6593 (message "line %d (narrowed line %d)"
6594 (+ n (line-number-at-pos start) -1) n))))))
6595
6596 (defun line-number-at-pos (&optional pos)
6597 "Return (narrowed) buffer line number at position POS.
6598 If POS is nil, use current buffer location.
6599 Counting starts at (point-min), so the value refers
6600 to the contents of the accessible portion of the buffer."
6601 (let ((opoint (or pos (point))) start)
6602 (save-excursion
6603 (goto-char (point-min))
6604 (setq start (point))
6605 (goto-char opoint)
6606 (forward-line 0)
6607 (1+ (count-lines start (point))))))
6608
6609 (defun count-lines (start end)
6610 "Return number of lines between START and END.
6611 This is usually the number of newlines between them,
6612 but can be one more if START is not equal to END
6613 and the greater of them is not at the start of a line."
6614 (save-excursion
6615 (save-restriction
6616 (narrow-to-region start end)
6617 (goto-char (point-min))
6618 (if (eq selective-display t)
6619 (save-match-data
6620 (let ((done 0))
6621 (while (re-search-forward "[\n\C-m]" nil t 40)
6622 (setq done (+ 40 done)))
6623 (while (re-search-forward "[\n\C-m]" nil t 1)
6624 (setq done (+ 1 done)))
6625 (goto-char (point-max))
6626 (if (and (/= start end)
6627 (not (bolp)))
6628 (1+ done)
6629 done)))
6630 (- (buffer-size) (forward-line (buffer-size)))))))
6631 @end ignore
6632
6633 @node what-line
6634 @section @code{what-line}
6635 @findex what-line
6636 @cindex Widening, example of
6637
6638 The @code{what-line} command tells you the number of the line in which
6639 the cursor is located. The function illustrates the use of the
6640 @code{save-restriction} and @code{save-excursion} commands. Here is the
6641 original text of the function:
6642
6643 @smallexample
6644 @group
6645 (defun what-line ()
6646 "Print the current line number (in the buffer) of point."
6647 (interactive)
6648 (save-restriction
6649 (widen)
6650 (save-excursion
6651 (beginning-of-line)
6652 (message "Line %d"
6653 (1+ (count-lines 1 (point)))))))
6654 @end group
6655 @end smallexample
6656
6657 (In recent versions of GNU Emacs, the @code{what-line} function has
6658 been expanded to tell you your line number in a narrowed buffer as
6659 well as your line number in a widened buffer. The recent version is
6660 more complex than the version shown here. If you feel adventurous,
6661 you might want to look at it after figuring out how this version
6662 works. You will probably need to use @kbd{C-h f}
6663 (@code{describe-function}). The newer version uses a conditional to
6664 determine whether the buffer has been narrowed.
6665
6666 (Also, it uses @code{line-number-at-pos}, which among other simple
6667 expressions, such as @code{(goto-char (point-min))}, moves point to
6668 the beginning of the current line with @code{(forward-line 0)} rather
6669 than @code{beginning-of-line}.)
6670
6671 The @code{what-line} function as shown here has a documentation line
6672 and is interactive, as you would expect. The next two lines use the
6673 functions @code{save-restriction} and @code{widen}.
6674
6675 The @code{save-restriction} special form notes whatever narrowing is in
6676 effect, if any, in the current buffer and restores that narrowing after
6677 the code in the body of the @code{save-restriction} has been evaluated.
6678
6679 The @code{save-restriction} special form is followed by @code{widen}.
6680 This function undoes any narrowing the current buffer may have had
6681 when @code{what-line} was called. (The narrowing that was there is
6682 the narrowing that @code{save-restriction} remembers.) This widening
6683 makes it possible for the line counting commands to count from the
6684 beginning of the buffer. Otherwise, they would have been limited to
6685 counting within the accessible region. Any original narrowing is
6686 restored just before the completion of the function by the
6687 @code{save-restriction} special form.
6688
6689 The call to @code{widen} is followed by @code{save-excursion}, which
6690 saves the location of the cursor (i.e., of point) and of the mark, and
6691 restores them after the code in the body of the @code{save-excursion}
6692 uses the @code{beginning-of-line} function to move point.
6693
6694 (Note that the @code{(widen)} expression comes between the
6695 @code{save-restriction} and @code{save-excursion} special forms. When
6696 you write the two @code{save- @dots{}} expressions in sequence, write
6697 @code{save-excursion} outermost.)
6698
6699 @need 1200
6700 The last two lines of the @code{what-line} function are functions to
6701 count the number of lines in the buffer and then print the number in the
6702 echo area.
6703
6704 @smallexample
6705 @group
6706 (message "Line %d"
6707 (1+ (count-lines 1 (point)))))))
6708 @end group
6709 @end smallexample
6710
6711 The @code{message} function prints a one-line message at the bottom of
6712 the Emacs screen. The first argument is inside of quotation marks and
6713 is printed as a string of characters. However, it may contain a
6714 @samp{%d} expression to print a following argument. @samp{%d} prints
6715 the argument as a decimal, so the message will say something such as
6716 @samp{Line 243}.
6717
6718 @need 1200
6719 The number that is printed in place of the @samp{%d} is computed by the
6720 last line of the function:
6721
6722 @smallexample
6723 (1+ (count-lines 1 (point)))
6724 @end smallexample
6725
6726 @ignore
6727 GNU Emacs 22
6728
6729 (defun count-lines (start end)
6730 "Return number of lines between START and END.
6731 This is usually the number of newlines between them,
6732 but can be one more if START is not equal to END
6733 and the greater of them is not at the start of a line."
6734 (save-excursion
6735 (save-restriction
6736 (narrow-to-region start end)
6737 (goto-char (point-min))
6738 (if (eq selective-display t)
6739 (save-match-data
6740 (let ((done 0))
6741 (while (re-search-forward "[\n\C-m]" nil t 40)
6742 (setq done (+ 40 done)))
6743 (while (re-search-forward "[\n\C-m]" nil t 1)
6744 (setq done (+ 1 done)))
6745 (goto-char (point-max))
6746 (if (and (/= start end)
6747 (not (bolp)))
6748 (1+ done)
6749 done)))
6750 (- (buffer-size) (forward-line (buffer-size)))))))
6751 @end ignore
6752
6753 @noindent
6754 What this does is count the lines from the first position of the
6755 buffer, indicated by the @code{1}, up to @code{(point)}, and then add
6756 one to that number. (The @code{1+} function adds one to its
6757 argument.) We add one to it because line 2 has only one line before
6758 it, and @code{count-lines} counts only the lines @emph{before} the
6759 current line.
6760
6761 After @code{count-lines} has done its job, and the message has been
6762 printed in the echo area, the @code{save-excursion} restores point and
6763 mark to their original positions; and @code{save-restriction} restores
6764 the original narrowing, if any.
6765
6766 @node narrow Exercise
6767 @section Exercise with Narrowing
6768
6769 Write a function that will display the first 60 characters of the
6770 current buffer, even if you have narrowed the buffer to its latter
6771 half so that the first line is inaccessible. Restore point, mark, and
6772 narrowing. For this exercise, you need to use a whole potpourri of
6773 functions, including @code{save-restriction}, @code{widen},
6774 @code{goto-char}, @code{point-min}, @code{message}, and
6775 @code{buffer-substring}.
6776
6777 @cindex Properties, mention of @code{buffer-substring-no-properties}
6778 (@code{buffer-substring} is a previously unmentioned function you will
6779 have to investigate yourself; or perhaps you will have to use
6780 @code{buffer-substring-no-properties} or
6781 @code{filter-buffer-substring} @dots{}, yet other functions. Text
6782 properties are a feature otherwise not discussed here. @xref{Text
6783 Properties, , Text Properties, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference
6784 Manual}.)
6785
6786 Additionally, do you really need @code{goto-char} or @code{point-min}?
6787 Or can you write the function without them?
6788
6789 @node car cdr & cons
6790 @chapter @code{car}, @code{cdr}, @code{cons}: Fundamental Functions
6791 @findex car, @r{introduced}
6792 @findex cdr, @r{introduced}
6793
6794 In Lisp, @code{car}, @code{cdr}, and @code{cons} are fundamental
6795 functions. The @code{cons} function is used to construct lists, and
6796 the @code{car} and @code{cdr} functions are used to take them apart.
6797
6798 In the walk through of the @code{copy-region-as-kill} function, we
6799 will see @code{cons} as well as two variants on @code{cdr},
6800 namely, @code{setcdr} and @code{nthcdr}. (@xref{copy-region-as-kill}.)
6801
6802 @menu
6803 * Strange Names:: An historical aside: why the strange names?
6804 * car & cdr:: Functions for extracting part of a list.
6805 * cons:: Constructing a list.
6806 * nthcdr:: Calling @code{cdr} repeatedly.
6807 * nth::
6808 * setcar:: Changing the first element of a list.
6809 * setcdr:: Changing the rest of a list.
6810 * cons Exercise::
6811 @end menu
6812
6813 @ifnottex
6814 @node Strange Names
6815 @unnumberedsec Strange Names
6816 @end ifnottex
6817
6818 The name of the @code{cons} function is not unreasonable: it is an
6819 abbreviation of the word `construct'. The origins of the names for
6820 @code{car} and @code{cdr}, on the other hand, are esoteric: @code{car}
6821 is an acronym from the phrase `Contents of the Address part of the
6822 Register'; and @code{cdr} (pronounced `could-er') is an acronym from
6823 the phrase `Contents of the Decrement part of the Register'. These
6824 phrases refer to specific pieces of hardware on the very early
6825 computer on which the original Lisp was developed. Besides being
6826 obsolete, the phrases have been completely irrelevant for more than 25
6827 years to anyone thinking about Lisp. Nonetheless, although a few
6828 brave scholars have begun to use more reasonable names for these
6829 functions, the old terms are still in use. In particular, since the
6830 terms are used in the Emacs Lisp source code, we will use them in this
6831 introduction.
6832
6833 @node car & cdr
6834 @section @code{car} and @code{cdr}
6835
6836 The @sc{car} of a list is, quite simply, the first item in the list.
6837 Thus the @sc{car} of the list @code{(rose violet daisy buttercup)} is
6838 @code{rose}.
6839
6840 @need 1200
6841 If you are reading this in Info in GNU Emacs, you can see this by
6842 evaluating the following:
6843
6844 @smallexample
6845 (car '(rose violet daisy buttercup))
6846 @end smallexample
6847
6848 @noindent
6849 After evaluating the expression, @code{rose} will appear in the echo
6850 area.
6851
6852 Clearly, a more reasonable name for the @code{car} function would be
6853 @code{first} and this is often suggested.
6854
6855 @code{car} does not remove the first item from the list; it only reports
6856 what it is. After @code{car} has been applied to a list, the list is
6857 still the same as it was. In the jargon, @code{car} is
6858 `non-destructive'. This feature turns out to be important.
6859
6860 The @sc{cdr} of a list is the rest of the list, that is, the
6861 @code{cdr} function returns the part of the list that follows the
6862 first item. Thus, while the @sc{car} of the list @code{'(rose violet
6863 daisy buttercup)} is @code{rose}, the rest of the list, the value
6864 returned by the @code{cdr} function, is @code{(violet daisy
6865 buttercup)}.
6866
6867 @need 800
6868 You can see this by evaluating the following in the usual way:
6869
6870 @smallexample
6871 (cdr '(rose violet daisy buttercup))
6872 @end smallexample
6873
6874 @noindent
6875 When you evaluate this, @code{(violet daisy buttercup)} will appear in
6876 the echo area.
6877
6878 Like @code{car}, @code{cdr} does not remove any elements from the
6879 list---it just returns a report of what the second and subsequent
6880 elements are.
6881
6882 Incidentally, in the example, the list of flowers is quoted. If it were
6883 not, the Lisp interpreter would try to evaluate the list by calling
6884 @code{rose} as a function. In this example, we do not want to do that.
6885
6886 Clearly, a more reasonable name for @code{cdr} would be @code{rest}.
6887
6888 (There is a lesson here: when you name new functions, consider very
6889 carefully what you are doing, since you may be stuck with the names
6890 for far longer than you expect. The reason this document perpetuates
6891 these names is that the Emacs Lisp source code uses them, and if I did
6892 not use them, you would have a hard time reading the code; but do,
6893 please, try to avoid using these terms yourself. The people who come
6894 after you will be grateful to you.)
6895
6896 When @code{car} and @code{cdr} are applied to a list made up of symbols,
6897 such as the list @code{(pine fir oak maple)}, the element of the list
6898 returned by the function @code{car} is the symbol @code{pine} without
6899 any parentheses around it. @code{pine} is the first element in the
6900 list. However, the @sc{cdr} of the list is a list itself, @code{(fir
6901 oak maple)}, as you can see by evaluating the following expressions in
6902 the usual way:
6903
6904 @smallexample
6905 @group
6906 (car '(pine fir oak maple))
6907
6908 (cdr '(pine fir oak maple))
6909 @end group
6910 @end smallexample
6911
6912 On the other hand, in a list of lists, the first element is itself a
6913 list. @code{car} returns this first element as a list. For example,
6914 the following list contains three sub-lists, a list of carnivores, a
6915 list of herbivores and a list of sea mammals:
6916
6917 @smallexample
6918 @group
6919 (car '((lion tiger cheetah)
6920 (gazelle antelope zebra)
6921 (whale dolphin seal)))
6922 @end group
6923 @end smallexample
6924
6925 @noindent
6926 In this example, the first element or @sc{car} of the list is the list of
6927 carnivores, @code{(lion tiger cheetah)}, and the rest of the list is
6928 @code{((gazelle antelope zebra) (whale dolphin seal))}.
6929
6930 @smallexample
6931 @group
6932 (cdr '((lion tiger cheetah)
6933 (gazelle antelope zebra)
6934 (whale dolphin seal)))
6935 @end group
6936 @end smallexample
6937
6938 It is worth saying again that @code{car} and @code{cdr} are
6939 non-destructive---that is, they do not modify or change lists to which
6940 they are applied. This is very important for how they are used.
6941
6942 Also, in the first chapter, in the discussion about atoms, I said that
6943 in Lisp, ``certain kinds of atom, such as an array, can be separated
6944 into parts; but the mechanism for doing this is different from the
6945 mechanism for splitting a list. As far as Lisp is concerned, the
6946 atoms of a list are unsplittable.'' (@xref{Lisp Atoms}.) The
6947 @code{car} and @code{cdr} functions are used for splitting lists and
6948 are considered fundamental to Lisp. Since they cannot split or gain
6949 access to the parts of an array, an array is considered an atom.
6950 Conversely, the other fundamental function, @code{cons}, can put
6951 together or construct a list, but not an array. (Arrays are handled
6952 by array-specific functions. @xref{Arrays, , Arrays, elisp, The GNU
6953 Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}.)
6954
6955 @node cons
6956 @section @code{cons}
6957 @findex cons, @r{introduced}
6958
6959 The @code{cons} function constructs lists; it is the inverse of
6960 @code{car} and @code{cdr}. For example, @code{cons} can be used to make
6961 a four element list from the three element list, @code{(fir oak maple)}:
6962
6963 @smallexample
6964 (cons 'pine '(fir oak maple))
6965 @end smallexample
6966
6967 @need 800
6968 @noindent
6969 After evaluating this list, you will see
6970
6971 @smallexample
6972 (pine fir oak maple)
6973 @end smallexample
6974
6975 @noindent
6976 appear in the echo area. @code{cons} causes the creation of a new
6977 list in which the element is followed by the elements of the original
6978 list.
6979
6980 We often say that `@code{cons} puts a new element at the beginning of
6981 a list; it attaches or pushes elements onto the list', but this
6982 phrasing can be misleading, since @code{cons} does not change an
6983 existing list, but creates a new one.
6984
6985 Like @code{car} and @code{cdr}, @code{cons} is non-destructive.
6986
6987 @menu
6988 * Build a list::
6989 * length:: How to find the length of a list.
6990 @end menu
6991
6992 @ifnottex
6993 @node Build a list
6994 @unnumberedsubsec Build a list
6995 @end ifnottex
6996
6997 @code{cons} must have a list to attach to.@footnote{Actually, you can
6998 @code{cons} an element to an atom to produce a dotted pair. Dotted
6999 pairs are not discussed here; see @ref{Dotted Pair Notation, , Dotted
7000 Pair Notation, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}.} You
7001 cannot start from absolutely nothing. If you are building a list, you
7002 need to provide at least an empty list at the beginning. Here is a
7003 series of @code{cons} expressions that build up a list of flowers. If
7004 you are reading this in Info in GNU Emacs, you can evaluate each of
7005 the expressions in the usual way; the value is printed in this text
7006 after @samp{@result{}}, which you may read as `evaluates to'.
7007
7008 @smallexample
7009 @group
7010 (cons 'buttercup ())
7011 @result{} (buttercup)
7012 @end group
7013
7014 @group
7015 (cons 'daisy '(buttercup))
7016 @result{} (daisy buttercup)
7017 @end group
7018
7019 @group
7020 (cons 'violet '(daisy buttercup))
7021 @result{} (violet daisy buttercup)
7022 @end group
7023
7024 @group
7025 (cons 'rose '(violet daisy buttercup))
7026 @result{} (rose violet daisy buttercup)
7027 @end group
7028 @end smallexample
7029
7030 @noindent
7031 In the first example, the empty list is shown as @code{()} and a list
7032 made up of @code{buttercup} followed by the empty list is constructed.
7033 As you can see, the empty list is not shown in the list that was
7034 constructed. All that you see is @code{(buttercup)}. The empty list is
7035 not counted as an element of a list because there is nothing in an empty
7036 list. Generally speaking, an empty list is invisible.
7037
7038 The second example, @code{(cons 'daisy '(buttercup))} constructs a new,
7039 two element list by putting @code{daisy} in front of @code{buttercup};
7040 and the third example constructs a three element list by putting
7041 @code{violet} in front of @code{daisy} and @code{buttercup}.
7042
7043 @node length
7044 @subsection Find the Length of a List: @code{length}
7045 @findex length
7046
7047 You can find out how many elements there are in a list by using the Lisp
7048 function @code{length}, as in the following examples:
7049
7050 @smallexample
7051 @group
7052 (length '(buttercup))
7053 @result{} 1
7054 @end group
7055
7056 @group
7057 (length '(daisy buttercup))
7058 @result{} 2
7059 @end group
7060
7061 @group
7062 (length (cons 'violet '(daisy buttercup)))
7063 @result{} 3
7064 @end group
7065 @end smallexample
7066
7067 @noindent
7068 In the third example, the @code{cons} function is used to construct a
7069 three element list which is then passed to the @code{length} function as
7070 its argument.
7071
7072 @need 1200
7073 We can also use @code{length} to count the number of elements in an
7074 empty list:
7075
7076 @smallexample
7077 @group
7078 (length ())
7079 @result{} 0
7080 @end group
7081 @end smallexample
7082
7083 @noindent
7084 As you would expect, the number of elements in an empty list is zero.
7085
7086 An interesting experiment is to find out what happens if you try to find
7087 the length of no list at all; that is, if you try to call @code{length}
7088 without giving it an argument, not even an empty list:
7089
7090 @smallexample
7091 (length )
7092 @end smallexample
7093
7094 @need 800
7095 @noindent
7096 What you see, if you evaluate this, is the error message
7097
7098 @smallexample
7099 Lisp error: (wrong-number-of-arguments length 0)
7100 @end smallexample
7101
7102 @noindent
7103 This means that the function receives the wrong number of
7104 arguments, zero, when it expects some other number of arguments. In
7105 this case, one argument is expected, the argument being a list whose
7106 length the function is measuring. (Note that @emph{one} list is
7107 @emph{one} argument, even if the list has many elements inside it.)
7108
7109 The part of the error message that says @samp{length} is the name of
7110 the function.
7111
7112 @ignore
7113 @code{length} is still a subroutine, but you need C-h f to discover that.
7114
7115 In an earlier version:
7116 This is written with a special notation, @samp{#<subr},
7117 that indicates that the function @code{length} is one of the primitive
7118 functions written in C rather than in Emacs Lisp. (@samp{subr} is an
7119 abbreviation for `subroutine'.) @xref{What Is a Function, , What Is a
7120 Function?, elisp , The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}, for more
7121 about subroutines.
7122 @end ignore
7123
7124 @node nthcdr
7125 @section @code{nthcdr}
7126 @findex nthcdr
7127
7128 The @code{nthcdr} function is associated with the @code{cdr} function.
7129 What it does is take the @sc{cdr} of a list repeatedly.
7130
7131 If you take the @sc{cdr} of the list @code{(pine fir
7132 oak maple)}, you will be returned the list @code{(fir oak maple)}. If you
7133 repeat this on what was returned, you will be returned the list
7134 @code{(oak maple)}. (Of course, repeated @sc{cdr}ing on the original
7135 list will just give you the original @sc{cdr} since the function does
7136 not change the list. You need to evaluate the @sc{cdr} of the
7137 @sc{cdr} and so on.) If you continue this, eventually you will be
7138 returned an empty list, which in this case, instead of being shown as
7139 @code{()} is shown as @code{nil}.
7140
7141 @need 1200
7142 For review, here is a series of repeated @sc{cdr}s, the text following
7143 the @samp{@result{}} shows what is returned.
7144
7145 @smallexample
7146 @group
7147 (cdr '(pine fir oak maple))
7148 @result{}(fir oak maple)
7149 @end group
7150
7151 @group
7152 (cdr '(fir oak maple))
7153 @result{} (oak maple)
7154 @end group
7155
7156 @group
7157 (cdr '(oak maple))
7158 @result{}(maple)
7159 @end group
7160
7161 @group
7162 (cdr '(maple))
7163 @result{} nil
7164 @end group
7165
7166 @group
7167 (cdr 'nil)
7168 @result{} nil
7169 @end group
7170
7171 @group
7172 (cdr ())
7173 @result{} nil
7174 @end group
7175 @end smallexample
7176
7177 @need 1200
7178 You can also do several @sc{cdr}s without printing the values in
7179 between, like this:
7180
7181 @smallexample
7182 @group
7183 (cdr (cdr '(pine fir oak maple)))
7184 @result{} (oak maple)
7185 @end group
7186 @end smallexample
7187
7188 @noindent
7189 In this example, the Lisp interpreter evaluates the innermost list first.
7190 The innermost list is quoted, so it just passes the list as it is to the
7191 innermost @code{cdr}. This @code{cdr} passes a list made up of the
7192 second and subsequent elements of the list to the outermost @code{cdr},
7193 which produces a list composed of the third and subsequent elements of
7194 the original list. In this example, the @code{cdr} function is repeated
7195 and returns a list that consists of the original list without its
7196 first two elements.
7197
7198 The @code{nthcdr} function does the same as repeating the call to
7199 @code{cdr}. In the following example, the argument 2 is passed to the
7200 function @code{nthcdr}, along with the list, and the value returned is
7201 the list without its first two items, which is exactly the same
7202 as repeating @code{cdr} twice on the list:
7203
7204 @smallexample
7205 @group
7206 (nthcdr 2 '(pine fir oak maple))
7207 @result{} (oak maple)
7208 @end group
7209 @end smallexample
7210
7211 @need 1200
7212 Using the original four element list, we can see what happens when
7213 various numeric arguments are passed to @code{nthcdr}, including 0, 1,
7214 and 5:
7215
7216 @smallexample
7217 @group
7218 ;; @r{Leave the list as it was.}
7219 (nthcdr 0 '(pine fir oak maple))
7220 @result{} (pine fir oak maple)
7221 @end group
7222
7223 @group
7224 ;; @r{Return a copy without the first element.}
7225 (nthcdr 1 '(pine fir oak maple))
7226 @result{} (fir oak maple)
7227 @end group
7228
7229 @group
7230 ;; @r{Return a copy of the list without three elements.}
7231 (nthcdr 3 '(pine fir oak maple))
7232 @result{} (maple)
7233 @end group
7234
7235 @group
7236 ;; @r{Return a copy lacking all four elements.}
7237 (nthcdr 4 '(pine fir oak maple))
7238 @result{} nil
7239 @end group
7240
7241 @group
7242 ;; @r{Return a copy lacking all elements.}
7243 (nthcdr 5 '(pine fir oak maple))
7244 @result{} nil
7245 @end group
7246 @end smallexample
7247
7248 @node nth
7249 @section @code{nth}
7250 @findex nth
7251
7252 The @code{nthcdr} function takes the @sc{cdr} of a list repeatedly.
7253 The @code{nth} function takes the @sc{car} of the result returned by
7254 @code{nthcdr}. It returns the Nth element of the list.
7255
7256 @need 1500
7257 Thus, if it were not defined in C for speed, the definition of
7258 @code{nth} would be:
7259
7260 @smallexample
7261 @group
7262 (defun nth (n list)
7263 "Returns the Nth element of LIST.
7264 N counts from zero. If LIST is not that long, nil is returned."
7265 (car (nthcdr n list)))
7266 @end group
7267 @end smallexample
7268
7269 @noindent
7270 (Originally, @code{nth} was defined in Emacs Lisp in @file{subr.el},
7271 but its definition was redone in C in the 1980s.)
7272
7273 The @code{nth} function returns a single element of a list.
7274 This can be very convenient.
7275
7276 Note that the elements are numbered from zero, not one. That is to
7277 say, the first element of a list, its @sc{car} is the zeroth element.
7278 This is called `zero-based' counting and often bothers people who
7279 are accustomed to the first element in a list being number one, which
7280 is `one-based'.
7281
7282 @need 1250
7283 For example:
7284
7285 @smallexample
7286 @group
7287 (nth 0 '("one" "two" "three"))
7288 @result{} "one"
7289
7290 (nth 1 '("one" "two" "three"))
7291 @result{} "two"
7292 @end group
7293 @end smallexample
7294
7295 It is worth mentioning that @code{nth}, like @code{nthcdr} and
7296 @code{cdr}, does not change the original list---the function is
7297 non-destructive. This is in sharp contrast to the @code{setcar} and
7298 @code{setcdr} functions.
7299
7300 @node setcar
7301 @section @code{setcar}
7302 @findex setcar
7303
7304 As you might guess from their names, the @code{setcar} and @code{setcdr}
7305 functions set the @sc{car} or the @sc{cdr} of a list to a new value.
7306 They actually change the original list, unlike @code{car} and @code{cdr}
7307 which leave the original list as it was. One way to find out how this
7308 works is to experiment. We will start with the @code{setcar} function.
7309
7310 @need 1200
7311 First, we can make a list and then set the value of a variable to the
7312 list, using the @code{setq} function. Here is a list of animals:
7313
7314 @smallexample
7315 (setq animals '(antelope giraffe lion tiger))
7316 @end smallexample
7317
7318 @noindent
7319 If you are reading this in Info inside of GNU Emacs, you can evaluate
7320 this expression in the usual fashion, by positioning the cursor after
7321 the expression and typing @kbd{C-x C-e}. (I'm doing this right here
7322 as I write this. This is one of the advantages of having the
7323 interpreter built into the computing environment. Incidentally, when
7324 there is nothing on the line after the final parentheses, such as a
7325 comment, point can be on the next line. Thus, if your cursor is in
7326 the first column of the next line, you do not need to move it.
7327 Indeed, Emacs permits any amount of white space after the final
7328 parenthesis.)
7329
7330 @need 1200
7331 When we evaluate the variable @code{animals}, we see that it is bound to
7332 the list @code{(antelope giraffe lion tiger)}:
7333
7334 @smallexample
7335 @group
7336 animals
7337 @result{} (antelope giraffe lion tiger)
7338 @end group
7339 @end smallexample
7340
7341 @noindent
7342 Put another way, the variable @code{animals} points to the list
7343 @code{(antelope giraffe lion tiger)}.
7344
7345 Next, evaluate the function @code{setcar} while passing it two
7346 arguments, the variable @code{animals} and the quoted symbol
7347 @code{hippopotamus}; this is done by writing the three element list
7348 @code{(setcar animals 'hippopotamus)} and then evaluating it in the
7349 usual fashion:
7350
7351 @smallexample
7352 (setcar animals 'hippopotamus)
7353 @end smallexample
7354
7355 @need 1200
7356 @noindent
7357 After evaluating this expression, evaluate the variable @code{animals}
7358 again. You will see that the list of animals has changed:
7359
7360 @smallexample
7361 @group
7362 animals
7363 @result{} (hippopotamus giraffe lion tiger)
7364 @end group
7365 @end smallexample
7366
7367 @noindent
7368 The first element on the list, @code{antelope} is replaced by
7369 @code{hippopotamus}.
7370
7371 So we can see that @code{setcar} did not add a new element to the list
7372 as @code{cons} would have; it replaced @code{antelope} with
7373 @code{hippopotamus}; it @emph{changed} the list.
7374
7375 @node setcdr
7376 @section @code{setcdr}
7377 @findex setcdr
7378
7379 The @code{setcdr} function is similar to the @code{setcar} function,
7380 except that the function replaces the second and subsequent elements of
7381 a list rather than the first element.
7382
7383 (To see how to change the last element of a list, look ahead to
7384 @ref{kill-new function, , The @code{kill-new} function}, which uses
7385 the @code{nthcdr} and @code{setcdr} functions.)
7386
7387 @need 1200
7388 To see how this works, set the value of the variable to a list of
7389 domesticated animals by evaluating the following expression:
7390
7391 @smallexample
7392 (setq domesticated-animals '(horse cow sheep goat))
7393 @end smallexample
7394
7395 @need 1200
7396 @noindent
7397 If you now evaluate the list, you will be returned the list
7398 @code{(horse cow sheep goat)}:
7399
7400 @smallexample
7401 @group
7402 domesticated-animals
7403 @result{} (horse cow sheep goat)
7404 @end group
7405 @end smallexample
7406
7407 @need 1200
7408 Next, evaluate @code{setcdr} with two arguments, the name of the
7409 variable which has a list as its value, and the list to which the
7410 @sc{cdr} of the first list will be set;
7411
7412 @smallexample
7413 (setcdr domesticated-animals '(cat dog))
7414 @end smallexample
7415
7416 @noindent
7417 If you evaluate this expression, the list @code{(cat dog)} will appear
7418 in the echo area. This is the value returned by the function. The
7419 result we are interested in is the ``side effect'', which we can see by
7420 evaluating the variable @code{domesticated-animals}:
7421
7422 @smallexample
7423 @group
7424 domesticated-animals
7425 @result{} (horse cat dog)
7426 @end group
7427 @end smallexample
7428
7429 @noindent
7430 Indeed, the list is changed from @code{(horse cow sheep goat)} to
7431 @code{(horse cat dog)}. The @sc{cdr} of the list is changed from
7432 @code{(cow sheep goat)} to @code{(cat dog)}.
7433
7434 @node cons Exercise
7435 @section Exercise
7436
7437 Construct a list of four birds by evaluating several expressions with
7438 @code{cons}. Find out what happens when you @code{cons} a list onto
7439 itself. Replace the first element of the list of four birds with a
7440 fish. Replace the rest of that list with a list of other fish.
7441
7442 @node Cutting & Storing Text
7443 @chapter Cutting and Storing Text
7444 @cindex Cutting and storing text
7445 @cindex Storing and cutting text
7446 @cindex Killing text
7447 @cindex Clipping text
7448 @cindex Erasing text
7449 @cindex Deleting text
7450
7451 Whenever you cut or clip text out of a buffer with a `kill' command in
7452 GNU Emacs, it is stored in a list and you can bring it back with a
7453 `yank' command.
7454
7455 (The use of the word `kill' in Emacs for processes which specifically
7456 @emph{do not} destroy the values of the entities is an unfortunate
7457 historical accident. A much more appropriate word would be `clip' since
7458 that is what the kill commands do; they clip text out of a buffer and
7459 put it into storage from which it can be brought back. I have often
7460 been tempted to replace globally all occurrences of `kill' in the Emacs
7461 sources with `clip' and all occurrences of `killed' with `clipped'.)
7462
7463 @menu
7464 * Storing Text:: Text is stored in a list.
7465 * zap-to-char:: Cutting out text up to a character.
7466 * kill-region:: Cutting text out of a region.
7467 * copy-region-as-kill:: A definition for copying text.
7468 * Digression into C:: Minor note on C programming language macros.
7469 * defvar:: How to give a variable an initial value.
7470 * cons & search-fwd Review::
7471 * search Exercises::
7472 @end menu
7473
7474 @ifnottex
7475 @node Storing Text
7476 @unnumberedsec Storing Text in a List
7477 @end ifnottex
7478
7479 When text is cut out of a buffer, it is stored on a list. Successive
7480 pieces of text are stored on the list successively, so the list might
7481 look like this:
7482
7483 @smallexample
7484 ("a piece of text" "previous piece")
7485 @end smallexample
7486
7487 @need 1200
7488 @noindent
7489 The function @code{cons} can be used to create a new list from a piece
7490 of text (an `atom', to use the jargon) and an existing list, like
7491 this:
7492
7493 @smallexample
7494 @group
7495 (cons "another piece"
7496 '("a piece of text" "previous piece"))
7497 @end group
7498 @end smallexample
7499
7500 @need 1200
7501 @noindent
7502 If you evaluate this expression, a list of three elements will appear in
7503 the echo area:
7504
7505 @smallexample
7506 ("another piece" "a piece of text" "previous piece")
7507 @end smallexample
7508
7509 With the @code{car} and @code{nthcdr} functions, you can retrieve
7510 whichever piece of text you want. For example, in the following code,
7511 @code{nthcdr 1 @dots{}} returns the list with the first item removed;
7512 and the @code{car} returns the first element of that remainder---the
7513 second element of the original list:
7514
7515 @smallexample
7516 @group
7517 (car (nthcdr 1 '("another piece"
7518 "a piece of text"
7519 "previous piece")))
7520 @result{} "a piece of text"
7521 @end group
7522 @end smallexample
7523
7524 The actual functions in Emacs are more complex than this, of course.
7525 The code for cutting and retrieving text has to be written so that
7526 Emacs can figure out which element in the list you want---the first,
7527 second, third, or whatever. In addition, when you get to the end of
7528 the list, Emacs should give you the first element of the list, rather
7529 than nothing at all.
7530
7531 The list that holds the pieces of text is called the @dfn{kill ring}.
7532 This chapter leads up to a description of the kill ring and how it is
7533 used by first tracing how the @code{zap-to-char} function works. This
7534 function uses (or `calls') a function that invokes a function that
7535 manipulates the kill ring. Thus, before reaching the mountains, we
7536 climb the foothills.
7537
7538 A subsequent chapter describes how text that is cut from the buffer is
7539 retrieved. @xref{Yanking, , Yanking Text Back}.
7540
7541 @node zap-to-char
7542 @section @code{zap-to-char}
7543 @findex zap-to-char
7544
7545 @c FIXME remove obsolete stuff
7546 The @code{zap-to-char} function changed little between GNU Emacs
7547 version 19 and GNU Emacs version 22. However, @code{zap-to-char}
7548 calls another function, @code{kill-region}, which enjoyed a major
7549 rewrite.
7550
7551 The @code{kill-region} function in Emacs 19 is complex, but does not
7552 use code that is important at this time. We will skip it.
7553
7554 The @code{kill-region} function in Emacs 22 is easier to read than the
7555 same function in Emacs 19 and introduces a very important concept,
7556 that of error handling. We will walk through the function.
7557
7558 But first, let us look at the interactive @code{zap-to-char} function.
7559
7560 @menu
7561 * Complete zap-to-char:: The complete implementation.
7562 * zap-to-char interactive:: A three part interactive expression.
7563 * zap-to-char body:: A short overview.
7564 * search-forward:: How to search for a string.
7565 * progn:: The @code{progn} special form.
7566 * Summing up zap-to-char:: Using @code{point} and @code{search-forward}.
7567 @end menu
7568
7569 @ifnottex
7570 @node Complete zap-to-char
7571 @unnumberedsubsec The Complete @code{zap-to-char} Implementation
7572 @end ifnottex
7573
7574 The @code{zap-to-char} function removes the text in the region between
7575 the location of the cursor (i.e., of point) up to and including the
7576 next occurrence of a specified character. The text that
7577 @code{zap-to-char} removes is put in the kill ring; and it can be
7578 retrieved from the kill ring by typing @kbd{C-y} (@code{yank}). If
7579 the command is given an argument, it removes text through that number
7580 of occurrences. Thus, if the cursor were at the beginning of this
7581 sentence and the character were @samp{s}, @samp{Thus} would be
7582 removed. If the argument were two, @samp{Thus, if the curs} would be
7583 removed, up to and including the @samp{s} in @samp{cursor}.
7584
7585 If the specified character is not found, @code{zap-to-char} will say
7586 ``Search failed'', tell you the character you typed, and not remove
7587 any text.
7588
7589 In order to determine how much text to remove, @code{zap-to-char} uses
7590 a search function. Searches are used extensively in code that
7591 manipulates text, and we will focus attention on them as well as on the
7592 deletion command.
7593
7594 @ignore
7595 @c GNU Emacs version 19
7596 (defun zap-to-char (arg char) ; version 19 implementation
7597 "Kill up to and including ARG'th occurrence of CHAR.
7598 Goes backward if ARG is negative; error if CHAR not found."
7599 (interactive "*p\ncZap to char: ")
7600 (kill-region (point)
7601 (progn
7602 (search-forward
7603 (char-to-string char) nil nil arg)
7604 (point))))
7605 @end ignore
7606
7607 @need 1250
7608 Here is the complete text of the version 22 implementation of the function:
7609
7610 @c GNU Emacs 22
7611 @smallexample
7612 @group
7613 (defun zap-to-char (arg char)
7614 "Kill up to and including ARG'th occurrence of CHAR.
7615 Case is ignored if `case-fold-search' is non-nil in the current buffer.
7616 Goes backward if ARG is negative; error if CHAR not found."
7617 (interactive "p\ncZap to char: ")
7618 (if (char-table-p translation-table-for-input)
7619 (setq char (or (aref translation-table-for-input char) char)))
7620 (kill-region (point) (progn
7621 (search-forward (char-to-string char)
7622 nil nil arg)
7623 (point))))
7624 @end group
7625 @end smallexample
7626
7627 The documentation is thorough. You do need to know the jargon meaning
7628 of the word `kill'.
7629
7630 @node zap-to-char interactive
7631 @subsection The @code{interactive} Expression
7632
7633 @need 800
7634 The interactive expression in the @code{zap-to-char} command looks like
7635 this:
7636
7637 @smallexample
7638 (interactive "p\ncZap to char: ")
7639 @end smallexample
7640
7641 The part within quotation marks, @code{"p\ncZap to char:@: "}, specifies
7642 two different things. First, and most simply, is the @samp{p}.
7643 This part is separated from the next part by a newline, @samp{\n}.
7644 The @samp{p} means that the first argument to the function will be
7645 passed the value of a `processed prefix'. The prefix argument is
7646 passed by typing @kbd{C-u} and a number, or @kbd{M-} and a number. If
7647 the function is called interactively without a prefix, 1 is passed to
7648 this argument.
7649
7650 The second part of @code{"p\ncZap to char:@: "} is
7651 @samp{cZap to char:@: }. In this part, the lower case @samp{c}
7652 indicates that @code{interactive} expects a prompt and that the
7653 argument will be a character. The prompt follows the @samp{c} and is
7654 the string @samp{Zap to char:@: } (with a space after the colon to
7655 make it look good).
7656
7657 What all this does is prepare the arguments to @code{zap-to-char} so they
7658 are of the right type, and give the user a prompt.
7659
7660 In a read-only buffer, the @code{zap-to-char} function copies the text
7661 to the kill ring, but does not remove it. The echo area displays a
7662 message saying that the buffer is read-only. Also, the terminal may
7663 beep or blink at you.
7664
7665 @node zap-to-char body
7666 @subsection The Body of @code{zap-to-char}
7667
7668 The body of the @code{zap-to-char} function contains the code that
7669 kills (that is, removes) the text in the region from the current
7670 position of the cursor up to and including the specified character.
7671
7672 The first part of the code looks like this:
7673
7674 @smallexample
7675 (if (char-table-p translation-table-for-input)
7676 (setq char (or (aref translation-table-for-input char) char)))
7677 (kill-region (point) (progn
7678 (search-forward (char-to-string char) nil nil arg)
7679 (point)))
7680 @end smallexample
7681
7682 @noindent
7683 @code{char-table-p} is an hitherto unseen function. It determines
7684 whether its argument is a character table. When it is, it sets the
7685 character passed to @code{zap-to-char} to one of them, if that
7686 character exists, or to the character itself. (This becomes important
7687 for certain characters in non-European languages. The @code{aref}
7688 function extracts an element from an array. It is an array-specific
7689 function that is not described in this document. @xref{Arrays, ,
7690 Arrays, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}.)
7691
7692 @noindent
7693 @code{(point)} is the current position of the cursor.
7694
7695 The next part of the code is an expression using @code{progn}. The body
7696 of the @code{progn} consists of calls to @code{search-forward} and
7697 @code{point}.
7698
7699 It is easier to understand how @code{progn} works after learning about
7700 @code{search-forward}, so we will look at @code{search-forward} and
7701 then at @code{progn}.
7702
7703 @node search-forward
7704 @subsection The @code{search-forward} Function
7705 @findex search-forward
7706
7707 The @code{search-forward} function is used to locate the
7708 zapped-for-character in @code{zap-to-char}. If the search is
7709 successful, @code{search-forward} leaves point immediately after the
7710 last character in the target string. (In @code{zap-to-char}, the
7711 target string is just one character long. @code{zap-to-char} uses the
7712 function @code{char-to-string} to ensure that the computer treats that
7713 character as a string.) If the search is backwards,
7714 @code{search-forward} leaves point just before the first character in
7715 the target. Also, @code{search-forward} returns @code{t} for true.
7716 (Moving point is therefore a `side effect'.)
7717
7718 @need 1250
7719 In @code{zap-to-char}, the @code{search-forward} function looks like this:
7720
7721 @smallexample
7722 (search-forward (char-to-string char) nil nil arg)
7723 @end smallexample
7724
7725 The @code{search-forward} function takes four arguments:
7726
7727 @enumerate
7728 @item
7729 The first argument is the target, what is searched for. This must be a
7730 string, such as @samp{"z"}.
7731
7732 As it happens, the argument passed to @code{zap-to-char} is a single
7733 character. Because of the way computers are built, the Lisp
7734 interpreter may treat a single character as being different from a
7735 string of characters. Inside the computer, a single character has a
7736 different electronic format than a string of one character. (A single
7737 character can often be recorded in the computer using exactly one
7738 byte; but a string may be longer, and the computer needs to be ready
7739 for this.) Since the @code{search-forward} function searches for a
7740 string, the character that the @code{zap-to-char} function receives as
7741 its argument must be converted inside the computer from one format to
7742 the other; otherwise the @code{search-forward} function will fail.
7743 The @code{char-to-string} function is used to make this conversion.
7744
7745 @item
7746 The second argument bounds the search; it is specified as a position in
7747 the buffer. In this case, the search can go to the end of the buffer,
7748 so no bound is set and the second argument is @code{nil}.
7749
7750 @item
7751 The third argument tells the function what it should do if the search
7752 fails---it can signal an error (and print a message) or it can return
7753 @code{nil}. A @code{nil} as the third argument causes the function to
7754 signal an error when the search fails.
7755
7756 @item
7757 The fourth argument to @code{search-forward} is the repeat count---how
7758 many occurrences of the string to look for. This argument is optional
7759 and if the function is called without a repeat count, this argument is
7760 passed the value 1. If this argument is negative, the search goes
7761 backwards.
7762 @end enumerate
7763
7764 @need 800
7765 In template form, a @code{search-forward} expression looks like this:
7766
7767 @smallexample
7768 @group
7769 (search-forward "@var{target-string}"
7770 @var{limit-of-search}
7771 @var{what-to-do-if-search-fails}
7772 @var{repeat-count})
7773 @end group
7774 @end smallexample
7775
7776 We will look at @code{progn} next.
7777
7778 @node progn
7779 @subsection The @code{progn} Special Form
7780 @findex progn
7781
7782 @code{progn} is a special form that causes each of its arguments to be
7783 evaluated in sequence and then returns the value of the last one. The
7784 preceding expressions are evaluated only for the side effects they
7785 perform. The values produced by them are discarded.
7786
7787 @need 800
7788 The template for a @code{progn} expression is very simple:
7789
7790 @smallexample
7791 @group
7792 (progn
7793 @var{body}@dots{})
7794 @end group
7795 @end smallexample
7796
7797 In @code{zap-to-char}, the @code{progn} expression has to do two things:
7798 put point in exactly the right position; and return the location of
7799 point so that @code{kill-region} will know how far to kill to.
7800
7801 The first argument to the @code{progn} is @code{search-forward}. When
7802 @code{search-forward} finds the string, the function leaves point
7803 immediately after the last character in the target string. (In this
7804 case the target string is just one character long.) If the search is
7805 backwards, @code{search-forward} leaves point just before the first
7806 character in the target. The movement of point is a side effect.
7807
7808 The second and last argument to @code{progn} is the expression
7809 @code{(point)}. This expression returns the value of point, which in
7810 this case will be the location to which it has been moved by
7811 @code{search-forward}. (In the source, a line that tells the function
7812 to go to the previous character, if it is going forward, was commented
7813 out in 1999; I don't remember whether that feature or mis-feature was
7814 ever a part of the distributed source.) The value of @code{point} is
7815 returned by the @code{progn} expression and is passed to
7816 @code{kill-region} as @code{kill-region}'s second argument.
7817
7818 @node Summing up zap-to-char
7819 @subsection Summing up @code{zap-to-char}
7820
7821 Now that we have seen how @code{search-forward} and @code{progn} work,
7822 we can see how the @code{zap-to-char} function works as a whole.
7823
7824 The first argument to @code{kill-region} is the position of the cursor
7825 when the @code{zap-to-char} command is given---the value of point at
7826 that time. Within the @code{progn}, the search function then moves
7827 point to just after the zapped-to-character and @code{point} returns the
7828 value of this location. The @code{kill-region} function puts together
7829 these two values of point, the first one as the beginning of the region
7830 and the second one as the end of the region, and removes the region.
7831
7832 The @code{progn} special form is necessary because the
7833 @code{kill-region} command takes two arguments; and it would fail if
7834 @code{search-forward} and @code{point} expressions were written in
7835 sequence as two additional arguments. The @code{progn} expression is
7836 a single argument to @code{kill-region} and returns the one value that
7837 @code{kill-region} needs for its second argument.
7838
7839 @node kill-region
7840 @section @code{kill-region}
7841 @findex kill-region
7842
7843 The @code{zap-to-char} function uses the @code{kill-region} function.
7844 This function clips text from a region and copies that text to
7845 the kill ring, from which it may be retrieved.
7846
7847 @ignore
7848 GNU Emacs 22:
7849
7850 (defun kill-region (beg end &optional yank-handler)
7851 "Kill (\"cut\") text between point and mark.
7852 This deletes the text from the buffer and saves it in the kill ring.
7853 The command \\[yank] can retrieve it from there.
7854 \(If you want to kill and then yank immediately, use \\[kill-ring-save].)
7855
7856 If you want to append the killed region to the last killed text,
7857 use \\[append-next-kill] before \\[kill-region].
7858
7859 If the buffer is read-only, Emacs will beep and refrain from deleting
7860 the text, but put the text in the kill ring anyway. This means that
7861 you can use the killing commands to copy text from a read-only buffer.
7862
7863 This is the primitive for programs to kill text (as opposed to deleting it).
7864 Supply two arguments, character positions indicating the stretch of text
7865 to be killed.
7866 Any command that calls this function is a \"kill command\".
7867 If the previous command was also a kill command,
7868 the text killed this time appends to the text killed last time
7869 to make one entry in the kill ring.
7870
7871 In Lisp code, optional third arg YANK-HANDLER, if non-nil,
7872 specifies the yank-handler text property to be set on the killed
7873 text. See `insert-for-yank'."
7874 ;; Pass point first, then mark, because the order matters
7875 ;; when calling kill-append.
7876 (interactive (list (point) (mark)))
7877 (unless (and beg end)
7878 (error "The mark is not set now, so there is no region"))
7879 (condition-case nil
7880 (let ((string (filter-buffer-substring beg end t)))
7881 (when string ;STRING is nil if BEG = END
7882 ;; Add that string to the kill ring, one way or another.
7883 (if (eq last-command 'kill-region)
7884 (kill-append string (< end beg) yank-handler)
7885 (kill-new string nil yank-handler)))
7886 (when (or string (eq last-command 'kill-region))
7887 (setq this-command 'kill-region))
7888 nil)
7889 ((buffer-read-only text-read-only)
7890 ;; The code above failed because the buffer, or some of the characters
7891 ;; in the region, are read-only.
7892 ;; We should beep, in case the user just isn't aware of this.
7893 ;; However, there's no harm in putting
7894 ;; the region's text in the kill ring, anyway.
7895 (copy-region-as-kill beg end)
7896 ;; Set this-command now, so it will be set even if we get an error.
7897 (setq this-command 'kill-region)
7898 ;; This should barf, if appropriate, and give us the correct error.
7899 (if kill-read-only-ok
7900 (progn (message "Read only text copied to kill ring") nil)
7901 ;; Signal an error if the buffer is read-only.
7902 (barf-if-buffer-read-only)
7903 ;; If the buffer isn't read-only, the text is.
7904 (signal 'text-read-only (list (current-buffer)))))))
7905 @end ignore
7906
7907 The Emacs 22 version of that function uses @code{condition-case} and
7908 @code{copy-region-as-kill}, both of which we will explain.
7909 @code{condition-case} is an important special form.
7910
7911 In essence, the @code{kill-region} function calls
7912 @code{condition-case}, which takes three arguments. In this function,
7913 the first argument does nothing. The second argument contains the
7914 code that does the work when all goes well. The third argument
7915 contains the code that is called in the event of an error.
7916
7917 @menu
7918 * Complete kill-region:: The function definition.
7919 * condition-case:: Dealing with a problem.
7920 * Lisp macro::
7921 @end menu
7922
7923 @ifnottex
7924 @node Complete kill-region
7925 @unnumberedsubsec The Complete @code{kill-region} Definition
7926 @end ifnottex
7927
7928 @need 1200
7929 We will go through the @code{condition-case} code in a moment. First,
7930 let us look at the definition of @code{kill-region}, with comments
7931 added:
7932
7933 @c GNU Emacs 22:
7934 @smallexample
7935 @group
7936 (defun kill-region (beg end)
7937 "Kill (\"cut\") text between point and mark.
7938 This deletes the text from the buffer and saves it in the kill ring.
7939 The command \\[yank] can retrieve it from there. @dots{} "
7940 @end group
7941
7942 @group
7943 ;; @bullet{} Since order matters, pass point first.
7944 (interactive (list (point) (mark)))
7945 ;; @bullet{} And tell us if we cannot cut the text.
7946 ;; `unless' is an `if' without a then-part.
7947 (unless (and beg end)
7948 (error "The mark is not set now, so there is no region"))
7949 @end group
7950
7951 @group
7952 ;; @bullet{} `condition-case' takes three arguments.
7953 ;; If the first argument is nil, as it is here,
7954 ;; information about the error signal is not
7955 ;; stored for use by another function.
7956 (condition-case nil
7957 @end group
7958
7959 @group
7960 ;; @bullet{} The second argument to `condition-case' tells the
7961 ;; Lisp interpreter what to do when all goes well.
7962 @end group
7963
7964 @group
7965 ;; It starts with a `let' function that extracts the string
7966 ;; and tests whether it exists. If so (that is what the
7967 ;; `when' checks), it calls an `if' function that determines
7968 ;; whether the previous command was another call to
7969 ;; `kill-region'; if it was, then the new text is appended to
7970 ;; the previous text; if not, then a different function,
7971 ;; `kill-new', is called.
7972 @end group
7973
7974 @group
7975 ;; The `kill-append' function concatenates the new string and
7976 ;; the old. The `kill-new' function inserts text into a new
7977 ;; item in the kill ring.
7978 @end group
7979
7980 @group
7981 ;; `when' is an `if' without an else-part. The second `when'
7982 ;; again checks whether the current string exists; in
7983 ;; addition, it checks whether the previous command was
7984 ;; another call to `kill-region'. If one or the other
7985 ;; condition is true, then it sets the current command to
7986 ;; be `kill-region'.
7987 @end group
7988 @group
7989 (let ((string (filter-buffer-substring beg end t)))
7990 (when string ;STRING is nil if BEG = END
7991 ;; Add that string to the kill ring, one way or another.
7992 (if (eq last-command 'kill-region)
7993 @end group
7994 @group
7995 ;; @minus{} `yank-handler' is an optional argument to
7996 ;; `kill-region' that tells the `kill-append' and
7997 ;; `kill-new' functions how deal with properties
7998 ;; added to the text, such as `bold' or `italics'.
7999 (kill-append string (< end beg) yank-handler)
8000 (kill-new string nil yank-handler)))
8001 (when (or string (eq last-command 'kill-region))
8002 (setq this-command 'kill-region))
8003 nil)
8004 @end group
8005
8006 @group
8007 ;; @bullet{} The third argument to `condition-case' tells the interpreter
8008 ;; what to do with an error.
8009 @end group
8010 @group
8011 ;; The third argument has a conditions part and a body part.
8012 ;; If the conditions are met (in this case,
8013 ;; if text or buffer are read-only)
8014 ;; then the body is executed.
8015 @end group
8016 @group
8017 ;; The first part of the third argument is the following:
8018 ((buffer-read-only text-read-only) ;; the if-part
8019 ;; @dots{} the then-part
8020 (copy-region-as-kill beg end)
8021 @end group
8022 @group
8023 ;; Next, also as part of the then-part, set this-command, so
8024 ;; it will be set in an error
8025 (setq this-command 'kill-region)
8026 ;; Finally, in the then-part, send a message if you may copy
8027 ;; the text to the kill ring without signaling an error, but
8028 ;; don't if you may not.
8029 @end group
8030 @group
8031 (if kill-read-only-ok
8032 (progn (message "Read only text copied to kill ring") nil)
8033 (barf-if-buffer-read-only)
8034 ;; If the buffer isn't read-only, the text is.
8035 (signal 'text-read-only (list (current-buffer)))))
8036 @end group
8037 @end smallexample
8038
8039 @ignore
8040 @c v 21
8041 @smallexample
8042 @group
8043 (defun kill-region (beg end)
8044 "Kill between point and mark.
8045 The text is deleted but saved in the kill ring."
8046 (interactive "r")
8047 @end group
8048
8049 @group
8050 ;; 1. `condition-case' takes three arguments.
8051 ;; If the first argument is nil, as it is here,
8052 ;; information about the error signal is not
8053 ;; stored for use by another function.
8054 (condition-case nil
8055 @end group
8056
8057 @group
8058 ;; 2. The second argument to `condition-case'
8059 ;; tells the Lisp interpreter what to do when all goes well.
8060 @end group
8061
8062 @group
8063 ;; The `delete-and-extract-region' function usually does the
8064 ;; work. If the beginning and ending of the region are both
8065 ;; the same, then the variable `string' will be empty, or nil
8066 (let ((string (delete-and-extract-region beg end)))
8067 @end group
8068
8069 @group
8070 ;; `when' is an `if' clause that cannot take an `else-part'.
8071 ;; Emacs normally sets the value of `last-command' to the
8072 ;; previous command.
8073 @end group
8074 @group
8075 ;; `kill-append' concatenates the new string and the old.
8076 ;; `kill-new' inserts text into a new item in the kill ring.
8077 (when string
8078 (if (eq last-command 'kill-region)
8079 ;; if true, prepend string
8080 (kill-append string (< end beg))
8081 (kill-new string)))
8082 (setq this-command 'kill-region))
8083 @end group
8084
8085 @group
8086 ;; 3. The third argument to `condition-case' tells the interpreter
8087 ;; what to do with an error.
8088 @end group
8089 @group
8090 ;; The third argument has a conditions part and a body part.
8091 ;; If the conditions are met (in this case,
8092 ;; if text or buffer are read-only)
8093 ;; then the body is executed.
8094 @end group
8095 @group
8096 ((buffer-read-only text-read-only) ;; this is the if-part
8097 ;; then...
8098 (copy-region-as-kill beg end)
8099 @end group
8100 @group
8101 (if kill-read-only-ok ;; usually this variable is nil
8102 (message "Read only text copied to kill ring")
8103 ;; or else, signal an error if the buffer is read-only;
8104 (barf-if-buffer-read-only)
8105 ;; and, in any case, signal that the text is read-only.
8106 (signal 'text-read-only (list (current-buffer)))))))
8107 @end group
8108 @end smallexample
8109 @end ignore
8110
8111 @node condition-case
8112 @subsection @code{condition-case}
8113 @findex condition-case
8114
8115 As we have seen earlier (@pxref{Making Errors, , Generate an Error
8116 Message}), when the Emacs Lisp interpreter has trouble evaluating an
8117 expression, it provides you with help; in the jargon, this is called
8118 ``signaling an error''. Usually, the computer stops the program and
8119 shows you a message.
8120
8121 However, some programs undertake complicated actions. They should not
8122 simply stop on an error. In the @code{kill-region} function, the most
8123 likely error is that you will try to kill text that is read-only and
8124 cannot be removed. So the @code{kill-region} function contains code
8125 to handle this circumstance. This code, which makes up the body of
8126 the @code{kill-region} function, is inside of a @code{condition-case}
8127 special form.
8128
8129 @need 800
8130 The template for @code{condition-case} looks like this:
8131
8132 @smallexample
8133 @group
8134 (condition-case
8135 @var{var}
8136 @var{bodyform}
8137 @var{error-handler}@dots{})
8138 @end group
8139 @end smallexample
8140
8141 The second argument, @var{bodyform}, is straightforward. The
8142 @code{condition-case} special form causes the Lisp interpreter to
8143 evaluate the code in @var{bodyform}. If no error occurs, the special
8144 form returns the code's value and produces the side-effects, if any.
8145
8146 In short, the @var{bodyform} part of a @code{condition-case}
8147 expression determines what should happen when everything works
8148 correctly.
8149
8150 However, if an error occurs, among its other actions, the function
8151 generating the error signal will define one or more error condition
8152 names.
8153
8154 An error handler is the third argument to @code{condition case}.
8155 An error handler has two parts, a @var{condition-name} and a
8156 @var{body}. If the @var{condition-name} part of an error handler
8157 matches a condition name generated by an error, then the @var{body}
8158 part of the error handler is run.
8159
8160 As you will expect, the @var{condition-name} part of an error handler
8161 may be either a single condition name or a list of condition names.
8162
8163 Also, a complete @code{condition-case} expression may contain more
8164 than one error handler. When an error occurs, the first applicable
8165 handler is run.
8166
8167 Lastly, the first argument to the @code{condition-case} expression,
8168 the @var{var} argument, is sometimes bound to a variable that
8169 contains information about the error. However, if that argument is
8170 nil, as is the case in @code{kill-region}, that information is
8171 discarded.
8172
8173 @need 1200
8174 In brief, in the @code{kill-region} function, the code
8175 @code{condition-case} works like this:
8176
8177 @smallexample
8178 @group
8179 @var{If no errors}, @var{run only this code}
8180 @var{but}, @var{if errors}, @var{run this other code}.
8181 @end group
8182 @end smallexample
8183
8184 @ignore
8185 2006 Oct 24
8186 In Emacs 22,
8187 copy-region-as-kill is short, 12 lines, and uses
8188 filter-buffer-substring, which is longer, 39 lines
8189 and has delete-and-extract-region in it.
8190 delete-and-extract-region is written in C.
8191
8192 see Initializing a Variable with @code{defvar}
8193 this is line 8054
8194 Initializing a Variable with @code{defvar} includes line 8350
8195 @end ignore
8196
8197 @node Lisp macro
8198 @subsection Lisp macro
8199 @cindex Macro, lisp
8200 @cindex Lisp macro
8201
8202 The part of the @code{condition-case} expression that is evaluated in
8203 the expectation that all goes well has a @code{when}. The code uses
8204 @code{when} to determine whether the @code{string} variable points to
8205 text that exists.
8206
8207 A @code{when} expression is simply a programmers' convenience. It is
8208 an @code{if} without the possibility of an else clause. In your mind,
8209 you can replace @code{when} with @code{if} and understand what goes
8210 on. That is what the Lisp interpreter does.
8211
8212 Technically speaking, @code{when} is a Lisp macro. A Lisp macro
8213 enables you to define new control constructs and other language
8214 features. It tells the interpreter how to compute another Lisp
8215 expression which will in turn compute the value. In this case, the
8216 `other expression' is an @code{if} expression.
8217
8218 The @code{kill-region} function definition also has an @code{unless}
8219 macro; it is the converse of @code{when}. The @code{unless} macro is
8220 an @code{if} without a then clause
8221
8222 For more about Lisp macros, see @ref{Macros, , Macros, elisp, The GNU
8223 Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}. The C programming language also
8224 provides macros. These are different, but also useful.
8225
8226 @ignore
8227 We will briefly look at C macros in
8228 @ref{Digression into C}.
8229 @end ignore
8230
8231 @need 1200
8232 Regarding the @code{when} macro, in the @code{condition-case}
8233 expression, when the string has content, then another conditional
8234 expression is executed. This is an @code{if} with both a then-part
8235 and an else-part.
8236
8237 @smallexample
8238 @group
8239 (if (eq last-command 'kill-region)
8240 (kill-append string (< end beg) yank-handler)
8241 (kill-new string nil yank-handler))
8242 @end group
8243 @end smallexample
8244
8245 The then-part is evaluated if the previous command was another call to
8246 @code{kill-region}; if not, the else-part is evaluated.
8247
8248 @code{yank-handler} is an optional argument to @code{kill-region} that
8249 tells the @code{kill-append} and @code{kill-new} functions how deal
8250 with properties added to the text, such as `bold' or `italics'.
8251
8252 @code{last-command} is a variable that comes with Emacs that we have
8253 not seen before. Normally, whenever a function is executed, Emacs
8254 sets the value of @code{last-command} to the previous command.
8255
8256 @need 1200
8257 In this segment of the definition, the @code{if} expression checks
8258 whether the previous command was @code{kill-region}. If it was,
8259
8260 @smallexample
8261 (kill-append string (< end beg) yank-handler)
8262 @end smallexample
8263
8264 @noindent
8265 concatenates a copy of the newly clipped text to the just previously
8266 clipped text in the kill ring.
8267
8268 @node copy-region-as-kill
8269 @section @code{copy-region-as-kill}
8270 @findex copy-region-as-kill
8271 @findex nthcdr
8272
8273 The @code{copy-region-as-kill} function copies a region of text from a
8274 buffer and (via either @code{kill-append} or @code{kill-new}) saves it
8275 in the @code{kill-ring}.
8276
8277 If you call @code{copy-region-as-kill} immediately after a
8278 @code{kill-region} command, Emacs appends the newly copied text to the
8279 previously copied text. This means that if you yank back the text, you
8280 get it all, from both this and the previous operation. On the other
8281 hand, if some other command precedes the @code{copy-region-as-kill},
8282 the function copies the text into a separate entry in the kill ring.
8283
8284 @menu
8285 * Complete copy-region-as-kill:: The complete function definition.
8286 * copy-region-as-kill body:: The body of @code{copy-region-as-kill}.
8287 @end menu
8288
8289 @ifnottex
8290 @node Complete copy-region-as-kill
8291 @unnumberedsubsec The complete @code{copy-region-as-kill} function definition
8292 @end ifnottex
8293
8294 @need 1200
8295 Here is the complete text of the version 22 @code{copy-region-as-kill}
8296 function:
8297
8298 @smallexample
8299 @group
8300 (defun copy-region-as-kill (beg end)
8301 "Save the region as if killed, but don't kill it.
8302 In Transient Mark mode, deactivate the mark.
8303 If `interprogram-cut-function' is non-nil, also save the text for a window
8304 system cut and paste."
8305 (interactive "r")
8306 @end group
8307 @group
8308 (if (eq last-command 'kill-region)
8309 (kill-append (filter-buffer-substring beg end) (< end beg))
8310 (kill-new (filter-buffer-substring beg end)))
8311 @end group
8312 @group
8313 (if transient-mark-mode
8314 (setq deactivate-mark t))
8315 nil)
8316 @end group
8317 @end smallexample
8318
8319 @need 800
8320 As usual, this function can be divided into its component parts:
8321
8322 @smallexample
8323 @group
8324 (defun copy-region-as-kill (@var{argument-list})
8325 "@var{documentation}@dots{}"
8326 (interactive "r")
8327 @var{body}@dots{})
8328 @end group
8329 @end smallexample
8330
8331 The arguments are @code{beg} and @code{end} and the function is
8332 interactive with @code{"r"}, so the two arguments must refer to the
8333 beginning and end of the region. If you have been reading though this
8334 document from the beginning, understanding these parts of a function is
8335 almost becoming routine.
8336
8337 The documentation is somewhat confusing unless you remember that the
8338 word `kill' has a meaning different from usual. The `Transient Mark'
8339 and @code{interprogram-cut-function} comments explain certain
8340 side-effects.
8341
8342 After you once set a mark, a buffer always contains a region. If you
8343 wish, you can use Transient Mark mode to highlight the region
8344 temporarily. (No one wants to highlight the region all the time, so
8345 Transient Mark mode highlights it only at appropriate times. Many
8346 people turn off Transient Mark mode, so the region is never
8347 highlighted.)
8348
8349 Also, a windowing system allows you to copy, cut, and paste among
8350 different programs. In the X windowing system, for example, the
8351 @code{interprogram-cut-function} function is @code{x-select-text},
8352 which works with the windowing system's equivalent of the Emacs kill
8353 ring.
8354
8355 The body of the @code{copy-region-as-kill} function starts with an
8356 @code{if} clause. What this clause does is distinguish between two
8357 different situations: whether or not this command is executed
8358 immediately after a previous @code{kill-region} command. In the first
8359 case, the new region is appended to the previously copied text.
8360 Otherwise, it is inserted into the beginning of the kill ring as a
8361 separate piece of text from the previous piece.
8362
8363 The last two lines of the function prevent the region from lighting up
8364 if Transient Mark mode is turned on.
8365
8366 The body of @code{copy-region-as-kill} merits discussion in detail.
8367
8368 @node copy-region-as-kill body
8369 @subsection The Body of @code{copy-region-as-kill}
8370
8371 The @code{copy-region-as-kill} function works in much the same way as
8372 the @code{kill-region} function. Both are written so that two or more
8373 kills in a row combine their text into a single entry. If you yank
8374 back the text from the kill ring, you get it all in one piece.
8375 Moreover, kills that kill forward from the current position of the
8376 cursor are added to the end of the previously copied text and commands
8377 that copy text backwards add it to the beginning of the previously
8378 copied text. This way, the words in the text stay in the proper
8379 order.
8380
8381 Like @code{kill-region}, the @code{copy-region-as-kill} function makes
8382 use of the @code{last-command} variable that keeps track of the
8383 previous Emacs command.
8384
8385 @menu
8386 * last-command & this-command::
8387 * kill-append function::
8388 * kill-new function::
8389 @end menu
8390
8391 @ifnottex
8392 @node last-command & this-command
8393 @unnumberedsubsubsec @code{last-command} and @code{this-command}
8394 @end ifnottex
8395
8396 Normally, whenever a function is executed, Emacs sets the value of
8397 @code{this-command} to the function being executed (which in this case
8398 would be @code{copy-region-as-kill}). At the same time, Emacs sets
8399 the value of @code{last-command} to the previous value of
8400 @code{this-command}.
8401
8402 In the first part of the body of the @code{copy-region-as-kill}
8403 function, an @code{if} expression determines whether the value of
8404 @code{last-command} is @code{kill-region}. If so, the then-part of
8405 the @code{if} expression is evaluated; it uses the @code{kill-append}
8406 function to concatenate the text copied at this call to the function
8407 with the text already in the first element (the @sc{car}) of the kill
8408 ring. On the other hand, if the value of @code{last-command} is not
8409 @code{kill-region}, then the @code{copy-region-as-kill} function
8410 attaches a new element to the kill ring using the @code{kill-new}
8411 function.
8412
8413 @need 1250
8414 The @code{if} expression reads as follows; it uses @code{eq}:
8415
8416 @smallexample
8417 @group
8418 (if (eq last-command 'kill-region)
8419 ;; @r{then-part}
8420 (kill-append (filter-buffer-substring beg end) (< end beg))
8421 ;; @r{else-part}
8422 (kill-new (filter-buffer-substring beg end)))
8423 @end group
8424 @end smallexample
8425
8426 @findex filter-buffer-substring
8427 (The @code{filter-buffer-substring} function returns a filtered
8428 substring of the buffer, if any. Optionally---the arguments are not
8429 here, so neither is done---the function may delete the initial text or
8430 return the text without its properties; this function is a replacement
8431 for the older @code{buffer-substring} function, which came before text
8432 properties were implemented.)
8433
8434 @findex eq @r{(example of use)}
8435 @noindent
8436 The @code{eq} function tests whether its first argument is the same Lisp
8437 object as its second argument. The @code{eq} function is similar to the
8438 @code{equal} function in that it is used to test for equality, but
8439 differs in that it determines whether two representations are actually
8440 the same object inside the computer, but with different names.
8441 @code{equal} determines whether the structure and contents of two
8442 expressions are the same.
8443
8444 If the previous command was @code{kill-region}, then the Emacs Lisp
8445 interpreter calls the @code{kill-append} function
8446
8447 @node kill-append function
8448 @unnumberedsubsubsec The @code{kill-append} function
8449 @findex kill-append
8450
8451 @need 800
8452 The @code{kill-append} function looks like this:
8453
8454 @c in GNU Emacs 22
8455 @smallexample
8456 @group
8457 (defun kill-append (string before-p &optional yank-handler)
8458 "Append STRING to the end of the latest kill in the kill ring.
8459 If BEFORE-P is non-nil, prepend STRING to the kill.
8460 @dots{} "
8461 (let* ((cur (car kill-ring)))
8462 (kill-new (if before-p (concat string cur) (concat cur string))
8463 (or (= (length cur) 0)
8464 (equal yank-handler
8465 (get-text-property 0 'yank-handler cur)))
8466 yank-handler)))
8467 @end group
8468 @end smallexample
8469
8470 @ignore
8471 was:
8472 (defun kill-append (string before-p)
8473 "Append STRING to the end of the latest kill in the kill ring.
8474 If BEFORE-P is non-nil, prepend STRING to the kill.
8475 If `interprogram-cut-function' is set, pass the resulting kill to
8476 it."
8477 (kill-new (if before-p
8478 (concat string (car kill-ring))
8479 (concat (car kill-ring) string))
8480 t))
8481 @end ignore
8482
8483 @noindent
8484 The @code{kill-append} function is fairly straightforward. It uses
8485 the @code{kill-new} function, which we will discuss in more detail in
8486 a moment.
8487
8488 (Also, the function provides an optional argument called
8489 @code{yank-handler}; when invoked, this argument tells the function
8490 how to deal with properties added to the text, such as `bold' or
8491 `italics'.)
8492
8493 @c !!! bug in GNU Emacs 22 version of kill-append ?
8494 It has a @code{let*} function to set the value of the first element of
8495 the kill ring to @code{cur}. (I do not know why the function does not
8496 use @code{let} instead; only one value is set in the expression.
8497 Perhaps this is a bug that produces no problems?)
8498
8499 Consider the conditional that is one of the two arguments to
8500 @code{kill-new}. It uses @code{concat} to concatenate the new text to
8501 the @sc{car} of the kill ring. Whether it prepends or appends the
8502 text depends on the results of an @code{if} expression:
8503
8504 @smallexample
8505 @group
8506 (if before-p ; @r{if-part}
8507 (concat string cur) ; @r{then-part}
8508 (concat cur string)) ; @r{else-part}
8509 @end group
8510 @end smallexample
8511
8512 @noindent
8513 If the region being killed is before the region that was killed in the
8514 last command, then it should be prepended before the material that was
8515 saved in the previous kill; and conversely, if the killed text follows
8516 what was just killed, it should be appended after the previous text.
8517 The @code{if} expression depends on the predicate @code{before-p} to
8518 decide whether the newly saved text should be put before or after the
8519 previously saved text.
8520
8521 The symbol @code{before-p} is the name of one of the arguments to
8522 @code{kill-append}. When the @code{kill-append} function is
8523 evaluated, it is bound to the value returned by evaluating the actual
8524 argument. In this case, this is the expression @code{(< end beg)}.
8525 This expression does not directly determine whether the killed text in
8526 this command is located before or after the kill text of the last
8527 command; what it does is determine whether the value of the variable
8528 @code{end} is less than the value of the variable @code{beg}. If it
8529 is, it means that the user is most likely heading towards the
8530 beginning of the buffer. Also, the result of evaluating the predicate
8531 expression, @code{(< end beg)}, will be true and the text will be
8532 prepended before the previous text. On the other hand, if the value of
8533 the variable @code{end} is greater than the value of the variable
8534 @code{beg}, the text will be appended after the previous text.
8535
8536 @need 800
8537 When the newly saved text will be prepended, then the string with the new
8538 text will be concatenated before the old text:
8539
8540 @smallexample
8541 (concat string cur)
8542 @end smallexample
8543
8544 @need 1200
8545 @noindent
8546 But if the text will be appended, it will be concatenated
8547 after the old text:
8548
8549 @smallexample
8550 (concat cur string))
8551 @end smallexample
8552
8553 To understand how this works, we first need to review the
8554 @code{concat} function. The @code{concat} function links together or
8555 unites two strings of text. The result is a string. For example:
8556
8557 @smallexample
8558 @group
8559 (concat "abc" "def")
8560 @result{} "abcdef"
8561 @end group
8562
8563 @group
8564 (concat "new "
8565 (car '("first element" "second element")))
8566 @result{} "new first element"
8567
8568 (concat (car
8569 '("first element" "second element")) " modified")
8570 @result{} "first element modified"
8571 @end group
8572 @end smallexample
8573
8574 We can now make sense of @code{kill-append}: it modifies the contents
8575 of the kill ring. The kill ring is a list, each element of which is
8576 saved text. The @code{kill-append} function uses the @code{kill-new}
8577 function which in turn uses the @code{setcar} function.
8578
8579 @node kill-new function
8580 @unnumberedsubsubsec The @code{kill-new} function
8581 @findex kill-new
8582
8583 @c in GNU Emacs 22, additional documentation to kill-new:
8584 @ignore
8585 Optional third arguments YANK-HANDLER controls how the STRING is later
8586 inserted into a buffer; see `insert-for-yank' for details.
8587 When a yank handler is specified, STRING must be non-empty (the yank
8588 handler, if non-nil, is stored as a `yank-handler' text property on STRING).
8589
8590 When the yank handler has a non-nil PARAM element, the original STRING
8591 argument is not used by `insert-for-yank'. However, since Lisp code
8592 may access and use elements from the kill ring directly, the STRING
8593 argument should still be a \"useful\" string for such uses."
8594 @end ignore
8595 @need 1200
8596 The @code{kill-new} function looks like this:
8597
8598 @smallexample
8599 @group
8600 (defun kill-new (string &optional replace yank-handler)
8601 "Make STRING the latest kill in the kill ring.
8602 Set `kill-ring-yank-pointer' to point to it.
8603
8604 If `interprogram-cut-function' is non-nil, apply it to STRING.
8605 Optional second argument REPLACE non-nil means that STRING will replace
8606 the front of the kill ring, rather than being added to the list.
8607 @dots{}"
8608 @end group
8609 @group
8610 (if (> (length string) 0)
8611 (if yank-handler
8612 (put-text-property 0 (length string)
8613 'yank-handler yank-handler string))
8614 (if yank-handler
8615 (signal 'args-out-of-range
8616 (list string "yank-handler specified for empty string"))))
8617 @end group
8618 @group
8619 (if (fboundp 'menu-bar-update-yank-menu)
8620 (menu-bar-update-yank-menu string (and replace (car kill-ring))))
8621 @end group
8622 @group
8623 (if (and replace kill-ring)
8624 (setcar kill-ring string)
8625 (push string kill-ring)
8626 (if (> (length kill-ring) kill-ring-max)
8627 (setcdr (nthcdr (1- kill-ring-max) kill-ring) nil)))
8628 @end group
8629 @group
8630 (setq kill-ring-yank-pointer kill-ring)
8631 (if interprogram-cut-function
8632 (funcall interprogram-cut-function string (not replace))))
8633 @end group
8634 @end smallexample
8635 @ignore
8636 was:
8637 (defun kill-new (string &optional replace)
8638 "Make STRING the latest kill in the kill ring.
8639 Set the kill-ring-yank pointer to point to it.
8640 If `interprogram-cut-function' is non-nil, apply it to STRING.
8641 Optional second argument REPLACE non-nil means that STRING will replace
8642 the front of the kill ring, rather than being added to the list."
8643 (and (fboundp 'menu-bar-update-yank-menu)
8644 (menu-bar-update-yank-menu string (and replace (car kill-ring))))
8645 (if (and replace kill-ring)
8646 (setcar kill-ring string)
8647 (setq kill-ring (cons string kill-ring))
8648 (if (> (length kill-ring) kill-ring-max)
8649 (setcdr (nthcdr (1- kill-ring-max) kill-ring) nil)))
8650 (setq kill-ring-yank-pointer kill-ring)
8651 (if interprogram-cut-function
8652 (funcall interprogram-cut-function string (not replace))))
8653 @end ignore
8654
8655 (Notice that the function is not interactive.)
8656
8657 As usual, we can look at this function in parts.
8658
8659 The function definition has an optional @code{yank-handler} argument,
8660 which when invoked tells the function how to deal with properties
8661 added to the text, such as `bold' or `italics'. We will skip that.
8662
8663 @need 1200
8664 The first line of the documentation makes sense:
8665
8666 @smallexample
8667 Make STRING the latest kill in the kill ring.
8668 @end smallexample
8669
8670 @noindent
8671 Let's skip over the rest of the documentation for the moment.
8672
8673 @noindent
8674 Also, let's skip over the initial @code{if} expression and those lines
8675 of code involving @code{menu-bar-update-yank-menu}. We will explain
8676 them below.
8677
8678 @need 1200
8679 The critical lines are these:
8680
8681 @smallexample
8682 @group
8683 (if (and replace kill-ring)
8684 ;; @r{then}
8685 (setcar kill-ring string)
8686 @end group
8687 @group
8688 ;; @r{else}
8689 (push string kill-ring)
8690 @end group
8691 @group
8692 (setq kill-ring (cons string kill-ring))
8693 (if (> (length kill-ring) kill-ring-max)
8694 ;; @r{avoid overly long kill ring}
8695 (setcdr (nthcdr (1- kill-ring-max) kill-ring) nil)))
8696 @end group
8697 @group
8698 (setq kill-ring-yank-pointer kill-ring)
8699 (if interprogram-cut-function
8700 (funcall interprogram-cut-function string (not replace))))
8701 @end group
8702 @end smallexample
8703
8704 The conditional test is @w{@code{(and replace kill-ring)}}.
8705 This will be true when two conditions are met: the kill ring has
8706 something in it, and the @code{replace} variable is true.
8707
8708 @need 1250
8709 When the @code{kill-append} function sets @code{replace} to be true
8710 and when the kill ring has at least one item in it, the @code{setcar}
8711 expression is executed:
8712
8713 @smallexample
8714 (setcar kill-ring string)
8715 @end smallexample
8716
8717 The @code{setcar} function actually changes the first element of the
8718 @code{kill-ring} list to the value of @code{string}. It replaces the
8719 first element.
8720
8721 @need 1250
8722 On the other hand, if the kill ring is empty, or replace is false, the
8723 else-part of the condition is executed:
8724
8725 @smallexample
8726 (push string kill-ring)
8727 @end smallexample
8728
8729 @noindent
8730 @need 1250
8731 @code{push} puts its first argument onto the second. It is similar to
8732 the older
8733
8734 @smallexample
8735 (setq kill-ring (cons string kill-ring))
8736 @end smallexample
8737
8738 @noindent
8739 @need 1250
8740 or the newer
8741
8742 @smallexample
8743 (add-to-list kill-ring string)
8744 @end smallexample
8745
8746 @noindent
8747 When it is false, the expression first constructs a new version of the
8748 kill ring by prepending @code{string} to the existing kill ring as a
8749 new element (that is what the @code{push} does). Then it executes a
8750 second @code{if} clause. This second @code{if} clause keeps the kill
8751 ring from growing too long.
8752
8753 Let's look at these two expressions in order.
8754
8755 The @code{push} line of the else-part sets the new value of the kill
8756 ring to what results from adding the string being killed to the old
8757 kill ring.
8758
8759 We can see how this works with an example.
8760
8761 @need 800
8762 First,
8763
8764 @smallexample
8765 (setq example-list '("here is a clause" "another clause"))
8766 @end smallexample
8767
8768 @need 1200
8769 @noindent
8770 After evaluating this expression with @kbd{C-x C-e}, you can evaluate
8771 @code{example-list} and see what it returns:
8772
8773 @smallexample
8774 @group
8775 example-list
8776 @result{} ("here is a clause" "another clause")
8777 @end group
8778 @end smallexample
8779
8780 @need 1200
8781 @noindent
8782 Now, we can add a new element on to this list by evaluating the
8783 following expression:
8784 @findex push, @r{example}
8785
8786 @smallexample
8787 (push "a third clause" example-list)
8788 @end smallexample
8789
8790 @need 800
8791 @noindent
8792 When we evaluate @code{example-list}, we find its value is:
8793
8794 @smallexample
8795 @group
8796 example-list
8797 @result{} ("a third clause" "here is a clause" "another clause")
8798 @end group
8799 @end smallexample
8800
8801 @noindent
8802 Thus, the third clause is added to the list by @code{push}.
8803
8804 @need 1200
8805 Now for the second part of the @code{if} clause. This expression
8806 keeps the kill ring from growing too long. It looks like this:
8807
8808 @smallexample
8809 @group
8810 (if (> (length kill-ring) kill-ring-max)
8811 (setcdr (nthcdr (1- kill-ring-max) kill-ring) nil))
8812 @end group
8813 @end smallexample
8814
8815 The code checks whether the length of the kill ring is greater than
8816 the maximum permitted length. This is the value of
8817 @code{kill-ring-max} (which is 60, by default). If the length of the
8818 kill ring is too long, then this code sets the last element of the
8819 kill ring to @code{nil}. It does this by using two functions,
8820 @code{nthcdr} and @code{setcdr}.
8821
8822 We looked at @code{setcdr} earlier (@pxref{setcdr, , @code{setcdr}}).
8823 It sets the @sc{cdr} of a list, just as @code{setcar} sets the
8824 @sc{car} of a list. In this case, however, @code{setcdr} will not be
8825 setting the @sc{cdr} of the whole kill ring; the @code{nthcdr}
8826 function is used to cause it to set the @sc{cdr} of the next to last
8827 element of the kill ring---this means that since the @sc{cdr} of the
8828 next to last element is the last element of the kill ring, it will set
8829 the last element of the kill ring.
8830
8831 @findex nthcdr, @r{example}
8832 The @code{nthcdr} function works by repeatedly taking the @sc{cdr} of a
8833 list---it takes the @sc{cdr} of the @sc{cdr} of the @sc{cdr}
8834 @dots{} It does this @var{N} times and returns the results.
8835 (@xref{nthcdr, , @code{nthcdr}}.)
8836
8837 @findex setcdr, @r{example}
8838 Thus, if we had a four element list that was supposed to be three
8839 elements long, we could set the @sc{cdr} of the next to last element
8840 to @code{nil}, and thereby shorten the list. (If you set the last
8841 element to some other value than @code{nil}, which you could do, then
8842 you would not have shortened the list. @xref{setcdr, ,
8843 @code{setcdr}}.)
8844
8845 You can see shortening by evaluating the following three expressions
8846 in turn. First set the value of @code{trees} to @code{(maple oak pine
8847 birch)}, then set the @sc{cdr} of its second @sc{cdr} to @code{nil}
8848 and then find the value of @code{trees}:
8849
8850 @smallexample
8851 @group
8852 (setq trees '(maple oak pine birch))
8853 @result{} (maple oak pine birch)
8854 @end group
8855
8856 @group
8857 (setcdr (nthcdr 2 trees) nil)
8858 @result{} nil
8859
8860 trees
8861 @result{} (maple oak pine)
8862 @end group
8863 @end smallexample
8864
8865 @noindent
8866 (The value returned by the @code{setcdr} expression is @code{nil} since
8867 that is what the @sc{cdr} is set to.)
8868
8869 To repeat, in @code{kill-new}, the @code{nthcdr} function takes the
8870 @sc{cdr} a number of times that is one less than the maximum permitted
8871 size of the kill ring and @code{setcdr} sets the @sc{cdr} of that
8872 element (which will be the rest of the elements in the kill ring) to
8873 @code{nil}. This prevents the kill ring from growing too long.
8874
8875 @need 800
8876 The next to last expression in the @code{kill-new} function is
8877
8878 @smallexample
8879 (setq kill-ring-yank-pointer kill-ring)
8880 @end smallexample
8881
8882 The @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} is a global variable that is set to be
8883 the @code{kill-ring}.
8884
8885 Even though the @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} is called a
8886 @samp{pointer}, it is a variable just like the kill ring. However, the
8887 name has been chosen to help humans understand how the variable is used.
8888
8889 @need 1200
8890 Now, to return to an early expression in the body of the function:
8891
8892 @smallexample
8893 @group
8894 (if (fboundp 'menu-bar-update-yank-menu)
8895 (menu-bar-update-yank-menu string (and replace (car kill-ring))))
8896 @end group
8897 @end smallexample
8898
8899 @noindent
8900 It starts with an @code{if} expression
8901
8902 In this case, the expression tests first to see whether
8903 @code{menu-bar-update-yank-menu} exists as a function, and if so,
8904 calls it. The @code{fboundp} function returns true if the symbol it
8905 is testing has a function definition that `is not void'. If the
8906 symbol's function definition were void, we would receive an error
8907 message, as we did when we created errors intentionally (@pxref{Making
8908 Errors, , Generate an Error Message}).
8909
8910 @noindent
8911 The then-part contains an expression whose first element is the
8912 function @code{and}.
8913
8914 @findex and
8915 The @code{and} special form evaluates each of its arguments until one
8916 of the arguments returns a value of @code{nil}, in which case the
8917 @code{and} expression returns @code{nil}; however, if none of the
8918 arguments returns a value of @code{nil}, the value resulting from
8919 evaluating the last argument is returned. (Since such a value is not
8920 @code{nil}, it is considered true in Emacs Lisp.) In other words, an
8921 @code{and} expression returns a true value only if all its arguments
8922 are true. (@xref{Second Buffer Related Review}.)
8923
8924 The expression determines whether the second argument to
8925 @code{menu-bar-update-yank-menu} is true or not.
8926 @ignore
8927 ;; If we're supposed to be extending an existing string, and that
8928 ;; string really is at the front of the menu, then update it in place.
8929 @end ignore
8930
8931 @code{menu-bar-update-yank-menu} is one of the functions that make it
8932 possible to use the `Select and Paste' menu in the Edit item of a menu
8933 bar; using a mouse, you can look at the various pieces of text you
8934 have saved and select one piece to paste.
8935
8936 The last expression in the @code{kill-new} function adds the newly
8937 copied string to whatever facility exists for copying and pasting
8938 among different programs running in a windowing system. In the X
8939 Windowing system, for example, the @code{x-select-text} function takes
8940 the string and stores it in memory operated by X@. You can paste the
8941 string in another program, such as an Xterm.
8942
8943 @need 1200
8944 The expression looks like this:
8945
8946 @smallexample
8947 @group
8948 (if interprogram-cut-function
8949 (funcall interprogram-cut-function string (not replace))))
8950 @end group
8951 @end smallexample
8952
8953 If an @code{interprogram-cut-function} exists, then Emacs executes
8954 @code{funcall}, which in turn calls its first argument as a function
8955 and passes the remaining arguments to it. (Incidentally, as far as I
8956 can see, this @code{if} expression could be replaced by an @code{and}
8957 expression similar to the one in the first part of the function.)
8958
8959 We are not going to discuss windowing systems and other programs
8960 further, but merely note that this is a mechanism that enables GNU
8961 Emacs to work easily and well with other programs.
8962
8963 This code for placing text in the kill ring, either concatenated with
8964 an existing element or as a new element, leads us to the code for
8965 bringing back text that has been cut out of the buffer---the yank
8966 commands. However, before discussing the yank commands, it is better
8967 to learn how lists are implemented in a computer. This will make
8968 clear such mysteries as the use of the term `pointer'. But before
8969 that, we will digress into C.
8970
8971 @ignore
8972 @c is this true in Emacs 22? Does not seems to be
8973
8974 (If the @w{@code{(< end beg))}}
8975 expression is true, @code{kill-append} prepends the string to the just
8976 previously clipped text. For a detailed discussion, see
8977 @ref{kill-append function, , The @code{kill-append} function}.)
8978
8979 If you then yank back the text, i.e., `paste' it, you get both
8980 pieces of text at once. That way, if you delete two words in a row,
8981 and then yank them back, you get both words, in their proper order,
8982 with one yank. (The @w{@code{(< end beg))}} expression makes sure the
8983 order is correct.)
8984
8985 On the other hand, if the previous command is not @code{kill-region},
8986 then the @code{kill-new} function is called, which adds the text to
8987 the kill ring as the latest item, and sets the
8988 @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} variable to point to it.
8989 @end ignore
8990 @ignore
8991
8992 @c Evidently, changed for Emacs 22. The zap-to-char command does not
8993 @c use the delete-and-extract-region function
8994
8995 2006 Oct 26, the Digression into C is now OK but should come after
8996 copy-region-as-kill and filter-buffer-substring
8997
8998 2006 Oct 24
8999 In Emacs 22,
9000 copy-region-as-kill is short, 12 lines, and uses
9001 filter-buffer-substring, which is longer, 39 lines
9002 and has delete-and-extract-region in it.
9003 delete-and-extract-region is written in C.
9004
9005 see Initializing a Variable with @code{defvar}
9006 @end ignore
9007
9008 @node Digression into C
9009 @section Digression into C
9010 @findex delete-and-extract-region
9011 @cindex C, a digression into
9012 @cindex Digression into C
9013
9014 The @code{copy-region-as-kill} function (@pxref{copy-region-as-kill, ,
9015 @code{copy-region-as-kill}}) uses the @code{filter-buffer-substring}
9016 function, which in turn uses the @code{delete-and-extract-region}
9017 function. It removes the contents of a region and you cannot get them
9018 back.
9019
9020 Unlike the other code discussed here, the
9021 @code{delete-and-extract-region} function is not written in Emacs
9022 Lisp; it is written in C and is one of the primitives of the GNU Emacs
9023 system. Since it is very simple, I will digress briefly from Lisp and
9024 describe it here.
9025
9026 @c GNU Emacs 24 in src/editfns.c
9027 @c the DEFUN for delete-and-extract-region
9028
9029 @need 1500
9030 Like many of the other Emacs primitives,
9031 @code{delete-and-extract-region} is written as an instance of a C
9032 macro, a macro being a template for code. The complete macro looks
9033 like this:
9034
9035 @smallexample
9036 @group
9037 DEFUN ("delete-and-extract-region", Fdelete_and_extract_region,
9038 Sdelete_and_extract_region, 2, 2, 0,
9039 doc: /* Delete the text between START and END and return it. */)
9040 (Lisp_Object start, Lisp_Object end)
9041 @{
9042 validate_region (&start, &end);
9043 if (XINT (start) == XINT (end))
9044 return empty_unibyte_string;
9045 return del_range_1 (XINT (start), XINT (end), 1, 1);
9046 @}
9047 @end group
9048 @end smallexample
9049
9050 Without going into the details of the macro writing process, let me
9051 point out that this macro starts with the word @code{DEFUN}. The word
9052 @code{DEFUN} was chosen since the code serves the same purpose as
9053 @code{defun} does in Lisp. (The @code{DEFUN} C macro is defined in
9054 @file{emacs/src/lisp.h}.)
9055
9056 The word @code{DEFUN} is followed by seven parts inside of
9057 parentheses:
9058
9059 @itemize @bullet
9060 @item
9061 The first part is the name given to the function in Lisp,
9062 @code{delete-and-extract-region}.
9063
9064 @item
9065 The second part is the name of the function in C,
9066 @code{Fdelete_and_extract_region}. By convention, it starts with
9067 @samp{F}. Since C does not use hyphens in names, underscores are used
9068 instead.
9069
9070 @item
9071 The third part is the name for the C constant structure that records
9072 information on this function for internal use. It is the name of the
9073 function in C but begins with an @samp{S} instead of an @samp{F}.
9074
9075 @item
9076 The fourth and fifth parts specify the minimum and maximum number of
9077 arguments the function can have. This function demands exactly 2
9078 arguments.
9079
9080 @item
9081 The sixth part is nearly like the argument that follows the
9082 @code{interactive} declaration in a function written in Lisp: a letter
9083 followed, perhaps, by a prompt. The only difference from the Lisp is
9084 when the macro is called with no arguments. Then you write a @code{0}
9085 (which is a `null string'), as in this macro.
9086
9087 If you were to specify arguments, you would place them between
9088 quotation marks. The C macro for @code{goto-char} includes
9089 @code{"NGoto char: "} in this position to indicate that the function
9090 expects a raw prefix, in this case, a numerical location in a buffer,
9091 and provides a prompt.
9092
9093 @item
9094 The seventh part is a documentation string, just like the one for a
9095 function written in Emacs Lisp. This is written as a C comment. (When
9096 you build Emacs, the program @command{lib-src/make-docfile} extracts
9097 these comments and uses them to make the ``real'' documentation.)
9098 @end itemize
9099
9100 @need 1200
9101 In a C macro, the formal parameters come next, with a statement of
9102 what kind of object they are, followed by what might be called the `body'
9103 of the macro. For @code{delete-and-extract-region} the `body'
9104 consists of the following four lines:
9105
9106 @smallexample
9107 @group
9108 validate_region (&start, &end);
9109 if (XINT (start) == XINT (end))
9110 return empty_unibyte_string;
9111 return del_range_1 (XINT (start), XINT (end), 1, 1);
9112 @end group
9113 @end smallexample
9114
9115 The @code{validate_region} function checks whether the values
9116 passed as the beginning and end of the region are the proper type and
9117 are within range. If the beginning and end positions are the same,
9118 then return an empty string.
9119
9120 The @code{del_range_1} function actually deletes the text. It is a
9121 complex function we will not look into. It updates the buffer and
9122 does other things. However, it is worth looking at the two arguments
9123 passed to @code{del_range}. These are @w{@code{XINT (start)}} and
9124 @w{@code{XINT (end)}}.
9125
9126 As far as the C language is concerned, @code{start} and @code{end} are
9127 two integers that mark the beginning and end of the region to be
9128 deleted@footnote{More precisely, and requiring more expert knowledge
9129 to understand, the two integers are of type `Lisp_Object', which can
9130 also be a C union instead of an integer type.}.
9131
9132 In early versions of Emacs, these two numbers were thirty-two bits
9133 long, but the code is slowly being generalized to handle other
9134 lengths. Three of the available bits are used to specify the type of
9135 information; the remaining bits are used as `content'.
9136
9137 @samp{XINT} is a C macro that extracts the relevant number from the
9138 longer collection of bits; the three other bits are discarded.
9139
9140 @need 800
9141 The command in @code{delete-and-extract-region} looks like this:
9142
9143 @smallexample
9144 del_range_1 (XINT (start), XINT (end), 1, 1);
9145 @end smallexample
9146
9147 @noindent
9148 It deletes the region between the beginning position, @code{start},
9149 and the ending position, @code{end}.
9150
9151 From the point of view of the person writing Lisp, Emacs is all very
9152 simple; but hidden underneath is a great deal of complexity to make it
9153 all work.
9154
9155 @node defvar
9156 @section Initializing a Variable with @code{defvar}
9157 @findex defvar
9158 @cindex Initializing a variable
9159 @cindex Variable initialization
9160
9161 @ignore
9162 2006 Oct 24
9163 In Emacs 22,
9164 copy-region-as-kill is short, 12 lines, and uses
9165 filter-buffer-substring, which is longer, 39 lines
9166 and has delete-and-extract-region in it.
9167 delete-and-extract-region is written in C.
9168
9169 see Initializing a Variable with @code{defvar}
9170
9171 @end ignore
9172
9173 The @code{copy-region-as-kill} function is written in Emacs Lisp. Two
9174 functions within it, @code{kill-append} and @code{kill-new}, copy a
9175 region in a buffer and save it in a variable called the
9176 @code{kill-ring}. This section describes how the @code{kill-ring}
9177 variable is created and initialized using the @code{defvar} special
9178 form.
9179
9180 (Again we note that the term @code{kill-ring} is a misnomer. The text
9181 that is clipped out of the buffer can be brought back; it is not a ring
9182 of corpses, but a ring of resurrectable text.)
9183
9184 In Emacs Lisp, a variable such as the @code{kill-ring} is created and
9185 given an initial value by using the @code{defvar} special form. The
9186 name comes from ``define variable''.
9187
9188 The @code{defvar} special form is similar to @code{setq} in that it sets
9189 the value of a variable. It is unlike @code{setq} in two ways: first,
9190 it only sets the value of the variable if the variable does not already
9191 have a value. If the variable already has a value, @code{defvar} does
9192 not override the existing value. Second, @code{defvar} has a
9193 documentation string.
9194
9195 (There is a related macro, @code{defcustom}, designed for variables
9196 that people customize. It has more features than @code{defvar}.
9197 (@xref{defcustom, , Setting Variables with @code{defcustom}}.)
9198
9199 @menu
9200 * See variable current value::
9201 * defvar and asterisk::
9202 @end menu
9203
9204 @ifnottex
9205 @node See variable current value
9206 @unnumberedsubsec Seeing the Current Value of a Variable
9207 @end ifnottex
9208
9209 You can see the current value of a variable, any variable, by using
9210 the @code{describe-variable} function, which is usually invoked by
9211 typing @kbd{C-h v}. If you type @kbd{C-h v} and then @code{kill-ring}
9212 (followed by @key{RET}) when prompted, you will see what is in your
9213 current kill ring---this may be quite a lot! Conversely, if you have
9214 been doing nothing this Emacs session except read this document, you
9215 may have nothing in it. Also, you will see the documentation for
9216 @code{kill-ring}:
9217
9218 @smallexample
9219 @group
9220 Documentation:
9221 List of killed text sequences.
9222 Since the kill ring is supposed to interact nicely with cut-and-paste
9223 facilities offered by window systems, use of this variable should
9224 @end group
9225 @group
9226 interact nicely with `interprogram-cut-function' and
9227 `interprogram-paste-function'. The functions `kill-new',
9228 `kill-append', and `current-kill' are supposed to implement this
9229 interaction; you may want to use them instead of manipulating the kill
9230 ring directly.
9231 @end group
9232 @end smallexample
9233
9234 @need 800
9235 The kill ring is defined by a @code{defvar} in the following way:
9236
9237 @smallexample
9238 @group
9239 (defvar kill-ring nil
9240 "List of killed text sequences.
9241 @dots{}")
9242 @end group
9243 @end smallexample
9244
9245 @noindent
9246 In this variable definition, the variable is given an initial value of
9247 @code{nil}, which makes sense, since if you have saved nothing, you want
9248 nothing back if you give a @code{yank} command. The documentation
9249 string is written just like the documentation string of a @code{defun}.
9250 As with the documentation string of the @code{defun}, the first line of
9251 the documentation should be a complete sentence, since some commands,
9252 like @code{apropos}, print only the first line of documentation.
9253 Succeeding lines should not be indented; otherwise they look odd when
9254 you use @kbd{C-h v} (@code{describe-variable}).
9255
9256 @node defvar and asterisk
9257 @subsection @code{defvar} and an asterisk
9258 @findex defvar @r{for a user customizable variable}
9259 @findex defvar @r{with an asterisk}
9260
9261 In the past, Emacs used the @code{defvar} special form both for
9262 internal variables that you would not expect a user to change and for
9263 variables that you do expect a user to change. Although you can still
9264 use @code{defvar} for user customizable variables, please use
9265 @code{defcustom} instead, since it provides a path into
9266 the Customization commands. (@xref{defcustom, , Specifying Variables
9267 using @code{defcustom}}.)
9268
9269 When you specified a variable using the @code{defvar} special form,
9270 you could distinguish a variable that a user might want to change from
9271 others by typing an asterisk, @samp{*}, in the first column of its
9272 documentation string. For example:
9273
9274 @smallexample
9275 @group
9276 (defvar shell-command-default-error-buffer nil
9277 "*Buffer name for `shell-command' @dots{} error output.
9278 @dots{} ")
9279 @end group
9280 @end smallexample
9281
9282 @findex set-variable
9283 @noindent
9284 You could (and still can) use the @code{set-variable} command to
9285 change the value of @code{shell-command-default-error-buffer}
9286 temporarily. However, options set using @code{set-variable} are set
9287 only for the duration of your editing session. The new values are not
9288 saved between sessions. Each time Emacs starts, it reads the original
9289 value, unless you change the value within your @file{.emacs} file,
9290 either by setting it manually or by using @code{customize}.
9291 @xref{Emacs Initialization, , Your @file{.emacs} File}.
9292
9293 For me, the major use of the @code{set-variable} command is to suggest
9294 variables that I might want to set in my @file{.emacs} file. There
9295 are now more than 700 such variables, far too many to remember
9296 readily. Fortunately, you can press @key{TAB} after calling the
9297 @code{M-x set-variable} command to see the list of variables.
9298 (@xref{Examining, , Examining and Setting Variables, emacs,
9299 The GNU Emacs Manual}.)
9300
9301 @need 1250
9302 @node cons & search-fwd Review
9303 @section Review
9304
9305 Here is a brief summary of some recently introduced functions.
9306
9307 @table @code
9308 @item car
9309 @itemx cdr
9310 @code{car} returns the first element of a list; @code{cdr} returns the
9311 second and subsequent elements of a list.
9312
9313 @need 1250
9314 For example:
9315
9316 @smallexample
9317 @group
9318 (car '(1 2 3 4 5 6 7))
9319 @result{} 1
9320 (cdr '(1 2 3 4 5 6 7))
9321 @result{} (2 3 4 5 6 7)
9322 @end group
9323 @end smallexample
9324
9325 @item cons
9326 @code{cons} constructs a list by prepending its first argument to its
9327 second argument.
9328
9329 @need 1250
9330 For example:
9331
9332 @smallexample
9333 @group
9334 (cons 1 '(2 3 4))
9335 @result{} (1 2 3 4)
9336 @end group
9337 @end smallexample
9338
9339 @item funcall
9340 @code{funcall} evaluates its first argument as a function. It passes
9341 its remaining arguments to its first argument.
9342
9343 @item nthcdr
9344 Return the result of taking @sc{cdr} `n' times on a list.
9345 @iftex
9346 The
9347 @tex
9348 $n^{th}$
9349 @end tex
9350 @code{cdr}.
9351 @end iftex
9352 The `rest of the rest', as it were.
9353
9354 @need 1250
9355 For example:
9356
9357 @smallexample
9358 @group
9359 (nthcdr 3 '(1 2 3 4 5 6 7))
9360 @result{} (4 5 6 7)
9361 @end group
9362 @end smallexample
9363
9364 @item setcar
9365 @itemx setcdr
9366 @code{setcar} changes the first element of a list; @code{setcdr}
9367 changes the second and subsequent elements of a list.
9368
9369 @need 1250
9370 For example:
9371
9372 @smallexample
9373 @group
9374 (setq triple '(1 2 3))
9375
9376 (setcar triple '37)
9377
9378 triple
9379 @result{} (37 2 3)
9380
9381 (setcdr triple '("foo" "bar"))
9382
9383 triple
9384 @result{} (37 "foo" "bar")
9385 @end group
9386 @end smallexample
9387
9388 @item progn
9389 Evaluate each argument in sequence and then return the value of the
9390 last.
9391
9392 @need 1250
9393 For example:
9394
9395 @smallexample
9396 @group
9397 (progn 1 2 3 4)
9398 @result{} 4
9399 @end group
9400 @end smallexample
9401
9402 @item save-restriction
9403 Record whatever narrowing is in effect in the current buffer, if any,
9404 and restore that narrowing after evaluating the arguments.
9405
9406 @item search-forward
9407 Search for a string, and if the string is found, move point. With a
9408 regular expression, use the similar @code{re-search-forward}.
9409 (@xref{Regexp Search, , Regular Expression Searches}, for an
9410 explanation of regular expression patterns and searches.)
9411
9412 @need 1250
9413 @noindent
9414 @code{search-forward} and @code{re-search-forward} take four
9415 arguments:
9416
9417 @enumerate
9418 @item
9419 The string or regular expression to search for.
9420
9421 @item
9422 Optionally, the limit of the search.
9423
9424 @item
9425 Optionally, what to do if the search fails, return @code{nil} or an
9426 error message.
9427
9428 @item
9429 Optionally, how many times to repeat the search; if negative, the
9430 search goes backwards.
9431 @end enumerate
9432
9433 @item kill-region
9434 @itemx delete-and-extract-region
9435 @itemx copy-region-as-kill
9436
9437 @code{kill-region} cuts the text between point and mark from the
9438 buffer and stores that text in the kill ring, so you can get it back
9439 by yanking.
9440
9441 @code{copy-region-as-kill} copies the text between point and mark into
9442 the kill ring, from which you can get it by yanking. The function
9443 does not cut or remove the text from the buffer.
9444 @end table
9445
9446 @code{delete-and-extract-region} removes the text between point and
9447 mark from the buffer and throws it away. You cannot get it back.
9448 (This is not an interactive command.)
9449
9450 @need 1500
9451 @node search Exercises
9452 @section Searching Exercises
9453
9454 @itemize @bullet
9455 @item
9456 Write an interactive function that searches for a string. If the
9457 search finds the string, leave point after it and display a message
9458 that says ``Found!''. (Do not use @code{search-forward} for the name
9459 of this function; if you do, you will overwrite the existing version of
9460 @code{search-forward} that comes with Emacs. Use a name such as
9461 @code{test-search} instead.)
9462
9463 @item
9464 Write a function that prints the third element of the kill ring in the
9465 echo area, if any; if the kill ring does not contain a third element,
9466 print an appropriate message.
9467 @end itemize
9468
9469 @node List Implementation
9470 @chapter How Lists are Implemented
9471 @cindex Lists in a computer
9472
9473 In Lisp, atoms are recorded in a straightforward fashion; if the
9474 implementation is not straightforward in practice, it is, nonetheless,
9475 straightforward in theory. The atom @samp{rose}, for example, is
9476 recorded as the four contiguous letters @samp{r}, @samp{o}, @samp{s},
9477 @samp{e}. A list, on the other hand, is kept differently. The mechanism
9478 is equally simple, but it takes a moment to get used to the idea. A
9479 list is kept using a series of pairs of pointers. In the series, the
9480 first pointer in each pair points to an atom or to another list, and the
9481 second pointer in each pair points to the next pair, or to the symbol
9482 @code{nil}, which marks the end of the list.
9483
9484 A pointer itself is quite simply the electronic address of what is
9485 pointed to. Hence, a list is kept as a series of electronic addresses.
9486
9487 @menu
9488 * Lists diagrammed::
9489 * Symbols as Chest:: Exploring a powerful metaphor.
9490 * List Exercise::
9491 @end menu
9492
9493 @ifnottex
9494 @node Lists diagrammed
9495 @unnumberedsec Lists diagrammed
9496 @end ifnottex
9497
9498 For example, the list @code{(rose violet buttercup)} has three elements,
9499 @samp{rose}, @samp{violet}, and @samp{buttercup}. In the computer, the
9500 electronic address of @samp{rose} is recorded in a segment of computer
9501 memory along with the address that gives the electronic address of where
9502 the atom @samp{violet} is located; and that address (the one that tells
9503 where @samp{violet} is located) is kept along with an address that tells
9504 where the address for the atom @samp{buttercup} is located.
9505
9506 @need 1200
9507 This sounds more complicated than it is and is easier seen in a diagram:
9508
9509 @c clear print-postscript-figures
9510 @c !!! cons-cell-diagram #1
9511 @ifnottex
9512 @smallexample
9513 @group
9514 ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___
9515 |___|___|--> |___|___|--> |___|___|--> nil
9516 | | |
9517 | | |
9518 --> rose --> violet --> buttercup
9519 @end group
9520 @end smallexample
9521 @end ifnottex
9522 @ifset print-postscript-figures
9523 @sp 1
9524 @tex
9525 @center @image{cons-1}
9526 %%%% old method of including an image
9527 % \input /usr/local/lib/tex/inputs/psfig.tex
9528 % \centerline{\psfig{figure=/usr/local/lib/emacs/man/cons-1.eps}}
9529 % \catcode`\@=0 %
9530 @end tex
9531 @sp 1
9532 @end ifset
9533 @ifclear print-postscript-figures
9534 @iftex
9535 @smallexample
9536 @group
9537 ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___
9538 |___|___|--> |___|___|--> |___|___|--> nil
9539 | | |
9540 | | |
9541 --> rose --> violet --> buttercup
9542 @end group
9543 @end smallexample
9544 @end iftex
9545 @end ifclear
9546
9547 @noindent
9548 In the diagram, each box represents a word of computer memory that
9549 holds a Lisp object, usually in the form of a memory address. The boxes,
9550 i.e., the addresses, are in pairs. Each arrow points to what the address
9551 is the address of, either an atom or another pair of addresses. The
9552 first box is the electronic address of @samp{rose} and the arrow points
9553 to @samp{rose}; the second box is the address of the next pair of boxes,
9554 the first part of which is the address of @samp{violet} and the second
9555 part of which is the address of the next pair. The very last box
9556 points to the symbol @code{nil}, which marks the end of the list.
9557
9558 @need 1200
9559 When a variable is set to a list with a function such as @code{setq},
9560 it stores the address of the first box in the variable. Thus,
9561 evaluation of the expression
9562
9563 @smallexample
9564 (setq bouquet '(rose violet buttercup))
9565 @end smallexample
9566
9567 @need 1250
9568 @noindent
9569 creates a situation like this:
9570
9571 @c cons-cell-diagram #2
9572 @ifnottex
9573 @smallexample
9574 @group
9575 bouquet
9576 |
9577 | ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___
9578 --> |___|___|--> |___|___|--> |___|___|--> nil
9579 | | |
9580 | | |
9581 --> rose --> violet --> buttercup
9582 @end group
9583 @end smallexample
9584 @end ifnottex
9585 @ifset print-postscript-figures
9586 @sp 1
9587 @tex
9588 @center @image{cons-2}
9589 %%%% old method of including an image
9590 % \input /usr/local/lib/tex/inputs/psfig.tex
9591 % \centerline{\psfig{figure=/usr/local/lib/emacs/man/cons-2.eps}}
9592 % \catcode`\@=0 %
9593 @end tex
9594 @sp 1
9595 @end ifset
9596 @ifclear print-postscript-figures
9597 @iftex
9598 @smallexample
9599 @group
9600 bouquet
9601 |
9602 | ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___
9603 --> |___|___|--> |___|___|--> |___|___|--> nil
9604 | | |
9605 | | |
9606 --> rose --> violet --> buttercup
9607 @end group
9608 @end smallexample
9609 @end iftex
9610 @end ifclear
9611
9612 @noindent
9613 In this example, the symbol @code{bouquet} holds the address of the first
9614 pair of boxes.
9615
9616 @need 1200
9617 This same list can be illustrated in a different sort of box notation
9618 like this:
9619
9620 @c cons-cell-diagram #2a
9621 @ifnottex
9622 @smallexample
9623 @group
9624 bouquet
9625 |
9626 | -------------- --------------- ----------------
9627 | | car | cdr | | car | cdr | | car | cdr |
9628 -->| rose | o------->| violet | o------->| butter- | nil |
9629 | | | | | | | cup | |
9630 -------------- --------------- ----------------
9631 @end group
9632 @end smallexample
9633 @end ifnottex
9634 @ifset print-postscript-figures
9635 @sp 1
9636 @tex
9637 @center @image{cons-2a}
9638 %%%% old method of including an image
9639 % \input /usr/local/lib/tex/inputs/psfig.tex
9640 % \centerline{\psfig{figure=/usr/local/lib/emacs/man/cons-2a.eps}}
9641 % \catcode`\@=0 %
9642 @end tex
9643 @sp 1
9644 @end ifset
9645 @ifclear print-postscript-figures
9646 @iftex
9647 @smallexample
9648 @group
9649 bouquet
9650 |
9651 | -------------- --------------- ----------------
9652 | | car | cdr | | car | cdr | | car | cdr |
9653 -->| rose | o------->| violet | o------->| butter- | nil |
9654 | | | | | | | cup | |
9655 -------------- --------------- ----------------
9656 @end group
9657 @end smallexample
9658 @end iftex
9659 @end ifclear
9660
9661 (Symbols consist of more than pairs of addresses, but the structure of
9662 a symbol is made up of addresses. Indeed, the symbol @code{bouquet}
9663 consists of a group of address-boxes, one of which is the address of
9664 the printed word @samp{bouquet}, a second of which is the address of a
9665 function definition attached to the symbol, if any, a third of which
9666 is the address of the first pair of address-boxes for the list
9667 @code{(rose violet buttercup)}, and so on. Here we are showing that
9668 the symbol's third address-box points to the first pair of
9669 address-boxes for the list.)
9670
9671 If a symbol is set to the @sc{cdr} of a list, the list itself is not
9672 changed; the symbol simply has an address further down the list. (In
9673 the jargon, @sc{car} and @sc{cdr} are `non-destructive'.) Thus,
9674 evaluation of the following expression
9675
9676 @smallexample
9677 (setq flowers (cdr bouquet))
9678 @end smallexample
9679
9680 @need 800
9681 @noindent
9682 produces this:
9683
9684 @c cons-cell-diagram #3
9685 @ifnottex
9686 @sp 1
9687 @smallexample
9688 @group
9689 bouquet flowers
9690 | |
9691 | ___ ___ | ___ ___ ___ ___
9692 --> | | | --> | | | | | |
9693 |___|___|----> |___|___|--> |___|___|--> nil
9694 | | |
9695 | | |
9696 --> rose --> violet --> buttercup
9697 @end group
9698 @end smallexample
9699 @sp 1
9700 @end ifnottex
9701 @ifset print-postscript-figures
9702 @sp 1
9703 @tex
9704 @center @image{cons-3}
9705 %%%% old method of including an image
9706 % \input /usr/local/lib/tex/inputs/psfig.tex
9707 % \centerline{\psfig{figure=/usr/local/lib/emacs/man/cons-3.eps}}
9708 % \catcode`\@=0 %
9709 @end tex
9710 @sp 1
9711 @end ifset
9712 @ifclear print-postscript-figures
9713 @iftex
9714 @sp 1
9715 @smallexample
9716 @group
9717 bouquet flowers
9718 | |
9719 | ___ ___ | ___ ___ ___ ___
9720 --> | | | --> | | | | | |
9721 |___|___|----> |___|___|--> |___|___|--> nil
9722 | | |
9723 | | |
9724 --> rose --> violet --> buttercup
9725 @end group
9726 @end smallexample
9727 @sp 1
9728 @end iftex
9729 @end ifclear
9730
9731 @noindent
9732 The value of @code{flowers} is @code{(violet buttercup)}, which is
9733 to say, the symbol @code{flowers} holds the address of the pair of
9734 address-boxes, the first of which holds the address of @code{violet},
9735 and the second of which holds the address of @code{buttercup}.
9736
9737 A pair of address-boxes is called a @dfn{cons cell} or @dfn{dotted
9738 pair}. @xref{Cons Cell Type, , Cons Cell and List Types, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
9739 Reference Manual}, and @ref{Dotted Pair Notation, , Dotted Pair
9740 Notation, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}, for more
9741 information about cons cells and dotted pairs.
9742
9743 @need 1200
9744 The function @code{cons} adds a new pair of addresses to the front of
9745 a series of addresses like that shown above. For example, evaluating
9746 the expression
9747
9748 @smallexample
9749 (setq bouquet (cons 'lily bouquet))
9750 @end smallexample
9751
9752 @need 1500
9753 @noindent
9754 produces:
9755
9756 @c cons-cell-diagram #4
9757 @ifnottex
9758 @sp 1
9759 @smallexample
9760 @group
9761 bouquet flowers
9762 | |
9763 | ___ ___ ___ ___ | ___ ___ ___ ___
9764 --> | | | | | | --> | | | | | |
9765 |___|___|----> |___|___|----> |___|___|---->|___|___|--> nil
9766 | | | |
9767 | | | |
9768 --> lily --> rose --> violet --> buttercup
9769 @end group
9770 @end smallexample
9771 @sp 1
9772 @end ifnottex
9773 @ifset print-postscript-figures
9774 @sp 1
9775 @tex
9776 @center @image{cons-4}
9777 %%%% old method of including an image
9778 % \input /usr/local/lib/tex/inputs/psfig.tex
9779 % \centerline{\psfig{figure=/usr/local/lib/emacs/man/cons-4.eps}}
9780 % \catcode`\@=0 %
9781 @end tex
9782 @sp 1
9783 @end ifset
9784 @ifclear print-postscript-figures
9785 @iftex
9786 @sp 1
9787 @smallexample
9788 @group
9789 bouquet flowers
9790 | |
9791 | ___ ___ ___ ___ | ___ ___ ___ ___
9792 --> | | | | | | --> | | | | | |
9793 |___|___|----> |___|___|----> |___|___|---->|___|___|--> nil
9794 | | | |
9795 | | | |
9796 --> lily --> rose --> violet --> buttercup
9797 @end group
9798 @end smallexample
9799 @sp 1
9800 @end iftex
9801 @end ifclear
9802
9803 @need 1200
9804 @noindent
9805 However, this does not change the value of the symbol
9806 @code{flowers}, as you can see by evaluating the following,
9807
9808 @smallexample
9809 (eq (cdr (cdr bouquet)) flowers)
9810 @end smallexample
9811
9812 @noindent
9813 which returns @code{t} for true.
9814
9815 Until it is reset, @code{flowers} still has the value
9816 @code{(violet buttercup)}; that is, it has the address of the cons
9817 cell whose first address is of @code{violet}. Also, this does not
9818 alter any of the pre-existing cons cells; they are all still there.
9819
9820 Thus, in Lisp, to get the @sc{cdr} of a list, you just get the address
9821 of the next cons cell in the series; to get the @sc{car} of a list,
9822 you get the address of the first element of the list; to @code{cons} a
9823 new element on a list, you add a new cons cell to the front of the list.
9824 That is all there is to it! The underlying structure of Lisp is
9825 brilliantly simple!
9826
9827 And what does the last address in a series of cons cells refer to? It
9828 is the address of the empty list, of @code{nil}.
9829
9830 In summary, when a Lisp variable is set to a value, it is provided with
9831 the address of the list to which the variable refers.
9832
9833 @node Symbols as Chest
9834 @section Symbols as a Chest of Drawers
9835 @cindex Symbols as a Chest of Drawers
9836 @cindex Chest of Drawers, metaphor for a symbol
9837 @cindex Drawers, Chest of, metaphor for a symbol
9838
9839 In an earlier section, I suggested that you might imagine a symbol as
9840 being a chest of drawers. The function definition is put in one
9841 drawer, the value in another, and so on. What is put in the drawer
9842 holding the value can be changed without affecting the contents of the
9843 drawer holding the function definition, and vice-verse.
9844
9845 Actually, what is put in each drawer is the address of the value or
9846 function definition. It is as if you found an old chest in the attic,
9847 and in one of its drawers you found a map giving you directions to
9848 where the buried treasure lies.
9849
9850 (In addition to its name, symbol definition, and variable value, a
9851 symbol has a `drawer' for a @dfn{property list} which can be used to
9852 record other information. Property lists are not discussed here; see
9853 @ref{Property Lists, , Property Lists, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
9854 Reference Manual}.)
9855
9856 @need 1500
9857 Here is a fanciful representation:
9858
9859 @c chest-of-drawers diagram
9860 @ifnottex
9861 @sp 1
9862 @smallexample
9863 @group
9864 Chest of Drawers Contents of Drawers
9865
9866 __ o0O0o __
9867 / \
9868 ---------------------
9869 | directions to | [map to]
9870 | symbol name | bouquet
9871 | |
9872 +---------------------+
9873 | directions to |
9874 | symbol definition | [none]
9875 | |
9876 +---------------------+
9877 | directions to | [map to]
9878 | variable value | (rose violet buttercup)
9879 | |
9880 +---------------------+
9881 | directions to |
9882 | property list | [not described here]
9883 | |
9884 +---------------------+
9885 |/ \|
9886 @end group
9887 @end smallexample
9888 @sp 1
9889 @end ifnottex
9890 @ifset print-postscript-figures
9891 @sp 1
9892 @tex
9893 @center @image{drawers}
9894 %%%% old method of including an image
9895 % \input /usr/local/lib/tex/inputs/psfig.tex
9896 % \centerline{\psfig{figure=/usr/local/lib/emacs/man/drawers.eps}}
9897 % \catcode`\@=0 %
9898 @end tex
9899 @sp 1
9900 @end ifset
9901 @ifclear print-postscript-figures
9902 @iftex
9903 @sp 1
9904 @smallexample
9905 @group
9906 Chest of Drawers Contents of Drawers
9907
9908 __ o0O0o __
9909 / \
9910 ---------------------
9911 | directions to | [map to]
9912 | symbol name | bouquet
9913 | |
9914 +---------------------+
9915 | directions to |
9916 | symbol definition | [none]
9917 | |
9918 +---------------------+
9919 | directions to | [map to]
9920 | variable value | (rose violet buttercup)
9921 | |
9922 +---------------------+
9923 | directions to |
9924 | property list | [not described here]
9925 | |
9926 +---------------------+
9927 |/ \|
9928 @end group
9929 @end smallexample
9930 @sp 1
9931 @end iftex
9932 @end ifclear
9933
9934 @node List Exercise
9935 @section Exercise
9936
9937 Set @code{flowers} to @code{violet} and @code{buttercup}. Cons two
9938 more flowers on to this list and set this new list to
9939 @code{more-flowers}. Set the @sc{car} of @code{flowers} to a fish.
9940 What does the @code{more-flowers} list now contain?
9941
9942 @node Yanking
9943 @chapter Yanking Text Back
9944 @findex yank
9945 @cindex Text retrieval
9946 @cindex Retrieving text
9947 @cindex Pasting text
9948
9949 Whenever you cut text out of a buffer with a `kill' command in GNU Emacs,
9950 you can bring it back with a `yank' command. The text that is cut out of
9951 the buffer is put in the kill ring and the yank commands insert the
9952 appropriate contents of the kill ring back into a buffer (not necessarily
9953 the original buffer).
9954
9955 A simple @kbd{C-y} (@code{yank}) command inserts the first item from
9956 the kill ring into the current buffer. If the @kbd{C-y} command is
9957 followed immediately by @kbd{M-y}, the first element is replaced by
9958 the second element. Successive @kbd{M-y} commands replace the second
9959 element with the third, fourth, or fifth element, and so on. When the
9960 last element in the kill ring is reached, it is replaced by the first
9961 element and the cycle is repeated. (Thus the kill ring is called a
9962 `ring' rather than just a `list'. However, the actual data structure
9963 that holds the text is a list.
9964 @xref{Kill Ring, , Handling the Kill Ring}, for the details of how the
9965 list is handled as a ring.)
9966
9967 @menu
9968 * Kill Ring Overview::
9969 * kill-ring-yank-pointer:: The kill ring is a list.
9970 * yank nthcdr Exercises:: The @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} variable.
9971 @end menu
9972
9973 @node Kill Ring Overview
9974 @section Kill Ring Overview
9975 @cindex Kill ring overview
9976
9977 The kill ring is a list of textual strings. This is what it looks like:
9978
9979 @smallexample
9980 ("some text" "a different piece of text" "yet more text")
9981 @end smallexample
9982
9983 If this were the contents of my kill ring and I pressed @kbd{C-y}, the
9984 string of characters saying @samp{some text} would be inserted in this
9985 buffer where my cursor is located.
9986
9987 The @code{yank} command is also used for duplicating text by copying it.
9988 The copied text is not cut from the buffer, but a copy of it is put on the
9989 kill ring and is inserted by yanking it back.
9990
9991 Three functions are used for bringing text back from the kill ring:
9992 @code{yank}, which is usually bound to @kbd{C-y}; @code{yank-pop},
9993 which is usually bound to @kbd{M-y}; and @code{rotate-yank-pointer},
9994 which is used by the two other functions.
9995
9996 These functions refer to the kill ring through a variable called the
9997 @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer}. Indeed, the insertion code for both the
9998 @code{yank} and @code{yank-pop} functions is:
9999
10000 @smallexample
10001 (insert (car kill-ring-yank-pointer))
10002 @end smallexample
10003
10004 @noindent
10005 (Well, no more. In GNU Emacs 22, the function has been replaced by
10006 @code{insert-for-yank} which calls @code{insert-for-yank-1}
10007 repetitively for each @code{yank-handler} segment. In turn,
10008 @code{insert-for-yank-1} strips text properties from the inserted text
10009 according to @code{yank-excluded-properties}. Otherwise, it is just
10010 like @code{insert}. We will stick with plain @code{insert} since it
10011 is easier to understand.)
10012
10013 To begin to understand how @code{yank} and @code{yank-pop} work, it is
10014 first necessary to look at the @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} variable.
10015
10016 @node kill-ring-yank-pointer
10017 @section The @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} Variable
10018
10019 @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} is a variable, just as @code{kill-ring} is
10020 a variable. It points to something by being bound to the value of what
10021 it points to, like any other Lisp variable.
10022
10023 @need 1000
10024 Thus, if the value of the kill ring is:
10025
10026 @smallexample
10027 ("some text" "a different piece of text" "yet more text")
10028 @end smallexample
10029
10030 @need 1250
10031 @noindent
10032 and the @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} points to the second clause, the
10033 value of @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} is:
10034
10035 @smallexample
10036 ("a different piece of text" "yet more text")
10037 @end smallexample
10038
10039 As explained in the previous chapter (@pxref{List Implementation}), the
10040 computer does not keep two different copies of the text being pointed to
10041 by both the @code{kill-ring} and the @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer}. The
10042 words ``a different piece of text'' and ``yet more text'' are not
10043 duplicated. Instead, the two Lisp variables point to the same pieces of
10044 text. Here is a diagram:
10045
10046 @c cons-cell-diagram #5
10047 @ifnottex
10048 @smallexample
10049 @group
10050 kill-ring kill-ring-yank-pointer
10051 | |
10052 | ___ ___ | ___ ___ ___ ___
10053 ---> | | | --> | | | | | |
10054 |___|___|----> |___|___|--> |___|___|--> nil
10055 | | |
10056 | | |
10057 | | --> "yet more text"
10058 | |
10059 | --> "a different piece of text"
10060 |
10061 --> "some text"
10062 @end group
10063 @end smallexample
10064 @sp 1
10065 @end ifnottex
10066 @ifset print-postscript-figures
10067 @sp 1
10068 @tex
10069 @center @image{cons-5}
10070 %%%% old method of including an image
10071 % \input /usr/local/lib/tex/inputs/psfig.tex
10072 % \centerline{\psfig{figure=/usr/local/lib/emacs/man/cons-5.eps}}
10073 % \catcode`\@=0 %
10074 @end tex
10075 @sp 1
10076 @end ifset
10077 @ifclear print-postscript-figures
10078 @iftex
10079 @smallexample
10080 @group
10081 kill-ring kill-ring-yank-pointer
10082 | |
10083 | ___ ___ | ___ ___ ___ ___
10084 ---> | | | --> | | | | | |
10085 |___|___|----> |___|___|--> |___|___|--> nil
10086 | | |
10087 | | |
10088 | | --> "yet more text"
10089 | |
10090 | --> "a different piece of text
10091 |
10092 --> "some text"
10093 @end group
10094 @end smallexample
10095 @sp 1
10096 @end iftex
10097 @end ifclear
10098
10099 Both the variable @code{kill-ring} and the variable
10100 @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} are pointers. But the kill ring itself is
10101 usually described as if it were actually what it is composed of. The
10102 @code{kill-ring} is spoken of as if it were the list rather than that it
10103 points to the list. Conversely, the @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} is
10104 spoken of as pointing to a list.
10105
10106 These two ways of talking about the same thing sound confusing at first but
10107 make sense on reflection. The kill ring is generally thought of as the
10108 complete structure of data that holds the information of what has recently
10109 been cut out of the Emacs buffers. The @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer}
10110 on the other hand, serves to indicate---that is, to `point to'---that part
10111 of the kill ring of which the first element (the @sc{car}) will be
10112 inserted.
10113
10114 @ignore
10115 In GNU Emacs 22, the @code{kill-new} function calls
10116
10117 @code{(setq kill-ring-yank-pointer kill-ring)}
10118
10119 (defun rotate-yank-pointer (arg)
10120 "Rotate the yanking point in the kill ring.
10121 With argument, rotate that many kills forward (or backward, if negative)."
10122 (interactive "p")
10123 (current-kill arg))
10124
10125 (defun current-kill (n &optional do-not-move)
10126 "Rotate the yanking point by N places, and then return that kill.
10127 If N is zero, `interprogram-paste-function' is set, and calling it
10128 returns a string, then that string is added to the front of the
10129 kill ring and returned as the latest kill.
10130 If optional arg DO-NOT-MOVE is non-nil, then don't actually move the
10131 yanking point; just return the Nth kill forward."
10132 (let ((interprogram-paste (and (= n 0)
10133 interprogram-paste-function
10134 (funcall interprogram-paste-function))))
10135 (if interprogram-paste
10136 (progn
10137 ;; Disable the interprogram cut function when we add the new
10138 ;; text to the kill ring, so Emacs doesn't try to own the
10139 ;; selection, with identical text.
10140 (let ((interprogram-cut-function nil))
10141 (kill-new interprogram-paste))
10142 interprogram-paste)
10143 (or kill-ring (error "Kill ring is empty"))
10144 (let ((ARGth-kill-element
10145 (nthcdr (mod (- n (length kill-ring-yank-pointer))
10146 (length kill-ring))
10147 kill-ring)))
10148 (or do-not-move
10149 (setq kill-ring-yank-pointer ARGth-kill-element))
10150 (car ARGth-kill-element)))))
10151
10152 @end ignore
10153
10154 @need 1500
10155 @node yank nthcdr Exercises
10156 @section Exercises with @code{yank} and @code{nthcdr}
10157
10158 @itemize @bullet
10159 @item
10160 Using @kbd{C-h v} (@code{describe-variable}), look at the value of
10161 your kill ring. Add several items to your kill ring; look at its
10162 value again. Using @kbd{M-y} (@code{yank-pop)}, move all the way
10163 around the kill ring. How many items were in your kill ring? Find
10164 the value of @code{kill-ring-max}. Was your kill ring full, or could
10165 you have kept more blocks of text within it?
10166
10167 @item
10168 Using @code{nthcdr} and @code{car}, construct a series of expressions
10169 to return the first, second, third, and fourth elements of a list.
10170 @end itemize
10171
10172 @node Loops & Recursion
10173 @chapter Loops and Recursion
10174 @cindex Loops and recursion
10175 @cindex Recursion and loops
10176 @cindex Repetition (loops)
10177
10178 Emacs Lisp has two primary ways to cause an expression, or a series of
10179 expressions, to be evaluated repeatedly: one uses a @code{while}
10180 loop, and the other uses @dfn{recursion}.
10181
10182 Repetition can be very valuable. For example, to move forward four
10183 sentences, you need only write a program that will move forward one
10184 sentence and then repeat the process four times. Since a computer does
10185 not get bored or tired, such repetitive action does not have the
10186 deleterious effects that excessive or the wrong kinds of repetition can
10187 have on humans.
10188
10189 People mostly write Emacs Lisp functions using @code{while} loops and
10190 their kin; but you can use recursion, which provides a very powerful
10191 way to think about and then to solve problems@footnote{You can write
10192 recursive functions to be frugal or wasteful of mental or computer
10193 resources; as it happens, methods that people find easy---that are
10194 frugal of `mental resources'---sometimes use considerable computer
10195 resources. Emacs was designed to run on machines that we now consider
10196 limited and its default settings are conservative. You may want to
10197 increase the values of @code{max-specpdl-size} and
10198 @code{max-lisp-eval-depth}. In my @file{.emacs} file, I set them to
10199 15 and 30 times their default value.}.
10200
10201 @menu
10202 * while:: Causing a stretch of code to repeat.
10203 * dolist dotimes::
10204 * Recursion:: Causing a function to call itself.
10205 * Looping exercise::
10206 @end menu
10207
10208 @node while
10209 @section @code{while}
10210 @cindex Loops
10211 @findex while
10212
10213 The @code{while} special form tests whether the value returned by
10214 evaluating its first argument is true or false. This is similar to what
10215 the Lisp interpreter does with an @code{if}; what the interpreter does
10216 next, however, is different.
10217
10218 In a @code{while} expression, if the value returned by evaluating the
10219 first argument is false, the Lisp interpreter skips the rest of the
10220 expression (the @dfn{body} of the expression) and does not evaluate it.
10221 However, if the value is true, the Lisp interpreter evaluates the body
10222 of the expression and then again tests whether the first argument to
10223 @code{while} is true or false. If the value returned by evaluating the
10224 first argument is again true, the Lisp interpreter again evaluates the
10225 body of the expression.
10226
10227 @need 1200
10228 The template for a @code{while} expression looks like this:
10229
10230 @smallexample
10231 @group
10232 (while @var{true-or-false-test}
10233 @var{body}@dots{})
10234 @end group
10235 @end smallexample
10236
10237 @menu
10238 * Looping with while:: Repeat so long as test returns true.
10239 * Loop Example:: A @code{while} loop that uses a list.
10240 * print-elements-of-list:: Uses @code{while}, @code{car}, @code{cdr}.
10241 * Incrementing Loop:: A loop with an incrementing counter.
10242 * Incrementing Loop Details::
10243 * Decrementing Loop:: A loop with a decrementing counter.
10244 @end menu
10245
10246 @ifnottex
10247 @node Looping with while
10248 @unnumberedsubsec Looping with @code{while}
10249 @end ifnottex
10250
10251 So long as the true-or-false-test of the @code{while} expression
10252 returns a true value when it is evaluated, the body is repeatedly
10253 evaluated. This process is called a loop since the Lisp interpreter
10254 repeats the same thing again and again, like an airplane doing a loop.
10255 When the result of evaluating the true-or-false-test is false, the
10256 Lisp interpreter does not evaluate the rest of the @code{while}
10257 expression and `exits the loop'.
10258
10259 Clearly, if the value returned by evaluating the first argument to
10260 @code{while} is always true, the body following will be evaluated
10261 again and again @dots{} and again @dots{} forever. Conversely, if the
10262 value returned is never true, the expressions in the body will never
10263 be evaluated. The craft of writing a @code{while} loop consists of
10264 choosing a mechanism such that the true-or-false-test returns true
10265 just the number of times that you want the subsequent expressions to
10266 be evaluated, and then have the test return false.
10267
10268 The value returned by evaluating a @code{while} is the value of the
10269 true-or-false-test. An interesting consequence of this is that a
10270 @code{while} loop that evaluates without error will return @code{nil}
10271 or false regardless of whether it has looped 1 or 100 times or none at
10272 all. A @code{while} expression that evaluates successfully never
10273 returns a true value! What this means is that @code{while} is always
10274 evaluated for its side effects, which is to say, the consequences of
10275 evaluating the expressions within the body of the @code{while} loop.
10276 This makes sense. It is not the mere act of looping that is desired,
10277 but the consequences of what happens when the expressions in the loop
10278 are repeatedly evaluated.
10279
10280 @node Loop Example
10281 @subsection A @code{while} Loop and a List
10282
10283 A common way to control a @code{while} loop is to test whether a list
10284 has any elements. If it does, the loop is repeated; but if it does not,
10285 the repetition is ended. Since this is an important technique, we will
10286 create a short example to illustrate it.
10287
10288 A simple way to test whether a list has elements is to evaluate the
10289 list: if it has no elements, it is an empty list and will return the
10290 empty list, @code{()}, which is a synonym for @code{nil} or false. On
10291 the other hand, a list with elements will return those elements when it
10292 is evaluated. Since Emacs Lisp considers as true any value that is not
10293 @code{nil}, a list that returns elements will test true in a
10294 @code{while} loop.
10295
10296 @need 1200
10297 For example, you can set the variable @code{empty-list} to @code{nil} by
10298 evaluating the following @code{setq} expression:
10299
10300 @smallexample
10301 (setq empty-list ())
10302 @end smallexample
10303
10304 @noindent
10305 After evaluating the @code{setq} expression, you can evaluate the
10306 variable @code{empty-list} in the usual way, by placing the cursor after
10307 the symbol and typing @kbd{C-x C-e}; @code{nil} will appear in your
10308 echo area:
10309
10310 @smallexample
10311 empty-list
10312 @end smallexample
10313
10314 On the other hand, if you set a variable to be a list with elements, the
10315 list will appear when you evaluate the variable, as you can see by
10316 evaluating the following two expressions:
10317
10318 @smallexample
10319 @group
10320 (setq animals '(gazelle giraffe lion tiger))
10321
10322 animals
10323 @end group
10324 @end smallexample
10325
10326 Thus, to create a @code{while} loop that tests whether there are any
10327 items in the list @code{animals}, the first part of the loop will be
10328 written like this:
10329
10330 @smallexample
10331 @group
10332 (while animals
10333 @dots{}
10334 @end group
10335 @end smallexample
10336
10337 @noindent
10338 When the @code{while} tests its first argument, the variable
10339 @code{animals} is evaluated. It returns a list. So long as the list
10340 has elements, the @code{while} considers the results of the test to be
10341 true; but when the list is empty, it considers the results of the test
10342 to be false.
10343
10344 To prevent the @code{while} loop from running forever, some mechanism
10345 needs to be provided to empty the list eventually. An oft-used
10346 technique is to have one of the subsequent forms in the @code{while}
10347 expression set the value of the list to be the @sc{cdr} of the list.
10348 Each time the @code{cdr} function is evaluated, the list will be made
10349 shorter, until eventually only the empty list will be left. At this
10350 point, the test of the @code{while} loop will return false, and the
10351 arguments to the @code{while} will no longer be evaluated.
10352
10353 For example, the list of animals bound to the variable @code{animals}
10354 can be set to be the @sc{cdr} of the original list with the
10355 following expression:
10356
10357 @smallexample
10358 (setq animals (cdr animals))
10359 @end smallexample
10360
10361 @noindent
10362 If you have evaluated the previous expressions and then evaluate this
10363 expression, you will see @code{(giraffe lion tiger)} appear in the echo
10364 area. If you evaluate the expression again, @code{(lion tiger)} will
10365 appear in the echo area. If you evaluate it again and yet again,
10366 @code{(tiger)} appears and then the empty list, shown by @code{nil}.
10367
10368 A template for a @code{while} loop that uses the @code{cdr} function
10369 repeatedly to cause the true-or-false-test eventually to test false
10370 looks like this:
10371
10372 @smallexample
10373 @group
10374 (while @var{test-whether-list-is-empty}
10375 @var{body}@dots{}
10376 @var{set-list-to-cdr-of-list})
10377 @end group
10378 @end smallexample
10379
10380 This test and use of @code{cdr} can be put together in a function that
10381 goes through a list and prints each element of the list on a line of its
10382 own.
10383
10384 @node print-elements-of-list
10385 @subsection An Example: @code{print-elements-of-list}
10386 @findex print-elements-of-list
10387
10388 The @code{print-elements-of-list} function illustrates a @code{while}
10389 loop with a list.
10390
10391 @cindex @file{*scratch*} buffer
10392 The function requires several lines for its output. If you are
10393 reading this in a recent instance of GNU Emacs,
10394 @c GNU Emacs 21, GNU Emacs 22, or a later version,
10395 you can evaluate the following expression inside of Info, as usual.
10396
10397 If you are using an earlier version of Emacs, you need to copy the
10398 necessary expressions to your @file{*scratch*} buffer and evaluate
10399 them there. This is because the echo area had only one line in the
10400 earlier versions.
10401
10402 You can copy the expressions by marking the beginning of the region
10403 with @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} (@code{set-mark-command}), moving the cursor to
10404 the end of the region and then copying the region using @kbd{M-w}
10405 (@code{kill-ring-save}, which calls @code{copy-region-as-kill} and
10406 then provides visual feedback). In the @file{*scratch*}
10407 buffer, you can yank the expressions back by typing @kbd{C-y}
10408 (@code{yank}).
10409
10410 After you have copied the expressions to the @file{*scratch*} buffer,
10411 evaluate each expression in turn. Be sure to evaluate the last
10412 expression, @code{(print-elements-of-list animals)}, by typing
10413 @kbd{C-u C-x C-e}, that is, by giving an argument to
10414 @code{eval-last-sexp}. This will cause the result of the evaluation
10415 to be printed in the @file{*scratch*} buffer instead of being printed
10416 in the echo area. (Otherwise you will see something like this in your
10417 echo area: @code{^Jgazelle^J^Jgiraffe^J^Jlion^J^Jtiger^Jnil}, in which
10418 each @samp{^J} stands for a `newline'.)
10419
10420 @need 1500
10421 In a recent instance of GNU Emacs, you can evaluate these expressions
10422 directly in the Info buffer, and the echo area will grow to show the
10423 results.
10424
10425 @smallexample
10426 @group
10427 (setq animals '(gazelle giraffe lion tiger))
10428
10429 (defun print-elements-of-list (list)
10430 "Print each element of LIST on a line of its own."
10431 (while list
10432 (print (car list))
10433 (setq list (cdr list))))
10434
10435 (print-elements-of-list animals)
10436 @end group
10437 @end smallexample
10438
10439 @need 1200
10440 @noindent
10441 When you evaluate the three expressions in sequence, you will see
10442 this:
10443
10444 @smallexample
10445 @group
10446 gazelle
10447
10448 giraffe
10449
10450 lion
10451
10452 tiger
10453 nil
10454 @end group
10455 @end smallexample
10456
10457 Each element of the list is printed on a line of its own (that is what
10458 the function @code{print} does) and then the value returned by the
10459 function is printed. Since the last expression in the function is the
10460 @code{while} loop, and since @code{while} loops always return
10461 @code{nil}, a @code{nil} is printed after the last element of the list.
10462
10463 @node Incrementing Loop
10464 @subsection A Loop with an Incrementing Counter
10465
10466 A loop is not useful unless it stops when it ought. Besides
10467 controlling a loop with a list, a common way of stopping a loop is to
10468 write the first argument as a test that returns false when the correct
10469 number of repetitions are complete. This means that the loop must
10470 have a counter---an expression that counts how many times the loop
10471 repeats itself.
10472
10473 @ifnottex
10474 @node Incrementing Loop Details
10475 @unnumberedsubsec Details of an Incrementing Loop
10476 @end ifnottex
10477
10478 The test for a loop with an incrementing counter can be an expression
10479 such as @code{(< count desired-number)} which returns @code{t} for
10480 true if the value of @code{count} is less than the
10481 @code{desired-number} of repetitions and @code{nil} for false if the
10482 value of @code{count} is equal to or is greater than the
10483 @code{desired-number}. The expression that increments the count can
10484 be a simple @code{setq} such as @code{(setq count (1+ count))}, where
10485 @code{1+} is a built-in function in Emacs Lisp that adds 1 to its
10486 argument. (The expression @w{@code{(1+ count)}} has the same result
10487 as @w{@code{(+ count 1)}}, but is easier for a human to read.)
10488
10489 @need 1250
10490 The template for a @code{while} loop controlled by an incrementing
10491 counter looks like this:
10492
10493 @smallexample
10494 @group
10495 @var{set-count-to-initial-value}
10496 (while (< count desired-number) ; @r{true-or-false-test}
10497 @var{body}@dots{}
10498 (setq count (1+ count))) ; @r{incrementer}
10499 @end group
10500 @end smallexample
10501
10502 @noindent
10503 Note that you need to set the initial value of @code{count}; usually it
10504 is set to 1.
10505
10506 @menu
10507 * Incrementing Example:: Counting pebbles in a triangle.
10508 * Inc Example parts:: The parts of the function definition.
10509 * Inc Example altogether:: Putting the function definition together.
10510 @end menu
10511
10512 @node Incrementing Example
10513 @unnumberedsubsubsec Example with incrementing counter
10514
10515 Suppose you are playing on the beach and decide to make a triangle of
10516 pebbles, putting one pebble in the first row, two in the second row,
10517 three in the third row and so on, like this:
10518
10519 @sp 1
10520 @c pebble diagram
10521 @ifnottex
10522 @smallexample
10523 @group
10524 *
10525 * *
10526 * * *
10527 * * * *
10528 @end group
10529 @end smallexample
10530 @end ifnottex
10531 @iftex
10532 @smallexample
10533 @group
10534 @bullet{}
10535 @bullet{} @bullet{}
10536 @bullet{} @bullet{} @bullet{}
10537 @bullet{} @bullet{} @bullet{} @bullet{}
10538 @end group
10539 @end smallexample
10540 @end iftex
10541 @sp 1
10542
10543 @noindent
10544 (About 2500 years ago, Pythagoras and others developed the beginnings of
10545 number theory by considering questions such as this.)
10546
10547 Suppose you want to know how many pebbles you will need to make a
10548 triangle with 7 rows?
10549
10550 Clearly, what you need to do is add up the numbers from 1 to 7. There
10551 are two ways to do this; start with the smallest number, one, and add up
10552 the list in sequence, 1, 2, 3, 4 and so on; or start with the largest
10553 number and add the list going down: 7, 6, 5, 4 and so on. Because both
10554 mechanisms illustrate common ways of writing @code{while} loops, we will
10555 create two examples, one counting up and the other counting down. In
10556 this first example, we will start with 1 and add 2, 3, 4 and so on.
10557
10558 If you are just adding up a short list of numbers, the easiest way to do
10559 it is to add up all the numbers at once. However, if you do not know
10560 ahead of time how many numbers your list will have, or if you want to be
10561 prepared for a very long list, then you need to design your addition so
10562 that what you do is repeat a simple process many times instead of doing
10563 a more complex process once.
10564
10565 For example, instead of adding up all the pebbles all at once, what you
10566 can do is add the number of pebbles in the first row, 1, to the number
10567 in the second row, 2, and then add the total of those two rows to the
10568 third row, 3. Then you can add the number in the fourth row, 4, to the
10569 total of the first three rows; and so on.
10570
10571 The critical characteristic of the process is that each repetitive
10572 action is simple. In this case, at each step we add only two numbers,
10573 the number of pebbles in the row and the total already found. This
10574 process of adding two numbers is repeated again and again until the last
10575 row has been added to the total of all the preceding rows. In a more
10576 complex loop the repetitive action might not be so simple, but it will
10577 be simpler than doing everything all at once.
10578
10579 @node Inc Example parts
10580 @unnumberedsubsubsec The parts of the function definition
10581
10582 The preceding analysis gives us the bones of our function definition:
10583 first, we will need a variable that we can call @code{total} that will
10584 be the total number of pebbles. This will be the value returned by
10585 the function.
10586
10587 Second, we know that the function will require an argument: this
10588 argument will be the total number of rows in the triangle. It can be
10589 called @code{number-of-rows}.
10590
10591 Finally, we need a variable to use as a counter. We could call this
10592 variable @code{counter}, but a better name is @code{row-number}. That
10593 is because what the counter does in this function is count rows, and a
10594 program should be written to be as understandable as possible.
10595
10596 When the Lisp interpreter first starts evaluating the expressions in the
10597 function, the value of @code{total} should be set to zero, since we have
10598 not added anything to it. Then the function should add the number of
10599 pebbles in the first row to the total, and then add the number of
10600 pebbles in the second to the total, and then add the number of
10601 pebbles in the third row to the total, and so on, until there are no
10602 more rows left to add.
10603
10604 Both @code{total} and @code{row-number} are used only inside the
10605 function, so they can be declared as local variables with @code{let}
10606 and given initial values. Clearly, the initial value for @code{total}
10607 should be 0. The initial value of @code{row-number} should be 1,
10608 since we start with the first row. This means that the @code{let}
10609 statement will look like this:
10610
10611 @smallexample
10612 @group
10613 (let ((total 0)
10614 (row-number 1))
10615 @var{body}@dots{})
10616 @end group
10617 @end smallexample
10618
10619 After the internal variables are declared and bound to their initial
10620 values, we can begin the @code{while} loop. The expression that serves
10621 as the test should return a value of @code{t} for true so long as the
10622 @code{row-number} is less than or equal to the @code{number-of-rows}.
10623 (If the expression tests true only so long as the row number is less
10624 than the number of rows in the triangle, the last row will never be
10625 added to the total; hence the row number has to be either less than or
10626 equal to the number of rows.)
10627
10628 @need 1500
10629 @findex <= @r{(less than or equal)}
10630 Lisp provides the @code{<=} function that returns true if the value of
10631 its first argument is less than or equal to the value of its second
10632 argument and false otherwise. So the expression that the @code{while}
10633 will evaluate as its test should look like this:
10634
10635 @smallexample
10636 (<= row-number number-of-rows)
10637 @end smallexample
10638
10639 The total number of pebbles can be found by repeatedly adding the number
10640 of pebbles in a row to the total already found. Since the number of
10641 pebbles in the row is equal to the row number, the total can be found by
10642 adding the row number to the total. (Clearly, in a more complex
10643 situation, the number of pebbles in the row might be related to the row
10644 number in a more complicated way; if this were the case, the row number
10645 would be replaced by the appropriate expression.)
10646
10647 @smallexample
10648 (setq total (+ total row-number))
10649 @end smallexample
10650
10651 @noindent
10652 What this does is set the new value of @code{total} to be equal to the
10653 sum of adding the number of pebbles in the row to the previous total.
10654
10655 After setting the value of @code{total}, the conditions need to be
10656 established for the next repetition of the loop, if there is one. This
10657 is done by incrementing the value of the @code{row-number} variable,
10658 which serves as a counter. After the @code{row-number} variable has
10659 been incremented, the true-or-false-test at the beginning of the
10660 @code{while} loop tests whether its value is still less than or equal to
10661 the value of the @code{number-of-rows} and if it is, adds the new value
10662 of the @code{row-number} variable to the @code{total} of the previous
10663 repetition of the loop.
10664
10665 @need 1200
10666 The built-in Emacs Lisp function @code{1+} adds 1 to a number, so the
10667 @code{row-number} variable can be incremented with this expression:
10668
10669 @smallexample
10670 (setq row-number (1+ row-number))
10671 @end smallexample
10672
10673 @node Inc Example altogether
10674 @unnumberedsubsubsec Putting the function definition together
10675
10676 We have created the parts for the function definition; now we need to
10677 put them together.
10678
10679 @need 800
10680 First, the contents of the @code{while} expression:
10681
10682 @smallexample
10683 @group
10684 (while (<= row-number number-of-rows) ; @r{true-or-false-test}
10685 (setq total (+ total row-number))
10686 (setq row-number (1+ row-number))) ; @r{incrementer}
10687 @end group
10688 @end smallexample
10689
10690 Along with the @code{let} expression varlist, this very nearly
10691 completes the body of the function definition. However, it requires
10692 one final element, the need for which is somewhat subtle.
10693
10694 The final touch is to place the variable @code{total} on a line by
10695 itself after the @code{while} expression. Otherwise, the value returned
10696 by the whole function is the value of the last expression that is
10697 evaluated in the body of the @code{let}, and this is the value
10698 returned by the @code{while}, which is always @code{nil}.
10699
10700 This may not be evident at first sight. It almost looks as if the
10701 incrementing expression is the last expression of the whole function.
10702 But that expression is part of the body of the @code{while}; it is the
10703 last element of the list that starts with the symbol @code{while}.
10704 Moreover, the whole of the @code{while} loop is a list within the body
10705 of the @code{let}.
10706
10707 @need 1250
10708 In outline, the function will look like this:
10709
10710 @smallexample
10711 @group
10712 (defun @var{name-of-function} (@var{argument-list})
10713 "@var{documentation}@dots{}"
10714 (let (@var{varlist})
10715 (while (@var{true-or-false-test})
10716 @var{body-of-while}@dots{} )
10717 @dots{} )) ; @r{Need final expression here.}
10718 @end group
10719 @end smallexample
10720
10721 The result of evaluating the @code{let} is what is going to be returned
10722 by the @code{defun} since the @code{let} is not embedded within any
10723 containing list, except for the @code{defun} as a whole. However, if
10724 the @code{while} is the last element of the @code{let} expression, the
10725 function will always return @code{nil}. This is not what we want!
10726 Instead, what we want is the value of the variable @code{total}. This
10727 is returned by simply placing the symbol as the last element of the list
10728 starting with @code{let}. It gets evaluated after the preceding
10729 elements of the list are evaluated, which means it gets evaluated after
10730 it has been assigned the correct value for the total.
10731
10732 It may be easier to see this by printing the list starting with
10733 @code{let} all on one line. This format makes it evident that the
10734 @var{varlist} and @code{while} expressions are the second and third
10735 elements of the list starting with @code{let}, and the @code{total} is
10736 the last element:
10737
10738 @smallexample
10739 @group
10740 (let (@var{varlist}) (while (@var{true-or-false-test}) @var{body-of-while}@dots{} ) total)
10741 @end group
10742 @end smallexample
10743
10744 @need 1200
10745 Putting everything together, the @code{triangle} function definition
10746 looks like this:
10747
10748 @smallexample
10749 @group
10750 (defun triangle (number-of-rows) ; @r{Version with}
10751 ; @r{ incrementing counter.}
10752 "Add up the number of pebbles in a triangle.
10753 The first row has one pebble, the second row two pebbles,
10754 the third row three pebbles, and so on.
10755 The argument is NUMBER-OF-ROWS."
10756 @end group
10757 @group
10758 (let ((total 0)
10759 (row-number 1))
10760 (while (<= row-number number-of-rows)
10761 (setq total (+ total row-number))
10762 (setq row-number (1+ row-number)))
10763 total))
10764 @end group
10765 @end smallexample
10766
10767 @need 1200
10768 After you have installed @code{triangle} by evaluating the function, you
10769 can try it out. Here are two examples:
10770
10771 @smallexample
10772 @group
10773 (triangle 4)
10774
10775 (triangle 7)
10776 @end group
10777 @end smallexample
10778
10779 @noindent
10780 The sum of the first four numbers is 10 and the sum of the first seven
10781 numbers is 28.
10782
10783 @node Decrementing Loop
10784 @subsection Loop with a Decrementing Counter
10785
10786 Another common way to write a @code{while} loop is to write the test
10787 so that it determines whether a counter is greater than zero. So long
10788 as the counter is greater than zero, the loop is repeated. But when
10789 the counter is equal to or less than zero, the loop is stopped. For
10790 this to work, the counter has to start out greater than zero and then
10791 be made smaller and smaller by a form that is evaluated
10792 repeatedly.
10793
10794 The test will be an expression such as @code{(> counter 0)} which
10795 returns @code{t} for true if the value of @code{counter} is greater
10796 than zero, and @code{nil} for false if the value of @code{counter} is
10797 equal to or less than zero. The expression that makes the number
10798 smaller and smaller can be a simple @code{setq} such as @code{(setq
10799 counter (1- counter))}, where @code{1-} is a built-in function in
10800 Emacs Lisp that subtracts 1 from its argument.
10801
10802 @need 1250
10803 The template for a decrementing @code{while} loop looks like this:
10804
10805 @smallexample
10806 @group
10807 (while (> counter 0) ; @r{true-or-false-test}
10808 @var{body}@dots{}
10809 (setq counter (1- counter))) ; @r{decrementer}
10810 @end group
10811 @end smallexample
10812
10813 @menu
10814 * Decrementing Example:: More pebbles on the beach.
10815 * Dec Example parts:: The parts of the function definition.
10816 * Dec Example altogether:: Putting the function definition together.
10817 @end menu
10818
10819 @node Decrementing Example
10820 @unnumberedsubsubsec Example with decrementing counter
10821
10822 To illustrate a loop with a decrementing counter, we will rewrite the
10823 @code{triangle} function so the counter decreases to zero.
10824
10825 This is the reverse of the earlier version of the function. In this
10826 case, to find out how many pebbles are needed to make a triangle with
10827 3 rows, add the number of pebbles in the third row, 3, to the number
10828 in the preceding row, 2, and then add the total of those two rows to
10829 the row that precedes them, which is 1.
10830
10831 Likewise, to find the number of pebbles in a triangle with 7 rows, add
10832 the number of pebbles in the seventh row, 7, to the number in the
10833 preceding row, which is 6, and then add the total of those two rows to
10834 the row that precedes them, which is 5, and so on. As in the previous
10835 example, each addition only involves adding two numbers, the total of
10836 the rows already added up and the number of pebbles in the row that is
10837 being added to the total. This process of adding two numbers is
10838 repeated again and again until there are no more pebbles to add.
10839
10840 We know how many pebbles to start with: the number of pebbles in the
10841 last row is equal to the number of rows. If the triangle has seven
10842 rows, the number of pebbles in the last row is 7. Likewise, we know how
10843 many pebbles are in the preceding row: it is one less than the number in
10844 the row.
10845
10846 @node Dec Example parts
10847 @unnumberedsubsubsec The parts of the function definition
10848
10849 We start with three variables: the total number of rows in the
10850 triangle; the number of pebbles in a row; and the total number of
10851 pebbles, which is what we want to calculate. These variables can be
10852 named @code{number-of-rows}, @code{number-of-pebbles-in-row}, and
10853 @code{total}, respectively.
10854
10855 Both @code{total} and @code{number-of-pebbles-in-row} are used only
10856 inside the function and are declared with @code{let}. The initial
10857 value of @code{total} should, of course, be zero. However, the
10858 initial value of @code{number-of-pebbles-in-row} should be equal to
10859 the number of rows in the triangle, since the addition will start with
10860 the longest row.
10861
10862 @need 1250
10863 This means that the beginning of the @code{let} expression will look
10864 like this:
10865
10866 @smallexample
10867 @group
10868 (let ((total 0)
10869 (number-of-pebbles-in-row number-of-rows))
10870 @var{body}@dots{})
10871 @end group
10872 @end smallexample
10873
10874 The total number of pebbles can be found by repeatedly adding the number
10875 of pebbles in a row to the total already found, that is, by repeatedly
10876 evaluating the following expression:
10877
10878 @smallexample
10879 (setq total (+ total number-of-pebbles-in-row))
10880 @end smallexample
10881
10882 @noindent
10883 After the @code{number-of-pebbles-in-row} is added to the @code{total},
10884 the @code{number-of-pebbles-in-row} should be decremented by one, since
10885 the next time the loop repeats, the preceding row will be
10886 added to the total.
10887
10888 The number of pebbles in a preceding row is one less than the number of
10889 pebbles in a row, so the built-in Emacs Lisp function @code{1-} can be
10890 used to compute the number of pebbles in the preceding row. This can be
10891 done with the following expression:
10892
10893 @smallexample
10894 @group
10895 (setq number-of-pebbles-in-row
10896 (1- number-of-pebbles-in-row))
10897 @end group
10898 @end smallexample
10899
10900 Finally, we know that the @code{while} loop should stop making repeated
10901 additions when there are no pebbles in a row. So the test for
10902 the @code{while} loop is simply:
10903
10904 @smallexample
10905 (while (> number-of-pebbles-in-row 0)
10906 @end smallexample
10907
10908 @node Dec Example altogether
10909 @unnumberedsubsubsec Putting the function definition together
10910
10911 We can put these expressions together to create a function definition
10912 that works. However, on examination, we find that one of the local
10913 variables is unneeded!
10914
10915 @need 1250
10916 The function definition looks like this:
10917
10918 @smallexample
10919 @group
10920 ;;; @r{First subtractive version.}
10921 (defun triangle (number-of-rows)
10922 "Add up the number of pebbles in a triangle."
10923 (let ((total 0)
10924 (number-of-pebbles-in-row number-of-rows))
10925 (while (> number-of-pebbles-in-row 0)
10926 (setq total (+ total number-of-pebbles-in-row))
10927 (setq number-of-pebbles-in-row
10928 (1- number-of-pebbles-in-row)))
10929 total))
10930 @end group
10931 @end smallexample
10932
10933 As written, this function works.
10934
10935 However, we do not need @code{number-of-pebbles-in-row}.
10936
10937 @cindex Argument as local variable
10938 When the @code{triangle} function is evaluated, the symbol
10939 @code{number-of-rows} will be bound to a number, giving it an initial
10940 value. That number can be changed in the body of the function as if
10941 it were a local variable, without any fear that such a change will
10942 effect the value of the variable outside of the function. This is a
10943 very useful characteristic of Lisp; it means that the variable
10944 @code{number-of-rows} can be used anywhere in the function where
10945 @code{number-of-pebbles-in-row} is used.
10946
10947 @need 800
10948 Here is a second version of the function written a bit more cleanly:
10949
10950 @smallexample
10951 @group
10952 (defun triangle (number) ; @r{Second version.}
10953 "Return sum of numbers 1 through NUMBER inclusive."
10954 (let ((total 0))
10955 (while (> number 0)
10956 (setq total (+ total number))
10957 (setq number (1- number)))
10958 total))
10959 @end group
10960 @end smallexample
10961
10962 In brief, a properly written @code{while} loop will consist of three parts:
10963
10964 @enumerate
10965 @item
10966 A test that will return false after the loop has repeated itself the
10967 correct number of times.
10968
10969 @item
10970 An expression the evaluation of which will return the value desired
10971 after being repeatedly evaluated.
10972
10973 @item
10974 An expression to change the value passed to the true-or-false-test so
10975 that the test returns false after the loop has repeated itself the right
10976 number of times.
10977 @end enumerate
10978
10979 @node dolist dotimes
10980 @section Save your time: @code{dolist} and @code{dotimes}
10981
10982 In addition to @code{while}, both @code{dolist} and @code{dotimes}
10983 provide for looping. Sometimes these are quicker to write than the
10984 equivalent @code{while} loop. Both are Lisp macros. (@xref{Macros, ,
10985 Macros, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}. )
10986
10987 @code{dolist} works like a @code{while} loop that `@sc{cdr}s down a
10988 list': @code{dolist} automatically shortens the list each time it
10989 loops---takes the @sc{cdr} of the list---and binds the @sc{car} of
10990 each shorter version of the list to the first of its arguments.
10991
10992 @code{dotimes} loops a specific number of times: you specify the number.
10993
10994 @menu
10995 * dolist::
10996 * dotimes::
10997 @end menu
10998
10999 @node dolist
11000 @unnumberedsubsec The @code{dolist} Macro
11001 @findex dolist
11002
11003 Suppose, for example, you want to reverse a list, so that
11004 ``first'' ``second'' ``third'' becomes ``third'' ``second'' ``first''.
11005
11006 @need 1250
11007 In practice, you would use the @code{reverse} function, like this:
11008
11009 @smallexample
11010 @group
11011 (setq animals '(gazelle giraffe lion tiger))
11012
11013 (reverse animals)
11014 @end group
11015 @end smallexample
11016
11017 @need 800
11018 @noindent
11019 Here is how you could reverse the list using a @code{while} loop:
11020
11021 @smallexample
11022 @group
11023 (setq animals '(gazelle giraffe lion tiger))
11024
11025 (defun reverse-list-with-while (list)
11026 "Using while, reverse the order of LIST."
11027 (let (value) ; make sure list starts empty
11028 (while list
11029 (setq value (cons (car list) value))
11030 (setq list (cdr list)))
11031 value))
11032
11033 (reverse-list-with-while animals)
11034 @end group
11035 @end smallexample
11036
11037 @need 800
11038 @noindent
11039 And here is how you could use the @code{dolist} macro:
11040
11041 @smallexample
11042 @group
11043 (setq animals '(gazelle giraffe lion tiger))
11044
11045 (defun reverse-list-with-dolist (list)
11046 "Using dolist, reverse the order of LIST."
11047 (let (value) ; make sure list starts empty
11048 (dolist (element list value)
11049 (setq value (cons element value)))))
11050
11051 (reverse-list-with-dolist animals)
11052 @end group
11053 @end smallexample
11054
11055 @need 1250
11056 @noindent
11057 In Info, you can place your cursor after the closing parenthesis of
11058 each expression and type @kbd{C-x C-e}; in each case, you should see
11059
11060 @smallexample
11061 (tiger lion giraffe gazelle)
11062 @end smallexample
11063
11064 @noindent
11065 in the echo area.
11066
11067 For this example, the existing @code{reverse} function is obviously best.
11068 The @code{while} loop is just like our first example (@pxref{Loop
11069 Example, , A @code{while} Loop and a List}). The @code{while} first
11070 checks whether the list has elements; if so, it constructs a new list
11071 by adding the first element of the list to the existing list (which in
11072 the first iteration of the loop is @code{nil}). Since the second
11073 element is prepended in front of the first element, and the third
11074 element is prepended in front of the second element, the list is reversed.
11075
11076 In the expression using a @code{while} loop,
11077 the @w{@code{(setq list (cdr list))}}
11078 expression shortens the list, so the @code{while} loop eventually
11079 stops. In addition, it provides the @code{cons} expression with a new
11080 first element by creating a new and shorter list at each repetition of
11081 the loop.
11082
11083 The @code{dolist} expression does very much the same as the
11084 @code{while} expression, except that the @code{dolist} macro does some
11085 of the work you have to do when writing a @code{while} expression.
11086
11087 Like a @code{while} loop, a @code{dolist} loops. What is different is
11088 that it automatically shortens the list each time it loops---it
11089 `@sc{cdr}s down the list' on its own---and it automatically binds
11090 the @sc{car} of each shorter version of the list to the first of its
11091 arguments.
11092
11093 In the example, the @sc{car} of each shorter version of the list is
11094 referred to using the symbol @samp{element}, the list itself is called
11095 @samp{list}, and the value returned is called @samp{value}. The
11096 remainder of the @code{dolist} expression is the body.
11097
11098 The @code{dolist} expression binds the @sc{car} of each shorter
11099 version of the list to @code{element} and then evaluates the body of
11100 the expression; and repeats the loop. The result is returned in
11101 @code{value}.
11102
11103 @node dotimes
11104 @unnumberedsubsec The @code{dotimes} Macro
11105 @findex dotimes
11106
11107 The @code{dotimes} macro is similar to @code{dolist}, except that it
11108 loops a specific number of times.
11109
11110 The first argument to @code{dotimes} is assigned the numbers 0, 1, 2
11111 and so forth each time around the loop, and the value of the third
11112 argument is returned. You need to provide the value of the second
11113 argument, which is how many times the macro loops.
11114
11115 @need 1250
11116 For example, the following binds the numbers from 0 up to, but not
11117 including, the number 3 to the first argument, @var{number}, and then
11118 constructs a list of the three numbers. (The first number is 0, the
11119 second number is 1, and the third number is 2; this makes a total of
11120 three numbers in all, starting with zero as the first number.)
11121
11122 @smallexample
11123 @group
11124 (let (value) ; otherwise a value is a void variable
11125 (dotimes (number 3 value)
11126 (setq value (cons number value))))
11127
11128 @result{} (2 1 0)
11129 @end group
11130 @end smallexample
11131
11132 @noindent
11133 @code{dotimes} returns @code{value}, so the way to use
11134 @code{dotimes} is to operate on some expression @var{number} number of
11135 times and then return the result, either as a list or an atom.
11136
11137 @need 1250
11138 Here is an example of a @code{defun} that uses @code{dotimes} to add
11139 up the number of pebbles in a triangle.
11140
11141 @smallexample
11142 @group
11143 (defun triangle-using-dotimes (number-of-rows)
11144 "Using dotimes, add up the number of pebbles in a triangle."
11145 (let ((total 0)) ; otherwise a total is a void variable
11146 (dotimes (number number-of-rows total)
11147 (setq total (+ total (1+ number))))))
11148
11149 (triangle-using-dotimes 4)
11150 @end group
11151 @end smallexample
11152
11153 @node Recursion
11154 @section Recursion
11155 @cindex Recursion
11156
11157 A recursive function contains code that tells the Lisp interpreter to
11158 call a program that runs exactly like itself, but with slightly
11159 different arguments. The code runs exactly the same because it has
11160 the same name. However, even though the program has the same name, it
11161 is not the same entity. It is different. In the jargon, it is a
11162 different `instance'.
11163
11164 Eventually, if the program is written correctly, the `slightly
11165 different arguments' will become sufficiently different from the first
11166 arguments that the final instance will stop.
11167
11168 @menu
11169 * Building Robots:: Same model, different serial number ...
11170 * Recursive Definition Parts:: Walk until you stop ...
11171 * Recursion with list:: Using a list as the test whether to recurse.
11172 * Recursive triangle function::
11173 * Recursion with cond::
11174 * Recursive Patterns:: Often used templates.
11175 * No Deferment:: Don't store up work ...
11176 * No deferment solution::
11177 @end menu
11178
11179 @node Building Robots
11180 @subsection Building Robots: Extending the Metaphor
11181 @cindex Building robots
11182 @cindex Robots, building
11183
11184 It is sometimes helpful to think of a running program as a robot that
11185 does a job. In doing its job, a recursive function calls on a second
11186 robot to help it. The second robot is identical to the first in every
11187 way, except that the second robot helps the first and has been
11188 passed different arguments than the first.
11189
11190 In a recursive function, the second robot may call a third; and the
11191 third may call a fourth, and so on. Each of these is a different
11192 entity; but all are clones.
11193
11194 Since each robot has slightly different instructions---the arguments
11195 will differ from one robot to the next---the last robot should know
11196 when to stop.
11197
11198 Let's expand on the metaphor in which a computer program is a robot.
11199
11200 A function definition provides the blueprints for a robot. When you
11201 install a function definition, that is, when you evaluate a
11202 @code{defun} macro, you install the necessary equipment to build
11203 robots. It is as if you were in a factory, setting up an assembly
11204 line. Robots with the same name are built according to the same
11205 blueprints. So they have, as it were, the same `model number', but a
11206 different `serial number'.
11207
11208 We often say that a recursive function `calls itself'. What we mean
11209 is that the instructions in a recursive function cause the Lisp
11210 interpreter to run a different function that has the same name and
11211 does the same job as the first, but with different arguments.
11212
11213 It is important that the arguments differ from one instance to the
11214 next; otherwise, the process will never stop.
11215
11216 @node Recursive Definition Parts
11217 @subsection The Parts of a Recursive Definition
11218 @cindex Parts of a Recursive Definition
11219 @cindex Recursive Definition Parts
11220
11221 A recursive function typically contains a conditional expression which
11222 has three parts:
11223
11224 @enumerate
11225 @item
11226 A true-or-false-test that determines whether the function is called
11227 again, here called the @dfn{do-again-test}.
11228
11229 @item
11230 The name of the function. When this name is called, a new instance of
11231 the function---a new robot, as it were---is created and told what to do.
11232
11233 @item
11234 An expression that returns a different value each time the function is
11235 called, here called the @dfn{next-step-expression}. Consequently, the
11236 argument (or arguments) passed to the new instance of the function
11237 will be different from that passed to the previous instance. This
11238 causes the conditional expression, the @dfn{do-again-test}, to test
11239 false after the correct number of repetitions.
11240 @end enumerate
11241
11242 Recursive functions can be much simpler than any other kind of
11243 function. Indeed, when people first start to use them, they often look
11244 so mysteriously simple as to be incomprehensible. Like riding a
11245 bicycle, reading a recursive function definition takes a certain knack
11246 which is hard at first but then seems simple.
11247
11248 @need 1200
11249 There are several different common recursive patterns. A very simple
11250 pattern looks like this:
11251
11252 @smallexample
11253 @group
11254 (defun @var{name-of-recursive-function} (@var{argument-list})
11255 "@var{documentation}@dots{}"
11256 (if @var{do-again-test}
11257 @var{body}@dots{}
11258 (@var{name-of-recursive-function}
11259 @var{next-step-expression})))
11260 @end group
11261 @end smallexample
11262
11263 Each time a recursive function is evaluated, a new instance of it is
11264 created and told what to do. The arguments tell the instance what to do.
11265
11266 An argument is bound to the value of the next-step-expression. Each
11267 instance runs with a different value of the next-step-expression.
11268
11269 The value in the next-step-expression is used in the do-again-test.
11270
11271 The value returned by the next-step-expression is passed to the new
11272 instance of the function, which evaluates it (or some
11273 transmogrification of it) to determine whether to continue or stop.
11274 The next-step-expression is designed so that the do-again-test returns
11275 false when the function should no longer be repeated.
11276
11277 The do-again-test is sometimes called the @dfn{stop condition},
11278 since it stops the repetitions when it tests false.
11279
11280 @node Recursion with list
11281 @subsection Recursion with a List
11282
11283 The example of a @code{while} loop that printed the elements of a list
11284 of numbers can be written recursively. Here is the code, including
11285 an expression to set the value of the variable @code{animals} to a list.
11286
11287 If you are reading this in Info in Emacs, you can evaluate this
11288 expression directly in Info. Otherwise, you must copy the example
11289 to the @file{*scratch*} buffer and evaluate each expression there.
11290 Use @kbd{C-u C-x C-e} to evaluate the
11291 @code{(print-elements-recursively animals)} expression so that the
11292 results are printed in the buffer; otherwise the Lisp interpreter will
11293 try to squeeze the results into the one line of the echo area.
11294
11295 Also, place your cursor immediately after the last closing parenthesis
11296 of the @code{print-elements-recursively} function, before the comment.
11297 Otherwise, the Lisp interpreter will try to evaluate the comment.
11298
11299 @findex print-elements-recursively
11300 @smallexample
11301 @group
11302 (setq animals '(gazelle giraffe lion tiger))
11303
11304 (defun print-elements-recursively (list)
11305 "Print each element of LIST on a line of its own.
11306 Uses recursion."
11307 (when list ; @r{do-again-test}
11308 (print (car list)) ; @r{body}
11309 (print-elements-recursively ; @r{recursive call}
11310 (cdr list)))) ; @r{next-step-expression}
11311
11312 (print-elements-recursively animals)
11313 @end group
11314 @end smallexample
11315
11316 The @code{print-elements-recursively} function first tests whether
11317 there is any content in the list; if there is, the function prints the
11318 first element of the list, the @sc{car} of the list. Then the
11319 function `invokes itself', but gives itself as its argument, not the
11320 whole list, but the second and subsequent elements of the list, the
11321 @sc{cdr} of the list.
11322
11323 Put another way, if the list is not empty, the function invokes
11324 another instance of code that is similar to the initial code, but is a
11325 different thread of execution, with different arguments than the first
11326 instance.
11327
11328 Put in yet another way, if the list is not empty, the first robot
11329 assembles a second robot and tells it what to do; the second robot is
11330 a different individual from the first, but is the same model.
11331
11332 When the second evaluation occurs, the @code{when} expression is
11333 evaluated and if true, prints the first element of the list it
11334 receives as its argument (which is the second element of the original
11335 list). Then the function `calls itself' with the @sc{cdr} of the list
11336 it is invoked with, which (the second time around) is the @sc{cdr} of
11337 the @sc{cdr} of the original list.
11338
11339 Note that although we say that the function `calls itself', what we
11340 mean is that the Lisp interpreter assembles and instructs a new
11341 instance of the program. The new instance is a clone of the first,
11342 but is a separate individual.
11343
11344 Each time the function `invokes itself', it invokes itself on a
11345 shorter version of the original list. It creates a new instance that
11346 works on a shorter list.
11347
11348 Eventually, the function invokes itself on an empty list. It creates
11349 a new instance whose argument is @code{nil}. The conditional expression
11350 tests the value of @code{list}. Since the value of @code{list} is
11351 @code{nil}, the @code{when} expression tests false so the then-part is
11352 not evaluated. The function as a whole then returns @code{nil}.
11353
11354 @need 1200
11355 When you evaluate the expression @code{(print-elements-recursively
11356 animals)} in the @file{*scratch*} buffer, you see this result:
11357
11358 @smallexample
11359 @group
11360 gazelle
11361
11362 giraffe
11363
11364 lion
11365
11366 tiger
11367 nil
11368 @end group
11369 @end smallexample
11370
11371 @need 2000
11372 @node Recursive triangle function
11373 @subsection Recursion in Place of a Counter
11374 @findex triangle-recursively
11375
11376 @need 1200
11377 The @code{triangle} function described in a previous section can also
11378 be written recursively. It looks like this:
11379
11380 @smallexample
11381 @group
11382 (defun triangle-recursively (number)
11383 "Return the sum of the numbers 1 through NUMBER inclusive.
11384 Uses recursion."
11385 (if (= number 1) ; @r{do-again-test}
11386 1 ; @r{then-part}
11387 (+ number ; @r{else-part}
11388 (triangle-recursively ; @r{recursive call}
11389 (1- number))))) ; @r{next-step-expression}
11390
11391 (triangle-recursively 7)
11392 @end group
11393 @end smallexample
11394
11395 @noindent
11396 You can install this function by evaluating it and then try it by
11397 evaluating @code{(triangle-recursively 7)}. (Remember to put your
11398 cursor immediately after the last parenthesis of the function
11399 definition, before the comment.) The function evaluates to 28.
11400
11401 To understand how this function works, let's consider what happens in the
11402 various cases when the function is passed 1, 2, 3, or 4 as the value of
11403 its argument.
11404
11405 @menu
11406 * Recursive Example arg of 1 or 2::
11407 * Recursive Example arg of 3 or 4::
11408 @end menu
11409
11410 @ifnottex
11411 @node Recursive Example arg of 1 or 2
11412 @unnumberedsubsubsec An argument of 1 or 2
11413 @end ifnottex
11414
11415 First, what happens if the value of the argument is 1?
11416
11417 The function has an @code{if} expression after the documentation
11418 string. It tests whether the value of @code{number} is equal to 1; if
11419 so, Emacs evaluates the then-part of the @code{if} expression, which
11420 returns the number 1 as the value of the function. (A triangle with
11421 one row has one pebble in it.)
11422
11423 Suppose, however, that the value of the argument is 2. In this case,
11424 Emacs evaluates the else-part of the @code{if} expression.
11425
11426 @need 1200
11427 The else-part consists of an addition, the recursive call to
11428 @code{triangle-recursively} and a decrementing action; and it looks like
11429 this:
11430
11431 @smallexample
11432 (+ number (triangle-recursively (1- number)))
11433 @end smallexample
11434
11435 When Emacs evaluates this expression, the innermost expression is
11436 evaluated first; then the other parts in sequence. Here are the steps
11437 in detail:
11438
11439 @table @i
11440 @item Step 1 @w{ } Evaluate the innermost expression.
11441
11442 The innermost expression is @code{(1- number)} so Emacs decrements the
11443 value of @code{number} from 2 to 1.
11444
11445 @item Step 2 @w{ } Evaluate the @code{triangle-recursively} function.
11446
11447 The Lisp interpreter creates an individual instance of
11448 @code{triangle-recursively}. It does not matter that this function is
11449 contained within itself. Emacs passes the result Step 1 as the
11450 argument used by this instance of the @code{triangle-recursively}
11451 function
11452
11453 In this case, Emacs evaluates @code{triangle-recursively} with an
11454 argument of 1. This means that this evaluation of
11455 @code{triangle-recursively} returns 1.
11456
11457 @item Step 3 @w{ } Evaluate the value of @code{number}.
11458
11459 The variable @code{number} is the second element of the list that
11460 starts with @code{+}; its value is 2.
11461
11462 @item Step 4 @w{ } Evaluate the @code{+} expression.
11463
11464 The @code{+} expression receives two arguments, the first
11465 from the evaluation of @code{number} (Step 3) and the second from the
11466 evaluation of @code{triangle-recursively} (Step 2).
11467
11468 The result of the addition is the sum of 2 plus 1, and the number 3 is
11469 returned, which is correct. A triangle with two rows has three
11470 pebbles in it.
11471 @end table
11472
11473 @node Recursive Example arg of 3 or 4
11474 @unnumberedsubsubsec An argument of 3 or 4
11475
11476 Suppose that @code{triangle-recursively} is called with an argument of
11477 3.
11478
11479 @table @i
11480 @item Step 1 @w{ } Evaluate the do-again-test.
11481
11482 The @code{if} expression is evaluated first. This is the do-again
11483 test and returns false, so the else-part of the @code{if} expression
11484 is evaluated. (Note that in this example, the do-again-test causes
11485 the function to call itself when it tests false, not when it tests
11486 true.)
11487
11488 @item Step 2 @w{ } Evaluate the innermost expression of the else-part.
11489
11490 The innermost expression of the else-part is evaluated, which decrements
11491 3 to 2. This is the next-step-expression.
11492
11493 @item Step 3 @w{ } Evaluate the @code{triangle-recursively} function.
11494
11495 The number 2 is passed to the @code{triangle-recursively} function.
11496
11497 We already know what happens when Emacs evaluates @code{triangle-recursively} with
11498 an argument of 2. After going through the sequence of actions described
11499 earlier, it returns a value of 3. So that is what will happen here.
11500
11501 @item Step 4 @w{ } Evaluate the addition.
11502
11503 3 will be passed as an argument to the addition and will be added to the
11504 number with which the function was called, which is 3.
11505 @end table
11506
11507 @noindent
11508 The value returned by the function as a whole will be 6.
11509
11510 Now that we know what will happen when @code{triangle-recursively} is
11511 called with an argument of 3, it is evident what will happen if it is
11512 called with an argument of 4:
11513
11514 @quotation
11515 @need 800
11516 In the recursive call, the evaluation of
11517
11518 @smallexample
11519 (triangle-recursively (1- 4))
11520 @end smallexample
11521
11522 @need 800
11523 @noindent
11524 will return the value of evaluating
11525
11526 @smallexample
11527 (triangle-recursively 3)
11528 @end smallexample
11529
11530 @noindent
11531 which is 6 and this value will be added to 4 by the addition in the
11532 third line.
11533 @end quotation
11534
11535 @noindent
11536 The value returned by the function as a whole will be 10.
11537
11538 Each time @code{triangle-recursively} is evaluated, it evaluates a
11539 version of itself---a different instance of itself---with a smaller
11540 argument, until the argument is small enough so that it does not
11541 evaluate itself.
11542
11543 Note that this particular design for a recursive function
11544 requires that operations be deferred.
11545
11546 Before @code{(triangle-recursively 7)} can calculate its answer, it
11547 must call @code{(triangle-recursively 6)}; and before
11548 @code{(triangle-recursively 6)} can calculate its answer, it must call
11549 @code{(triangle-recursively 5)}; and so on. That is to say, the
11550 calculation that @code{(triangle-recursively 7)} makes must be
11551 deferred until @code{(triangle-recursively 6)} makes its calculation;
11552 and @code{(triangle-recursively 6)} must defer until
11553 @code{(triangle-recursively 5)} completes; and so on.
11554
11555 If each of these instances of @code{triangle-recursively} are thought
11556 of as different robots, the first robot must wait for the second to
11557 complete its job, which must wait until the third completes, and so
11558 on.
11559
11560 There is a way around this kind of waiting, which we will discuss in
11561 @ref{No Deferment, , Recursion without Deferments}.
11562
11563 @node Recursion with cond
11564 @subsection Recursion Example Using @code{cond}
11565 @findex cond
11566
11567 The version of @code{triangle-recursively} described earlier is written
11568 with the @code{if} special form. It can also be written using another
11569 special form called @code{cond}. The name of the special form
11570 @code{cond} is an abbreviation of the word @samp{conditional}.
11571
11572 Although the @code{cond} special form is not used as often in the
11573 Emacs Lisp sources as @code{if}, it is used often enough to justify
11574 explaining it.
11575
11576 @need 800
11577 The template for a @code{cond} expression looks like this:
11578
11579 @smallexample
11580 @group
11581 (cond
11582 @var{body}@dots{})
11583 @end group
11584 @end smallexample
11585
11586 @noindent
11587 where the @var{body} is a series of lists.
11588
11589 @need 800
11590 Written out more fully, the template looks like this:
11591
11592 @smallexample
11593 @group
11594 (cond
11595 (@var{first-true-or-false-test} @var{first-consequent})
11596 (@var{second-true-or-false-test} @var{second-consequent})
11597 (@var{third-true-or-false-test} @var{third-consequent})
11598 @dots{})
11599 @end group
11600 @end smallexample
11601
11602 When the Lisp interpreter evaluates the @code{cond} expression, it
11603 evaluates the first element (the @sc{car} or true-or-false-test) of
11604 the first expression in a series of expressions within the body of the
11605 @code{cond}.
11606
11607 If the true-or-false-test returns @code{nil} the rest of that
11608 expression, the consequent, is skipped and the true-or-false-test of the
11609 next expression is evaluated. When an expression is found whose
11610 true-or-false-test returns a value that is not @code{nil}, the
11611 consequent of that expression is evaluated. The consequent can be one
11612 or more expressions. If the consequent consists of more than one
11613 expression, the expressions are evaluated in sequence and the value of
11614 the last one is returned. If the expression does not have a consequent,
11615 the value of the true-or-false-test is returned.
11616
11617 If none of the true-or-false-tests test true, the @code{cond} expression
11618 returns @code{nil}.
11619
11620 @need 1250
11621 Written using @code{cond}, the @code{triangle} function looks like this:
11622
11623 @smallexample
11624 @group
11625 (defun triangle-using-cond (number)
11626 (cond ((<= number 0) 0)
11627 ((= number 1) 1)
11628 ((> number 1)
11629 (+ number (triangle-using-cond (1- number))))))
11630 @end group
11631 @end smallexample
11632
11633 @noindent
11634 In this example, the @code{cond} returns 0 if the number is less than or
11635 equal to 0, it returns 1 if the number is 1 and it evaluates @code{(+
11636 number (triangle-using-cond (1- number)))} if the number is greater than
11637 1.
11638
11639 @node Recursive Patterns
11640 @subsection Recursive Patterns
11641 @cindex Recursive Patterns
11642
11643 Here are three common recursive patterns. Each involves a list.
11644 Recursion does not need to involve lists, but Lisp is designed for lists
11645 and this provides a sense of its primal capabilities.
11646
11647 @menu
11648 * Every::
11649 * Accumulate::
11650 * Keep::
11651 @end menu
11652
11653 @node Every
11654 @unnumberedsubsubsec Recursive Pattern: @emph{every}
11655 @cindex Every, type of recursive pattern
11656 @cindex Recursive pattern: every
11657
11658 In the @code{every} recursive pattern, an action is performed on every
11659 element of a list.
11660
11661 @need 1500
11662 The basic pattern is:
11663
11664 @itemize @bullet
11665 @item
11666 If a list be empty, return @code{nil}.
11667 @item
11668 Else, act on the beginning of the list (the @sc{car} of the list)
11669 @itemize @minus
11670 @item
11671 through a recursive call by the function on the rest (the
11672 @sc{cdr}) of the list,
11673 @item
11674 and, optionally, combine the acted-on element, using @code{cons},
11675 with the results of acting on the rest.
11676 @end itemize
11677 @end itemize
11678
11679 @need 1500
11680 Here is example:
11681
11682 @smallexample
11683 @group
11684 (defun square-each (numbers-list)
11685 "Square each of a NUMBERS LIST, recursively."
11686 (if (not numbers-list) ; do-again-test
11687 nil
11688 (cons
11689 (* (car numbers-list) (car numbers-list))
11690 (square-each (cdr numbers-list))))) ; next-step-expression
11691 @end group
11692
11693 @group
11694 (square-each '(1 2 3))
11695 @result{} (1 4 9)
11696 @end group
11697 @end smallexample
11698
11699 @need 1200
11700 @noindent
11701 If @code{numbers-list} is empty, do nothing. But if it has content,
11702 construct a list combining the square of the first number in the list
11703 with the result of the recursive call.
11704
11705 (The example follows the pattern exactly: @code{nil} is returned if
11706 the numbers' list is empty. In practice, you would write the
11707 conditional so it carries out the action when the numbers' list is not
11708 empty.)
11709
11710 The @code{print-elements-recursively} function (@pxref{Recursion with
11711 list, , Recursion with a List}) is another example of an @code{every}
11712 pattern, except in this case, rather than bring the results together
11713 using @code{cons}, we print each element of output.
11714
11715 @need 1250
11716 The @code{print-elements-recursively} function looks like this:
11717
11718 @smallexample
11719 @group
11720 (setq animals '(gazelle giraffe lion tiger))
11721 @end group
11722
11723 @group
11724 (defun print-elements-recursively (list)
11725 "Print each element of LIST on a line of its own.
11726 Uses recursion."
11727 (when list ; @r{do-again-test}
11728 (print (car list)) ; @r{body}
11729 (print-elements-recursively ; @r{recursive call}
11730 (cdr list)))) ; @r{next-step-expression}
11731
11732 (print-elements-recursively animals)
11733 @end group
11734 @end smallexample
11735
11736 @need 1500
11737 The pattern for @code{print-elements-recursively} is:
11738
11739 @itemize @bullet
11740 @item
11741 When the list is empty, do nothing.
11742 @item
11743 But when the list has at least one element,
11744 @itemize @minus
11745 @item
11746 act on the beginning of the list (the @sc{car} of the list),
11747 @item
11748 and make a recursive call on the rest (the @sc{cdr}) of the list.
11749 @end itemize
11750 @end itemize
11751
11752 @node Accumulate
11753 @unnumberedsubsubsec Recursive Pattern: @emph{accumulate}
11754 @cindex Accumulate, type of recursive pattern
11755 @cindex Recursive pattern: accumulate
11756
11757 Another recursive pattern is called the @code{accumulate} pattern. In
11758 the @code{accumulate} recursive pattern, an action is performed on
11759 every element of a list and the result of that action is accumulated
11760 with the results of performing the action on the other elements.
11761
11762 This is very like the `every' pattern using @code{cons}, except that
11763 @code{cons} is not used, but some other combiner.
11764
11765 @need 1500
11766 The pattern is:
11767
11768 @itemize @bullet
11769 @item
11770 If a list be empty, return zero or some other constant.
11771 @item
11772 Else, act on the beginning of the list (the @sc{car} of the list),
11773 @itemize @minus
11774 @item
11775 and combine that acted-on element, using @code{+} or
11776 some other combining function, with
11777 @item
11778 a recursive call by the function on the rest (the @sc{cdr}) of the list.
11779 @end itemize
11780 @end itemize
11781
11782 @need 1500
11783 Here is an example:
11784
11785 @smallexample
11786 @group
11787 (defun add-elements (numbers-list)
11788 "Add the elements of NUMBERS-LIST together."
11789 (if (not numbers-list)
11790 0
11791 (+ (car numbers-list) (add-elements (cdr numbers-list)))))
11792 @end group
11793
11794 @group
11795 (add-elements '(1 2 3 4))
11796 @result{} 10
11797 @end group
11798 @end smallexample
11799
11800 @xref{Files List, , Making a List of Files}, for an example of the
11801 accumulate pattern.
11802
11803 @node Keep
11804 @unnumberedsubsubsec Recursive Pattern: @emph{keep}
11805 @cindex Keep, type of recursive pattern
11806 @cindex Recursive pattern: keep
11807
11808 A third recursive pattern is called the @code{keep} pattern.
11809 In the @code{keep} recursive pattern, each element of a list is tested;
11810 the element is acted on and the results are kept only if the element
11811 meets a criterion.
11812
11813 Again, this is very like the `every' pattern, except the element is
11814 skipped unless it meets a criterion.
11815
11816 @need 1500
11817 The pattern has three parts:
11818
11819 @itemize @bullet
11820 @item
11821 If a list be empty, return @code{nil}.
11822 @item
11823 Else, if the beginning of the list (the @sc{car} of the list) passes
11824 a test
11825 @itemize @minus
11826 @item
11827 act on that element and combine it, using @code{cons} with
11828 @item
11829 a recursive call by the function on the rest (the @sc{cdr}) of the list.
11830 @end itemize
11831 @item
11832 Otherwise, if the beginning of the list (the @sc{car} of the list) fails
11833 the test
11834 @itemize @minus
11835 @item
11836 skip on that element,
11837 @item
11838 and, recursively call the function on the rest (the @sc{cdr}) of the list.
11839 @end itemize
11840 @end itemize
11841
11842 @need 1500
11843 Here is an example that uses @code{cond}:
11844
11845 @smallexample
11846 @group
11847 (defun keep-three-letter-words (word-list)
11848 "Keep three letter words in WORD-LIST."
11849 (cond
11850 ;; First do-again-test: stop-condition
11851 ((not word-list) nil)
11852
11853 ;; Second do-again-test: when to act
11854 ((eq 3 (length (symbol-name (car word-list))))
11855 ;; combine acted-on element with recursive call on shorter list
11856 (cons (car word-list) (keep-three-letter-words (cdr word-list))))
11857
11858 ;; Third do-again-test: when to skip element;
11859 ;; recursively call shorter list with next-step expression
11860 (t (keep-three-letter-words (cdr word-list)))))
11861 @end group
11862
11863 @group
11864 (keep-three-letter-words '(one two three four five six))
11865 @result{} (one two six)
11866 @end group
11867 @end smallexample
11868
11869 It goes without saying that you need not use @code{nil} as the test for
11870 when to stop; and you can, of course, combine these patterns.
11871
11872 @node No Deferment
11873 @subsection Recursion without Deferments
11874 @cindex Deferment in recursion
11875 @cindex Recursion without Deferments
11876
11877 Let's consider again what happens with the @code{triangle-recursively}
11878 function. We will find that the intermediate calculations are
11879 deferred until all can be done.
11880
11881 @need 800
11882 Here is the function definition:
11883
11884 @smallexample
11885 @group
11886 (defun triangle-recursively (number)
11887 "Return the sum of the numbers 1 through NUMBER inclusive.
11888 Uses recursion."
11889 (if (= number 1) ; @r{do-again-test}
11890 1 ; @r{then-part}
11891 (+ number ; @r{else-part}
11892 (triangle-recursively ; @r{recursive call}
11893 (1- number))))) ; @r{next-step-expression}
11894 @end group
11895 @end smallexample
11896
11897 What happens when we call this function with a argument of 7?
11898
11899 The first instance of the @code{triangle-recursively} function adds
11900 the number 7 to the value returned by a second instance of
11901 @code{triangle-recursively}, an instance that has been passed an
11902 argument of 6. That is to say, the first calculation is:
11903
11904 @smallexample
11905 (+ 7 (triangle-recursively 6))
11906 @end smallexample
11907
11908 @noindent
11909 The first instance of @code{triangle-recursively}---you may want to
11910 think of it as a little robot---cannot complete its job. It must hand
11911 off the calculation for @code{(triangle-recursively 6)} to a second
11912 instance of the program, to a second robot. This second individual is
11913 completely different from the first one; it is, in the jargon, a
11914 `different instantiation'. Or, put another way, it is a different
11915 robot. It is the same model as the first; it calculates triangle
11916 numbers recursively; but it has a different serial number.
11917
11918 And what does @code{(triangle-recursively 6)} return? It returns the
11919 number 6 added to the value returned by evaluating
11920 @code{triangle-recursively} with an argument of 5. Using the robot
11921 metaphor, it asks yet another robot to help it.
11922
11923 @need 800
11924 Now the total is:
11925
11926 @smallexample
11927 (+ 7 6 (triangle-recursively 5))
11928 @end smallexample
11929
11930 @need 800
11931 And what happens next?
11932
11933 @smallexample
11934 (+ 7 6 5 (triangle-recursively 4))
11935 @end smallexample
11936
11937 Each time @code{triangle-recursively} is called, except for the last
11938 time, it creates another instance of the program---another robot---and
11939 asks it to make a calculation.
11940
11941 @need 800
11942 Eventually, the full addition is set up and performed:
11943
11944 @smallexample
11945 (+ 7 6 5 4 3 2 1)
11946 @end smallexample
11947
11948 This design for the function defers the calculation of the first step
11949 until the second can be done, and defers that until the third can be
11950 done, and so on. Each deferment means the computer must remember what
11951 is being waited on. This is not a problem when there are only a few
11952 steps, as in this example. But it can be a problem when there are
11953 more steps.
11954
11955 @node No deferment solution
11956 @subsection No Deferment Solution
11957 @cindex No deferment solution
11958 @cindex Defermentless solution
11959 @cindex Solution without deferment
11960
11961 The solution to the problem of deferred operations is to write in a
11962 manner that does not defer operations@footnote{The phrase @dfn{tail
11963 recursive} is used to describe such a process, one that uses
11964 `constant space'.}. This requires
11965 writing to a different pattern, often one that involves writing two
11966 function definitions, an `initialization' function and a `helper'
11967 function.
11968
11969 The `initialization' function sets up the job; the `helper' function
11970 does the work.
11971
11972 @need 1200
11973 Here are the two function definitions for adding up numbers. They are
11974 so simple, I find them hard to understand.
11975
11976 @smallexample
11977 @group
11978 (defun triangle-initialization (number)
11979 "Return the sum of the numbers 1 through NUMBER inclusive.
11980 This is the `initialization' component of a two function
11981 duo that uses recursion."
11982 (triangle-recursive-helper 0 0 number))
11983 @end group
11984 @end smallexample
11985
11986 @smallexample
11987 @group
11988 (defun triangle-recursive-helper (sum counter number)
11989 "Return SUM, using COUNTER, through NUMBER inclusive.
11990 This is the `helper' component of a two function duo
11991 that uses recursion."
11992 (if (> counter number)
11993 sum
11994 (triangle-recursive-helper (+ sum counter) ; @r{sum}
11995 (1+ counter) ; @r{counter}
11996 number))) ; @r{number}
11997 @end group
11998 @end smallexample
11999
12000 @need 1250
12001 Install both function definitions by evaluating them, then call
12002 @code{triangle-initialization} with 2 rows:
12003
12004 @smallexample
12005 @group
12006 (triangle-initialization 2)
12007 @result{} 3
12008 @end group
12009 @end smallexample
12010
12011 The `initialization' function calls the first instance of the `helper'
12012 function with three arguments: zero, zero, and a number which is the
12013 number of rows in the triangle.
12014
12015 The first two arguments passed to the `helper' function are
12016 initialization values. These values are changed when
12017 @code{triangle-recursive-helper} invokes new instances.@footnote{The
12018 jargon is mildly confusing: @code{triangle-recursive-helper} uses a
12019 process that is iterative in a procedure that is recursive. The
12020 process is called iterative because the computer need only record the
12021 three values, @code{sum}, @code{counter}, and @code{number}; the
12022 procedure is recursive because the function `calls itself'. On the
12023 other hand, both the process and the procedure used by
12024 @code{triangle-recursively} are called recursive. The word
12025 `recursive' has different meanings in the two contexts.}
12026
12027 Let's see what happens when we have a triangle that has one row. (This
12028 triangle will have one pebble in it!)
12029
12030 @need 1200
12031 @code{triangle-initialization} will call its helper with
12032 the arguments @w{@code{0 0 1}}. That function will run the conditional
12033 test whether @code{(> counter number)}:
12034
12035 @smallexample
12036 (> 0 1)
12037 @end smallexample
12038
12039 @need 1200
12040 @noindent
12041 and find that the result is false, so it will invoke
12042 the else-part of the @code{if} clause:
12043
12044 @smallexample
12045 @group
12046 (triangle-recursive-helper
12047 (+ sum counter) ; @r{sum plus counter} @result{} @r{sum}
12048 (1+ counter) ; @r{increment counter} @result{} @r{counter}
12049 number) ; @r{number stays the same}
12050 @end group
12051 @end smallexample
12052
12053 @need 800
12054 @noindent
12055 which will first compute:
12056
12057 @smallexample
12058 @group
12059 (triangle-recursive-helper (+ 0 0) ; @r{sum}
12060 (1+ 0) ; @r{counter}
12061 1) ; @r{number}
12062 @exdent which is:
12063
12064 (triangle-recursive-helper 0 1 1)
12065 @end group
12066 @end smallexample
12067
12068 Again, @code{(> counter number)} will be false, so again, the Lisp
12069 interpreter will evaluate @code{triangle-recursive-helper}, creating a
12070 new instance with new arguments.
12071
12072 @need 800
12073 This new instance will be;
12074
12075 @smallexample
12076 @group
12077 (triangle-recursive-helper
12078 (+ sum counter) ; @r{sum plus counter} @result{} @r{sum}
12079 (1+ counter) ; @r{increment counter} @result{} @r{counter}
12080 number) ; @r{number stays the same}
12081
12082 @exdent which is:
12083
12084 (triangle-recursive-helper 1 2 1)
12085 @end group
12086 @end smallexample
12087
12088 In this case, the @code{(> counter number)} test will be true! So the
12089 instance will return the value of the sum, which will be 1, as
12090 expected.
12091
12092 Now, let's pass @code{triangle-initialization} an argument
12093 of 2, to find out how many pebbles there are in a triangle with two rows.
12094
12095 That function calls @code{(triangle-recursive-helper 0 0 2)}.
12096
12097 @need 800
12098 In stages, the instances called will be:
12099
12100 @smallexample
12101 @group
12102 @r{sum counter number}
12103 (triangle-recursive-helper 0 1 2)
12104
12105 (triangle-recursive-helper 1 2 2)
12106
12107 (triangle-recursive-helper 3 3 2)
12108 @end group
12109 @end smallexample
12110
12111 When the last instance is called, the @code{(> counter number)} test
12112 will be true, so the instance will return the value of @code{sum},
12113 which will be 3.
12114
12115 This kind of pattern helps when you are writing functions that can use
12116 many resources in a computer.
12117
12118 @need 1500
12119 @node Looping exercise
12120 @section Looping Exercise
12121
12122 @itemize @bullet
12123 @item
12124 Write a function similar to @code{triangle} in which each row has a
12125 value which is the square of the row number. Use a @code{while} loop.
12126
12127 @item
12128 Write a function similar to @code{triangle} that multiplies instead of
12129 adds the values.
12130
12131 @item
12132 Rewrite these two functions recursively. Rewrite these functions
12133 using @code{cond}.
12134
12135 @c comma in printed title causes problem in Info cross reference
12136 @item
12137 Write a function for Texinfo mode that creates an index entry at the
12138 beginning of a paragraph for every @samp{@@dfn} within the paragraph.
12139 (In a Texinfo file, @samp{@@dfn} marks a definition. This book is
12140 written in Texinfo.)
12141
12142 Many of the functions you will need are described in two of the
12143 previous chapters, @ref{Cutting & Storing Text, , Cutting and Storing
12144 Text}, and @ref{Yanking, , Yanking Text Back}. If you use
12145 @code{forward-paragraph} to put the index entry at the beginning of
12146 the paragraph, you will have to use @w{@kbd{C-h f}}
12147 (@code{describe-function}) to find out how to make the command go
12148 backwards.
12149
12150 For more information, see
12151 @ifinfo
12152 @ref{Indicating, , Indicating Definitions, texinfo}.
12153 @end ifinfo
12154 @ifhtml
12155 @ref{Indicating, , Indicating, texinfo, Texinfo Manual}, which goes to
12156 a Texinfo manual in the current directory. Or, if you are on the
12157 Internet, see
12158 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo/manual/texinfo/}
12159 @end ifhtml
12160 @iftex
12161 ``Indicating Definitions, Commands, etc.'' in @cite{Texinfo, The GNU
12162 Documentation Format}.
12163 @end iftex
12164 @end itemize
12165
12166 @node Regexp Search
12167 @chapter Regular Expression Searches
12168 @cindex Searches, illustrating
12169 @cindex Regular expression searches
12170 @cindex Patterns, searching for
12171 @cindex Motion by sentence and paragraph
12172 @cindex Sentences, movement by
12173 @cindex Paragraphs, movement by
12174
12175 Regular expression searches are used extensively in GNU Emacs. The
12176 two functions, @code{forward-sentence} and @code{forward-paragraph},
12177 illustrate these searches well. They use regular expressions to find
12178 where to move point. The phrase `regular expression' is often written
12179 as `regexp'.
12180
12181 Regular expression searches are described in @ref{Regexp Search, ,
12182 Regular Expression Search, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}, as well as in
12183 @ref{Regular Expressions, , , elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference
12184 Manual}. In writing this chapter, I am presuming that you have at
12185 least a mild acquaintance with them. The major point to remember is
12186 that regular expressions permit you to search for patterns as well as
12187 for literal strings of characters. For example, the code in
12188 @code{forward-sentence} searches for the pattern of possible
12189 characters that could mark the end of a sentence, and moves point to
12190 that spot.
12191
12192 Before looking at the code for the @code{forward-sentence} function, it
12193 is worth considering what the pattern that marks the end of a sentence
12194 must be. The pattern is discussed in the next section; following that
12195 is a description of the regular expression search function,
12196 @code{re-search-forward}. The @code{forward-sentence} function
12197 is described in the section following. Finally, the
12198 @code{forward-paragraph} function is described in the last section of
12199 this chapter. @code{forward-paragraph} is a complex function that
12200 introduces several new features.
12201
12202 @menu
12203 * sentence-end:: The regular expression for @code{sentence-end}.
12204 * re-search-forward:: Very similar to @code{search-forward}.
12205 * forward-sentence:: A straightforward example of regexp search.
12206 * forward-paragraph:: A somewhat complex example.
12207 * etags:: How to create your own @file{TAGS} table.
12208 * Regexp Review::
12209 * re-search Exercises::
12210 @end menu
12211
12212 @node sentence-end
12213 @section The Regular Expression for @code{sentence-end}
12214 @findex sentence-end
12215
12216 The symbol @code{sentence-end} is bound to the pattern that marks the
12217 end of a sentence. What should this regular expression be?
12218
12219 Clearly, a sentence may be ended by a period, a question mark, or an
12220 exclamation mark. Indeed, in English, only clauses that end with one
12221 of those three characters should be considered the end of a sentence.
12222 This means that the pattern should include the character set:
12223
12224 @smallexample
12225 [.?!]
12226 @end smallexample
12227
12228 However, we do not want @code{forward-sentence} merely to jump to a
12229 period, a question mark, or an exclamation mark, because such a character
12230 might be used in the middle of a sentence. A period, for example, is
12231 used after abbreviations. So other information is needed.
12232
12233 According to convention, you type two spaces after every sentence, but
12234 only one space after a period, a question mark, or an exclamation mark in
12235 the body of a sentence. So a period, a question mark, or an exclamation
12236 mark followed by two spaces is a good indicator of an end of sentence.
12237 However, in a file, the two spaces may instead be a tab or the end of a
12238 line. This means that the regular expression should include these three
12239 items as alternatives.
12240
12241 @need 800
12242 This group of alternatives will look like this:
12243
12244 @smallexample
12245 @group
12246 \\($\\| \\| \\)
12247 ^ ^^
12248 TAB SPC
12249 @end group
12250 @end smallexample
12251
12252 @noindent
12253 Here, @samp{$} indicates the end of the line, and I have pointed out
12254 where the tab and two spaces are inserted in the expression. Both are
12255 inserted by putting the actual characters into the expression.
12256
12257 Two backslashes, @samp{\\}, are required before the parentheses and
12258 vertical bars: the first backslash quotes the following backslash in
12259 Emacs; and the second indicates that the following character, the
12260 parenthesis or the vertical bar, is special.
12261
12262 @need 1000
12263 Also, a sentence may be followed by one or more carriage returns, like
12264 this:
12265
12266 @smallexample
12267 @group
12268 [
12269 ]*
12270 @end group
12271 @end smallexample
12272
12273 @noindent
12274 Like tabs and spaces, a carriage return is inserted into a regular
12275 expression by inserting it literally. The asterisk indicates that the
12276 @key{RET} is repeated zero or more times.
12277
12278 But a sentence end does not consist only of a period, a question mark or
12279 an exclamation mark followed by appropriate space: a closing quotation
12280 mark or a closing brace of some kind may precede the space. Indeed more
12281 than one such mark or brace may precede the space. These require a
12282 expression that looks like this:
12283
12284 @smallexample
12285 []\"')@}]*
12286 @end smallexample
12287
12288 In this expression, the first @samp{]} is the first character in the
12289 expression; the second character is @samp{"}, which is preceded by a
12290 @samp{\} to tell Emacs the @samp{"} is @emph{not} special. The last
12291 three characters are @samp{'}, @samp{)}, and @samp{@}}.
12292
12293 All this suggests what the regular expression pattern for matching the
12294 end of a sentence should be; and, indeed, if we evaluate
12295 @code{sentence-end} we find that it returns the following value:
12296
12297 @smallexample
12298 @group
12299 sentence-end
12300 @result{} "[.?!][]\"')@}]*\\($\\| \\| \\)[
12301 ]*"
12302 @end group
12303 @end smallexample
12304
12305 @noindent
12306 (Well, not in GNU Emacs 22; that is because of an effort to make the
12307 process simpler and to handle more glyphs and languages. When the
12308 value of @code{sentence-end} is @code{nil}, then use the value defined
12309 by the function @code{sentence-end}. (Here is a use of the difference
12310 between a value and a function in Emacs Lisp.) The function returns a
12311 value constructed from the variables @code{sentence-end-base},
12312 @code{sentence-end-double-space}, @code{sentence-end-without-period},
12313 and @code{sentence-end-without-space}. The critical variable is
12314 @code{sentence-end-base}; its global value is similar to the one
12315 described above but it also contains two additional quotation marks.
12316 These have differing degrees of curliness. The
12317 @code{sentence-end-without-period} variable, when true, tells Emacs
12318 that a sentence may end without a period, such as text in Thai.)
12319
12320 @ignore
12321 @noindent
12322 (Note that here the @key{TAB}, two spaces, and @key{RET} are shown
12323 literally in the pattern.)
12324
12325 This regular expression can be deciphered as follows:
12326
12327 @table @code
12328 @item [.?!]
12329 The first part of the pattern is the three characters, a period, a question
12330 mark and an exclamation mark, within square brackets. The pattern must
12331 begin with one or other of these characters.
12332
12333 @item []\"')@}]*
12334 The second part of the pattern is the group of closing braces and
12335 quotation marks, which can appear zero or more times. These may follow
12336 the period, question mark or exclamation mark. In a regular expression,
12337 the backslash, @samp{\}, followed by the double quotation mark,
12338 @samp{"}, indicates the class of string-quote characters. Usually, the
12339 double quotation mark is the only character in this class. The
12340 asterisk, @samp{*}, indicates that the items in the previous group (the
12341 group surrounded by square brackets, @samp{[]}) may be repeated zero or
12342 more times.
12343
12344 @item \\($\\| \\| \\)
12345 The third part of the pattern is one or other of: either the end of a
12346 line, or two blank spaces, or a tab. The double back-slashes are used
12347 to prevent Emacs from reading the parentheses and vertical bars as part
12348 of the search pattern; the parentheses are used to mark the group and
12349 the vertical bars are used to indicated that the patterns to either side
12350 of them are alternatives. The dollar sign is used to indicate the end
12351 of a line and both the two spaces and the tab are each inserted as is to
12352 indicate what they are.
12353
12354 @item [@key{RET}]*
12355 Finally, the last part of the pattern indicates that the end of the line
12356 or the whitespace following the period, question mark or exclamation
12357 mark may, but need not, be followed by one or more carriage returns. In
12358 the pattern, the carriage return is inserted as an actual carriage
12359 return between square brackets but here it is shown as @key{RET}.
12360 @end table
12361 @end ignore
12362
12363 @node re-search-forward
12364 @section The @code{re-search-forward} Function
12365 @findex re-search-forward
12366
12367 The @code{re-search-forward} function is very like the
12368 @code{search-forward} function. (@xref{search-forward, , The
12369 @code{search-forward} Function}.)
12370
12371 @code{re-search-forward} searches for a regular expression. If the
12372 search is successful, it leaves point immediately after the last
12373 character in the target. If the search is backwards, it leaves point
12374 just before the first character in the target. You may tell
12375 @code{re-search-forward} to return @code{t} for true. (Moving point
12376 is therefore a `side effect'.)
12377
12378 Like @code{search-forward}, the @code{re-search-forward} function takes
12379 four arguments:
12380
12381 @enumerate
12382 @item
12383 The first argument is the regular expression that the function searches
12384 for. The regular expression will be a string between quotation marks.
12385
12386 @item
12387 The optional second argument limits how far the function will search; it is a
12388 bound, which is specified as a position in the buffer.
12389
12390 @item
12391 The optional third argument specifies how the function responds to
12392 failure: @code{nil} as the third argument causes the function to
12393 signal an error (and print a message) when the search fails; any other
12394 value causes it to return @code{nil} if the search fails and @code{t}
12395 if the search succeeds.
12396
12397 @item
12398 The optional fourth argument is the repeat count. A negative repeat
12399 count causes @code{re-search-forward} to search backwards.
12400 @end enumerate
12401
12402 @need 800
12403 The template for @code{re-search-forward} looks like this:
12404
12405 @smallexample
12406 @group
12407 (re-search-forward "@var{regular-expression}"
12408 @var{limit-of-search}
12409 @var{what-to-do-if-search-fails}
12410 @var{repeat-count})
12411 @end group
12412 @end smallexample
12413
12414 The second, third, and fourth arguments are optional. However, if you
12415 want to pass a value to either or both of the last two arguments, you
12416 must also pass a value to all the preceding arguments. Otherwise, the
12417 Lisp interpreter will mistake which argument you are passing the value
12418 to.
12419
12420 @need 1200
12421 In the @code{forward-sentence} function, the regular expression will be
12422 the value of the variable @code{sentence-end}. In simple form, that is:
12423
12424 @smallexample
12425 @group
12426 "[.?!][]\"')@}]*\\($\\| \\| \\)[
12427 ]*"
12428 @end group
12429 @end smallexample
12430
12431 @noindent
12432 The limit of the search will be the end of the paragraph (since a
12433 sentence cannot go beyond a paragraph). If the search fails, the
12434 function will return @code{nil}; and the repeat count will be provided
12435 by the argument to the @code{forward-sentence} function.
12436
12437 @node forward-sentence
12438 @section @code{forward-sentence}
12439 @findex forward-sentence
12440
12441 The command to move the cursor forward a sentence is a straightforward
12442 illustration of how to use regular expression searches in Emacs Lisp.
12443 Indeed, the function looks longer and more complicated than it is; this
12444 is because the function is designed to go backwards as well as forwards;
12445 and, optionally, over more than one sentence. The function is usually
12446 bound to the key command @kbd{M-e}.
12447
12448 @menu
12449 * Complete forward-sentence::
12450 * fwd-sentence while loops:: Two @code{while} loops.
12451 * fwd-sentence re-search:: A regular expression search.
12452 @end menu
12453
12454 @ifnottex
12455 @node Complete forward-sentence
12456 @unnumberedsubsec Complete @code{forward-sentence} function definition
12457 @end ifnottex
12458
12459 @need 1250
12460 Here is the code for @code{forward-sentence}:
12461
12462 @c in GNU Emacs 22
12463 @smallexample
12464 @group
12465 (defun forward-sentence (&optional arg)
12466 "Move forward to next `sentence-end'. With argument, repeat.
12467 With negative argument, move backward repeatedly to `sentence-beginning'.
12468
12469 The variable `sentence-end' is a regular expression that matches ends of
12470 sentences. Also, every paragraph boundary terminates sentences as well."
12471 @end group
12472 @group
12473 (interactive "p")
12474 (or arg (setq arg 1))
12475 (let ((opoint (point))
12476 (sentence-end (sentence-end)))
12477 (while (< arg 0)
12478 (let ((pos (point))
12479 (par-beg (save-excursion (start-of-paragraph-text) (point))))
12480 (if (and (re-search-backward sentence-end par-beg t)
12481 (or (< (match-end 0) pos)
12482 (re-search-backward sentence-end par-beg t)))
12483 (goto-char (match-end 0))
12484 (goto-char par-beg)))
12485 (setq arg (1+ arg)))
12486 @end group
12487 @group
12488 (while (> arg 0)
12489 (let ((par-end (save-excursion (end-of-paragraph-text) (point))))
12490 (if (re-search-forward sentence-end par-end t)
12491 (skip-chars-backward " \t\n")
12492 (goto-char par-end)))
12493 (setq arg (1- arg)))
12494 (constrain-to-field nil opoint t)))
12495 @end group
12496 @end smallexample
12497
12498 @ignore
12499 GNU Emacs 21
12500 @smallexample
12501 @group
12502 (defun forward-sentence (&optional arg)
12503 "Move forward to next sentence-end. With argument, repeat.
12504 With negative argument, move backward repeatedly to sentence-beginning.
12505 Sentence ends are identified by the value of sentence-end
12506 treated as a regular expression. Also, every paragraph boundary
12507 terminates sentences as well."
12508 @end group
12509 @group
12510 (interactive "p")
12511 (or arg (setq arg 1))
12512 (while (< arg 0)
12513 (let ((par-beg
12514 (save-excursion (start-of-paragraph-text) (point))))
12515 (if (re-search-backward
12516 (concat sentence-end "[^ \t\n]") par-beg t)
12517 (goto-char (1- (match-end 0)))
12518 (goto-char par-beg)))
12519 (setq arg (1+ arg)))
12520 (while (> arg 0)
12521 (let ((par-end
12522 (save-excursion (end-of-paragraph-text) (point))))
12523 (if (re-search-forward sentence-end par-end t)
12524 (skip-chars-backward " \t\n")
12525 (goto-char par-end)))
12526 (setq arg (1- arg))))
12527 @end group
12528 @end smallexample
12529 @end ignore
12530
12531 The function looks long at first sight and it is best to look at its
12532 skeleton first, and then its muscle. The way to see the skeleton is to
12533 look at the expressions that start in the left-most columns:
12534
12535 @smallexample
12536 @group
12537 (defun forward-sentence (&optional arg)
12538 "@var{documentation}@dots{}"
12539 (interactive "p")
12540 (or arg (setq arg 1))
12541 (let ((opoint (point)) (sentence-end (sentence-end)))
12542 (while (< arg 0)
12543 (let ((pos (point))
12544 (par-beg (save-excursion (start-of-paragraph-text) (point))))
12545 @var{rest-of-body-of-while-loop-when-going-backwards}
12546 (while (> arg 0)
12547 (let ((par-end (save-excursion (end-of-paragraph-text) (point))))
12548 @var{rest-of-body-of-while-loop-when-going-forwards}
12549 @var{handle-forms-and-equivalent}
12550 @end group
12551 @end smallexample
12552
12553 This looks much simpler! The function definition consists of
12554 documentation, an @code{interactive} expression, an @code{or}
12555 expression, a @code{let} expression, and @code{while} loops.
12556
12557 Let's look at each of these parts in turn.
12558
12559 We note that the documentation is thorough and understandable.
12560
12561 The function has an @code{interactive "p"} declaration. This means
12562 that the processed prefix argument, if any, is passed to the
12563 function as its argument. (This will be a number.) If the function
12564 is not passed an argument (it is optional) then the argument
12565 @code{arg} will be bound to 1.
12566
12567 When @code{forward-sentence} is called non-interactively without an
12568 argument, @code{arg} is bound to @code{nil}. The @code{or} expression
12569 handles this. What it does is either leave the value of @code{arg} as
12570 it is, but only if @code{arg} is bound to a value; or it sets the
12571 value of @code{arg} to 1, in the case when @code{arg} is bound to
12572 @code{nil}.
12573
12574 Next is a @code{let}. That specifies the values of two local
12575 variables, @code{point} and @code{sentence-end}. The local value of
12576 point, from before the search, is used in the
12577 @code{constrain-to-field} function which handles forms and
12578 equivalents. The @code{sentence-end} variable is set by the
12579 @code{sentence-end} function.
12580
12581 @node fwd-sentence while loops
12582 @unnumberedsubsec The @code{while} loops
12583
12584 Two @code{while} loops follow. The first @code{while} has a
12585 true-or-false-test that tests true if the prefix argument for
12586 @code{forward-sentence} is a negative number. This is for going
12587 backwards. The body of this loop is similar to the body of the second
12588 @code{while} clause, but it is not exactly the same. We will skip
12589 this @code{while} loop and concentrate on the second @code{while}
12590 loop.
12591
12592 @need 1500
12593 The second @code{while} loop is for moving point forward. Its skeleton
12594 looks like this:
12595
12596 @smallexample
12597 @group
12598 (while (> arg 0) ; @r{true-or-false-test}
12599 (let @var{varlist}
12600 (if (@var{true-or-false-test})
12601 @var{then-part}
12602 @var{else-part}
12603 (setq arg (1- arg)))) ; @code{while} @r{loop decrementer}
12604 @end group
12605 @end smallexample
12606
12607 The @code{while} loop is of the decrementing kind.
12608 (@xref{Decrementing Loop, , A Loop with a Decrementing Counter}.) It
12609 has a true-or-false-test that tests true so long as the counter (in
12610 this case, the variable @code{arg}) is greater than zero; and it has a
12611 decrementer that subtracts 1 from the value of the counter every time
12612 the loop repeats.
12613
12614 If no prefix argument is given to @code{forward-sentence}, which is
12615 the most common way the command is used, this @code{while} loop will
12616 run once, since the value of @code{arg} will be 1.
12617
12618 The body of the @code{while} loop consists of a @code{let} expression,
12619 which creates and binds a local variable, and has, as its body, an
12620 @code{if} expression.
12621
12622 @need 1250
12623 The body of the @code{while} loop looks like this:
12624
12625 @smallexample
12626 @group
12627 (let ((par-end
12628 (save-excursion (end-of-paragraph-text) (point))))
12629 (if (re-search-forward sentence-end par-end t)
12630 (skip-chars-backward " \t\n")
12631 (goto-char par-end)))
12632 @end group
12633 @end smallexample
12634
12635 The @code{let} expression creates and binds the local variable
12636 @code{par-end}. As we shall see, this local variable is designed to
12637 provide a bound or limit to the regular expression search. If the
12638 search fails to find a proper sentence ending in the paragraph, it will
12639 stop on reaching the end of the paragraph.
12640
12641 But first, let us examine how @code{par-end} is bound to the value of
12642 the end of the paragraph. What happens is that the @code{let} sets the
12643 value of @code{par-end} to the value returned when the Lisp interpreter
12644 evaluates the expression
12645
12646 @smallexample
12647 @group
12648 (save-excursion (end-of-paragraph-text) (point))
12649 @end group
12650 @end smallexample
12651
12652 @noindent
12653 In this expression, @code{(end-of-paragraph-text)} moves point to the
12654 end of the paragraph, @code{(point)} returns the value of point, and then
12655 @code{save-excursion} restores point to its original position. Thus,
12656 the @code{let} binds @code{par-end} to the value returned by the
12657 @code{save-excursion} expression, which is the position of the end of
12658 the paragraph. (The @code{end-of-paragraph-text} function uses
12659 @code{forward-paragraph}, which we will discuss shortly.)
12660
12661 @need 1200
12662 Emacs next evaluates the body of the @code{let}, which is an @code{if}
12663 expression that looks like this:
12664
12665 @smallexample
12666 @group
12667 (if (re-search-forward sentence-end par-end t) ; @r{if-part}
12668 (skip-chars-backward " \t\n") ; @r{then-part}
12669 (goto-char par-end))) ; @r{else-part}
12670 @end group
12671 @end smallexample
12672
12673 The @code{if} tests whether its first argument is true and if so,
12674 evaluates its then-part; otherwise, the Emacs Lisp interpreter
12675 evaluates the else-part. The true-or-false-test of the @code{if}
12676 expression is the regular expression search.
12677
12678 It may seem odd to have what looks like the `real work' of
12679 the @code{forward-sentence} function buried here, but this is a common
12680 way this kind of operation is carried out in Lisp.
12681
12682 @node fwd-sentence re-search
12683 @unnumberedsubsec The regular expression search
12684
12685 The @code{re-search-forward} function searches for the end of the
12686 sentence, that is, for the pattern defined by the @code{sentence-end}
12687 regular expression. If the pattern is found---if the end of the sentence is
12688 found---then the @code{re-search-forward} function does two things:
12689
12690 @enumerate
12691 @item
12692 The @code{re-search-forward} function carries out a side effect, which
12693 is to move point to the end of the occurrence found.
12694
12695 @item
12696 The @code{re-search-forward} function returns a value of true. This is
12697 the value received by the @code{if}, and means that the search was
12698 successful.
12699 @end enumerate
12700
12701 @noindent
12702 The side effect, the movement of point, is completed before the
12703 @code{if} function is handed the value returned by the successful
12704 conclusion of the search.
12705
12706 When the @code{if} function receives the value of true from a successful
12707 call to @code{re-search-forward}, the @code{if} evaluates the then-part,
12708 which is the expression @code{(skip-chars-backward " \t\n")}. This
12709 expression moves backwards over any blank spaces, tabs or carriage
12710 returns until a printed character is found and then leaves point after
12711 the character. Since point has already been moved to the end of the
12712 pattern that marks the end of the sentence, this action leaves point
12713 right after the closing printed character of the sentence, which is
12714 usually a period.
12715
12716 On the other hand, if the @code{re-search-forward} function fails to
12717 find a pattern marking the end of the sentence, the function returns
12718 false. The false then causes the @code{if} to evaluate its third
12719 argument, which is @code{(goto-char par-end)}: it moves point to the
12720 end of the paragraph.
12721
12722 (And if the text is in a form or equivalent, and point may not move
12723 fully, then the @code{constrain-to-field} function comes into play.)
12724
12725 Regular expression searches are exceptionally useful and the pattern
12726 illustrated by @code{re-search-forward}, in which the search is the
12727 test of an @code{if} expression, is handy. You will see or write code
12728 incorporating this pattern often.
12729
12730 @node forward-paragraph
12731 @section @code{forward-paragraph}: a Goldmine of Functions
12732 @findex forward-paragraph
12733
12734 @ignore
12735 @c in GNU Emacs 22
12736 (defun forward-paragraph (&optional arg)
12737 "Move forward to end of paragraph.
12738 With argument ARG, do it ARG times;
12739 a negative argument ARG = -N means move backward N paragraphs.
12740
12741 A line which `paragraph-start' matches either separates paragraphs
12742 \(if `paragraph-separate' matches it also) or is the first line of a paragraph.
12743 A paragraph end is the beginning of a line which is not part of the paragraph
12744 to which the end of the previous line belongs, or the end of the buffer.
12745 Returns the count of paragraphs left to move."
12746 (interactive "p")
12747 (or arg (setq arg 1))
12748 (let* ((opoint (point))
12749 (fill-prefix-regexp
12750 (and fill-prefix (not (equal fill-prefix ""))
12751 (not paragraph-ignore-fill-prefix)
12752 (regexp-quote fill-prefix)))
12753 ;; Remove ^ from paragraph-start and paragraph-sep if they are there.
12754 ;; These regexps shouldn't be anchored, because we look for them
12755 ;; starting at the left-margin. This allows paragraph commands to
12756 ;; work normally with indented text.
12757 ;; This hack will not find problem cases like "whatever\\|^something".
12758 (parstart (if (and (not (equal "" paragraph-start))
12759 (equal ?^ (aref paragraph-start 0)))
12760 (substring paragraph-start 1)
12761 paragraph-start))
12762 (parsep (if (and (not (equal "" paragraph-separate))
12763 (equal ?^ (aref paragraph-separate 0)))
12764 (substring paragraph-separate 1)
12765 paragraph-separate))
12766 (parsep
12767 (if fill-prefix-regexp
12768 (concat parsep "\\|"
12769 fill-prefix-regexp "[ \t]*$")
12770 parsep))
12771 ;; This is used for searching.
12772 (sp-parstart (concat "^[ \t]*\\(?:" parstart "\\|" parsep "\\)"))
12773 start found-start)
12774 (while (and (< arg 0) (not (bobp)))
12775 (if (and (not (looking-at parsep))
12776 (re-search-backward "^\n" (max (1- (point)) (point-min)) t)
12777 (looking-at parsep))
12778 (setq arg (1+ arg))
12779 (setq start (point))
12780 ;; Move back over paragraph-separating lines.
12781 (forward-char -1) (beginning-of-line)
12782 (while (and (not (bobp))
12783 (progn (move-to-left-margin)
12784 (looking-at parsep)))
12785 (forward-line -1))
12786 (if (bobp)
12787 nil
12788 (setq arg (1+ arg))
12789 ;; Go to end of the previous (non-separating) line.
12790 (end-of-line)
12791 ;; Search back for line that starts or separates paragraphs.
12792 (if (if fill-prefix-regexp
12793 ;; There is a fill prefix; it overrides parstart.
12794 (let (multiple-lines)
12795 (while (and (progn (beginning-of-line) (not (bobp)))
12796 (progn (move-to-left-margin)
12797 (not (looking-at parsep)))
12798 (looking-at fill-prefix-regexp))
12799 (unless (= (point) start)
12800 (setq multiple-lines t))
12801 (forward-line -1))
12802 (move-to-left-margin)
12803 ;; This deleted code caused a long hanging-indent line
12804 ;; not to be filled together with the following lines.
12805 ;; ;; Don't move back over a line before the paragraph
12806 ;; ;; which doesn't start with fill-prefix
12807 ;; ;; unless that is the only line we've moved over.
12808 ;; (and (not (looking-at fill-prefix-regexp))
12809 ;; multiple-lines
12810 ;; (forward-line 1))
12811 (not (bobp)))
12812 (while (and (re-search-backward sp-parstart nil 1)
12813 (setq found-start t)
12814 ;; Found a candidate, but need to check if it is a
12815 ;; REAL parstart.
12816 (progn (setq start (point))
12817 (move-to-left-margin)
12818 (not (looking-at parsep)))
12819 (not (and (looking-at parstart)
12820 (or (not use-hard-newlines)
12821 (bobp)
12822 (get-text-property
12823 (1- start) 'hard)))))
12824 (setq found-start nil)
12825 (goto-char start))
12826 found-start)
12827 ;; Found one.
12828 (progn
12829 ;; Move forward over paragraph separators.
12830 ;; We know this cannot reach the place we started
12831 ;; because we know we moved back over a non-separator.
12832 (while (and (not (eobp))
12833 (progn (move-to-left-margin)
12834 (looking-at parsep)))
12835 (forward-line 1))
12836 ;; If line before paragraph is just margin, back up to there.
12837 (end-of-line 0)
12838 (if (> (current-column) (current-left-margin))
12839 (forward-char 1)
12840 (skip-chars-backward " \t")
12841 (if (not (bolp))
12842 (forward-line 1))))
12843 ;; No starter or separator line => use buffer beg.
12844 (goto-char (point-min))))))
12845
12846 (while (and (> arg 0) (not (eobp)))
12847 ;; Move forward over separator lines...
12848 (while (and (not (eobp))
12849 (progn (move-to-left-margin) (not (eobp)))
12850 (looking-at parsep))
12851 (forward-line 1))
12852 (unless (eobp) (setq arg (1- arg)))
12853 ;; ... and one more line.
12854 (forward-line 1)
12855 (if fill-prefix-regexp
12856 ;; There is a fill prefix; it overrides parstart.
12857 (while (and (not (eobp))
12858 (progn (move-to-left-margin) (not (eobp)))
12859 (not (looking-at parsep))
12860 (looking-at fill-prefix-regexp))
12861 (forward-line 1))
12862 (while (and (re-search-forward sp-parstart nil 1)
12863 (progn (setq start (match-beginning 0))
12864 (goto-char start)
12865 (not (eobp)))
12866 (progn (move-to-left-margin)
12867 (not (looking-at parsep)))
12868 (or (not (looking-at parstart))
12869 (and use-hard-newlines
12870 (not (get-text-property (1- start) 'hard)))))
12871 (forward-char 1))
12872 (if (< (point) (point-max))
12873 (goto-char start))))
12874 (constrain-to-field nil opoint t)
12875 ;; Return the number of steps that could not be done.
12876 arg))
12877 @end ignore
12878
12879 The @code{forward-paragraph} function moves point forward to the end
12880 of the paragraph. It is usually bound to @kbd{M-@}} and makes use of a
12881 number of functions that are important in themselves, including
12882 @code{let*}, @code{match-beginning}, and @code{looking-at}.
12883
12884 The function definition for @code{forward-paragraph} is considerably
12885 longer than the function definition for @code{forward-sentence}
12886 because it works with a paragraph, each line of which may begin with a
12887 fill prefix.
12888
12889 A fill prefix consists of a string of characters that are repeated at
12890 the beginning of each line. For example, in Lisp code, it is a
12891 convention to start each line of a paragraph-long comment with
12892 @samp{;;; }. In Text mode, four blank spaces make up another common
12893 fill prefix, creating an indented paragraph. (@xref{Fill Prefix, , ,
12894 emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}, for more information about fill
12895 prefixes.)
12896
12897 The existence of a fill prefix means that in addition to being able to
12898 find the end of a paragraph whose lines begin on the left-most
12899 column, the @code{forward-paragraph} function must be able to find the
12900 end of a paragraph when all or many of the lines in the buffer begin
12901 with the fill prefix.
12902
12903 Moreover, it is sometimes practical to ignore a fill prefix that
12904 exists, especially when blank lines separate paragraphs.
12905 This is an added complication.
12906
12907 @menu
12908 * forward-paragraph in brief:: Key parts of the function definition.
12909 * fwd-para let:: The @code{let*} expression.
12910 * fwd-para while:: The forward motion @code{while} loop.
12911 @end menu
12912
12913 @ifnottex
12914 @node forward-paragraph in brief
12915 @unnumberedsubsec Shortened @code{forward-paragraph} function definition
12916 @end ifnottex
12917
12918 Rather than print all of the @code{forward-paragraph} function, we
12919 will only print parts of it. Read without preparation, the function
12920 can be daunting!
12921
12922 @need 800
12923 In outline, the function looks like this:
12924
12925 @smallexample
12926 @group
12927 (defun forward-paragraph (&optional arg)
12928 "@var{documentation}@dots{}"
12929 (interactive "p")
12930 (or arg (setq arg 1))
12931 (let*
12932 @var{varlist}
12933 (while (and (< arg 0) (not (bobp))) ; @r{backward-moving-code}
12934 @dots{}
12935 (while (and (> arg 0) (not (eobp))) ; @r{forward-moving-code}
12936 @dots{}
12937 @end group
12938 @end smallexample
12939
12940 The first parts of the function are routine: the function's argument
12941 list consists of one optional argument. Documentation follows.
12942
12943 The lower case @samp{p} in the @code{interactive} declaration means
12944 that the processed prefix argument, if any, is passed to the function.
12945 This will be a number, and is the repeat count of how many paragraphs
12946 point will move. The @code{or} expression in the next line handles
12947 the common case when no argument is passed to the function, which occurs
12948 if the function is called from other code rather than interactively.
12949 This case was described earlier. (@xref{forward-sentence, The
12950 @code{forward-sentence} function}.) Now we reach the end of the
12951 familiar part of this function.
12952
12953 @node fwd-para let
12954 @unnumberedsubsec The @code{let*} expression
12955
12956 The next line of the @code{forward-paragraph} function begins a
12957 @code{let*} expression. This is a different than @code{let}. The
12958 symbol is @code{let*} not @code{let}.
12959
12960 The @code{let*} special form is like @code{let} except that Emacs sets
12961 each variable in sequence, one after another, and variables in the
12962 latter part of the varlist can make use of the values to which Emacs
12963 set variables in the earlier part of the varlist.
12964
12965 @ignore
12966 ( refappend save-excursion, , code save-excursion in code append-to-buffer .)
12967 @end ignore
12968
12969 (@ref{append save-excursion, , @code{save-excursion} in @code{append-to-buffer}}.)
12970
12971 In the @code{let*} expression in this function, Emacs binds a total of
12972 seven variables: @code{opoint}, @code{fill-prefix-regexp},
12973 @code{parstart}, @code{parsep}, @code{sp-parstart}, @code{start}, and
12974 @code{found-start}.
12975
12976 The variable @code{parsep} appears twice, first, to remove instances
12977 of @samp{^}, and second, to handle fill prefixes.
12978
12979 The variable @code{opoint} is just the value of @code{point}. As you
12980 can guess, it is used in a @code{constrain-to-field} expression, just
12981 as in @code{forward-sentence}.
12982
12983 The variable @code{fill-prefix-regexp} is set to the value returned by
12984 evaluating the following list:
12985
12986 @smallexample
12987 @group
12988 (and fill-prefix
12989 (not (equal fill-prefix ""))
12990 (not paragraph-ignore-fill-prefix)
12991 (regexp-quote fill-prefix))
12992 @end group
12993 @end smallexample
12994
12995 @noindent
12996 This is an expression whose first element is the @code{and} special form.
12997
12998 As we learned earlier (@pxref{kill-new function, , The @code{kill-new}
12999 function}), the @code{and} special form evaluates each of its
13000 arguments until one of the arguments returns a value of @code{nil}, in
13001 which case the @code{and} expression returns @code{nil}; however, if
13002 none of the arguments returns a value of @code{nil}, the value
13003 resulting from evaluating the last argument is returned. (Since such
13004 a value is not @code{nil}, it is considered true in Lisp.) In other
13005 words, an @code{and} expression returns a true value only if all its
13006 arguments are true.
13007 @findex and
13008
13009 In this case, the variable @code{fill-prefix-regexp} is bound to a
13010 non-@code{nil} value only if the following four expressions produce a
13011 true (i.e., a non-@code{nil}) value when they are evaluated; otherwise,
13012 @code{fill-prefix-regexp} is bound to @code{nil}.
13013
13014 @table @code
13015 @item fill-prefix
13016 When this variable is evaluated, the value of the fill prefix, if any,
13017 is returned. If there is no fill prefix, this variable returns
13018 @code{nil}.
13019
13020 @item (not (equal fill-prefix "")
13021 This expression checks whether an existing fill prefix is an empty
13022 string, that is, a string with no characters in it. An empty string is
13023 not a useful fill prefix.
13024
13025 @item (not paragraph-ignore-fill-prefix)
13026 This expression returns @code{nil} if the variable
13027 @code{paragraph-ignore-fill-prefix} has been turned on by being set to a
13028 true value such as @code{t}.
13029
13030 @item (regexp-quote fill-prefix)
13031 This is the last argument to the @code{and} special form. If all the
13032 arguments to the @code{and} are true, the value resulting from
13033 evaluating this expression will be returned by the @code{and} expression
13034 and bound to the variable @code{fill-prefix-regexp},
13035 @end table
13036
13037 @findex regexp-quote
13038 @noindent
13039 The result of evaluating this @code{and} expression successfully is that
13040 @code{fill-prefix-regexp} will be bound to the value of
13041 @code{fill-prefix} as modified by the @code{regexp-quote} function.
13042 What @code{regexp-quote} does is read a string and return a regular
13043 expression that will exactly match the string and match nothing else.
13044 This means that @code{fill-prefix-regexp} will be set to a value that
13045 will exactly match the fill prefix if the fill prefix exists.
13046 Otherwise, the variable will be set to @code{nil}.
13047
13048 The next two local variables in the @code{let*} expression are
13049 designed to remove instances of @samp{^} from @code{parstart} and
13050 @code{parsep}, the local variables which indicate the paragraph start
13051 and the paragraph separator. The next expression sets @code{parsep}
13052 again. That is to handle fill prefixes.
13053
13054 This is the setting that requires the definition call @code{let*}
13055 rather than @code{let}. The true-or-false-test for the @code{if}
13056 depends on whether the variable @code{fill-prefix-regexp} evaluates to
13057 @code{nil} or some other value.
13058
13059 If @code{fill-prefix-regexp} does not have a value, Emacs evaluates
13060 the else-part of the @code{if} expression and binds @code{parsep} to
13061 its local value. (@code{parsep} is a regular expression that matches
13062 what separates paragraphs.)
13063
13064 But if @code{fill-prefix-regexp} does have a value, Emacs evaluates
13065 the then-part of the @code{if} expression and binds @code{parsep} to a
13066 regular expression that includes the @code{fill-prefix-regexp} as part
13067 of the pattern.
13068
13069 Specifically, @code{parsep} is set to the original value of the
13070 paragraph separate regular expression concatenated with an alternative
13071 expression that consists of the @code{fill-prefix-regexp} followed by
13072 optional whitespace to the end of the line. The whitespace is defined
13073 by @w{@code{"[ \t]*$"}}.) The @samp{\\|} defines this portion of the
13074 regexp as an alternative to @code{parsep}.
13075
13076 According to a comment in the code, the next local variable,
13077 @code{sp-parstart}, is used for searching, and then the final two,
13078 @code{start} and @code{found-start}, are set to @code{nil}.
13079
13080 Now we get into the body of the @code{let*}. The first part of the body
13081 of the @code{let*} deals with the case when the function is given a
13082 negative argument and is therefore moving backwards. We will skip this
13083 section.
13084
13085 @node fwd-para while
13086 @unnumberedsubsec The forward motion @code{while} loop
13087
13088 The second part of the body of the @code{let*} deals with forward
13089 motion. It is a @code{while} loop that repeats itself so long as the
13090 value of @code{arg} is greater than zero. In the most common use of
13091 the function, the value of the argument is 1, so the body of the
13092 @code{while} loop is evaluated exactly once, and the cursor moves
13093 forward one paragraph.
13094
13095 @ignore
13096 (while (and (> arg 0) (not (eobp)))
13097
13098 ;; Move forward over separator lines...
13099 (while (and (not (eobp))
13100 (progn (move-to-left-margin) (not (eobp)))
13101 (looking-at parsep))
13102 (forward-line 1))
13103 (unless (eobp) (setq arg (1- arg)))
13104 ;; ... and one more line.
13105 (forward-line 1)
13106
13107 (if fill-prefix-regexp
13108 ;; There is a fill prefix; it overrides parstart.
13109 (while (and (not (eobp))
13110 (progn (move-to-left-margin) (not (eobp)))
13111 (not (looking-at parsep))
13112 (looking-at fill-prefix-regexp))
13113 (forward-line 1))
13114
13115 (while (and (re-search-forward sp-parstart nil 1)
13116 (progn (setq start (match-beginning 0))
13117 (goto-char start)
13118 (not (eobp)))
13119 (progn (move-to-left-margin)
13120 (not (looking-at parsep)))
13121 (or (not (looking-at parstart))
13122 (and use-hard-newlines
13123 (not (get-text-property (1- start) 'hard)))))
13124 (forward-char 1))
13125
13126 (if (< (point) (point-max))
13127 (goto-char start))))
13128 @end ignore
13129
13130 This part handles three situations: when point is between paragraphs,
13131 when there is a fill prefix and when there is no fill prefix.
13132
13133 @need 800
13134 The @code{while} loop looks like this:
13135
13136 @smallexample
13137 @group
13138 ;; @r{going forwards and not at the end of the buffer}
13139 (while (and (> arg 0) (not (eobp)))
13140
13141 ;; @r{between paragraphs}
13142 ;; Move forward over separator lines...
13143 (while (and (not (eobp))
13144 (progn (move-to-left-margin) (not (eobp)))
13145 (looking-at parsep))
13146 (forward-line 1))
13147 ;; @r{This decrements the loop}
13148 (unless (eobp) (setq arg (1- arg)))
13149 ;; ... and one more line.
13150 (forward-line 1)
13151 @end group
13152
13153 @group
13154 (if fill-prefix-regexp
13155 ;; There is a fill prefix; it overrides parstart;
13156 ;; we go forward line by line
13157 (while (and (not (eobp))
13158 (progn (move-to-left-margin) (not (eobp)))
13159 (not (looking-at parsep))
13160 (looking-at fill-prefix-regexp))
13161 (forward-line 1))
13162 @end group
13163
13164 @group
13165 ;; There is no fill prefix;
13166 ;; we go forward character by character
13167 (while (and (re-search-forward sp-parstart nil 1)
13168 (progn (setq start (match-beginning 0))
13169 (goto-char start)
13170 (not (eobp)))
13171 (progn (move-to-left-margin)
13172 (not (looking-at parsep)))
13173 (or (not (looking-at parstart))
13174 (and use-hard-newlines
13175 (not (get-text-property (1- start) 'hard)))))
13176 (forward-char 1))
13177 @end group
13178
13179 @group
13180 ;; and if there is no fill prefix and if we are not at the end,
13181 ;; go to whatever was found in the regular expression search
13182 ;; for sp-parstart
13183 (if (< (point) (point-max))
13184 (goto-char start))))
13185 @end group
13186 @end smallexample
13187
13188 @findex eobp
13189 We can see that this is a decrementing counter @code{while} loop,
13190 using the expression @code{(setq arg (1- arg))} as the decrementer.
13191 That expression is not far from the @code{while}, but is hidden in
13192 another Lisp macro, an @code{unless} macro. Unless we are at the end
13193 of the buffer---that is what the @code{eobp} function determines; it
13194 is an abbreviation of @samp{End Of Buffer P}---we decrease the value
13195 of @code{arg} by one.
13196
13197 (If we are at the end of the buffer, we cannot go forward any more and
13198 the next loop of the @code{while} expression will test false since the
13199 test is an @code{and} with @code{(not (eobp))}. The @code{not}
13200 function means exactly as you expect; it is another name for
13201 @code{null}, a function that returns true when its argument is false.)
13202
13203 Interestingly, the loop count is not decremented until we leave the
13204 space between paragraphs, unless we come to the end of buffer or stop
13205 seeing the local value of the paragraph separator.
13206
13207 That second @code{while} also has a @code{(move-to-left-margin)}
13208 expression. The function is self-explanatory. It is inside a
13209 @code{progn} expression and not the last element of its body, so it is
13210 only invoked for its side effect, which is to move point to the left
13211 margin of the current line.
13212
13213 @findex looking-at
13214 The @code{looking-at} function is also self-explanatory; it returns
13215 true if the text after point matches the regular expression given as
13216 its argument.
13217
13218 The rest of the body of the loop looks difficult at first, but makes
13219 sense as you come to understand it.
13220
13221 @need 800
13222 First consider what happens if there is a fill prefix:
13223
13224 @smallexample
13225 @group
13226 (if fill-prefix-regexp
13227 ;; There is a fill prefix; it overrides parstart;
13228 ;; we go forward line by line
13229 (while (and (not (eobp))
13230 (progn (move-to-left-margin) (not (eobp)))
13231 (not (looking-at parsep))
13232 (looking-at fill-prefix-regexp))
13233 (forward-line 1))
13234 @end group
13235 @end smallexample
13236
13237 @noindent
13238 This expression moves point forward line by line so long
13239 as four conditions are true:
13240
13241 @enumerate
13242 @item
13243 Point is not at the end of the buffer.
13244
13245 @item
13246 We can move to the left margin of the text and are
13247 not at the end of the buffer.
13248
13249 @item
13250 The text following point does not separate paragraphs.
13251
13252 @item
13253 The pattern following point is the fill prefix regular expression.
13254 @end enumerate
13255
13256 The last condition may be puzzling, until you remember that point was
13257 moved to the beginning of the line early in the @code{forward-paragraph}
13258 function. This means that if the text has a fill prefix, the
13259 @code{looking-at} function will see it.
13260
13261 @need 1250
13262 Consider what happens when there is no fill prefix.
13263
13264 @smallexample
13265 @group
13266 (while (and (re-search-forward sp-parstart nil 1)
13267 (progn (setq start (match-beginning 0))
13268 (goto-char start)
13269 (not (eobp)))
13270 (progn (move-to-left-margin)
13271 (not (looking-at parsep)))
13272 (or (not (looking-at parstart))
13273 (and use-hard-newlines
13274 (not (get-text-property (1- start) 'hard)))))
13275 (forward-char 1))
13276 @end group
13277 @end smallexample
13278
13279 @noindent
13280 This @code{while} loop has us searching forward for
13281 @code{sp-parstart}, which is the combination of possible whitespace
13282 with a the local value of the start of a paragraph or of a paragraph
13283 separator. (The latter two are within an expression starting
13284 @code{\(?:} so that they are not referenced by the
13285 @code{match-beginning} function.)
13286
13287 @need 800
13288 The two expressions,
13289
13290 @smallexample
13291 @group
13292 (setq start (match-beginning 0))
13293 (goto-char start)
13294 @end group
13295 @end smallexample
13296
13297 @noindent
13298 mean go to the start of the text matched by the regular expression
13299 search.
13300
13301 The @code{(match-beginning 0)} expression is new. It returns a number
13302 specifying the location of the start of the text that was matched by
13303 the last search.
13304
13305 The @code{match-beginning} function is used here because of a
13306 characteristic of a forward search: a successful forward search,
13307 regardless of whether it is a plain search or a regular expression
13308 search, moves point to the end of the text that is found. In this
13309 case, a successful search moves point to the end of the pattern for
13310 @code{sp-parstart}.
13311
13312 However, we want to put point at the end of the current paragraph, not
13313 somewhere else. Indeed, since the search possibly includes the
13314 paragraph separator, point may end up at the beginning of the next one
13315 unless we use an expression that includes @code{match-beginning}.
13316
13317 @findex match-beginning
13318 When given an argument of 0, @code{match-beginning} returns the
13319 position that is the start of the text matched by the most recent
13320 search. In this case, the most recent search looks for
13321 @code{sp-parstart}. The @code{(match-beginning 0)} expression returns
13322 the beginning position of that pattern, rather than the end position
13323 of that pattern.
13324
13325 (Incidentally, when passed a positive number as an argument, the
13326 @code{match-beginning} function returns the location of point at that
13327 parenthesized expression in the last search unless that parenthesized
13328 expression begins with @code{\(?:}. I don't know why @code{\(?:}
13329 appears here since the argument is 0.)
13330
13331 @need 1250
13332 The last expression when there is no fill prefix is
13333
13334 @smallexample
13335 @group
13336 (if (< (point) (point-max))
13337 (goto-char start))))
13338 @end group
13339 @end smallexample
13340
13341 @noindent
13342 This says that if there is no fill prefix and if we are not at the
13343 end, point should move to the beginning of whatever was found by the
13344 regular expression search for @code{sp-parstart}.
13345
13346 The full definition for the @code{forward-paragraph} function not only
13347 includes code for going forwards, but also code for going backwards.
13348
13349 If you are reading this inside of GNU Emacs and you want to see the
13350 whole function, you can type @kbd{C-h f} (@code{describe-function})
13351 and the name of the function. This gives you the function
13352 documentation and the name of the library containing the function's
13353 source. Place point over the name of the library and press the RET
13354 key; you will be taken directly to the source. (Be sure to install
13355 your sources! Without them, you are like a person who tries to drive
13356 a car with his eyes shut!)
13357
13358 @node etags
13359 @section Create Your Own @file{TAGS} File
13360 @findex etags
13361 @cindex @file{TAGS} file, create own
13362
13363 Besides @kbd{C-h f} (@code{describe-function}), another way to see the
13364 source of a function is to type @kbd{M-.} (@code{find-tag}) and the
13365 name of the function when prompted for it. This is a good habit to
13366 get into. The @kbd{M-.} (@code{find-tag}) command takes you directly
13367 to the source for a function, variable, or node. The function depends
13368 on tags tables to tell it where to go.
13369
13370 If the @code{find-tag} function first asks you for the name of a
13371 @file{TAGS} table, give it the name of a @file{TAGS} file such as
13372 @file{/usr/local/src/emacs/src/TAGS}. (The exact path to your
13373 @file{TAGS} file depends on how your copy of Emacs was installed. I
13374 just told you the location that provides both my C and my Emacs Lisp
13375 sources.)
13376
13377 You can also create your own @file{TAGS} file for directories that
13378 lack one.
13379
13380 You often need to build and install tags tables yourself. They are
13381 not built automatically. A tags table is called a @file{TAGS} file;
13382 the name is in upper case letters.
13383
13384 You can create a @file{TAGS} file by calling the @code{etags} program
13385 that comes as a part of the Emacs distribution. Usually, @code{etags}
13386 is compiled and installed when Emacs is built. (@code{etags} is not
13387 an Emacs Lisp function or a part of Emacs; it is a C program.)
13388
13389 @need 1250
13390 To create a @file{TAGS} file, first switch to the directory in which
13391 you want to create the file. In Emacs you can do this with the
13392 @kbd{M-x cd} command, or by visiting a file in the directory, or by
13393 listing the directory with @kbd{C-x d} (@code{dired}). Then run the
13394 compile command, with @w{@code{etags *.el}} as the command to execute
13395
13396 @smallexample
13397 M-x compile RET etags *.el RET
13398 @end smallexample
13399
13400 @noindent
13401 to create a @file{TAGS} file for Emacs Lisp.
13402
13403 For example, if you have a large number of files in your
13404 @file{~/emacs} directory, as I do---I have 137 @file{.el} files in it,
13405 of which I load 12---you can create a @file{TAGS} file for the Emacs
13406 Lisp files in that directory.
13407
13408 @need 1250
13409 The @code{etags} program takes all the usual shell `wildcards'. For
13410 example, if you have two directories for which you want a single
13411 @file{TAGS} file, type @w{@code{etags *.el ../elisp/*.el}}, where
13412 @file{../elisp/} is the second directory:
13413
13414 @smallexample
13415 M-x compile RET etags *.el ../elisp/*.el RET
13416 @end smallexample
13417
13418 @need 1250
13419 Type
13420
13421 @smallexample
13422 M-x compile RET etags --help RET
13423 @end smallexample
13424
13425 @noindent
13426 to see a list of the options accepted by @code{etags} as well as a
13427 list of supported languages.
13428
13429 The @code{etags} program handles more than 20 languages, including
13430 Emacs Lisp, Common Lisp, Scheme, C, C++, Ada, Fortran, HTML, Java,
13431 LaTeX, Pascal, Perl, PostScript, Python, TeX, Texinfo, makefiles, and
13432 most assemblers. The program has no switches for specifying the
13433 language; it recognizes the language in an input file according to its
13434 file name and contents.
13435
13436 @file{etags} is very helpful when you are writing code yourself and
13437 want to refer back to functions you have already written. Just run
13438 @code{etags} again at intervals as you write new functions, so they
13439 become part of the @file{TAGS} file.
13440
13441 If you think an appropriate @file{TAGS} file already exists for what
13442 you want, but do not know where it is, you can use the @code{locate}
13443 program to attempt to find it.
13444
13445 Type @w{@kbd{M-x locate @key{RET} TAGS @key{RET}}} and Emacs will list
13446 for you the full path names of all your @file{TAGS} files. On my
13447 system, this command lists 34 @file{TAGS} files. On the other hand, a
13448 `plain vanilla' system I recently installed did not contain any
13449 @file{TAGS} files.
13450
13451 If the tags table you want has been created, you can use the @code{M-x
13452 visit-tags-table} command to specify it. Otherwise, you will need to
13453 create the tag table yourself and then use @code{M-x
13454 visit-tags-table}.
13455
13456 @subsubheading Building Tags in the Emacs sources
13457 @cindex Building Tags in the Emacs sources
13458 @cindex Tags in the Emacs sources
13459 @findex make tags
13460
13461 The GNU Emacs sources come with a @file{Makefile} that contains a
13462 sophisticated @code{etags} command that creates, collects, and merges
13463 tags tables from all over the Emacs sources and puts the information
13464 into one @file{TAGS} file in the @file{src/} directory. (The
13465 @file{src/} directory is below the top level of your Emacs directory.)
13466
13467 @need 1250
13468 To build this @file{TAGS} file, go to the top level of your Emacs
13469 source directory and run the compile command @code{make tags}:
13470
13471 @smallexample
13472 M-x compile RET make tags RET
13473 @end smallexample
13474
13475 @noindent
13476 (The @code{make tags} command works well with the GNU Emacs sources,
13477 as well as with some other source packages.)
13478
13479 For more information, see @ref{Tags, , Tag Tables, emacs, The GNU Emacs
13480 Manual}.
13481
13482 @node Regexp Review
13483 @section Review
13484
13485 Here is a brief summary of some recently introduced functions.
13486
13487 @table @code
13488 @item while
13489 Repeatedly evaluate the body of the expression so long as the first
13490 element of the body tests true. Then return @code{nil}. (The
13491 expression is evaluated only for its side effects.)
13492
13493 @need 1250
13494 For example:
13495
13496 @smallexample
13497 @group
13498 (let ((foo 2))
13499 (while (> foo 0)
13500 (insert (format "foo is %d.\n" foo))
13501 (setq foo (1- foo))))
13502
13503 @result{} foo is 2.
13504 foo is 1.
13505 nil
13506 @end group
13507 @end smallexample
13508
13509 @noindent
13510 (The @code{insert} function inserts its arguments at point; the
13511 @code{format} function returns a string formatted from its arguments
13512 the way @code{message} formats its arguments; @code{\n} produces a new
13513 line.)
13514
13515 @item re-search-forward
13516 Search for a pattern, and if the pattern is found, move point to rest
13517 just after it.
13518
13519 @noindent
13520 Takes four arguments, like @code{search-forward}:
13521
13522 @enumerate
13523 @item
13524 A regular expression that specifies the pattern to search for.
13525 (Remember to put quotation marks around this argument!)
13526
13527 @item
13528 Optionally, the limit of the search.
13529
13530 @item
13531 Optionally, what to do if the search fails, return @code{nil} or an
13532 error message.
13533
13534 @item
13535 Optionally, how many times to repeat the search; if negative, the
13536 search goes backwards.
13537 @end enumerate
13538
13539 @item let*
13540 Bind some variables locally to particular values,
13541 and then evaluate the remaining arguments, returning the value of the
13542 last one. While binding the local variables, use the local values of
13543 variables bound earlier, if any.
13544
13545 @need 1250
13546 For example:
13547
13548 @smallexample
13549 @group
13550 (let* ((foo 7)
13551 (bar (* 3 foo)))
13552 (message "`bar' is %d." bar))
13553 @result{} `bar' is 21.
13554 @end group
13555 @end smallexample
13556
13557 @item match-beginning
13558 Return the position of the start of the text found by the last regular
13559 expression search.
13560
13561 @item looking-at
13562 Return @code{t} for true if the text after point matches the argument,
13563 which should be a regular expression.
13564
13565 @item eobp
13566 Return @code{t} for true if point is at the end of the accessible part
13567 of a buffer. The end of the accessible part is the end of the buffer
13568 if the buffer is not narrowed; it is the end of the narrowed part if
13569 the buffer is narrowed.
13570 @end table
13571
13572 @need 1500
13573 @node re-search Exercises
13574 @section Exercises with @code{re-search-forward}
13575
13576 @itemize @bullet
13577 @item
13578 Write a function to search for a regular expression that matches two
13579 or more blank lines in sequence.
13580
13581 @item
13582 Write a function to search for duplicated words, such as `the the'.
13583 @xref{Regexps, , Syntax of Regular Expressions, emacs, The GNU Emacs
13584 Manual}, for information on how to write a regexp (a regular
13585 expression) to match a string that is composed of two identical
13586 halves. You can devise several regexps; some are better than others.
13587 The function I use is described in an appendix, along with several
13588 regexps. @xref{the-the, , @code{the-the} Duplicated Words Function}.
13589 @end itemize
13590
13591 @node Counting Words
13592 @chapter Counting: Repetition and Regexps
13593 @cindex Repetition for word counting
13594 @cindex Regular expressions for word counting
13595
13596 Repetition and regular expression searches are powerful tools that you
13597 often use when you write code in Emacs Lisp. This chapter illustrates
13598 the use of regular expression searches through the construction of
13599 word count commands using @code{while} loops and recursion.
13600
13601 @menu
13602 * Why Count Words::
13603 * @value{COUNT-WORDS}:: Use a regexp, but find a problem.
13604 * recursive-count-words:: Start with case of no words in region.
13605 * Counting Exercise::
13606 @end menu
13607
13608 @ifnottex
13609 @node Why Count Words
13610 @unnumberedsec Counting words
13611 @end ifnottex
13612
13613 The standard Emacs distribution contains functions for counting the
13614 number of lines and words within a region.
13615
13616 Certain types of writing ask you to count words. Thus, if you write
13617 an essay, you may be limited to 800 words; if you write a novel, you
13618 may discipline yourself to write 1000 words a day. It seems odd, but
13619 for a long time, Emacs lacked a word count command. Perhaps people used
13620 Emacs mostly for code or types of documentation that did not require
13621 word counts; or perhaps they restricted themselves to the operating
13622 system word count command, @code{wc}. Alternatively, people may have
13623 followed the publishers' convention and computed a word count by
13624 dividing the number of characters in a document by five.
13625
13626 There are many ways to implement a command to count words. Here are
13627 some examples, which you may wish to compare with the standard Emacs
13628 command, @code{count-words-region}.
13629
13630 @node @value{COUNT-WORDS}
13631 @section The @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}} Function
13632 @findex @value{COUNT-WORDS}
13633
13634 A word count command could count words in a line, paragraph, region,
13635 or buffer. What should the command cover? You could design the
13636 command to count the number of words in a complete buffer. However,
13637 the Emacs tradition encourages flexibility---you may want to count
13638 words in just a section, rather than all of a buffer. So it makes
13639 more sense to design the command to count the number of words in a
13640 region. Once you have a command to count words in a region, you can,
13641 if you wish, count words in a whole buffer by marking it with
13642 @w{@kbd{C-x h}} (@code{mark-whole-buffer}).
13643
13644 Clearly, counting words is a repetitive act: starting from the
13645 beginning of the region, you count the first word, then the second
13646 word, then the third word, and so on, until you reach the end of the
13647 region. This means that word counting is ideally suited to recursion
13648 or to a @code{while} loop.
13649
13650 @menu
13651 * Design @value{COUNT-WORDS}:: The definition using a @code{while} loop.
13652 * Whitespace Bug:: The Whitespace Bug in @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}}.
13653 @end menu
13654
13655 @ifnottex
13656 @node Design @value{COUNT-WORDS}
13657 @unnumberedsubsec Designing @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}}
13658 @end ifnottex
13659
13660 First, we will implement the word count command with a @code{while}
13661 loop, then with recursion. The command will, of course, be
13662 interactive.
13663
13664 @need 800
13665 The template for an interactive function definition is, as always:
13666
13667 @smallexample
13668 @group
13669 (defun @var{name-of-function} (@var{argument-list})
13670 "@var{documentation}@dots{}"
13671 (@var{interactive-expression}@dots{})
13672 @var{body}@dots{})
13673 @end group
13674 @end smallexample
13675
13676 What we need to do is fill in the slots.
13677
13678 The name of the function should be self-explanatory and similar to the
13679 existing @code{count-lines-region} name. This makes the name easier
13680 to remember. @code{count-words-region} is the obvious choice. Since
13681 that name is now used for the standard Emacs command to count words, we
13682 will name our implementation @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}}.
13683
13684 The function counts words within a region. This means that the
13685 argument list must contain symbols that are bound to the two
13686 positions, the beginning and end of the region. These two positions
13687 can be called @samp{beginning} and @samp{end} respectively. The first
13688 line of the documentation should be a single sentence, since that is
13689 all that is printed as documentation by a command such as
13690 @code{apropos}. The interactive expression will be of the form
13691 @samp{(interactive "r")}, since that will cause Emacs to pass the
13692 beginning and end of the region to the function's argument list. All
13693 this is routine.
13694
13695 The body of the function needs to be written to do three tasks:
13696 first, to set up conditions under which the @code{while} loop can
13697 count words, second, to run the @code{while} loop, and third, to send
13698 a message to the user.
13699
13700 When a user calls @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}}, point may be at the
13701 beginning or the end of the region. However, the counting process
13702 must start at the beginning of the region. This means we will want
13703 to put point there if it is not already there. Executing
13704 @code{(goto-char beginning)} ensures this. Of course, we will want to
13705 return point to its expected position when the function finishes its
13706 work. For this reason, the body must be enclosed in a
13707 @code{save-excursion} expression.
13708
13709 The central part of the body of the function consists of a
13710 @code{while} loop in which one expression jumps point forward word by
13711 word, and another expression counts those jumps. The true-or-false-test
13712 of the @code{while} loop should test true so long as point should jump
13713 forward, and false when point is at the end of the region.
13714
13715 We could use @code{(forward-word 1)} as the expression for moving point
13716 forward word by word, but it is easier to see what Emacs identifies as a
13717 `word' if we use a regular expression search.
13718
13719 A regular expression search that finds the pattern for which it is
13720 searching leaves point after the last character matched. This means
13721 that a succession of successful word searches will move point forward
13722 word by word.
13723
13724 As a practical matter, we want the regular expression search to jump
13725 over whitespace and punctuation between words as well as over the
13726 words themselves. A regexp that refuses to jump over interword
13727 whitespace would never jump more than one word! This means that
13728 the regexp should include the whitespace and punctuation that follows
13729 a word, if any, as well as the word itself. (A word may end a buffer
13730 and not have any following whitespace or punctuation, so that part of
13731 the regexp must be optional.)
13732
13733 Thus, what we want for the regexp is a pattern defining one or more
13734 word constituent characters followed, optionally, by one or more
13735 characters that are not word constituents. The regular expression for
13736 this is:
13737
13738 @smallexample
13739 \w+\W*
13740 @end smallexample
13741
13742 @noindent
13743 The buffer's syntax table determines which characters are and are not
13744 word constituents. For more information about syntax,
13745 @pxref{Syntax Tables, , Syntax Tables, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
13746 Reference Manual}.
13747
13748 @need 800
13749 The search expression looks like this:
13750
13751 @smallexample
13752 (re-search-forward "\\w+\\W*")
13753 @end smallexample
13754
13755 @noindent
13756 (Note that paired backslashes precede the @samp{w} and @samp{W}. A
13757 single backslash has special meaning to the Emacs Lisp interpreter.
13758 It indicates that the following character is interpreted differently
13759 than usual. For example, the two characters, @samp{\n}, stand for
13760 @samp{newline}, rather than for a backslash followed by @samp{n}. Two
13761 backslashes in a row stand for an ordinary, `unspecial' backslash, so
13762 Emacs Lisp interpreter ends of seeing a single backslash followed by a
13763 letter. So it discovers the letter is special.)
13764
13765 We need a counter to count how many words there are; this variable
13766 must first be set to 0 and then incremented each time Emacs goes
13767 around the @code{while} loop. The incrementing expression is simply:
13768
13769 @smallexample
13770 (setq count (1+ count))
13771 @end smallexample
13772
13773 Finally, we want to tell the user how many words there are in the
13774 region. The @code{message} function is intended for presenting this
13775 kind of information to the user. The message has to be phrased so
13776 that it reads properly regardless of how many words there are in the
13777 region: we don't want to say that ``there are 1 words in the region''.
13778 The conflict between singular and plural is ungrammatical. We can
13779 solve this problem by using a conditional expression that evaluates
13780 different messages depending on the number of words in the region.
13781 There are three possibilities: no words in the region, one word in the
13782 region, and more than one word. This means that the @code{cond}
13783 special form is appropriate.
13784
13785 @need 1500
13786 All this leads to the following function definition:
13787
13788 @smallexample
13789 @group
13790 ;;; @r{First version; has bugs!}
13791 (defun @value{COUNT-WORDS} (beginning end)
13792 "Print number of words in the region.
13793 Words are defined as at least one word-constituent
13794 character followed by at least one character that
13795 is not a word-constituent. The buffer's syntax
13796 table determines which characters these are."
13797 (interactive "r")
13798 (message "Counting words in region ... ")
13799 @end group
13800
13801 @group
13802 ;;; @r{1. Set up appropriate conditions.}
13803 (save-excursion
13804 (goto-char beginning)
13805 (let ((count 0))
13806 @end group
13807
13808 @group
13809 ;;; @r{2. Run the} while @r{loop.}
13810 (while (< (point) end)
13811 (re-search-forward "\\w+\\W*")
13812 (setq count (1+ count)))
13813 @end group
13814
13815 @group
13816 ;;; @r{3. Send a message to the user.}
13817 (cond ((zerop count)
13818 (message
13819 "The region does NOT have any words."))
13820 ((= 1 count)
13821 (message
13822 "The region has 1 word."))
13823 (t
13824 (message
13825 "The region has %d words." count))))))
13826 @end group
13827 @end smallexample
13828
13829 @noindent
13830 As written, the function works, but not in all circumstances.
13831
13832 @node Whitespace Bug
13833 @subsection The Whitespace Bug in @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}}
13834
13835 The @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}} command described in the preceding
13836 section has two bugs, or rather, one bug with two manifestations.
13837 First, if you mark a region containing only whitespace in the middle
13838 of some text, the @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}} command tells you that the
13839 region contains one word! Second, if you mark a region containing
13840 only whitespace at the end of the buffer or the accessible portion of
13841 a narrowed buffer, the command displays an error message that looks
13842 like this:
13843
13844 @smallexample
13845 Search failed: "\\w+\\W*"
13846 @end smallexample
13847
13848 If you are reading this in Info in GNU Emacs, you can test for these
13849 bugs yourself.
13850
13851 First, evaluate the function in the usual manner to install it.
13852 @ifinfo
13853 Here is a copy of the definition. Place your cursor after the closing
13854 parenthesis and type @kbd{C-x C-e} to install it.
13855
13856 @smallexample
13857 @group
13858 ;; @r{First version; has bugs!}
13859 (defun @value{COUNT-WORDS} (beginning end)
13860 "Print number of words in the region.
13861 Words are defined as at least one word-constituent character followed
13862 by at least one character that is not a word-constituent. The buffer's
13863 syntax table determines which characters these are."
13864 @end group
13865 @group
13866 (interactive "r")
13867 (message "Counting words in region ... ")
13868 @end group
13869
13870 @group
13871 ;;; @r{1. Set up appropriate conditions.}
13872 (save-excursion
13873 (goto-char beginning)
13874 (let ((count 0))
13875 @end group
13876
13877 @group
13878 ;;; @r{2. Run the} while @r{loop.}
13879 (while (< (point) end)
13880 (re-search-forward "\\w+\\W*")
13881 (setq count (1+ count)))
13882 @end group
13883
13884 @group
13885 ;;; @r{3. Send a message to the user.}
13886 (cond ((zerop count)
13887 (message "The region does NOT have any words."))
13888 ((= 1 count) (message "The region has 1 word."))
13889 (t (message "The region has %d words." count))))))
13890 @end group
13891 @end smallexample
13892 @end ifinfo
13893
13894 @need 1000
13895 If you wish, you can also install this keybinding by evaluating it:
13896
13897 @smallexample
13898 (global-set-key "\C-c=" '@value{COUNT-WORDS})
13899 @end smallexample
13900
13901 To conduct the first test, set mark and point to the beginning and end
13902 of the following line and then type @kbd{C-c =} (or @kbd{M-x
13903 @value{COUNT-WORDS}} if you have not bound @kbd{C-c =}):
13904
13905 @smallexample
13906 one two three
13907 @end smallexample
13908
13909 @noindent
13910 Emacs will tell you, correctly, that the region has three words.
13911
13912 Repeat the test, but place mark at the beginning of the line and place
13913 point just @emph{before} the word @samp{one}. Again type the command
13914 @kbd{C-c =} (or @kbd{M-x @value{COUNT-WORDS}}). Emacs should tell you
13915 that the region has no words, since it is composed only of the
13916 whitespace at the beginning of the line. But instead Emacs tells you
13917 that the region has one word!
13918
13919 For the third test, copy the sample line to the end of the
13920 @file{*scratch*} buffer and then type several spaces at the end of the
13921 line. Place mark right after the word @samp{three} and point at the
13922 end of line. (The end of the line will be the end of the buffer.)
13923 Type @kbd{C-c =} (or @kbd{M-x @value{COUNT-WORDS}}) as you did before.
13924 Again, Emacs should tell you that the region has no words, since it is
13925 composed only of the whitespace at the end of the line. Instead,
13926 Emacs displays an error message saying @samp{Search failed}.
13927
13928 The two bugs stem from the same problem.
13929
13930 Consider the first manifestation of the bug, in which the command
13931 tells you that the whitespace at the beginning of the line contains
13932 one word. What happens is this: The @code{M-x @value{COUNT-WORDS}}
13933 command moves point to the beginning of the region. The @code{while}
13934 tests whether the value of point is smaller than the value of
13935 @code{end}, which it is. Consequently, the regular expression search
13936 looks for and finds the first word. It leaves point after the word.
13937 @code{count} is set to one. The @code{while} loop repeats; but this
13938 time the value of point is larger than the value of @code{end}, the
13939 loop is exited; and the function displays a message saying the number
13940 of words in the region is one. In brief, the regular expression
13941 search looks for and finds the word even though it is outside
13942 the marked region.
13943
13944 In the second manifestation of the bug, the region is whitespace at
13945 the end of the buffer. Emacs says @samp{Search failed}. What happens
13946 is that the true-or-false-test in the @code{while} loop tests true, so
13947 the search expression is executed. But since there are no more words
13948 in the buffer, the search fails.
13949
13950 In both manifestations of the bug, the search extends or attempts to
13951 extend outside of the region.
13952
13953 The solution is to limit the search to the region---this is a fairly
13954 simple action, but as you may have come to expect, it is not quite as
13955 simple as you might think.
13956
13957 As we have seen, the @code{re-search-forward} function takes a search
13958 pattern as its first argument. But in addition to this first,
13959 mandatory argument, it accepts three optional arguments. The optional
13960 second argument bounds the search. The optional third argument, if
13961 @code{t}, causes the function to return @code{nil} rather than signal
13962 an error if the search fails. The optional fourth argument is a
13963 repeat count. (In Emacs, you can see a function's documentation by
13964 typing @kbd{C-h f}, the name of the function, and then @key{RET}.)
13965
13966 In the @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}} definition, the value of the end of
13967 the region is held by the variable @code{end} which is passed as an
13968 argument to the function. Thus, we can add @code{end} as an argument
13969 to the regular expression search expression:
13970
13971 @smallexample
13972 (re-search-forward "\\w+\\W*" end)
13973 @end smallexample
13974
13975 However, if you make only this change to the @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}}
13976 definition and then test the new version of the definition on a
13977 stretch of whitespace, you will receive an error message saying
13978 @samp{Search failed}.
13979
13980 What happens is this: the search is limited to the region, and fails
13981 as you expect because there are no word-constituent characters in the
13982 region. Since it fails, we receive an error message. But we do not
13983 want to receive an error message in this case; we want to receive the
13984 message that "The region does NOT have any words."
13985
13986 The solution to this problem is to provide @code{re-search-forward}
13987 with a third argument of @code{t}, which causes the function to return
13988 @code{nil} rather than signal an error if the search fails.
13989
13990 However, if you make this change and try it, you will see the message
13991 ``Counting words in region ... '' and @dots{} you will keep on seeing
13992 that message @dots{}, until you type @kbd{C-g} (@code{keyboard-quit}).
13993
13994 Here is what happens: the search is limited to the region, as before,
13995 and it fails because there are no word-constituent characters in the
13996 region, as expected. Consequently, the @code{re-search-forward}
13997 expression returns @code{nil}. It does nothing else. In particular,
13998 it does not move point, which it does as a side effect if it finds the
13999 search target. After the @code{re-search-forward} expression returns
14000 @code{nil}, the next expression in the @code{while} loop is evaluated.
14001 This expression increments the count. Then the loop repeats. The
14002 true-or-false-test tests true because the value of point is still less
14003 than the value of end, since the @code{re-search-forward} expression
14004 did not move point. @dots{} and the cycle repeats @dots{}
14005
14006 The @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}} definition requires yet another
14007 modification, to cause the true-or-false-test of the @code{while} loop
14008 to test false if the search fails. Put another way, there are two
14009 conditions that must be satisfied in the true-or-false-test before the
14010 word count variable is incremented: point must still be within the
14011 region and the search expression must have found a word to count.
14012
14013 Since both the first condition and the second condition must be true
14014 together, the two expressions, the region test and the search
14015 expression, can be joined with an @code{and} special form and embedded in
14016 the @code{while} loop as the true-or-false-test, like this:
14017
14018 @smallexample
14019 (and (< (point) end) (re-search-forward "\\w+\\W*" end t))
14020 @end smallexample
14021
14022 @c colon in printed section title causes problem in Info cross reference
14023 @c also trouble with an overfull hbox
14024 @iftex
14025 @noindent
14026 (For information about @code{and}, see
14027 @ref{kill-new function, , The @code{kill-new} function}.)
14028 @end iftex
14029 @ifinfo
14030 @noindent
14031 (@xref{kill-new function, , The @code{kill-new} function}, for
14032 information about @code{and}.)
14033 @end ifinfo
14034
14035 The @code{re-search-forward} expression returns @code{t} if the search
14036 succeeds and as a side effect moves point. Consequently, as words are
14037 found, point is moved through the region. When the search expression
14038 fails to find another word, or when point reaches the end of the
14039 region, the true-or-false-test tests false, the @code{while} loop
14040 exits, and the @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}} function displays one or
14041 other of its messages.
14042
14043 After incorporating these final changes, the @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}}
14044 works without bugs (or at least, without bugs that I have found!).
14045 Here is what it looks like:
14046
14047 @smallexample
14048 @group
14049 ;;; @r{Final version:} @code{while}
14050 (defun @value{COUNT-WORDS} (beginning end)
14051 "Print number of words in the region."
14052 (interactive "r")
14053 (message "Counting words in region ... ")
14054 @end group
14055
14056 @group
14057 ;;; @r{1. Set up appropriate conditions.}
14058 (save-excursion
14059 (let ((count 0))
14060 (goto-char beginning)
14061 @end group
14062
14063 @group
14064 ;;; @r{2. Run the} while @r{loop.}
14065 (while (and (< (point) end)
14066 (re-search-forward "\\w+\\W*" end t))
14067 (setq count (1+ count)))
14068 @end group
14069
14070 @group
14071 ;;; @r{3. Send a message to the user.}
14072 (cond ((zerop count)
14073 (message
14074 "The region does NOT have any words."))
14075 ((= 1 count)
14076 (message
14077 "The region has 1 word."))
14078 (t
14079 (message
14080 "The region has %d words." count))))))
14081 @end group
14082 @end smallexample
14083
14084 @node recursive-count-words
14085 @section Count Words Recursively
14086 @cindex Count words recursively
14087 @cindex Recursively counting words
14088 @cindex Words, counted recursively
14089
14090 You can write the function for counting words recursively as well as
14091 with a @code{while} loop. Let's see how this is done.
14092
14093 First, we need to recognize that the @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}}
14094 function has three jobs: it sets up the appropriate conditions for
14095 counting to occur; it counts the words in the region; and it sends a
14096 message to the user telling how many words there are.
14097
14098 If we write a single recursive function to do everything, we will
14099 receive a message for every recursive call. If the region contains 13
14100 words, we will receive thirteen messages, one right after the other.
14101 We don't want this! Instead, we must write two functions to do the
14102 job, one of which (the recursive function) will be used inside of the
14103 other. One function will set up the conditions and display the
14104 message; the other will return the word count.
14105
14106 Let us start with the function that causes the message to be displayed.
14107 We can continue to call this @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}}.
14108
14109 This is the function that the user will call. It will be interactive.
14110 Indeed, it will be similar to our previous versions of this
14111 function, except that it will call @code{recursive-count-words} to
14112 determine how many words are in the region.
14113
14114 @need 1250
14115 We can readily construct a template for this function, based on our
14116 previous versions:
14117
14118 @smallexample
14119 @group
14120 ;; @r{Recursive version; uses regular expression search}
14121 (defun @value{COUNT-WORDS} (beginning end)
14122 "@var{documentation}@dots{}"
14123 (@var{interactive-expression}@dots{})
14124 @end group
14125 @group
14126
14127 ;;; @r{1. Set up appropriate conditions.}
14128 (@var{explanatory message})
14129 (@var{set-up functions}@dots{}
14130 @end group
14131 @group
14132
14133 ;;; @r{2. Count the words.}
14134 @var{recursive call}
14135 @end group
14136 @group
14137
14138 ;;; @r{3. Send a message to the user.}
14139 @var{message providing word count}))
14140 @end group
14141 @end smallexample
14142
14143 The definition looks straightforward, except that somehow the count
14144 returned by the recursive call must be passed to the message
14145 displaying the word count. A little thought suggests that this can be
14146 done by making use of a @code{let} expression: we can bind a variable
14147 in the varlist of a @code{let} expression to the number of words in
14148 the region, as returned by the recursive call; and then the
14149 @code{cond} expression, using binding, can display the value to the
14150 user.
14151
14152 Often, one thinks of the binding within a @code{let} expression as
14153 somehow secondary to the `primary' work of a function. But in this
14154 case, what you might consider the `primary' job of the function,
14155 counting words, is done within the @code{let} expression.
14156
14157 @need 1250
14158 Using @code{let}, the function definition looks like this:
14159
14160 @smallexample
14161 @group
14162 (defun @value{COUNT-WORDS} (beginning end)
14163 "Print number of words in the region."
14164 (interactive "r")
14165 @end group
14166
14167 @group
14168 ;;; @r{1. Set up appropriate conditions.}
14169 (message "Counting words in region ... ")
14170 (save-excursion
14171 (goto-char beginning)
14172 @end group
14173
14174 @group
14175 ;;; @r{2. Count the words.}
14176 (let ((count (recursive-count-words end)))
14177 @end group
14178
14179 @group
14180 ;;; @r{3. Send a message to the user.}
14181 (cond ((zerop count)
14182 (message
14183 "The region does NOT have any words."))
14184 ((= 1 count)
14185 (message
14186 "The region has 1 word."))
14187 (t
14188 (message
14189 "The region has %d words." count))))))
14190 @end group
14191 @end smallexample
14192
14193 Next, we need to write the recursive counting function.
14194
14195 A recursive function has at least three parts: the `do-again-test', the
14196 `next-step-expression', and the recursive call.
14197
14198 The do-again-test determines whether the function will or will not be
14199 called again. Since we are counting words in a region and can use a
14200 function that moves point forward for every word, the do-again-test
14201 can check whether point is still within the region. The do-again-test
14202 should find the value of point and determine whether point is before,
14203 at, or after the value of the end of the region. We can use the
14204 @code{point} function to locate point. Clearly, we must pass the
14205 value of the end of the region to the recursive counting function as an
14206 argument.
14207
14208 In addition, the do-again-test should also test whether the search finds a
14209 word. If it does not, the function should not call itself again.
14210
14211 The next-step-expression changes a value so that when the recursive
14212 function is supposed to stop calling itself, it stops. More
14213 precisely, the next-step-expression changes a value so that at the
14214 right time, the do-again-test stops the recursive function from
14215 calling itself again. In this case, the next-step-expression can be
14216 the expression that moves point forward, word by word.
14217
14218 The third part of a recursive function is the recursive call.
14219
14220 Somewhere, also, we also need a part that does the `work' of the
14221 function, a part that does the counting. A vital part!
14222
14223 @need 1250
14224 But already, we have an outline of the recursive counting function:
14225
14226 @smallexample
14227 @group
14228 (defun recursive-count-words (region-end)
14229 "@var{documentation}@dots{}"
14230 @var{do-again-test}
14231 @var{next-step-expression}
14232 @var{recursive call})
14233 @end group
14234 @end smallexample
14235
14236 Now we need to fill in the slots. Let's start with the simplest cases
14237 first: if point is at or beyond the end of the region, there cannot
14238 be any words in the region, so the function should return zero.
14239 Likewise, if the search fails, there are no words to count, so the
14240 function should return zero.
14241
14242 On the other hand, if point is within the region and the search
14243 succeeds, the function should call itself again.
14244
14245 @need 800
14246 Thus, the do-again-test should look like this:
14247
14248 @smallexample
14249 @group
14250 (and (< (point) region-end)
14251 (re-search-forward "\\w+\\W*" region-end t))
14252 @end group
14253 @end smallexample
14254
14255 Note that the search expression is part of the do-again-test---the
14256 function returns @code{t} if its search succeeds and @code{nil} if it
14257 fails. (@xref{Whitespace Bug, , The Whitespace Bug in
14258 @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}}}, for an explanation of how
14259 @code{re-search-forward} works.)
14260
14261 The do-again-test is the true-or-false test of an @code{if} clause.
14262 Clearly, if the do-again-test succeeds, the then-part of the @code{if}
14263 clause should call the function again; but if it fails, the else-part
14264 should return zero since either point is outside the region or the
14265 search failed because there were no words to find.
14266
14267 But before considering the recursive call, we need to consider the
14268 next-step-expression. What is it? Interestingly, it is the search
14269 part of the do-again-test.
14270
14271 In addition to returning @code{t} or @code{nil} for the
14272 do-again-test, @code{re-search-forward} moves point forward as a side
14273 effect of a successful search. This is the action that changes the
14274 value of point so that the recursive function stops calling itself
14275 when point completes its movement through the region. Consequently,
14276 the @code{re-search-forward} expression is the next-step-expression.
14277
14278 @need 1200
14279 In outline, then, the body of the @code{recursive-count-words}
14280 function looks like this:
14281
14282 @smallexample
14283 @group
14284 (if @var{do-again-test-and-next-step-combined}
14285 ;; @r{then}
14286 @var{recursive-call-returning-count}
14287 ;; @r{else}
14288 @var{return-zero})
14289 @end group
14290 @end smallexample
14291
14292 How to incorporate the mechanism that counts?
14293
14294 If you are not used to writing recursive functions, a question like
14295 this can be troublesome. But it can and should be approached
14296 systematically.
14297
14298 We know that the counting mechanism should be associated in some way
14299 with the recursive call. Indeed, since the next-step-expression moves
14300 point forward by one word, and since a recursive call is made for
14301 each word, the counting mechanism must be an expression that adds one
14302 to the value returned by a call to @code{recursive-count-words}.
14303
14304 @need 800
14305 Consider several cases:
14306
14307 @itemize @bullet
14308 @item
14309 If there are two words in the region, the function should return
14310 a value resulting from adding one to the value returned when it counts
14311 the first word, plus the number returned when it counts the remaining
14312 words in the region, which in this case is one.
14313
14314 @item
14315 If there is one word in the region, the function should return
14316 a value resulting from adding one to the value returned when it counts
14317 that word, plus the number returned when it counts the remaining
14318 words in the region, which in this case is zero.
14319
14320 @item
14321 If there are no words in the region, the function should return zero.
14322 @end itemize
14323
14324 From the sketch we can see that the else-part of the @code{if} returns
14325 zero for the case of no words. This means that the then-part of the
14326 @code{if} must return a value resulting from adding one to the value
14327 returned from a count of the remaining words.
14328
14329 @need 1200
14330 The expression will look like this, where @code{1+} is a function that
14331 adds one to its argument.
14332
14333 @smallexample
14334 (1+ (recursive-count-words region-end))
14335 @end smallexample
14336
14337 @need 1200
14338 The whole @code{recursive-count-words} function will then look like
14339 this:
14340
14341 @smallexample
14342 @group
14343 (defun recursive-count-words (region-end)
14344 "@var{documentation}@dots{}"
14345
14346 ;;; @r{1. do-again-test}
14347 (if (and (< (point) region-end)
14348 (re-search-forward "\\w+\\W*" region-end t))
14349 @end group
14350
14351 @group
14352 ;;; @r{2. then-part: the recursive call}
14353 (1+ (recursive-count-words region-end))
14354
14355 ;;; @r{3. else-part}
14356 0))
14357 @end group
14358 @end smallexample
14359
14360 @need 1250
14361 Let's examine how this works:
14362
14363 If there are no words in the region, the else part of the @code{if}
14364 expression is evaluated and consequently the function returns zero.
14365
14366 If there is one word in the region, the value of point is less than
14367 the value of @code{region-end} and the search succeeds. In this case,
14368 the true-or-false-test of the @code{if} expression tests true, and the
14369 then-part of the @code{if} expression is evaluated. The counting
14370 expression is evaluated. This expression returns a value (which will
14371 be the value returned by the whole function) that is the sum of one
14372 added to the value returned by a recursive call.
14373
14374 Meanwhile, the next-step-expression has caused point to jump over the
14375 first (and in this case only) word in the region. This means that
14376 when @code{(recursive-count-words region-end)} is evaluated a second
14377 time, as a result of the recursive call, the value of point will be
14378 equal to or greater than the value of region end. So this time,
14379 @code{recursive-count-words} will return zero. The zero will be added
14380 to one, and the original evaluation of @code{recursive-count-words}
14381 will return one plus zero, which is one, which is the correct amount.
14382
14383 Clearly, if there are two words in the region, the first call to
14384 @code{recursive-count-words} returns one added to the value returned
14385 by calling @code{recursive-count-words} on a region containing the
14386 remaining word---that is, it adds one to one, producing two, which is
14387 the correct amount.
14388
14389 Similarly, if there are three words in the region, the first call to
14390 @code{recursive-count-words} returns one added to the value returned
14391 by calling @code{recursive-count-words} on a region containing the
14392 remaining two words---and so on and so on.
14393
14394 @need 1250
14395 @noindent
14396 With full documentation the two functions look like this:
14397
14398 @need 1250
14399 @noindent
14400 The recursive function:
14401
14402 @findex recursive-count-words
14403 @smallexample
14404 @group
14405 (defun recursive-count-words (region-end)
14406 "Number of words between point and REGION-END."
14407 @end group
14408
14409 @group
14410 ;;; @r{1. do-again-test}
14411 (if (and (< (point) region-end)
14412 (re-search-forward "\\w+\\W*" region-end t))
14413 @end group
14414
14415 @group
14416 ;;; @r{2. then-part: the recursive call}
14417 (1+ (recursive-count-words region-end))
14418
14419 ;;; @r{3. else-part}
14420 0))
14421 @end group
14422 @end smallexample
14423
14424 @need 800
14425 @noindent
14426 The wrapper:
14427
14428 @smallexample
14429 @group
14430 ;;; @r{Recursive version}
14431 (defun @value{COUNT-WORDS} (beginning end)
14432 "Print number of words in the region.
14433 @end group
14434
14435 @group
14436 Words are defined as at least one word-constituent
14437 character followed by at least one character that is
14438 not a word-constituent. The buffer's syntax table
14439 determines which characters these are."
14440 @end group
14441 @group
14442 (interactive "r")
14443 (message "Counting words in region ... ")
14444 (save-excursion
14445 (goto-char beginning)
14446 (let ((count (recursive-count-words end)))
14447 @end group
14448 @group
14449 (cond ((zerop count)
14450 (message
14451 "The region does NOT have any words."))
14452 @end group
14453 @group
14454 ((= 1 count)
14455 (message "The region has 1 word."))
14456 (t
14457 (message
14458 "The region has %d words." count))))))
14459 @end group
14460 @end smallexample
14461
14462 @node Counting Exercise
14463 @section Exercise: Counting Punctuation
14464
14465 Using a @code{while} loop, write a function to count the number of
14466 punctuation marks in a region---period, comma, semicolon, colon,
14467 exclamation mark, and question mark. Do the same using recursion.
14468
14469 @node Words in a defun
14470 @chapter Counting Words in a @code{defun}
14471 @cindex Counting words in a @code{defun}
14472 @cindex Word counting in a @code{defun}
14473
14474 Our next project is to count the number of words in a function
14475 definition. Clearly, this can be done using some variant of
14476 @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}}. @xref{Counting Words, , Counting Words:
14477 Repetition and Regexps}. If we are just going to count the words in
14478 one definition, it is easy enough to mark the definition with the
14479 @kbd{C-M-h} (@code{mark-defun}) command, and then call
14480 @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}}.
14481
14482 However, I am more ambitious: I want to count the words and symbols in
14483 every definition in the Emacs sources and then print a graph that
14484 shows how many functions there are of each length: how many contain 40
14485 to 49 words or symbols, how many contain 50 to 59 words or symbols,
14486 and so on. I have often been curious how long a typical function is,
14487 and this will tell.
14488
14489 @menu
14490 * Divide and Conquer::
14491 * Words and Symbols:: What to count?
14492 * Syntax:: What constitutes a word or symbol?
14493 * count-words-in-defun:: Very like @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}}.
14494 * Several defuns:: Counting several defuns in a file.
14495 * Find a File:: Do you want to look at a file?
14496 * lengths-list-file:: A list of the lengths of many definitions.
14497 * Several files:: Counting in definitions in different files.
14498 * Several files recursively:: Recursively counting in different files.
14499 * Prepare the data:: Prepare the data for display in a graph.
14500 @end menu
14501
14502 @ifnottex
14503 @node Divide and Conquer
14504 @unnumberedsec Divide and Conquer
14505 @end ifnottex
14506
14507 Described in one phrase, the histogram project is daunting; but
14508 divided into numerous small steps, each of which we can take one at a
14509 time, the project becomes less fearsome. Let us consider what the
14510 steps must be:
14511
14512 @itemize @bullet
14513 @item
14514 First, write a function to count the words in one definition. This
14515 includes the problem of handling symbols as well as words.
14516
14517 @item
14518 Second, write a function to list the numbers of words in each function
14519 in a file. This function can use the @code{count-words-in-defun}
14520 function.
14521
14522 @item
14523 Third, write a function to list the numbers of words in each function
14524 in each of several files. This entails automatically finding the
14525 various files, switching to them, and counting the words in the
14526 definitions within them.
14527
14528 @item
14529 Fourth, write a function to convert the list of numbers that we
14530 created in step three to a form that will be suitable for printing as
14531 a graph.
14532
14533 @item
14534 Fifth, write a function to print the results as a graph.
14535 @end itemize
14536
14537 This is quite a project! But if we take each step slowly, it will not
14538 be difficult.
14539
14540 @node Words and Symbols
14541 @section What to Count?
14542 @cindex Words and symbols in defun
14543
14544 When we first start thinking about how to count the words in a
14545 function definition, the first question is (or ought to be) what are
14546 we going to count? When we speak of `words' with respect to a Lisp
14547 function definition, we are actually speaking, in large part, of
14548 `symbols'. For example, the following @code{multiply-by-seven}
14549 function contains the five symbols @code{defun},
14550 @code{multiply-by-seven}, @code{number}, @code{*}, and @code{7}. In
14551 addition, in the documentation string, it contains the four words
14552 @samp{Multiply}, @samp{NUMBER}, @samp{by}, and @samp{seven}. The
14553 symbol @samp{number} is repeated, so the definition contains a total
14554 of ten words and symbols.
14555
14556 @smallexample
14557 @group
14558 (defun multiply-by-seven (number)
14559 "Multiply NUMBER by seven."
14560 (* 7 number))
14561 @end group
14562 @end smallexample
14563
14564 @noindent
14565 However, if we mark the @code{multiply-by-seven} definition with
14566 @kbd{C-M-h} (@code{mark-defun}), and then call
14567 @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}} on it, we will find that
14568 @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}} claims the definition has eleven words, not
14569 ten! Something is wrong!
14570
14571 The problem is twofold: @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}} does not count the
14572 @samp{*} as a word, and it counts the single symbol,
14573 @code{multiply-by-seven}, as containing three words. The hyphens are
14574 treated as if they were interword spaces rather than intraword
14575 connectors: @samp{multiply-by-seven} is counted as if it were written
14576 @samp{multiply by seven}.
14577
14578 The cause of this confusion is the regular expression search within
14579 the @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}} definition that moves point forward word
14580 by word. In the canonical version of @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}}, the
14581 regexp is:
14582
14583 @smallexample
14584 "\\w+\\W*"
14585 @end smallexample
14586
14587 @noindent
14588 This regular expression is a pattern defining one or more word
14589 constituent characters possibly followed by one or more characters
14590 that are not word constituents. What is meant by `word constituent
14591 characters' brings us to the issue of syntax, which is worth a section
14592 of its own.
14593
14594 @node Syntax
14595 @section What Constitutes a Word or Symbol?
14596 @cindex Syntax categories and tables
14597
14598 Emacs treats different characters as belonging to different
14599 @dfn{syntax categories}. For example, the regular expression,
14600 @samp{\\w+}, is a pattern specifying one or more @emph{word
14601 constituent} characters. Word constituent characters are members of
14602 one syntax category. Other syntax categories include the class of
14603 punctuation characters, such as the period and the comma, and the
14604 class of whitespace characters, such as the blank space and the tab
14605 character. (For more information, @pxref{Syntax Tables, , Syntax
14606 Tables, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}.)
14607
14608 Syntax tables specify which characters belong to which categories.
14609 Usually, a hyphen is not specified as a `word constituent character'.
14610 Instead, it is specified as being in the `class of characters that are
14611 part of symbol names but not words.' This means that the
14612 @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}} function treats it in the same way it treats
14613 an interword white space, which is why @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}}
14614 counts @samp{multiply-by-seven} as three words.
14615
14616 There are two ways to cause Emacs to count @samp{multiply-by-seven} as
14617 one symbol: modify the syntax table or modify the regular expression.
14618
14619 We could redefine a hyphen as a word constituent character by
14620 modifying the syntax table that Emacs keeps for each mode. This
14621 action would serve our purpose, except that a hyphen is merely the
14622 most common character within symbols that is not typically a word
14623 constituent character; there are others, too.
14624
14625 Alternatively, we can redefine the regexp used in the
14626 @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}} definition so as to include symbols. This
14627 procedure has the merit of clarity, but the task is a little tricky.
14628
14629 @need 1200
14630 The first part is simple enough: the pattern must match ``at least one
14631 character that is a word or symbol constituent''. Thus:
14632
14633 @smallexample
14634 "\\(\\w\\|\\s_\\)+"
14635 @end smallexample
14636
14637 @noindent
14638 The @samp{\\(} is the first part of the grouping construct that
14639 includes the @samp{\\w} and the @samp{\\s_} as alternatives, separated
14640 by the @samp{\\|}. The @samp{\\w} matches any word-constituent
14641 character and the @samp{\\s_} matches any character that is part of a
14642 symbol name but not a word-constituent character. The @samp{+}
14643 following the group indicates that the word or symbol constituent
14644 characters must be matched at least once.
14645
14646 However, the second part of the regexp is more difficult to design.
14647 What we want is to follow the first part with ``optionally one or more
14648 characters that are not constituents of a word or symbol''. At first,
14649 I thought I could define this with the following:
14650
14651 @smallexample
14652 "\\(\\W\\|\\S_\\)*"
14653 @end smallexample
14654
14655 @noindent
14656 The upper case @samp{W} and @samp{S} match characters that are
14657 @emph{not} word or symbol constituents. Unfortunately, this
14658 expression matches any character that is either not a word constituent
14659 or not a symbol constituent. This matches any character!
14660
14661 I then noticed that every word or symbol in my test region was
14662 followed by white space (blank space, tab, or newline). So I tried
14663 placing a pattern to match one or more blank spaces after the pattern
14664 for one or more word or symbol constituents. This failed, too. Words
14665 and symbols are often separated by whitespace, but in actual code
14666 parentheses may follow symbols and punctuation may follow words. So
14667 finally, I designed a pattern in which the word or symbol constituents
14668 are followed optionally by characters that are not white space and
14669 then followed optionally by white space.
14670
14671 @need 800
14672 Here is the full regular expression:
14673
14674 @smallexample
14675 "\\(\\w\\|\\s_\\)+[^ \t\n]*[ \t\n]*"
14676 @end smallexample
14677
14678 @node count-words-in-defun
14679 @section The @code{count-words-in-defun} Function
14680 @cindex Counting words in a @code{defun}
14681
14682 We have seen that there are several ways to write a
14683 @code{count-words-region} function. To write a
14684 @code{count-words-in-defun}, we need merely adapt one of these
14685 versions.
14686
14687 The version that uses a @code{while} loop is easy to understand, so I
14688 am going to adapt that. Because @code{count-words-in-defun} will be
14689 part of a more complex program, it need not be interactive and it need
14690 not display a message but just return the count. These considerations
14691 simplify the definition a little.
14692
14693 On the other hand, @code{count-words-in-defun} will be used within a
14694 buffer that contains function definitions. Consequently, it is
14695 reasonable to ask that the function determine whether it is called
14696 when point is within a function definition, and if it is, to return
14697 the count for that definition. This adds complexity to the
14698 definition, but saves us from needing to pass arguments to the
14699 function.
14700
14701 @need 1250
14702 These considerations lead us to prepare the following template:
14703
14704 @smallexample
14705 @group
14706 (defun count-words-in-defun ()
14707 "@var{documentation}@dots{}"
14708 (@var{set up}@dots{}
14709 (@var{while loop}@dots{})
14710 @var{return count})
14711 @end group
14712 @end smallexample
14713
14714 @noindent
14715 As usual, our job is to fill in the slots.
14716
14717 First, the set up.
14718
14719 We are presuming that this function will be called within a buffer
14720 containing function definitions. Point will either be within a
14721 function definition or not. For @code{count-words-in-defun} to work,
14722 point must move to the beginning of the definition, a counter must
14723 start at zero, and the counting loop must stop when point reaches the
14724 end of the definition.
14725
14726 The @code{beginning-of-defun} function searches backwards for an
14727 opening delimiter such as a @samp{(} at the beginning of a line, and
14728 moves point to that position, or else to the limit of the search. In
14729 practice, this means that @code{beginning-of-defun} moves point to the
14730 beginning of an enclosing or preceding function definition, or else to
14731 the beginning of the buffer. We can use @code{beginning-of-defun} to
14732 place point where we wish to start.
14733
14734 The @code{while} loop requires a counter to keep track of the words or
14735 symbols being counted. A @code{let} expression can be used to create
14736 a local variable for this purpose, and bind it to an initial value of zero.
14737
14738 The @code{end-of-defun} function works like @code{beginning-of-defun}
14739 except that it moves point to the end of the definition.
14740 @code{end-of-defun} can be used as part of an expression that
14741 determines the position of the end of the definition.
14742
14743 The set up for @code{count-words-in-defun} takes shape rapidly: first
14744 we move point to the beginning of the definition, then we create a
14745 local variable to hold the count, and finally, we record the position
14746 of the end of the definition so the @code{while} loop will know when to stop
14747 looping.
14748
14749 @need 1250
14750 The code looks like this:
14751
14752 @smallexample
14753 @group
14754 (beginning-of-defun)
14755 (let ((count 0)
14756 (end (save-excursion (end-of-defun) (point))))
14757 @end group
14758 @end smallexample
14759
14760 @noindent
14761 The code is simple. The only slight complication is likely to concern
14762 @code{end}: it is bound to the position of the end of the definition
14763 by a @code{save-excursion} expression that returns the value of point
14764 after @code{end-of-defun} temporarily moves it to the end of the
14765 definition.
14766
14767 The second part of the @code{count-words-in-defun}, after the set up,
14768 is the @code{while} loop.
14769
14770 The loop must contain an expression that jumps point forward word by
14771 word and symbol by symbol, and another expression that counts the
14772 jumps. The true-or-false-test for the @code{while} loop should test
14773 true so long as point should jump forward, and false when point is at
14774 the end of the definition. We have already redefined the regular
14775 expression for this, so the loop is straightforward:
14776
14777 @smallexample
14778 @group
14779 (while (and (< (point) end)
14780 (re-search-forward
14781 "\\(\\w\\|\\s_\\)+[^ \t\n]*[ \t\n]*" end t))
14782 (setq count (1+ count)))
14783 @end group
14784 @end smallexample
14785
14786 The third part of the function definition returns the count of words
14787 and symbols. This part is the last expression within the body of the
14788 @code{let} expression, and can be, very simply, the local variable
14789 @code{count}, which when evaluated returns the count.
14790
14791 @need 1250
14792 Put together, the @code{count-words-in-defun} definition looks like this:
14793
14794 @findex count-words-in-defun
14795 @smallexample
14796 @group
14797 (defun count-words-in-defun ()
14798 "Return the number of words and symbols in a defun."
14799 (beginning-of-defun)
14800 (let ((count 0)
14801 (end (save-excursion (end-of-defun) (point))))
14802 @end group
14803 @group
14804 (while
14805 (and (< (point) end)
14806 (re-search-forward
14807 "\\(\\w\\|\\s_\\)+[^ \t\n]*[ \t\n]*"
14808 end t))
14809 (setq count (1+ count)))
14810 count))
14811 @end group
14812 @end smallexample
14813
14814 How to test this? The function is not interactive, but it is easy to
14815 put a wrapper around the function to make it interactive; we can use
14816 almost the same code as for the recursive version of
14817 @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}}:
14818
14819 @smallexample
14820 @group
14821 ;;; @r{Interactive version.}
14822 (defun count-words-defun ()
14823 "Number of words and symbols in a function definition."
14824 (interactive)
14825 (message
14826 "Counting words and symbols in function definition ... ")
14827 @end group
14828 @group
14829 (let ((count (count-words-in-defun)))
14830 (cond
14831 ((zerop count)
14832 (message
14833 "The definition does NOT have any words or symbols."))
14834 @end group
14835 @group
14836 ((= 1 count)
14837 (message
14838 "The definition has 1 word or symbol."))
14839 (t
14840 (message
14841 "The definition has %d words or symbols." count)))))
14842 @end group
14843 @end smallexample
14844
14845 @need 800
14846 @noindent
14847 Let's re-use @kbd{C-c =} as a convenient keybinding:
14848
14849 @smallexample
14850 (global-set-key "\C-c=" 'count-words-defun)
14851 @end smallexample
14852
14853 Now we can try out @code{count-words-defun}: install both
14854 @code{count-words-in-defun} and @code{count-words-defun}, and set the
14855 keybinding, and then place the cursor within the following definition:
14856
14857 @smallexample
14858 @group
14859 (defun multiply-by-seven (number)
14860 "Multiply NUMBER by seven."
14861 (* 7 number))
14862 @result{} 10
14863 @end group
14864 @end smallexample
14865
14866 @noindent
14867 Success! The definition has 10 words and symbols.
14868
14869 The next problem is to count the numbers of words and symbols in
14870 several definitions within a single file.
14871
14872 @node Several defuns
14873 @section Count Several @code{defuns} Within a File
14874
14875 A file such as @file{simple.el} may have a hundred or more function
14876 definitions within it. Our long term goal is to collect statistics on
14877 many files, but as a first step, our immediate goal is to collect
14878 statistics on one file.
14879
14880 The information will be a series of numbers, each number being the
14881 length of a function definition. We can store the numbers in a list.
14882
14883 We know that we will want to incorporate the information regarding one
14884 file with information about many other files; this means that the
14885 function for counting definition lengths within one file need only
14886 return the list of lengths. It need not and should not display any
14887 messages.
14888
14889 The word count commands contain one expression to jump point forward
14890 word by word and another expression to count the jumps. The function
14891 to return the lengths of definitions can be designed to work the same
14892 way, with one expression to jump point forward definition by
14893 definition and another expression to construct the lengths' list.
14894
14895 This statement of the problem makes it elementary to write the
14896 function definition. Clearly, we will start the count at the
14897 beginning of the file, so the first command will be @code{(goto-char
14898 (point-min))}. Next, we start the @code{while} loop; and the
14899 true-or-false test of the loop can be a regular expression search for
14900 the next function definition---so long as the search succeeds, point
14901 is moved forward and then the body of the loop is evaluated. The body
14902 needs an expression that constructs the lengths' list. @code{cons},
14903 the list construction command, can be used to create the list. That
14904 is almost all there is to it.
14905
14906 @need 800
14907 Here is what this fragment of code looks like:
14908
14909 @smallexample
14910 @group
14911 (goto-char (point-min))
14912 (while (re-search-forward "^(defun" nil t)
14913 (setq lengths-list
14914 (cons (count-words-in-defun) lengths-list)))
14915 @end group
14916 @end smallexample
14917
14918 What we have left out is the mechanism for finding the file that
14919 contains the function definitions.
14920
14921 In previous examples, we either used this, the Info file, or we
14922 switched back and forth to some other buffer, such as the
14923 @file{*scratch*} buffer.
14924
14925 Finding a file is a new process that we have not yet discussed.
14926
14927 @node Find a File
14928 @section Find a File
14929 @cindex Find a File
14930
14931 To find a file in Emacs, you use the @kbd{C-x C-f} (@code{find-file})
14932 command. This command is almost, but not quite right for the lengths
14933 problem.
14934
14935 @need 1200
14936 Let's look at the source for @code{find-file}:
14937
14938 @smallexample
14939 @group
14940 (defun find-file (filename)
14941 "Edit file FILENAME.
14942 Switch to a buffer visiting file FILENAME,
14943 creating one if none already exists."
14944 (interactive "FFind file: ")
14945 (switch-to-buffer (find-file-noselect filename)))
14946 @end group
14947 @end smallexample
14948
14949 @noindent
14950 (The most recent version of the @code{find-file} function definition
14951 permits you to specify optional wildcards to visit multiple files; that
14952 makes the definition more complex and we will not discuss it here,
14953 since it is not relevant. You can see its source using either
14954 @kbd{M-.} (@code{find-tag}) or @kbd{C-h f} (@code{describe-function}).)
14955
14956 @ignore
14957 In Emacs 22
14958 (defun find-file (filename &optional wildcards)
14959 "Edit file FILENAME.
14960 Switch to a buffer visiting file FILENAME,
14961 creating one if none already exists.
14962 Interactively, the default if you just type RET is the current directory,
14963 but the visited file name is available through the minibuffer history:
14964 type M-n to pull it into the minibuffer.
14965
14966 Interactively, or if WILDCARDS is non-nil in a call from Lisp,
14967 expand wildcards (if any) and visit multiple files. You can
14968 suppress wildcard expansion by setting `find-file-wildcards' to nil.
14969
14970 To visit a file without any kind of conversion and without
14971 automatically choosing a major mode, use \\[find-file-literally]."
14972 (interactive (find-file-read-args "Find file: " nil))
14973 (let ((value (find-file-noselect filename nil nil wildcards)))
14974 (if (listp value)
14975 (mapcar 'switch-to-buffer (nreverse value))
14976 (switch-to-buffer value))))
14977 @end ignore
14978
14979 The definition I am showing possesses short but complete documentation
14980 and an interactive specification that prompts you for a file name when
14981 you use the command interactively. The body of the definition
14982 contains two functions, @code{find-file-noselect} and
14983 @code{switch-to-buffer}.
14984
14985 According to its documentation as shown by @kbd{C-h f} (the
14986 @code{describe-function} command), the @code{find-file-noselect}
14987 function reads the named file into a buffer and returns the buffer.
14988 (Its most recent version includes an optional wildcards argument,
14989 too, as well as another to read a file literally and an other you
14990 suppress warning messages. These optional arguments are irrelevant.)
14991
14992 However, the @code{find-file-noselect} function does not select the
14993 buffer in which it puts the file. Emacs does not switch its attention
14994 (or yours if you are using @code{find-file-noselect}) to the selected
14995 buffer. That is what @code{switch-to-buffer} does: it switches the
14996 buffer to which Emacs attention is directed; and it switches the
14997 buffer displayed in the window to the new buffer. We have discussed
14998 buffer switching elsewhere. (@xref{Switching Buffers}.)
14999
15000 In this histogram project, we do not need to display each file on the
15001 screen as the program determines the length of each definition within
15002 it. Instead of employing @code{switch-to-buffer}, we can work with
15003 @code{set-buffer}, which redirects the attention of the computer
15004 program to a different buffer but does not redisplay it on the screen.
15005 So instead of calling on @code{find-file} to do the job, we must write
15006 our own expression.
15007
15008 The task is easy: use @code{find-file-noselect} and @code{set-buffer}.
15009
15010 @node lengths-list-file
15011 @section @code{lengths-list-file} in Detail
15012
15013 The core of the @code{lengths-list-file} function is a @code{while}
15014 loop containing a function to move point forward `defun by defun' and
15015 a function to count the number of words and symbols in each defun.
15016 This core must be surrounded by functions that do various other tasks,
15017 including finding the file, and ensuring that point starts out at the
15018 beginning of the file. The function definition looks like this:
15019 @findex lengths-list-file
15020
15021 @smallexample
15022 @group
15023 (defun lengths-list-file (filename)
15024 "Return list of definitions' lengths within FILE.
15025 The returned list is a list of numbers.
15026 Each number is the number of words or
15027 symbols in one function definition."
15028 @end group
15029 @group
15030 (message "Working on `%s' ... " filename)
15031 (save-excursion
15032 (let ((buffer (find-file-noselect filename))
15033 (lengths-list))
15034 (set-buffer buffer)
15035 (setq buffer-read-only t)
15036 (widen)
15037 (goto-char (point-min))
15038 (while (re-search-forward "^(defun" nil t)
15039 (setq lengths-list
15040 (cons (count-words-in-defun) lengths-list)))
15041 (kill-buffer buffer)
15042 lengths-list)))
15043 @end group
15044 @end smallexample
15045
15046 @noindent
15047 The function is passed one argument, the name of the file on which it
15048 will work. It has four lines of documentation, but no interactive
15049 specification. Since people worry that a computer is broken if they
15050 don't see anything going on, the first line of the body is a
15051 message.
15052
15053 The next line contains a @code{save-excursion} that returns Emacs's
15054 attention to the current buffer when the function completes. This is
15055 useful in case you embed this function in another function that
15056 presumes point is restored to the original buffer.
15057
15058 In the varlist of the @code{let} expression, Emacs finds the file and
15059 binds the local variable @code{buffer} to the buffer containing the
15060 file. At the same time, Emacs creates @code{lengths-list} as a local
15061 variable.
15062
15063 Next, Emacs switches its attention to the buffer.
15064
15065 In the following line, Emacs makes the buffer read-only. Ideally,
15066 this line is not necessary. None of the functions for counting words
15067 and symbols in a function definition should change the buffer.
15068 Besides, the buffer is not going to be saved, even if it were changed.
15069 This line is entirely the consequence of great, perhaps excessive,
15070 caution. The reason for the caution is that this function and those
15071 it calls work on the sources for Emacs and it is inconvenient if they
15072 are inadvertently modified. It goes without saying that I did not
15073 realize a need for this line until an experiment went awry and started
15074 to modify my Emacs source files @dots{}
15075
15076 Next comes a call to widen the buffer if it is narrowed. This
15077 function is usually not needed---Emacs creates a fresh buffer if none
15078 already exists; but if a buffer visiting the file already exists Emacs
15079 returns that one. In this case, the buffer may be narrowed and must
15080 be widened. If we wanted to be fully `user-friendly', we would
15081 arrange to save the restriction and the location of point, but we
15082 won't.
15083
15084 The @code{(goto-char (point-min))} expression moves point to the
15085 beginning of the buffer.
15086
15087 Then comes a @code{while} loop in which the `work' of the function is
15088 carried out. In the loop, Emacs determines the length of each
15089 definition and constructs a lengths' list containing the information.
15090
15091 Emacs kills the buffer after working through it. This is to save
15092 space inside of Emacs. My version of GNU Emacs 19 contained over 300
15093 source files of interest; GNU Emacs 22 contains over a thousand source
15094 files. Another function will apply @code{lengths-list-file} to each
15095 of the files.
15096
15097 Finally, the last expression within the @code{let} expression is the
15098 @code{lengths-list} variable; its value is returned as the value of
15099 the whole function.
15100
15101 You can try this function by installing it in the usual fashion. Then
15102 place your cursor after the following expression and type @kbd{C-x
15103 C-e} (@code{eval-last-sexp}).
15104
15105 @c !!! 22.1.1 lisp sources location here
15106 @smallexample
15107 (lengths-list-file
15108 "/usr/local/share/emacs/22.1.1/lisp/emacs-lisp/debug.el")
15109 @end smallexample
15110
15111 @noindent
15112 (You may need to change the pathname of the file; the one here is for
15113 GNU Emacs version 22.1.1. To change the expression, copy it to
15114 the @file{*scratch*} buffer and edit it.
15115
15116 @need 1200
15117 @noindent
15118 (Also, to see the full length of the list, rather than a truncated
15119 version, you may have to evaluate the following:
15120
15121 @smallexample
15122 (custom-set-variables '(eval-expression-print-length nil))
15123 @end smallexample
15124
15125 @noindent
15126 (@xref{defcustom, , Specifying Variables using @code{defcustom}}.
15127 Then evaluate the @code{lengths-list-file} expression.)
15128
15129 @need 1200
15130 The lengths' list for @file{debug.el} takes less than a second to
15131 produce and looks like this in GNU Emacs 22:
15132
15133 @smallexample
15134 (83 113 105 144 289 22 30 97 48 89 25 52 52 88 28 29 77 49 43 290 232 587)
15135 @end smallexample
15136
15137 @need 1500
15138 (Using my old machine, the version 19 lengths' list for @file{debug.el}
15139 took seven seconds to produce and looked like this:
15140
15141 @smallexample
15142 (75 41 80 62 20 45 44 68 45 12 34 235)
15143 @end smallexample
15144
15145 (The newer version of @file{debug.el} contains more defuns than the
15146 earlier one; and my new machine is much faster than the old one.)
15147
15148 Note that the length of the last definition in the file is first in
15149 the list.
15150
15151 @node Several files
15152 @section Count Words in @code{defuns} in Different Files
15153
15154 In the previous section, we created a function that returns a list of
15155 the lengths of each definition in a file. Now, we want to define a
15156 function to return a master list of the lengths of the definitions in
15157 a list of files.
15158
15159 Working on each of a list of files is a repetitious act, so we can use
15160 either a @code{while} loop or recursion.
15161
15162 @menu
15163 * lengths-list-many-files:: Return a list of the lengths of defuns.
15164 * append:: Attach one list to another.
15165 @end menu
15166
15167 @ifnottex
15168 @node lengths-list-many-files
15169 @unnumberedsubsec Determine the lengths of @code{defuns}
15170 @end ifnottex
15171
15172 The design using a @code{while} loop is routine. The argument passed
15173 the function is a list of files. As we saw earlier (@pxref{Loop
15174 Example}), you can write a @code{while} loop so that the body of the
15175 loop is evaluated if such a list contains elements, but to exit the
15176 loop if the list is empty. For this design to work, the body of the
15177 loop must contain an expression that shortens the list each time the
15178 body is evaluated, so that eventually the list is empty. The usual
15179 technique is to set the value of the list to the value of the @sc{cdr}
15180 of the list each time the body is evaluated.
15181
15182 @need 800
15183 The template looks like this:
15184
15185 @smallexample
15186 @group
15187 (while @var{test-whether-list-is-empty}
15188 @var{body}@dots{}
15189 @var{set-list-to-cdr-of-list})
15190 @end group
15191 @end smallexample
15192
15193 Also, we remember that a @code{while} loop returns @code{nil} (the
15194 result of evaluating the true-or-false-test), not the result of any
15195 evaluation within its body. (The evaluations within the body of the
15196 loop are done for their side effects.) However, the expression that
15197 sets the lengths' list is part of the body---and that is the value
15198 that we want returned by the function as a whole. To do this, we
15199 enclose the @code{while} loop within a @code{let} expression, and
15200 arrange that the last element of the @code{let} expression contains
15201 the value of the lengths' list. (@xref{Incrementing Example, , Loop
15202 Example with an Incrementing Counter}.)
15203
15204 @findex lengths-list-many-files
15205 @need 1250
15206 These considerations lead us directly to the function itself:
15207
15208 @smallexample
15209 @group
15210 ;;; @r{Use @code{while} loop.}
15211 (defun lengths-list-many-files (list-of-files)
15212 "Return list of lengths of defuns in LIST-OF-FILES."
15213 @end group
15214 @group
15215 (let (lengths-list)
15216
15217 ;;; @r{true-or-false-test}
15218 (while list-of-files
15219 (setq lengths-list
15220 (append
15221 lengths-list
15222
15223 ;;; @r{Generate a lengths' list.}
15224 (lengths-list-file
15225 (expand-file-name (car list-of-files)))))
15226 @end group
15227
15228 @group
15229 ;;; @r{Make files' list shorter.}
15230 (setq list-of-files (cdr list-of-files)))
15231
15232 ;;; @r{Return final value of lengths' list.}
15233 lengths-list))
15234 @end group
15235 @end smallexample
15236
15237 @code{expand-file-name} is a built-in function that converts a file
15238 name to the absolute, long, path name form. The function employs the
15239 name of the directory in which the function is called.
15240
15241 @c !!! 22.1.1 lisp sources location here
15242 @need 1500
15243 Thus, if @code{expand-file-name} is called on @code{debug.el} when
15244 Emacs is visiting the
15245 @file{/usr/local/share/emacs/22.1.1/lisp/emacs-lisp/} directory,
15246
15247 @smallexample
15248 debug.el
15249 @end smallexample
15250
15251 @need 800
15252 @noindent
15253 becomes
15254
15255 @c !!! 22.1.1 lisp sources location here
15256 @smallexample
15257 /usr/local/share/emacs/22.1.1/lisp/emacs-lisp/debug.el
15258 @end smallexample
15259
15260 The only other new element of this function definition is the as yet
15261 unstudied function @code{append}, which merits a short section for
15262 itself.
15263
15264 @node append
15265 @subsection The @code{append} Function
15266
15267 @need 800
15268 The @code{append} function attaches one list to another. Thus,
15269
15270 @smallexample
15271 (append '(1 2 3 4) '(5 6 7 8))
15272 @end smallexample
15273
15274 @need 800
15275 @noindent
15276 produces the list
15277
15278 @smallexample
15279 (1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8)
15280 @end smallexample
15281
15282 This is exactly how we want to attach two lengths' lists produced by
15283 @code{lengths-list-file} to each other. The results contrast with
15284 @code{cons},
15285
15286 @smallexample
15287 (cons '(1 2 3 4) '(5 6 7 8))
15288 @end smallexample
15289
15290 @need 1250
15291 @noindent
15292 which constructs a new list in which the first argument to @code{cons}
15293 becomes the first element of the new list:
15294
15295 @smallexample
15296 ((1 2 3 4) 5 6 7 8)
15297 @end smallexample
15298
15299 @node Several files recursively
15300 @section Recursively Count Words in Different Files
15301
15302 Besides a @code{while} loop, you can work on each of a list of files
15303 with recursion. A recursive version of @code{lengths-list-many-files}
15304 is short and simple.
15305
15306 The recursive function has the usual parts: the `do-again-test', the
15307 `next-step-expression', and the recursive call. The `do-again-test'
15308 determines whether the function should call itself again, which it
15309 will do if the @code{list-of-files} contains any remaining elements;
15310 the `next-step-expression' resets the @code{list-of-files} to the
15311 @sc{cdr} of itself, so eventually the list will be empty; and the
15312 recursive call calls itself on the shorter list. The complete
15313 function is shorter than this description!
15314 @findex recursive-lengths-list-many-files
15315
15316 @smallexample
15317 @group
15318 (defun recursive-lengths-list-many-files (list-of-files)
15319 "Return list of lengths of each defun in LIST-OF-FILES."
15320 (if list-of-files ; @r{do-again-test}
15321 (append
15322 (lengths-list-file
15323 (expand-file-name (car list-of-files)))
15324 (recursive-lengths-list-many-files
15325 (cdr list-of-files)))))
15326 @end group
15327 @end smallexample
15328
15329 @noindent
15330 In a sentence, the function returns the lengths' list for the first of
15331 the @code{list-of-files} appended to the result of calling itself on
15332 the rest of the @code{list-of-files}.
15333
15334 Here is a test of @code{recursive-lengths-list-many-files}, along with
15335 the results of running @code{lengths-list-file} on each of the files
15336 individually.
15337
15338 Install @code{recursive-lengths-list-many-files} and
15339 @code{lengths-list-file}, if necessary, and then evaluate the
15340 following expressions. You may need to change the files' pathnames;
15341 those here work when this Info file and the Emacs sources are located
15342 in their customary places. To change the expressions, copy them to
15343 the @file{*scratch*} buffer, edit them, and then evaluate them.
15344
15345 The results are shown after the @samp{@result{}}. (These results are
15346 for files from Emacs version 22.1.1; files from other versions of
15347 Emacs may produce different results.)
15348
15349 @c !!! 22.1.1 lisp sources location here
15350 @smallexample
15351 @group
15352 (cd "/usr/local/share/emacs/22.1.1/")
15353
15354 (lengths-list-file "./lisp/macros.el")
15355 @result{} (283 263 480 90)
15356 @end group
15357
15358 @group
15359 (lengths-list-file "./lisp/mail/mailalias.el")
15360 @result{} (38 32 29 95 178 180 321 218 324)
15361 @end group
15362
15363 @group
15364 (lengths-list-file "./lisp/makesum.el")
15365 @result{} (85 181)
15366 @end group
15367
15368 @group
15369 (recursive-lengths-list-many-files
15370 '("./lisp/macros.el"
15371 "./lisp/mail/mailalias.el"
15372 "./lisp/makesum.el"))
15373 @result{} (283 263 480 90 38 32 29 95 178 180 321 218 324 85 181)
15374 @end group
15375 @end smallexample
15376
15377 The @code{recursive-lengths-list-many-files} function produces the
15378 output we want.
15379
15380 The next step is to prepare the data in the list for display in a graph.
15381
15382 @node Prepare the data
15383 @section Prepare the Data for Display in a Graph
15384
15385 The @code{recursive-lengths-list-many-files} function returns a list
15386 of numbers. Each number records the length of a function definition.
15387 What we need to do now is transform this data into a list of numbers
15388 suitable for generating a graph. The new list will tell how many
15389 functions definitions contain less than 10 words and
15390 symbols, how many contain between 10 and 19 words and symbols, how
15391 many contain between 20 and 29 words and symbols, and so on.
15392
15393 In brief, we need to go through the lengths' list produced by the
15394 @code{recursive-lengths-list-many-files} function and count the number
15395 of defuns within each range of lengths, and produce a list of those
15396 numbers.
15397
15398 @menu
15399 * Data for Display in Detail::
15400 * Sorting:: Sorting lists.
15401 * Files List:: Making a list of files.
15402 * Counting function definitions::
15403 @end menu
15404
15405 @ifnottex
15406 @node Data for Display in Detail
15407 @unnumberedsubsec The Data for Display in Detail
15408 @end ifnottex
15409
15410 Based on what we have done before, we can readily foresee that it
15411 should not be too hard to write a function that `@sc{cdr}s' down the
15412 lengths' list, looks at each element, determines which length range it
15413 is in, and increments a counter for that range.
15414
15415 However, before beginning to write such a function, we should consider
15416 the advantages of sorting the lengths' list first, so the numbers are
15417 ordered from smallest to largest. First, sorting will make it easier
15418 to count the numbers in each range, since two adjacent numbers will
15419 either be in the same length range or in adjacent ranges. Second, by
15420 inspecting a sorted list, we can discover the highest and lowest
15421 number, and thereby determine the largest and smallest length range
15422 that we will need.
15423
15424 @node Sorting
15425 @subsection Sorting Lists
15426 @findex sort
15427
15428 Emacs contains a function to sort lists, called (as you might guess)
15429 @code{sort}. The @code{sort} function takes two arguments, the list
15430 to be sorted, and a predicate that determines whether the first of
15431 two list elements is ``less'' than the second.
15432
15433 As we saw earlier (@pxref{Wrong Type of Argument, , Using the Wrong
15434 Type Object as an Argument}), a predicate is a function that
15435 determines whether some property is true or false. The @code{sort}
15436 function will reorder a list according to whatever property the
15437 predicate uses; this means that @code{sort} can be used to sort
15438 non-numeric lists by non-numeric criteria---it can, for example,
15439 alphabetize a list.
15440
15441 @need 1250
15442 The @code{<} function is used when sorting a numeric list. For example,
15443
15444 @smallexample
15445 (sort '(4 8 21 17 33 7 21 7) '<)
15446 @end smallexample
15447
15448 @need 800
15449 @noindent
15450 produces this:
15451
15452 @smallexample
15453 (4 7 7 8 17 21 21 33)
15454 @end smallexample
15455
15456 @noindent
15457 (Note that in this example, both the arguments are quoted so that the
15458 symbols are not evaluated before being passed to @code{sort} as
15459 arguments.)
15460
15461 Sorting the list returned by the
15462 @code{recursive-lengths-list-many-files} function is straightforward;
15463 it uses the @code{<} function:
15464
15465 @ignore
15466 2006 Oct 29
15467 In GNU Emacs 22, eval
15468 (progn
15469 (cd "/usr/local/share/emacs/22.0.50/")
15470 (sort
15471 (recursive-lengths-list-many-files
15472 '("./lisp/macros.el"
15473 "./lisp/mail/mailalias.el"
15474 "./lisp/makesum.el"))
15475 '<))
15476
15477 @end ignore
15478
15479 @smallexample
15480 @group
15481 (sort
15482 (recursive-lengths-list-many-files
15483 '("./lisp/macros.el"
15484 "./lisp/mailalias.el"
15485 "./lisp/makesum.el"))
15486 '<)
15487 @end group
15488 @end smallexample
15489
15490 @need 800
15491 @noindent
15492 which produces:
15493
15494 @smallexample
15495 (29 32 38 85 90 95 178 180 181 218 263 283 321 324 480)
15496 @end smallexample
15497
15498 @noindent
15499 (Note that in this example, the first argument to @code{sort} is not
15500 quoted, since the expression must be evaluated so as to produce the
15501 list that is passed to @code{sort}.)
15502
15503 @node Files List
15504 @subsection Making a List of Files
15505
15506 The @code{recursive-lengths-list-many-files} function requires a list
15507 of files as its argument. For our test examples, we constructed such
15508 a list by hand; but the Emacs Lisp source directory is too large for
15509 us to do for that. Instead, we will write a function to do the job
15510 for us. In this function, we will use both a @code{while} loop and a
15511 recursive call.
15512
15513 @findex directory-files
15514 We did not have to write a function like this for older versions of
15515 GNU Emacs, since they placed all the @samp{.el} files in one
15516 directory. Instead, we were able to use the @code{directory-files}
15517 function, which lists the names of files that match a specified
15518 pattern within a single directory.
15519
15520 However, recent versions of Emacs place Emacs Lisp files in
15521 sub-directories of the top level @file{lisp} directory. This
15522 re-arrangement eases navigation. For example, all the mail related
15523 files are in a @file{lisp} sub-directory called @file{mail}. But at
15524 the same time, this arrangement forces us to create a file listing
15525 function that descends into the sub-directories.
15526
15527 @findex files-in-below-directory
15528 We can create this function, called @code{files-in-below-directory},
15529 using familiar functions such as @code{car}, @code{nthcdr}, and
15530 @code{substring} in conjunction with an existing function called
15531 @code{directory-files-and-attributes}. This latter function not only
15532 lists all the filenames in a directory, including the names
15533 of sub-directories, but also their attributes.
15534
15535 To restate our goal: to create a function that will enable us
15536 to feed filenames to @code{recursive-lengths-list-many-files}
15537 as a list that looks like this (but with more elements):
15538
15539 @smallexample
15540 @group
15541 ("./lisp/macros.el"
15542 "./lisp/mail/rmail.el"
15543 "./lisp/makesum.el")
15544 @end group
15545 @end smallexample
15546
15547 The @code{directory-files-and-attributes} function returns a list of
15548 lists. Each of the lists within the main list consists of 13
15549 elements. The first element is a string that contains the name of the
15550 file---which, in GNU/Linux, may be a `directory file', that is to
15551 say, a file with the special attributes of a directory. The second
15552 element of the list is @code{t} for a directory, a string
15553 for symbolic link (the string is the name linked to), or @code{nil}.
15554
15555 For example, the first @samp{.el} file in the @file{lisp/} directory
15556 is @file{abbrev.el}. Its name is
15557 @file{/usr/local/share/emacs/22.1.1/lisp/abbrev.el} and it is not a
15558 directory or a symbolic link.
15559
15560 @need 1000
15561 This is how @code{directory-files-and-attributes} lists that file and
15562 its attributes:
15563
15564 @smallexample
15565 @group
15566 ("abbrev.el"
15567 nil
15568 1
15569 1000
15570 100
15571 @end group
15572 @group
15573 (20615 27034 579989 697000)
15574 (17905 55681 0 0)
15575 (20615 26327 734791 805000)
15576 13188
15577 "-rw-r--r--"
15578 @end group
15579 @group
15580 t
15581 2971624
15582 773)
15583 @end group
15584 @end smallexample
15585
15586 @need 1200
15587 On the other hand, @file{mail/} is a directory within the @file{lisp/}
15588 directory. The beginning of its listing looks like this:
15589
15590 @smallexample
15591 @group
15592 ("mail"
15593 t
15594 @dots{}
15595 )
15596 @end group
15597 @end smallexample
15598
15599 (To learn about the different attributes, look at the documentation of
15600 @code{file-attributes}. Bear in mind that the @code{file-attributes}
15601 function does not list the filename, so its first element is
15602 @code{directory-files-and-attributes}'s second element.)
15603
15604 We will want our new function, @code{files-in-below-directory}, to
15605 list the @samp{.el} files in the directory it is told to check, and in
15606 any directories below that directory.
15607
15608 This gives us a hint on how to construct
15609 @code{files-in-below-directory}: within a directory, the function
15610 should add @samp{.el} filenames to a list; and if, within a directory,
15611 the function comes upon a sub-directory, it should go into that
15612 sub-directory and repeat its actions.
15613
15614 However, we should note that every directory contains a name that
15615 refers to itself, called @file{.}, (``dot'') and a name that refers to
15616 its parent directory, called @file{..} (``double dot''). (In
15617 @file{/}, the root directory, @file{..} refers to itself, since
15618 @file{/} has no parent.) Clearly, we do not want our
15619 @code{files-in-below-directory} function to enter those directories,
15620 since they always lead us, directly or indirectly, to the current
15621 directory.
15622
15623 Consequently, our @code{files-in-below-directory} function must do
15624 several tasks:
15625
15626 @itemize @bullet
15627 @item
15628 Check to see whether it is looking at a filename that ends in
15629 @samp{.el}; and if so, add its name to a list.
15630
15631 @item
15632 Check to see whether it is looking at a filename that is the name of a
15633 directory; and if so,
15634
15635 @itemize @minus
15636 @item
15637 Check to see whether it is looking at @file{.} or @file{..}; and if
15638 so skip it.
15639
15640 @item
15641 Or else, go into that directory and repeat the process.
15642 @end itemize
15643 @end itemize
15644
15645 Let's write a function definition to do these tasks. We will use a
15646 @code{while} loop to move from one filename to another within a
15647 directory, checking what needs to be done; and we will use a recursive
15648 call to repeat the actions on each sub-directory. The recursive
15649 pattern is `accumulate'
15650 (@pxref{Accumulate, , Recursive Pattern: @emph{accumulate}}),
15651 using @code{append} as the combiner.
15652
15653 @ignore
15654 (directory-files "/usr/local/src/emacs/lisp/" t "\\.el$")
15655 (shell-command "find /usr/local/src/emacs/lisp/ -name '*.el'")
15656
15657 (directory-files "/usr/local/share/emacs/22.1.1/lisp/" t "\\.el$")
15658 (shell-command "find /usr/local/share/emacs/22.1.1/lisp/ -name '*.el'")
15659 @end ignore
15660
15661 @c /usr/local/share/emacs/22.1.1/lisp/
15662
15663 @need 800
15664 Here is the function:
15665
15666 @smallexample
15667 @group
15668 (defun files-in-below-directory (directory)
15669 "List the .el files in DIRECTORY and in its sub-directories."
15670 ;; Although the function will be used non-interactively,
15671 ;; it will be easier to test if we make it interactive.
15672 ;; The directory will have a name such as
15673 ;; "/usr/local/share/emacs/22.1.1/lisp/"
15674 (interactive "DDirectory name: ")
15675 @end group
15676 @group
15677 (let (el-files-list
15678 (current-directory-list
15679 (directory-files-and-attributes directory t)))
15680 ;; while we are in the current directory
15681 (while current-directory-list
15682 @end group
15683 @group
15684 (cond
15685 ;; check to see whether filename ends in `.el'
15686 ;; and if so, append its name to a list.
15687 ((equal ".el" (substring (car (car current-directory-list)) -3))
15688 (setq el-files-list
15689 (cons (car (car current-directory-list)) el-files-list)))
15690 @end group
15691 @group
15692 ;; check whether filename is that of a directory
15693 ((eq t (car (cdr (car current-directory-list))))
15694 ;; decide whether to skip or recurse
15695 (if
15696 (equal "."
15697 (substring (car (car current-directory-list)) -1))
15698 ;; then do nothing since filename is that of
15699 ;; current directory or parent, "." or ".."
15700 ()
15701 @end group
15702 @group
15703 ;; else descend into the directory and repeat the process
15704 (setq el-files-list
15705 (append
15706 (files-in-below-directory
15707 (car (car current-directory-list)))
15708 el-files-list)))))
15709 ;; move to the next filename in the list; this also
15710 ;; shortens the list so the while loop eventually comes to an end
15711 (setq current-directory-list (cdr current-directory-list)))
15712 ;; return the filenames
15713 el-files-list))
15714 @end group
15715 @end smallexample
15716
15717 @c (files-in-below-directory "/usr/local/src/emacs/lisp/")
15718 @c (files-in-below-directory "/usr/local/share/emacs/22.1.1/lisp/")
15719
15720 The @code{files-in-below-directory} @code{directory-files} function
15721 takes one argument, the name of a directory.
15722
15723 @need 1250
15724 Thus, on my system,
15725
15726 @c (length (files-in-below-directory "/usr/local/src/emacs/lisp/"))
15727
15728 @c !!! 22.1.1 lisp sources location here
15729 @smallexample
15730 @group
15731 (length
15732 (files-in-below-directory "/usr/local/share/emacs/22.1.1/lisp/"))
15733 @end group
15734 @end smallexample
15735
15736 @noindent
15737 tells me that in and below my Lisp sources directory are 1031
15738 @samp{.el} files.
15739
15740 @code{files-in-below-directory} returns a list in reverse alphabetical
15741 order. An expression to sort the list in alphabetical order looks
15742 like this:
15743
15744 @smallexample
15745 @group
15746 (sort
15747 (files-in-below-directory "/usr/local/share/emacs/22.1.1/lisp/")
15748 'string-lessp)
15749 @end group
15750 @end smallexample
15751
15752 @ignore
15753 (defun test ()
15754 "Test how long it takes to find lengths of all sorted elisp defuns."
15755 (insert "\n" (current-time-string) "\n")
15756 (sit-for 0)
15757 (sort
15758 (recursive-lengths-list-many-files
15759 (files-in-below-directory "/usr/local/src/emacs/lisp/"))
15760 '<)
15761 (insert (format "%s" (current-time-string))))
15762 @end ignore
15763
15764 @node Counting function definitions
15765 @subsection Counting function definitions
15766
15767 Our immediate goal is to generate a list that tells us how many
15768 function definitions contain fewer than 10 words and symbols, how many
15769 contain between 10 and 19 words and symbols, how many contain between
15770 20 and 29 words and symbols, and so on.
15771
15772 With a sorted list of numbers, this is easy: count how many elements
15773 of the list are smaller than 10, then, after moving past the numbers
15774 just counted, count how many are smaller than 20, then, after moving
15775 past the numbers just counted, count how many are smaller than 30, and
15776 so on. Each of the numbers, 10, 20, 30, 40, and the like, is one
15777 larger than the top of that range. We can call the list of such
15778 numbers the @code{top-of-ranges} list.
15779
15780 @need 1200
15781 If we wished, we could generate this list automatically, but it is
15782 simpler to write a list manually. Here it is:
15783 @vindex top-of-ranges
15784
15785 @smallexample
15786 @group
15787 (defvar top-of-ranges
15788 '(10 20 30 40 50
15789 60 70 80 90 100
15790 110 120 130 140 150
15791 160 170 180 190 200
15792 210 220 230 240 250
15793 260 270 280 290 300)
15794 "List specifying ranges for `defuns-per-range'.")
15795 @end group
15796 @end smallexample
15797
15798 To change the ranges, we edit this list.
15799
15800 Next, we need to write the function that creates the list of the
15801 number of definitions within each range. Clearly, this function must
15802 take the @code{sorted-lengths} and the @code{top-of-ranges} lists
15803 as arguments.
15804
15805 The @code{defuns-per-range} function must do two things again and
15806 again: it must count the number of definitions within a range
15807 specified by the current top-of-range value; and it must shift to the
15808 next higher value in the @code{top-of-ranges} list after counting the
15809 number of definitions in the current range. Since each of these
15810 actions is repetitive, we can use @code{while} loops for the job.
15811 One loop counts the number of definitions in the range defined by the
15812 current top-of-range value, and the other loop selects each of the
15813 top-of-range values in turn.
15814
15815 Several entries of the @code{sorted-lengths} list are counted for each
15816 range; this means that the loop for the @code{sorted-lengths} list
15817 will be inside the loop for the @code{top-of-ranges} list, like a
15818 small gear inside a big gear.
15819
15820 The inner loop counts the number of definitions within the range. It
15821 is a simple counting loop of the type we have seen before.
15822 (@xref{Incrementing Loop, , A loop with an incrementing counter}.)
15823 The true-or-false test of the loop tests whether the value from the
15824 @code{sorted-lengths} list is smaller than the current value of the
15825 top of the range. If it is, the function increments the counter and
15826 tests the next value from the @code{sorted-lengths} list.
15827
15828 @need 1250
15829 The inner loop looks like this:
15830
15831 @smallexample
15832 @group
15833 (while @var{length-element-smaller-than-top-of-range}
15834 (setq number-within-range (1+ number-within-range))
15835 (setq sorted-lengths (cdr sorted-lengths)))
15836 @end group
15837 @end smallexample
15838
15839 The outer loop must start with the lowest value of the
15840 @code{top-of-ranges} list, and then be set to each of the succeeding
15841 higher values in turn. This can be done with a loop like this:
15842
15843 @smallexample
15844 @group
15845 (while top-of-ranges
15846 @var{body-of-loop}@dots{}
15847 (setq top-of-ranges (cdr top-of-ranges)))
15848 @end group
15849 @end smallexample
15850
15851 @need 1200
15852 Put together, the two loops look like this:
15853
15854 @smallexample
15855 @group
15856 (while top-of-ranges
15857
15858 ;; @r{Count the number of elements within the current range.}
15859 (while @var{length-element-smaller-than-top-of-range}
15860 (setq number-within-range (1+ number-within-range))
15861 (setq sorted-lengths (cdr sorted-lengths)))
15862
15863 ;; @r{Move to next range.}
15864 (setq top-of-ranges (cdr top-of-ranges)))
15865 @end group
15866 @end smallexample
15867
15868 In addition, in each circuit of the outer loop, Emacs should record
15869 the number of definitions within that range (the value of
15870 @code{number-within-range}) in a list. We can use @code{cons} for
15871 this purpose. (@xref{cons, , @code{cons}}.)
15872
15873 The @code{cons} function works fine, except that the list it
15874 constructs will contain the number of definitions for the highest
15875 range at its beginning and the number of definitions for the lowest
15876 range at its end. This is because @code{cons} attaches new elements
15877 of the list to the beginning of the list, and since the two loops are
15878 working their way through the lengths' list from the lower end first,
15879 the @code{defuns-per-range-list} will end up largest number first.
15880 But we will want to print our graph with smallest values first and the
15881 larger later. The solution is to reverse the order of the
15882 @code{defuns-per-range-list}. We can do this using the
15883 @code{nreverse} function, which reverses the order of a list.
15884 @findex nreverse
15885
15886 @need 800
15887 For example,
15888
15889 @smallexample
15890 (nreverse '(1 2 3 4))
15891 @end smallexample
15892
15893 @need 800
15894 @noindent
15895 produces:
15896
15897 @smallexample
15898 (4 3 2 1)
15899 @end smallexample
15900
15901 Note that the @code{nreverse} function is ``destructive''---that is,
15902 it changes the list to which it is applied; this contrasts with the
15903 @code{car} and @code{cdr} functions, which are non-destructive. In
15904 this case, we do not want the original @code{defuns-per-range-list},
15905 so it does not matter that it is destroyed. (The @code{reverse}
15906 function provides a reversed copy of a list, leaving the original list
15907 as is.)
15908 @findex reverse
15909
15910 @need 1250
15911 Put all together, the @code{defuns-per-range} looks like this:
15912
15913 @smallexample
15914 @group
15915 (defun defuns-per-range (sorted-lengths top-of-ranges)
15916 "SORTED-LENGTHS defuns in each TOP-OF-RANGES range."
15917 (let ((top-of-range (car top-of-ranges))
15918 (number-within-range 0)
15919 defuns-per-range-list)
15920 @end group
15921
15922 @group
15923 ;; @r{Outer loop.}
15924 (while top-of-ranges
15925 @end group
15926
15927 @group
15928 ;; @r{Inner loop.}
15929 (while (and
15930 ;; @r{Need number for numeric test.}
15931 (car sorted-lengths)
15932 (< (car sorted-lengths) top-of-range))
15933 @end group
15934
15935 @group
15936 ;; @r{Count number of definitions within current range.}
15937 (setq number-within-range (1+ number-within-range))
15938 (setq sorted-lengths (cdr sorted-lengths)))
15939
15940 ;; @r{Exit inner loop but remain within outer loop.}
15941 @end group
15942
15943 @group
15944 (setq defuns-per-range-list
15945 (cons number-within-range defuns-per-range-list))
15946 (setq number-within-range 0) ; @r{Reset count to zero.}
15947 @end group
15948
15949 @group
15950 ;; @r{Move to next range.}
15951 (setq top-of-ranges (cdr top-of-ranges))
15952 ;; @r{Specify next top of range value.}
15953 (setq top-of-range (car top-of-ranges)))
15954 @end group
15955
15956 @group
15957 ;; @r{Exit outer loop and count the number of defuns larger than}
15958 ;; @r{ the largest top-of-range value.}
15959 (setq defuns-per-range-list
15960 (cons
15961 (length sorted-lengths)
15962 defuns-per-range-list))
15963 @end group
15964
15965 @group
15966 ;; @r{Return a list of the number of definitions within each range,}
15967 ;; @r{ smallest to largest.}
15968 (nreverse defuns-per-range-list)))
15969 @end group
15970 @end smallexample
15971
15972 @need 1200
15973 @noindent
15974 The function is straightforward except for one subtle feature. The
15975 true-or-false test of the inner loop looks like this:
15976
15977 @smallexample
15978 @group
15979 (and (car sorted-lengths)
15980 (< (car sorted-lengths) top-of-range))
15981 @end group
15982 @end smallexample
15983
15984 @need 800
15985 @noindent
15986 instead of like this:
15987
15988 @smallexample
15989 (< (car sorted-lengths) top-of-range)
15990 @end smallexample
15991
15992 The purpose of the test is to determine whether the first item in the
15993 @code{sorted-lengths} list is less than the value of the top of the
15994 range.
15995
15996 The simple version of the test works fine unless the
15997 @code{sorted-lengths} list has a @code{nil} value. In that case, the
15998 @code{(car sorted-lengths)} expression function returns
15999 @code{nil}. The @code{<} function cannot compare a number to
16000 @code{nil}, which is an empty list, so Emacs signals an error and
16001 stops the function from attempting to continue to execute.
16002
16003 The @code{sorted-lengths} list always becomes @code{nil} when the
16004 counter reaches the end of the list. This means that any attempt to
16005 use the @code{defuns-per-range} function with the simple version of
16006 the test will fail.
16007
16008 We solve the problem by using the @code{(car sorted-lengths)}
16009 expression in conjunction with the @code{and} expression. The
16010 @code{(car sorted-lengths)} expression returns a non-@code{nil}
16011 value so long as the list has at least one number within it, but
16012 returns @code{nil} if the list is empty. The @code{and} expression
16013 first evaluates the @code{(car sorted-lengths)} expression, and
16014 if it is @code{nil}, returns false @emph{without} evaluating the
16015 @code{<} expression. But if the @code{(car sorted-lengths)}
16016 expression returns a non-@code{nil} value, the @code{and} expression
16017 evaluates the @code{<} expression, and returns that value as the value
16018 of the @code{and} expression.
16019
16020 @c colon in printed section title causes problem in Info cross reference
16021 This way, we avoid an error.
16022 @iftex
16023 @noindent
16024 (For information about @code{and}, see
16025 @ref{kill-new function, , The @code{kill-new} function}.)
16026 @end iftex
16027 @ifinfo
16028 @noindent
16029 (@xref{kill-new function, , The @code{kill-new} function}, for
16030 information about @code{and}.)
16031 @end ifinfo
16032
16033 Here is a short test of the @code{defuns-per-range} function. First,
16034 evaluate the expression that binds (a shortened)
16035 @code{top-of-ranges} list to the list of values, then evaluate the
16036 expression for binding the @code{sorted-lengths} list, and then
16037 evaluate the @code{defuns-per-range} function.
16038
16039 @smallexample
16040 @group
16041 ;; @r{(Shorter list than we will use later.)}
16042 (setq top-of-ranges
16043 '(110 120 130 140 150
16044 160 170 180 190 200))
16045
16046 (setq sorted-lengths
16047 '(85 86 110 116 122 129 154 176 179 200 265 300 300))
16048
16049 (defuns-per-range sorted-lengths top-of-ranges)
16050 @end group
16051 @end smallexample
16052
16053 @need 800
16054 @noindent
16055 The list returned looks like this:
16056
16057 @smallexample
16058 (2 2 2 0 0 1 0 2 0 0 4)
16059 @end smallexample
16060
16061 @noindent
16062 Indeed, there are two elements of the @code{sorted-lengths} list
16063 smaller than 110, two elements between 110 and 119, two elements
16064 between 120 and 129, and so on. There are four elements with a value
16065 of 200 or larger.
16066
16067 @c The next step is to turn this numbers' list into a graph.
16068 @node Readying a Graph
16069 @chapter Readying a Graph
16070 @cindex Readying a graph
16071 @cindex Graph prototype
16072 @cindex Prototype graph
16073 @cindex Body of graph
16074
16075 Our goal is to construct a graph showing the numbers of function
16076 definitions of various lengths in the Emacs lisp sources.
16077
16078 As a practical matter, if you were creating a graph, you would
16079 probably use a program such as @code{gnuplot} to do the job.
16080 (@code{gnuplot} is nicely integrated into GNU Emacs.) In this case,
16081 however, we create one from scratch, and in the process we will
16082 re-acquaint ourselves with some of what we learned before and learn
16083 more.
16084
16085 In this chapter, we will first write a simple graph printing function.
16086 This first definition will be a @dfn{prototype}, a rapidly written
16087 function that enables us to reconnoiter this unknown graph-making
16088 territory. We will discover dragons, or find that they are myth.
16089 After scouting the terrain, we will feel more confident and enhance
16090 the function to label the axes automatically.
16091
16092 @menu
16093 * Columns of a graph::
16094 * graph-body-print:: How to print the body of a graph.
16095 * recursive-graph-body-print::
16096 * Printed Axes::
16097 * Line Graph Exercise::
16098 @end menu
16099
16100 @ifnottex
16101 @node Columns of a graph
16102 @unnumberedsec Printing the Columns of a Graph
16103 @end ifnottex
16104
16105 Since Emacs is designed to be flexible and work with all kinds of
16106 terminals, including character-only terminals, the graph will need to
16107 be made from one of the `typewriter' symbols. An asterisk will do; as
16108 we enhance the graph-printing function, we can make the choice of
16109 symbol a user option.
16110
16111 We can call this function @code{graph-body-print}; it will take a
16112 @code{numbers-list} as its only argument. At this stage, we will not
16113 label the graph, but only print its body.
16114
16115 The @code{graph-body-print} function inserts a vertical column of
16116 asterisks for each element in the @code{numbers-list}. The height of
16117 each line is determined by the value of that element of the
16118 @code{numbers-list}.
16119
16120 Inserting columns is a repetitive act; that means that this function can
16121 be written either with a @code{while} loop or recursively.
16122
16123 Our first challenge is to discover how to print a column of asterisks.
16124 Usually, in Emacs, we print characters onto a screen horizontally,
16125 line by line, by typing. We have two routes we can follow: write our
16126 own column-insertion function or discover whether one exists in Emacs.
16127
16128 To see whether there is one in Emacs, we can use the @kbd{M-x apropos}
16129 command. This command is like the @kbd{C-h a} (@code{command-apropos})
16130 command, except that the latter finds only those functions that are
16131 commands. The @kbd{M-x apropos} command lists all symbols that match
16132 a regular expression, including functions that are not interactive.
16133 @findex apropos
16134
16135 What we want to look for is some command that prints or inserts
16136 columns. Very likely, the name of the function will contain either
16137 the word `print' or the word `insert' or the word `column'.
16138 Therefore, we can simply type @kbd{M-x apropos RET
16139 print\|insert\|column RET} and look at the result. On my system, this
16140 command once too takes quite some time, and then produced a list of 79
16141 functions and variables. Now it does not take much time at all and
16142 produces a list of 211 functions and variables. Scanning down the
16143 list, the only function that looks as if it might do the job is
16144 @code{insert-rectangle}.
16145
16146 @need 1200
16147 Indeed, this is the function we want; its documentation says:
16148
16149 @smallexample
16150 @group
16151 insert-rectangle:
16152 Insert text of RECTANGLE with upper left corner at point.
16153 RECTANGLE's first line is inserted at point,
16154 its second line is inserted at a point vertically under point, etc.
16155 RECTANGLE should be a list of strings.
16156 After this command, the mark is at the upper left corner
16157 and point is at the lower right corner.
16158 @end group
16159 @end smallexample
16160
16161 We can run a quick test, to make sure it does what we expect of it.
16162
16163 Here is the result of placing the cursor after the
16164 @code{insert-rectangle} expression and typing @kbd{C-u C-x C-e}
16165 (@code{eval-last-sexp}). The function inserts the strings
16166 @samp{"first"}, @samp{"second"}, and @samp{"third"} at and below
16167 point. Also the function returns @code{nil}.
16168
16169 @smallexample
16170 @group
16171 (insert-rectangle '("first" "second" "third"))first
16172 second
16173 thirdnil
16174 @end group
16175 @end smallexample
16176
16177 @noindent
16178 Of course, we won't be inserting the text of the
16179 @code{insert-rectangle} expression itself into the buffer in which we
16180 are making the graph, but will call the function from our program. We
16181 shall, however, have to make sure that point is in the buffer at the
16182 place where the @code{insert-rectangle} function will insert its
16183 column of strings.
16184
16185 If you are reading this in Info, you can see how this works by
16186 switching to another buffer, such as the @file{*scratch*} buffer,
16187 placing point somewhere in the buffer, typing @kbd{M-:}, typing the
16188 @code{insert-rectangle} expression into the minibuffer at the prompt,
16189 and then typing @key{RET}. This causes Emacs to evaluate the
16190 expression in the minibuffer, but to use as the value of point the
16191 position of point in the @file{*scratch*} buffer. (@kbd{M-:} is the
16192 keybinding for @code{eval-expression}. Also, @code{nil} does not
16193 appear in the @file{*scratch*} buffer since the expression is
16194 evaluated in the minibuffer.)
16195
16196 We find when we do this that point ends up at the end of the last
16197 inserted line---that is to say, this function moves point as a
16198 side-effect. If we were to repeat the command, with point at this
16199 position, the next insertion would be below and to the right of the
16200 previous insertion. We don't want this! If we are going to make a
16201 bar graph, the columns need to be beside each other.
16202
16203 So we discover that each cycle of the column-inserting @code{while}
16204 loop must reposition point to the place we want it, and that place
16205 will be at the top, not the bottom, of the column. Moreover, we
16206 remember that when we print a graph, we do not expect all the columns
16207 to be the same height. This means that the top of each column may be
16208 at a different height from the previous one. We cannot simply
16209 reposition point to the same line each time, but moved over to the
16210 right---or perhaps we can@dots{}
16211
16212 We are planning to make the columns of the bar graph out of asterisks.
16213 The number of asterisks in the column is the number specified by the
16214 current element of the @code{numbers-list}. We need to construct a
16215 list of asterisks of the right length for each call to
16216 @code{insert-rectangle}. If this list consists solely of the requisite
16217 number of asterisks, then we will have position point the right number
16218 of lines above the base for the graph to print correctly. This could
16219 be difficult.
16220
16221 Alternatively, if we can figure out some way to pass
16222 @code{insert-rectangle} a list of the same length each time, then we
16223 can place point on the same line each time, but move it over one
16224 column to the right for each new column. If we do this, however, some
16225 of the entries in the list passed to @code{insert-rectangle} must be
16226 blanks rather than asterisks. For example, if the maximum height of
16227 the graph is 5, but the height of the column is 3, then
16228 @code{insert-rectangle} requires an argument that looks like this:
16229
16230 @smallexample
16231 (" " " " "*" "*" "*")
16232 @end smallexample
16233
16234 This last proposal is not so difficult, so long as we can determine
16235 the column height. There are two ways for us to specify the column
16236 height: we can arbitrarily state what it will be, which would work
16237 fine for graphs of that height; or we can search through the list of
16238 numbers and use the maximum height of the list as the maximum height
16239 of the graph. If the latter operation were difficult, then the former
16240 procedure would be easiest, but there is a function built into Emacs
16241 that determines the maximum of its arguments. We can use that
16242 function. The function is called @code{max} and it returns the
16243 largest of all its arguments, which must be numbers. Thus, for
16244 example,
16245
16246 @smallexample
16247 (max 3 4 6 5 7 3)
16248 @end smallexample
16249
16250 @noindent
16251 returns 7. (A corresponding function called @code{min} returns the
16252 smallest of all its arguments.)
16253 @findex max
16254 @findex min
16255
16256 However, we cannot simply call @code{max} on the @code{numbers-list};
16257 the @code{max} function expects numbers as its argument, not a list of
16258 numbers. Thus, the following expression,
16259
16260 @smallexample
16261 (max '(3 4 6 5 7 3))
16262 @end smallexample
16263
16264 @need 800
16265 @noindent
16266 produces the following error message;
16267
16268 @smallexample
16269 Wrong type of argument: number-or-marker-p, (3 4 6 5 7 3)
16270 @end smallexample
16271
16272 @findex apply
16273 We need a function that passes a list of arguments to a function.
16274 This function is @code{apply}. This function `applies' its first
16275 argument (a function) to its remaining arguments, the last of which
16276 may be a list.
16277
16278 @need 1250
16279 For example,
16280
16281 @smallexample
16282 (apply 'max 3 4 7 3 '(4 8 5))
16283 @end smallexample
16284
16285 @noindent
16286 returns 8.
16287
16288 (Incidentally, I don't know how you would learn of this function
16289 without a book such as this. It is possible to discover other
16290 functions, like @code{search-forward} or @code{insert-rectangle}, by
16291 guessing at a part of their names and then using @code{apropos}. Even
16292 though its base in metaphor is clear---`apply' its first argument to
16293 the rest---I doubt a novice would come up with that particular word
16294 when using @code{apropos} or other aid. Of course, I could be wrong;
16295 after all, the function was first named by someone who had to invent
16296 it.)
16297
16298 The second and subsequent arguments to @code{apply} are optional, so
16299 we can use @code{apply} to call a function and pass the elements of a
16300 list to it, like this, which also returns 8:
16301
16302 @smallexample
16303 (apply 'max '(4 8 5))
16304 @end smallexample
16305
16306 This latter way is how we will use @code{apply}. The
16307 @code{recursive-lengths-list-many-files} function returns a numbers'
16308 list to which we can apply @code{max} (we could also apply @code{max} to
16309 the sorted numbers' list; it does not matter whether the list is
16310 sorted or not.)
16311
16312 @need 800
16313 Hence, the operation for finding the maximum height of the graph is this:
16314
16315 @smallexample
16316 (setq max-graph-height (apply 'max numbers-list))
16317 @end smallexample
16318
16319 Now we can return to the question of how to create a list of strings
16320 for a column of the graph. Told the maximum height of the graph
16321 and the number of asterisks that should appear in the column, the
16322 function should return a list of strings for the
16323 @code{insert-rectangle} command to insert.
16324
16325 Each column is made up of asterisks or blanks. Since the function is
16326 passed the value of the height of the column and the number of
16327 asterisks in the column, the number of blanks can be found by
16328 subtracting the number of asterisks from the height of the column.
16329 Given the number of blanks and the number of asterisks, two
16330 @code{while} loops can be used to construct the list:
16331
16332 @smallexample
16333 @group
16334 ;;; @r{First version.}
16335 (defun column-of-graph (max-graph-height actual-height)
16336 "Return list of strings that is one column of a graph."
16337 (let ((insert-list nil)
16338 (number-of-top-blanks
16339 (- max-graph-height actual-height)))
16340 @end group
16341
16342 @group
16343 ;; @r{Fill in asterisks.}
16344 (while (> actual-height 0)
16345 (setq insert-list (cons "*" insert-list))
16346 (setq actual-height (1- actual-height)))
16347 @end group
16348
16349 @group
16350 ;; @r{Fill in blanks.}
16351 (while (> number-of-top-blanks 0)
16352 (setq insert-list (cons " " insert-list))
16353 (setq number-of-top-blanks
16354 (1- number-of-top-blanks)))
16355 @end group
16356
16357 @group
16358 ;; @r{Return whole list.}
16359 insert-list))
16360 @end group
16361 @end smallexample
16362
16363 If you install this function and then evaluate the following
16364 expression you will see that it returns the list as desired:
16365
16366 @smallexample
16367 (column-of-graph 5 3)
16368 @end smallexample
16369
16370 @need 800
16371 @noindent
16372 returns
16373
16374 @smallexample
16375 (" " " " "*" "*" "*")
16376 @end smallexample
16377
16378 As written, @code{column-of-graph} contains a major flaw: the symbols
16379 used for the blank and for the marked entries in the column are
16380 `hard-coded' as a space and asterisk. This is fine for a prototype,
16381 but you, or another user, may wish to use other symbols. For example,
16382 in testing the graph function, you many want to use a period in place
16383 of the space, to make sure the point is being repositioned properly
16384 each time the @code{insert-rectangle} function is called; or you might
16385 want to substitute a @samp{+} sign or other symbol for the asterisk.
16386 You might even want to make a graph-column that is more than one
16387 display column wide. The program should be more flexible. The way to
16388 do that is to replace the blank and the asterisk with two variables
16389 that we can call @code{graph-blank} and @code{graph-symbol} and define
16390 those variables separately.
16391
16392 Also, the documentation is not well written. These considerations
16393 lead us to the second version of the function:
16394
16395 @smallexample
16396 @group
16397 (defvar graph-symbol "*"
16398 "String used as symbol in graph, usually an asterisk.")
16399 @end group
16400
16401 @group
16402 (defvar graph-blank " "
16403 "String used as blank in graph, usually a blank space.
16404 graph-blank must be the same number of columns wide
16405 as graph-symbol.")
16406 @end group
16407 @end smallexample
16408
16409 @noindent
16410 (For an explanation of @code{defvar}, see
16411 @ref{defvar, , Initializing a Variable with @code{defvar}}.)
16412
16413 @smallexample
16414 @group
16415 ;;; @r{Second version.}
16416 (defun column-of-graph (max-graph-height actual-height)
16417 "Return MAX-GRAPH-HEIGHT strings; ACTUAL-HEIGHT are graph-symbols.
16418
16419 @end group
16420 @group
16421 The graph-symbols are contiguous entries at the end
16422 of the list.
16423 The list will be inserted as one column of a graph.
16424 The strings are either graph-blank or graph-symbol."
16425 @end group
16426
16427 @group
16428 (let ((insert-list nil)
16429 (number-of-top-blanks
16430 (- max-graph-height actual-height)))
16431 @end group
16432
16433 @group
16434 ;; @r{Fill in @code{graph-symbols}.}
16435 (while (> actual-height 0)
16436 (setq insert-list (cons graph-symbol insert-list))
16437 (setq actual-height (1- actual-height)))
16438 @end group
16439
16440 @group
16441 ;; @r{Fill in @code{graph-blanks}.}
16442 (while (> number-of-top-blanks 0)
16443 (setq insert-list (cons graph-blank insert-list))
16444 (setq number-of-top-blanks
16445 (1- number-of-top-blanks)))
16446
16447 ;; @r{Return whole list.}
16448 insert-list))
16449 @end group
16450 @end smallexample
16451
16452 If we wished, we could rewrite @code{column-of-graph} a third time to
16453 provide optionally for a line graph as well as for a bar graph. This
16454 would not be hard to do. One way to think of a line graph is that it
16455 is no more than a bar graph in which the part of each bar that is
16456 below the top is blank. To construct a column for a line graph, the
16457 function first constructs a list of blanks that is one shorter than
16458 the value, then it uses @code{cons} to attach a graph symbol to the
16459 list; then it uses @code{cons} again to attach the `top blanks' to
16460 the list.
16461
16462 It is easy to see how to write such a function, but since we don't
16463 need it, we will not do it. But the job could be done, and if it were
16464 done, it would be done with @code{column-of-graph}. Even more
16465 important, it is worth noting that few changes would have to be made
16466 anywhere else. The enhancement, if we ever wish to make it, is
16467 simple.
16468
16469 Now, finally, we come to our first actual graph printing function.
16470 This prints the body of a graph, not the labels for the vertical and
16471 horizontal axes, so we can call this @code{graph-body-print}.
16472
16473 @node graph-body-print
16474 @section The @code{graph-body-print} Function
16475 @findex graph-body-print
16476
16477 After our preparation in the preceding section, the
16478 @code{graph-body-print} function is straightforward. The function
16479 will print column after column of asterisks and blanks, using the
16480 elements of a numbers' list to specify the number of asterisks in each
16481 column. This is a repetitive act, which means we can use a
16482 decrementing @code{while} loop or recursive function for the job. In
16483 this section, we will write the definition using a @code{while} loop.
16484
16485 The @code{column-of-graph} function requires the height of the graph
16486 as an argument, so we should determine and record that as a local variable.
16487
16488 This leads us to the following template for the @code{while} loop
16489 version of this function:
16490
16491 @smallexample
16492 @group
16493 (defun graph-body-print (numbers-list)
16494 "@var{documentation}@dots{}"
16495 (let ((height @dots{}
16496 @dots{}))
16497 @end group
16498
16499 @group
16500 (while numbers-list
16501 @var{insert-columns-and-reposition-point}
16502 (setq numbers-list (cdr numbers-list)))))
16503 @end group
16504 @end smallexample
16505
16506 @noindent
16507 We need to fill in the slots of the template.
16508
16509 Clearly, we can use the @code{(apply 'max numbers-list)} expression to
16510 determine the height of the graph.
16511
16512 The @code{while} loop will cycle through the @code{numbers-list} one
16513 element at a time. As it is shortened by the @code{(setq numbers-list
16514 (cdr numbers-list))} expression, the @sc{car} of each instance of the
16515 list is the value of the argument for @code{column-of-graph}.
16516
16517 At each cycle of the @code{while} loop, the @code{insert-rectangle}
16518 function inserts the list returned by @code{column-of-graph}. Since
16519 the @code{insert-rectangle} function moves point to the lower right of
16520 the inserted rectangle, we need to save the location of point at the
16521 time the rectangle is inserted, move back to that position after the
16522 rectangle is inserted, and then move horizontally to the next place
16523 from which @code{insert-rectangle} is called.
16524
16525 If the inserted columns are one character wide, as they will be if
16526 single blanks and asterisks are used, the repositioning command is
16527 simply @code{(forward-char 1)}; however, the width of a column may be
16528 greater than one. This means that the repositioning command should be
16529 written @code{(forward-char symbol-width)}. The @code{symbol-width}
16530 itself is the length of a @code{graph-blank} and can be found using
16531 the expression @code{(length graph-blank)}. The best place to bind
16532 the @code{symbol-width} variable to the value of the width of graph
16533 column is in the varlist of the @code{let} expression.
16534
16535 @need 1250
16536 These considerations lead to the following function definition:
16537
16538 @smallexample
16539 @group
16540 (defun graph-body-print (numbers-list)
16541 "Print a bar graph of the NUMBERS-LIST.
16542 The numbers-list consists of the Y-axis values."
16543
16544 (let ((height (apply 'max numbers-list))
16545 (symbol-width (length graph-blank))
16546 from-position)
16547 @end group
16548
16549 @group
16550 (while numbers-list
16551 (setq from-position (point))
16552 (insert-rectangle
16553 (column-of-graph height (car numbers-list)))
16554 (goto-char from-position)
16555 (forward-char symbol-width)
16556 @end group
16557 @group
16558 ;; @r{Draw graph column by column.}
16559 (sit-for 0)
16560 (setq numbers-list (cdr numbers-list)))
16561 @end group
16562 @group
16563 ;; @r{Place point for X axis labels.}
16564 (forward-line height)
16565 (insert "\n")
16566 ))
16567 @end group
16568 @end smallexample
16569
16570 @noindent
16571 The one unexpected expression in this function is the
16572 @w{@code{(sit-for 0)}} expression in the @code{while} loop. This
16573 expression makes the graph printing operation more interesting to
16574 watch than it would be otherwise. The expression causes Emacs to
16575 `sit' or do nothing for a zero length of time and then redraw the
16576 screen. Placed here, it causes Emacs to redraw the screen column by
16577 column. Without it, Emacs would not redraw the screen until the
16578 function exits.
16579
16580 We can test @code{graph-body-print} with a short list of numbers.
16581
16582 @enumerate
16583 @item
16584 Install @code{graph-symbol}, @code{graph-blank},
16585 @code{column-of-graph}, which are in
16586 @iftex
16587 @ref{Readying a Graph, , Readying a Graph},
16588 @end iftex
16589 @ifinfo
16590 @ref{Columns of a graph},
16591 @end ifinfo
16592 and @code{graph-body-print}.
16593
16594 @need 800
16595 @item
16596 Copy the following expression:
16597
16598 @smallexample
16599 (graph-body-print '(1 2 3 4 6 4 3 5 7 6 5 2 3))
16600 @end smallexample
16601
16602 @item
16603 Switch to the @file{*scratch*} buffer and place the cursor where you
16604 want the graph to start.
16605
16606 @item
16607 Type @kbd{M-:} (@code{eval-expression}).
16608
16609 @item
16610 Yank the @code{graph-body-print} expression into the minibuffer
16611 with @kbd{C-y} (@code{yank)}.
16612
16613 @item
16614 Press @key{RET} to evaluate the @code{graph-body-print} expression.
16615 @end enumerate
16616
16617 @need 800
16618 Emacs will print a graph like this:
16619
16620 @smallexample
16621 @group
16622 *
16623 * **
16624 * ****
16625 *** ****
16626 ********* *
16627 ************
16628 *************
16629 @end group
16630 @end smallexample
16631
16632 @node recursive-graph-body-print
16633 @section The @code{recursive-graph-body-print} Function
16634 @findex recursive-graph-body-print
16635
16636 The @code{graph-body-print} function may also be written recursively.
16637 The recursive solution is divided into two parts: an outside `wrapper'
16638 that uses a @code{let} expression to determine the values of several
16639 variables that need only be found once, such as the maximum height of
16640 the graph, and an inside function that is called recursively to print
16641 the graph.
16642
16643 @need 1250
16644 The `wrapper' is uncomplicated:
16645
16646 @smallexample
16647 @group
16648 (defun recursive-graph-body-print (numbers-list)
16649 "Print a bar graph of the NUMBERS-LIST.
16650 The numbers-list consists of the Y-axis values."
16651 (let ((height (apply 'max numbers-list))
16652 (symbol-width (length graph-blank))
16653 from-position)
16654 (recursive-graph-body-print-internal
16655 numbers-list
16656 height
16657 symbol-width)))
16658 @end group
16659 @end smallexample
16660
16661 The recursive function is a little more difficult. It has four parts:
16662 the `do-again-test', the printing code, the recursive call, and the
16663 `next-step-expression'. The `do-again-test' is a @code{when}
16664 expression that determines whether the @code{numbers-list} contains
16665 any remaining elements; if it does, the function prints one column of
16666 the graph using the printing code and calls itself again. The
16667 function calls itself again according to the value produced by the
16668 `next-step-expression' which causes the call to act on a shorter
16669 version of the @code{numbers-list}.
16670
16671 @smallexample
16672 @group
16673 (defun recursive-graph-body-print-internal
16674 (numbers-list height symbol-width)
16675 "Print a bar graph.
16676 Used within recursive-graph-body-print function."
16677 @end group
16678
16679 @group
16680 (when numbers-list
16681 (setq from-position (point))
16682 (insert-rectangle
16683 (column-of-graph height (car numbers-list)))
16684 @end group
16685 @group
16686 (goto-char from-position)
16687 (forward-char symbol-width)
16688 (sit-for 0) ; @r{Draw graph column by column.}
16689 (recursive-graph-body-print-internal
16690 (cdr numbers-list) height symbol-width)))
16691 @end group
16692 @end smallexample
16693
16694 @need 1250
16695 After installation, this expression can be tested; here is a sample:
16696
16697 @smallexample
16698 (recursive-graph-body-print '(3 2 5 6 7 5 3 4 6 4 3 2 1))
16699 @end smallexample
16700
16701 @need 800
16702 Here is what @code{recursive-graph-body-print} produces:
16703
16704 @smallexample
16705 @group
16706 *
16707 ** *
16708 **** *
16709 **** ***
16710 * *********
16711 ************
16712 *************
16713 @end group
16714 @end smallexample
16715
16716 Either of these two functions, @code{graph-body-print} or
16717 @code{recursive-graph-body-print}, create the body of a graph.
16718
16719 @node Printed Axes
16720 @section Need for Printed Axes
16721
16722 A graph needs printed axes, so you can orient yourself. For a do-once
16723 project, it may be reasonable to draw the axes by hand using Emacs's
16724 Picture mode; but a graph drawing function may be used more than once.
16725
16726 For this reason, I have written enhancements to the basic
16727 @code{print-graph-body} function that automatically print labels for
16728 the horizontal and vertical axes. Since the label printing functions
16729 do not contain much new material, I have placed their description in
16730 an appendix. @xref{Full Graph, , A Graph with Labeled Axes}.
16731
16732 @node Line Graph Exercise
16733 @section Exercise
16734
16735 Write a line graph version of the graph printing functions.
16736
16737 @node Emacs Initialization
16738 @chapter Your @file{.emacs} File
16739 @cindex @file{.emacs} file
16740 @cindex Customizing your @file{.emacs} file
16741 @cindex Initialization file
16742
16743 ``You don't have to like Emacs to like it''---this seemingly
16744 paradoxical statement is the secret of GNU Emacs. The plain, `out of
16745 the box' Emacs is a generic tool. Most people who use it, customize
16746 it to suit themselves.
16747
16748 GNU Emacs is mostly written in Emacs Lisp; this means that by writing
16749 expressions in Emacs Lisp you can change or extend Emacs.
16750
16751 @menu
16752 * Default Configuration::
16753 * Site-wide Init:: You can write site-wide init files.
16754 * defcustom:: Emacs will write code for you.
16755 * Beginning a .emacs File:: How to write a @code{.emacs file}.
16756 * Text and Auto-fill:: Automatically wrap lines.
16757 * Mail Aliases:: Use abbreviations for email addresses.
16758 * Indent Tabs Mode:: Don't use tabs with @TeX{}
16759 * Keybindings:: Create some personal keybindings.
16760 * Keymaps:: More about key binding.
16761 * Loading Files:: Load (i.e., evaluate) files automatically.
16762 * Autoload:: Make functions available.
16763 * Simple Extension:: Define a function; bind it to a key.
16764 * X11 Colors:: Colors in X.
16765 * Miscellaneous::
16766 * Mode Line:: How to customize your mode line.
16767 @end menu
16768
16769 @ifnottex
16770 @node Default Configuration
16771 @unnumberedsec Emacs's Default Configuration
16772 @end ifnottex
16773
16774 There are those who appreciate Emacs's default configuration. After
16775 all, Emacs starts you in C mode when you edit a C file, starts you in
16776 Fortran mode when you edit a Fortran file, and starts you in
16777 Fundamental mode when you edit an unadorned file. This all makes
16778 sense, if you do not know who is going to use Emacs. Who knows what a
16779 person hopes to do with an unadorned file? Fundamental mode is the
16780 right default for such a file, just as C mode is the right default for
16781 editing C code. (Enough programming languages have syntaxes
16782 that enable them to share or nearly share features, so C mode is
16783 now provided by CC mode, the `C Collection'.)
16784
16785 But when you do know who is going to use Emacs---you,
16786 yourself---then it makes sense to customize Emacs.
16787
16788 For example, I seldom want Fundamental mode when I edit an
16789 otherwise undistinguished file; I want Text mode. This is why I
16790 customize Emacs: so it suits me.
16791
16792 You can customize and extend Emacs by writing or adapting a
16793 @file{~/.emacs} file. This is your personal initialization file; its
16794 contents, written in Emacs Lisp, tell Emacs what to do.@footnote{You
16795 may also add @file{.el} to @file{~/.emacs} and call it a
16796 @file{~/.emacs.el} file. In the past, you were forbidden to type the
16797 extra keystrokes that the name @file{~/.emacs.el} requires, but now
16798 you may. The new format is consistent with the Emacs Lisp file
16799 naming conventions; the old format saves typing.}
16800
16801 A @file{~/.emacs} file contains Emacs Lisp code. You can write this
16802 code yourself; or you can use Emacs's @code{customize} feature to write
16803 the code for you. You can combine your own expressions and
16804 auto-written Customize expressions in your @file{.emacs} file.
16805
16806 (I myself prefer to write my own expressions, except for those,
16807 particularly fonts, that I find easier to manipulate using the
16808 @code{customize} command. I combine the two methods.)
16809
16810 Most of this chapter is about writing expressions yourself. It
16811 describes a simple @file{.emacs} file; for more information, see
16812 @ref{Init File, , The Init File, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}, and
16813 @ref{Init File, , The Init File, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference
16814 Manual}.
16815
16816 @node Site-wide Init
16817 @section Site-wide Initialization Files
16818
16819 @cindex @file{default.el} init file
16820 @cindex @file{site-init.el} init file
16821 @cindex @file{site-load.el} init file
16822 In addition to your personal initialization file, Emacs automatically
16823 loads various site-wide initialization files, if they exist. These
16824 have the same form as your @file{.emacs} file, but are loaded by
16825 everyone.
16826
16827 Two site-wide initialization files, @file{site-load.el} and
16828 @file{site-init.el}, are loaded into Emacs and then `dumped' if a
16829 `dumped' version of Emacs is created, as is most common. (Dumped
16830 copies of Emacs load more quickly. However, once a file is loaded and
16831 dumped, a change to it does not lead to a change in Emacs unless you
16832 load it yourself or re-dump Emacs. @xref{Building Emacs, , Building
16833 Emacs, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}, and the
16834 @file{INSTALL} file.)
16835
16836 Three other site-wide initialization files are loaded automatically
16837 each time you start Emacs, if they exist. These are
16838 @file{site-start.el}, which is loaded @emph{before} your @file{.emacs}
16839 file, and @file{default.el}, and the terminal type file, which are both
16840 loaded @emph{after} your @file{.emacs} file.
16841
16842 Settings and definitions in your @file{.emacs} file will overwrite
16843 conflicting settings and definitions in a @file{site-start.el} file,
16844 if it exists; but the settings and definitions in a @file{default.el}
16845 or terminal type file will overwrite those in your @file{.emacs} file.
16846 (You can prevent interference from a terminal type file by setting
16847 @code{term-file-prefix} to @code{nil}. @xref{Simple Extension, , A
16848 Simple Extension}.)
16849
16850 @c Rewritten to avoid overfull hbox.
16851 The @file{INSTALL} file that comes in the distribution contains
16852 descriptions of the @file{site-init.el} and @file{site-load.el} files.
16853
16854 The @file{loadup.el}, @file{startup.el}, and @file{loaddefs.el} files
16855 control loading. These files are in the @file{lisp} directory of the
16856 Emacs distribution and are worth perusing.
16857
16858 The @file{loaddefs.el} file contains a good many suggestions as to
16859 what to put into your own @file{.emacs} file, or into a site-wide
16860 initialization file.
16861
16862 @node defcustom
16863 @section Specifying Variables using @code{defcustom}
16864 @findex defcustom
16865
16866 You can specify variables using @code{defcustom} so that you and
16867 others can then use Emacs's @code{customize} feature to set their
16868 values. (You cannot use @code{customize} to write function
16869 definitions; but you can write @code{defuns} in your @file{.emacs}
16870 file. Indeed, you can write any Lisp expression in your @file{.emacs}
16871 file.)
16872
16873 The @code{customize} feature depends on the @code{defcustom} macro.
16874 Although you can use @code{defvar} or @code{setq} for variables that
16875 users set, the @code{defcustom} macro is designed for the job.
16876
16877 You can use your knowledge of @code{defvar} for writing the
16878 first three arguments for @code{defcustom}. The first argument to
16879 @code{defcustom} is the name of the variable. The second argument is
16880 the variable's initial value, if any; and this value is set only if
16881 the value has not already been set. The third argument is the
16882 documentation.
16883
16884 The fourth and subsequent arguments to @code{defcustom} specify types
16885 and options; these are not featured in @code{defvar}. (These
16886 arguments are optional.)
16887
16888 Each of these arguments consists of a keyword followed by a value.
16889 Each keyword starts with the colon character @samp{:}.
16890
16891 @need 1250
16892 For example, the customizable user option variable
16893 @code{text-mode-hook} looks like this:
16894
16895 @smallexample
16896 @group
16897 (defcustom text-mode-hook nil
16898 "Normal hook run when entering Text mode and many related modes."
16899 :type 'hook
16900 :options '(turn-on-auto-fill flyspell-mode)
16901 :group 'wp)
16902 @end group
16903 @end smallexample
16904
16905 @noindent
16906 The name of the variable is @code{text-mode-hook}; it has no default
16907 value; and its documentation string tells you what it does.
16908
16909 The @code{:type} keyword tells Emacs the kind of data to which
16910 @code{text-mode-hook} should be set and how to display the value in a
16911 Customization buffer.
16912
16913 The @code{:options} keyword specifies a suggested list of values for
16914 the variable. Usually, @code{:options} applies to a hook.
16915 The list is only a suggestion; it is not exclusive; a person who sets
16916 the variable may set it to other values; the list shown following the
16917 @code{:options} keyword is intended to offer convenient choices to a
16918 user.
16919
16920 Finally, the @code{:group} keyword tells the Emacs Customization
16921 command in which group the variable is located. This tells where to
16922 find it.
16923
16924 The @code{defcustom} macro recognizes more than a dozen keywords.
16925 For more information, see @ref{Customization, , Writing Customization
16926 Definitions, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}.
16927
16928 Consider @code{text-mode-hook} as an example.
16929
16930 There are two ways to customize this variable. You can use the
16931 customization command or write the appropriate expressions yourself.
16932
16933 @need 800
16934 Using the customization command, you can type:
16935
16936 @smallexample
16937 M-x customize
16938 @end smallexample
16939
16940 @noindent
16941 and find that the group for editing files of data is called `data'.
16942 Enter that group. Text Mode Hook is the first member. You can click
16943 on its various options, such as @code{turn-on-auto-fill}, to set the
16944 values. After you click on the button to
16945
16946 @smallexample
16947 Save for Future Sessions
16948 @end smallexample
16949
16950 @noindent
16951 Emacs will write an expression into your @file{.emacs} file.
16952 It will look like this:
16953
16954 @smallexample
16955 @group
16956 (custom-set-variables
16957 ;; custom-set-variables was added by Custom.
16958 ;; If you edit it by hand, you could mess it up, so be careful.
16959 ;; Your init file should contain only one such instance.
16960 ;; If there is more than one, they won't work right.
16961 '(text-mode-hook (quote (turn-on-auto-fill text-mode-hook-identify))))
16962 @end group
16963 @end smallexample
16964
16965 @noindent
16966 (The @code{text-mode-hook-identify} function tells
16967 @code{toggle-text-mode-auto-fill} which buffers are in Text mode.
16968 It comes on automatically.)
16969
16970 The @code{custom-set-variables} function works somewhat differently
16971 than a @code{setq}. While I have never learned the differences, I
16972 modify the @code{custom-set-variables} expressions in my @file{.emacs}
16973 file by hand: I make the changes in what appears to me to be a
16974 reasonable manner and have not had any problems. Others prefer to use
16975 the Customization command and let Emacs do the work for them.
16976
16977 Another @code{custom-set-@dots{}} function is @code{custom-set-faces}.
16978 This function sets the various font faces. Over time, I have set a
16979 considerable number of faces. Some of the time, I re-set them using
16980 @code{customize}; other times, I simply edit the
16981 @code{custom-set-faces} expression in my @file{.emacs} file itself.
16982
16983 The second way to customize your @code{text-mode-hook} is to set it
16984 yourself in your @file{.emacs} file using code that has nothing to do
16985 with the @code{custom-set-@dots{}} functions.
16986
16987 @need 800
16988 When you do this, and later use @code{customize}, you will see a
16989 message that says
16990
16991 @smallexample
16992 CHANGED outside Customize; operating on it here may be unreliable.
16993 @end smallexample
16994
16995 @need 800
16996 This message is only a warning. If you click on the button to
16997
16998 @smallexample
16999 Save for Future Sessions
17000 @end smallexample
17001
17002 @noindent
17003 Emacs will write a @code{custom-set-@dots{}} expression near the end
17004 of your @file{.emacs} file that will be evaluated after your
17005 hand-written expression. It will, therefore, overrule your
17006 hand-written expression. No harm will be done. When you do this,
17007 however, be careful to remember which expression is active; if you
17008 forget, you may confuse yourself.
17009
17010 So long as you remember where the values are set, you will have no
17011 trouble. In any event, the values are always set in your
17012 initialization file, which is usually called @file{.emacs}.
17013
17014 I myself use @code{customize} for hardly anything. Mostly, I write
17015 expressions myself.
17016
17017 @findex defsubst
17018 @findex defconst
17019 Incidentally, to be more complete concerning defines: @code{defsubst}
17020 defines an inline function. The syntax is just like that of
17021 @code{defun}. @code{defconst} defines a symbol as a constant. The
17022 intent is that neither programs nor users should ever change a value
17023 set by @code{defconst}. (You can change it; the value set is a
17024 variable; but please do not.)
17025
17026 @node Beginning a .emacs File
17027 @section Beginning a @file{.emacs} File
17028 @cindex @file{.emacs} file, beginning of
17029
17030 When you start Emacs, it loads your @file{.emacs} file unless you tell
17031 it not to by specifying @samp{-q} on the command line. (The
17032 @code{emacs -q} command gives you a plain, out-of-the-box Emacs.)
17033
17034 A @file{.emacs} file contains Lisp expressions. Often, these are no
17035 more than expressions to set values; sometimes they are function
17036 definitions.
17037
17038 @xref{Init File, , The Init File @file{~/.emacs}, emacs, The GNU Emacs
17039 Manual}, for a short description of initialization files.
17040
17041 This chapter goes over some of the same ground, but is a walk among
17042 extracts from a complete, long-used @file{.emacs} file---my own.
17043
17044 The first part of the file consists of comments: reminders to myself.
17045 By now, of course, I remember these things, but when I started, I did
17046 not.
17047
17048 @need 1200
17049 @smallexample
17050 @group
17051 ;;;; Bob's .emacs file
17052 ; Robert J. Chassell
17053 ; 26 September 1985
17054 @end group
17055 @end smallexample
17056
17057 @noindent
17058 Look at that date! I started this file a long time ago. I have been
17059 adding to it ever since.
17060
17061 @smallexample
17062 @group
17063 ; Each section in this file is introduced by a
17064 ; line beginning with four semicolons; and each
17065 ; entry is introduced by a line beginning with
17066 ; three semicolons.
17067 @end group
17068 @end smallexample
17069
17070 @noindent
17071 This describes the usual conventions for comments in Emacs Lisp.
17072 Everything on a line that follows a semicolon is a comment. Two,
17073 three, and four semicolons are used as subsection and section markers.
17074 (@xref{Comments, ,, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}, for
17075 more about comments.)
17076
17077 @smallexample
17078 @group
17079 ;;;; The Help Key
17080 ; Control-h is the help key;
17081 ; after typing control-h, type a letter to
17082 ; indicate the subject about which you want help.
17083 ; For an explanation of the help facility,
17084 ; type control-h two times in a row.
17085 @end group
17086 @end smallexample
17087
17088 @noindent
17089 Just remember: type @kbd{C-h} two times for help.
17090
17091 @smallexample
17092 @group
17093 ; To find out about any mode, type control-h m
17094 ; while in that mode. For example, to find out
17095 ; about mail mode, enter mail mode and then type
17096 ; control-h m.
17097 @end group
17098 @end smallexample
17099
17100 @noindent
17101 `Mode help', as I call this, is very helpful. Usually, it tells you
17102 all you need to know.
17103
17104 Of course, you don't need to include comments like these in your
17105 @file{.emacs} file. I included them in mine because I kept forgetting
17106 about Mode help or the conventions for comments---but I was able to
17107 remember to look here to remind myself.
17108
17109 @node Text and Auto-fill
17110 @section Text and Auto Fill Mode
17111
17112 Now we come to the part that `turns on' Text mode and
17113 Auto Fill mode.
17114
17115 @smallexample
17116 @group
17117 ;;; Text mode and Auto Fill mode
17118 ;; The next two lines put Emacs into Text mode
17119 ;; and Auto Fill mode, and are for writers who
17120 ;; want to start writing prose rather than code.
17121 (setq-default major-mode 'text-mode)
17122 (add-hook 'text-mode-hook 'turn-on-auto-fill)
17123 @end group
17124 @end smallexample
17125
17126 Here is the first part of this @file{.emacs} file that does something
17127 besides remind a forgetful human!
17128
17129 The first of the two lines in parentheses tells Emacs to turn on Text
17130 mode when you find a file, @emph{unless} that file should go into some
17131 other mode, such as C mode.
17132
17133 @cindex Per-buffer, local variables list
17134 @cindex Local variables list, per-buffer,
17135 @cindex Automatic mode selection
17136 @cindex Mode selection, automatic
17137 When Emacs reads a file, it looks at the extension to the file name,
17138 if any. (The extension is the part that comes after a @samp{.}.) If
17139 the file ends with a @samp{.c} or @samp{.h} extension then Emacs turns
17140 on C mode. Also, Emacs looks at first nonblank line of the file; if
17141 the line says @w{@samp{-*- C -*-}}, Emacs turns on C mode. Emacs
17142 possesses a list of extensions and specifications that it uses
17143 automatically. In addition, Emacs looks near the last page for a
17144 per-buffer, ``local variables list'', if any.
17145
17146 @ifinfo
17147 @xref{Choosing Modes, , How Major Modes are Chosen, emacs, The GNU
17148 Emacs Manual}.
17149
17150 @xref{File Variables, , Local Variables in Files, emacs, The GNU Emacs
17151 Manual}.
17152 @end ifinfo
17153 @iftex
17154 See sections ``How Major Modes are Chosen'' and ``Local Variables in
17155 Files'' in @cite{The GNU Emacs Manual}.
17156 @end iftex
17157
17158 Now, back to the @file{.emacs} file.
17159
17160 @need 800
17161 Here is the line again; how does it work?
17162
17163 @cindex Text Mode turned on
17164 @smallexample
17165 (setq major-mode 'text-mode)
17166 @end smallexample
17167
17168 @noindent
17169 This line is a short, but complete Emacs Lisp expression.
17170
17171 We are already familiar with @code{setq}. It sets the following variable,
17172 @code{major-mode}, to the subsequent value, which is @code{text-mode}.
17173 The single quote mark before @code{text-mode} tells Emacs to deal directly
17174 with the @code{text-mode} symbol, not with whatever it might stand for.
17175 @xref{set & setq, , Setting the Value of a Variable},
17176 for a reminder of how @code{setq} works.
17177 The main point is that there is no difference between the procedure you
17178 use to set a value in your @file{.emacs} file and the procedure you use
17179 anywhere else in Emacs.
17180
17181 @need 800
17182 Here is the next line:
17183
17184 @cindex Auto Fill mode turned on
17185 @findex add-hook
17186 @smallexample
17187 (add-hook 'text-mode-hook 'turn-on-auto-fill)
17188 @end smallexample
17189
17190 @noindent
17191 In this line, the @code{add-hook} command adds
17192 @code{turn-on-auto-fill} to the variable.
17193
17194 @code{turn-on-auto-fill} is the name of a program, that, you guessed
17195 it!, turns on Auto Fill mode.
17196
17197 Every time Emacs turns on Text mode, Emacs runs the commands `hooked'
17198 onto Text mode. So every time Emacs turns on Text mode, Emacs also
17199 turns on Auto Fill mode.
17200
17201 In brief, the first line causes Emacs to enter Text mode when you edit a
17202 file, unless the file name extension, a first non-blank line, or local
17203 variables to tell Emacs otherwise.
17204
17205 Text mode among other actions, sets the syntax table to work
17206 conveniently for writers. In Text mode, Emacs considers an apostrophe
17207 as part of a word like a letter; but Emacs does not consider a period
17208 or a space as part of a word. Thus, @kbd{M-f} moves you over
17209 @samp{it's}. On the other hand, in C mode, @kbd{M-f} stops just after
17210 the @samp{t} of @samp{it's}.
17211
17212 The second line causes Emacs to turn on Auto Fill mode when it turns
17213 on Text mode. In Auto Fill mode, Emacs automatically breaks a line
17214 that is too wide and brings the excessively wide part of the line down
17215 to the next line. Emacs breaks lines between words, not within them.
17216
17217 When Auto Fill mode is turned off, lines continue to the right as you
17218 type them. Depending on how you set the value of
17219 @code{truncate-lines}, the words you type either disappear off the
17220 right side of the screen, or else are shown, in a rather ugly and
17221 unreadable manner, as a continuation line on the screen.
17222
17223 @need 1250
17224 In addition, in this part of my @file{.emacs} file, I tell the Emacs
17225 fill commands to insert two spaces after a colon:
17226
17227 @smallexample
17228 (setq colon-double-space t)
17229 @end smallexample
17230
17231 @node Mail Aliases
17232 @section Mail Aliases
17233
17234 Here is a @code{setq} that `turns on' mail aliases, along with more
17235 reminders.
17236
17237 @smallexample
17238 @group
17239 ;;; Mail mode
17240 ; To enter mail mode, type `C-x m'
17241 ; To enter RMAIL (for reading mail),
17242 ; type `M-x rmail'
17243 (setq mail-aliases t)
17244 @end group
17245 @end smallexample
17246
17247 @cindex Mail aliases
17248 @noindent
17249 This @code{setq} command sets the value of the variable
17250 @code{mail-aliases} to @code{t}. Since @code{t} means true, the line
17251 says, in effect, ``Yes, use mail aliases.''
17252
17253 Mail aliases are convenient short names for long email addresses or
17254 for lists of email addresses. The file where you keep your `aliases'
17255 is @file{~/.mailrc}. You write an alias like this:
17256
17257 @smallexample
17258 alias geo george@@foobar.wiz.edu
17259 @end smallexample
17260
17261 @noindent
17262 When you write a message to George, address it to @samp{geo}; the
17263 mailer will automatically expand @samp{geo} to the full address.
17264
17265 @node Indent Tabs Mode
17266 @section Indent Tabs Mode
17267 @cindex Tabs, preventing
17268 @findex indent-tabs-mode
17269
17270 By default, Emacs inserts tabs in place of multiple spaces when it
17271 formats a region. (For example, you might indent many lines of text
17272 all at once with the @code{indent-region} command.) Tabs look fine on
17273 a terminal or with ordinary printing, but they produce badly indented
17274 output when you use @TeX{} or Texinfo since @TeX{} ignores tabs.
17275
17276 @need 1250
17277 The following turns off Indent Tabs mode:
17278
17279 @smallexample
17280 @group
17281 ;;; Prevent Extraneous Tabs
17282 (setq-default indent-tabs-mode nil)
17283 @end group
17284 @end smallexample
17285
17286 Note that this line uses @code{setq-default} rather than the
17287 @code{setq} command that we have seen before. The @code{setq-default}
17288 command sets values only in buffers that do not have their own local
17289 values for the variable.
17290
17291 @ifinfo
17292 @xref{Just Spaces, , Tabs vs. Spaces, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}.
17293
17294 @xref{File Variables, , Local Variables in Files, emacs, The GNU Emacs
17295 Manual}.
17296 @end ifinfo
17297 @iftex
17298 See sections ``Tabs vs.@: Spaces'' and ``Local Variables in
17299 Files'' in @cite{The GNU Emacs Manual}.
17300 @end iftex
17301
17302 @need 1700
17303 @node Keybindings
17304 @section Some Keybindings
17305
17306 Now for some personal keybindings:
17307
17308 @smallexample
17309 @group
17310 ;;; Compare windows
17311 (global-set-key "\C-cw" 'compare-windows)
17312 @end group
17313 @end smallexample
17314
17315 @findex compare-windows
17316 @code{compare-windows} is a nifty command that compares the text in
17317 your current window with text in the next window. It makes the
17318 comparison by starting at point in each window, moving over text in
17319 each window as far as they match. I use this command all the time.
17320
17321 This also shows how to set a key globally, for all modes.
17322
17323 @cindex Setting a key globally
17324 @cindex Global set key
17325 @cindex Key setting globally
17326 @findex global-set-key
17327 The command is @code{global-set-key}. It is followed by the
17328 keybinding. In a @file{.emacs} file, the keybinding is written as
17329 shown: @code{\C-c} stands for `control-c', which means `press the
17330 control key and the @key{c} key at the same time'. The @code{w} means
17331 `press the @key{w} key'. The keybinding is surrounded by double
17332 quotation marks. In documentation, you would write this as
17333 @w{@kbd{C-c w}}. (If you were binding a @key{META} key, such as
17334 @kbd{M-c}, rather than a @key{CTRL} key, you would write
17335 @w{@code{\M-c}} in your @file{.emacs} file. @xref{Init Rebinding, ,
17336 Rebinding Keys in Your Init File, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}, for
17337 details.)
17338
17339 The command invoked by the keys is @code{compare-windows}. Note that
17340 @code{compare-windows} is preceded by a single quote; otherwise, Emacs
17341 would first try to evaluate the symbol to determine its value.
17342
17343 These three things, the double quotation marks, the backslash before
17344 the @samp{C}, and the single quote mark are necessary parts of
17345 keybinding that I tend to forget. Fortunately, I have come to
17346 remember that I should look at my existing @file{.emacs} file, and
17347 adapt what is there.
17348
17349 As for the keybinding itself: @kbd{C-c w}. This combines the prefix
17350 key, @kbd{C-c}, with a single character, in this case, @kbd{w}. This
17351 set of keys, @kbd{C-c} followed by a single character, is strictly
17352 reserved for individuals' own use. (I call these `own' keys, since
17353 these are for my own use.) You should always be able to create such a
17354 keybinding for your own use without stomping on someone else's
17355 keybinding. If you ever write an extension to Emacs, please avoid
17356 taking any of these keys for public use. Create a key like @kbd{C-c
17357 C-w} instead. Otherwise, we will run out of `own' keys.
17358
17359 @need 1250
17360 Here is another keybinding, with a comment:
17361
17362 @smallexample
17363 @group
17364 ;;; Keybinding for `occur'
17365 ; I use occur a lot, so let's bind it to a key:
17366 (global-set-key "\C-co" 'occur)
17367 @end group
17368 @end smallexample
17369
17370 @findex occur
17371 The @code{occur} command shows all the lines in the current buffer
17372 that contain a match for a regular expression. Matching lines are
17373 shown in a buffer called @file{*Occur*}. That buffer serves as a menu
17374 to jump to occurrences.
17375
17376 @findex global-unset-key
17377 @cindex Unbinding key
17378 @cindex Key unbinding
17379 @need 1250
17380 Here is how to unbind a key, so it does not
17381 work:
17382
17383 @smallexample
17384 @group
17385 ;;; Unbind `C-x f'
17386 (global-unset-key "\C-xf")
17387 @end group
17388 @end smallexample
17389
17390 There is a reason for this unbinding: I found I inadvertently typed
17391 @w{@kbd{C-x f}} when I meant to type @kbd{C-x C-f}. Rather than find a
17392 file, as I intended, I accidentally set the width for filled text,
17393 almost always to a width I did not want. Since I hardly ever reset my
17394 default width, I simply unbound the key.
17395
17396 @findex list-buffers, @r{rebound}
17397 @findex buffer-menu, @r{bound to key}
17398 @need 1250
17399 The following rebinds an existing key:
17400
17401 @smallexample
17402 @group
17403 ;;; Rebind `C-x C-b' for `buffer-menu'
17404 (global-set-key "\C-x\C-b" 'buffer-menu)
17405 @end group
17406 @end smallexample
17407
17408 By default, @kbd{C-x C-b} runs the
17409 @code{list-buffers} command. This command lists
17410 your buffers in @emph{another} window. Since I
17411 almost always want to do something in that
17412 window, I prefer the @code{buffer-menu}
17413 command, which not only lists the buffers,
17414 but moves point into that window.
17415
17416 @node Keymaps
17417 @section Keymaps
17418 @cindex Keymaps
17419 @cindex Rebinding keys
17420
17421 Emacs uses @dfn{keymaps} to record which keys call which commands.
17422 When you use @code{global-set-key} to set the keybinding for a single
17423 command in all parts of Emacs, you are specifying the keybinding in
17424 @code{current-global-map}.
17425
17426 Specific modes, such as C mode or Text mode, have their own keymaps;
17427 the mode-specific keymaps override the global map that is shared by
17428 all buffers.
17429
17430 The @code{global-set-key} function binds, or rebinds, the global
17431 keymap. For example, the following binds the key @kbd{C-x C-b} to the
17432 function @code{buffer-menu}:
17433
17434 @smallexample
17435 (global-set-key "\C-x\C-b" 'buffer-menu)
17436 @end smallexample
17437
17438 Mode-specific keymaps are bound using the @code{define-key} function,
17439 which takes a specific keymap as an argument, as well as the key and
17440 the command. For example, my @file{.emacs} file contains the
17441 following expression to bind the @code{texinfo-insert-@@group} command
17442 to @kbd{C-c C-c g}:
17443
17444 @smallexample
17445 @group
17446 (define-key texinfo-mode-map "\C-c\C-cg" 'texinfo-insert-@@group)
17447 @end group
17448 @end smallexample
17449
17450 @noindent
17451 The @code{texinfo-insert-@@group} function itself is a little extension
17452 to Texinfo mode that inserts @samp{@@group} into a Texinfo file. I
17453 use this command all the time and prefer to type the three strokes
17454 @kbd{C-c C-c g} rather than the six strokes @kbd{@@ g r o u p}.
17455 (@samp{@@group} and its matching @samp{@@end group} are commands that
17456 keep all enclosed text together on one page; many multi-line examples
17457 in this book are surrounded by @samp{@@group @dots{} @@end group}.)
17458
17459 @need 1250
17460 Here is the @code{texinfo-insert-@@group} function definition:
17461
17462 @smallexample
17463 @group
17464 (defun texinfo-insert-@@group ()
17465 "Insert the string @@group in a Texinfo buffer."
17466 (interactive)
17467 (beginning-of-line)
17468 (insert "@@group\n"))
17469 @end group
17470 @end smallexample
17471
17472 (Of course, I could have used Abbrev mode to save typing, rather than
17473 write a function to insert a word; but I prefer key strokes consistent
17474 with other Texinfo mode key bindings.)
17475
17476 You will see numerous @code{define-key} expressions in
17477 @file{loaddefs.el} as well as in the various mode libraries, such as
17478 @file{cc-mode.el} and @file{lisp-mode.el}.
17479
17480 @xref{Key Bindings, , Customizing Key Bindings, emacs, The GNU Emacs
17481 Manual}, and @ref{Keymaps, , Keymaps, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
17482 Reference Manual}, for more information about keymaps.
17483
17484 @node Loading Files
17485 @section Loading Files
17486 @cindex Loading files
17487 @c findex load
17488
17489 Many people in the GNU Emacs community have written extensions to
17490 Emacs. As time goes by, these extensions are often included in new
17491 releases. For example, the Calendar and Diary packages are now part
17492 of the standard GNU Emacs, as is Calc.
17493
17494 You can use a @code{load} command to evaluate a complete file and
17495 thereby install all the functions and variables in the file into Emacs.
17496 For example:
17497
17498 @c (auto-compression-mode t)
17499
17500 @smallexample
17501 (load "~/emacs/slowsplit")
17502 @end smallexample
17503
17504 This evaluates, i.e., loads, the @file{slowsplit.el} file or if it
17505 exists, the faster, byte compiled @file{slowsplit.elc} file from the
17506 @file{emacs} sub-directory of your home directory. The file contains
17507 the function @code{split-window-quietly}, which John Robinson wrote in
17508 1989.
17509
17510 The @code{split-window-quietly} function splits a window with the
17511 minimum of redisplay. I installed it in 1989 because it worked well
17512 with the slow 1200 baud terminals I was then using. Nowadays, I only
17513 occasionally come across such a slow connection, but I continue to use
17514 the function because I like the way it leaves the bottom half of a
17515 buffer in the lower of the new windows and the top half in the upper
17516 window.
17517
17518 @need 1250
17519 To replace the key binding for the default
17520 @code{split-window-vertically}, you must also unset that key and bind
17521 the keys to @code{split-window-quietly}, like this:
17522
17523 @smallexample
17524 @group
17525 (global-unset-key "\C-x2")
17526 (global-set-key "\C-x2" 'split-window-quietly)
17527 @end group
17528 @end smallexample
17529
17530 @vindex load-path
17531 If you load many extensions, as I do, then instead of specifying the
17532 exact location of the extension file, as shown above, you can specify
17533 that directory as part of Emacs's @code{load-path}. Then, when Emacs
17534 loads a file, it will search that directory as well as its default
17535 list of directories. (The default list is specified in @file{paths.h}
17536 when Emacs is built.)
17537
17538 @need 1250
17539 The following command adds your @file{~/emacs} directory to the
17540 existing load path:
17541
17542 @smallexample
17543 @group
17544 ;;; Emacs Load Path
17545 (setq load-path (cons "~/emacs" load-path))
17546 @end group
17547 @end smallexample
17548
17549 Incidentally, @code{load-library} is an interactive interface to the
17550 @code{load} function. The complete function looks like this:
17551
17552 @findex load-library
17553 @smallexample
17554 @group
17555 (defun load-library (library)
17556 "Load the library named LIBRARY.
17557 This is an interface to the function `load'."
17558 (interactive
17559 (list (completing-read "Load library: "
17560 (apply-partially 'locate-file-completion-table
17561 load-path
17562 (get-load-suffixes)))))
17563 (load library))
17564 @end group
17565 @end smallexample
17566
17567 The name of the function, @code{load-library}, comes from the use of
17568 `library' as a conventional synonym for `file'. The source for the
17569 @code{load-library} command is in the @file{files.el} library.
17570
17571 Another interactive command that does a slightly different job is
17572 @code{load-file}. @xref{Lisp Libraries, , Libraries of Lisp Code for
17573 Emacs, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}, for information on the
17574 distinction between @code{load-library} and this command.
17575
17576 @node Autoload
17577 @section Autoloading
17578 @findex autoload
17579
17580 Instead of installing a function by loading the file that contains it,
17581 or by evaluating the function definition, you can make the function
17582 available but not actually install it until it is first called. This
17583 is called @dfn{autoloading}.
17584
17585 When you execute an autoloaded function, Emacs automatically evaluates
17586 the file that contains the definition, and then calls the function.
17587
17588 Emacs starts quicker with autoloaded functions, since their libraries
17589 are not loaded right away; but you need to wait a moment when you
17590 first use such a function, while its containing file is evaluated.
17591
17592 Rarely used functions are frequently autoloaded. The
17593 @file{loaddefs.el} library contains hundreds of autoloaded functions,
17594 from @code{bookmark-set} to @code{wordstar-mode}. Of course, you may
17595 come to use a `rare' function frequently. When you do, you should
17596 load that function's file with a @code{load} expression in your
17597 @file{.emacs} file.
17598
17599 In my @file{.emacs} file, I load 14 libraries that contain functions
17600 that would otherwise be autoloaded. (Actually, it would have been
17601 better to include these files in my `dumped' Emacs, but I forgot.
17602 @xref{Building Emacs, , Building Emacs, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
17603 Reference Manual}, and the @file{INSTALL} file for more about
17604 dumping.)
17605
17606 You may also want to include autoloaded expressions in your @file{.emacs}
17607 file. @code{autoload} is a built-in function that takes up to five
17608 arguments, the final three of which are optional. The first argument
17609 is the name of the function to be autoloaded; the second is the name
17610 of the file to be loaded. The third argument is documentation for the
17611 function, and the fourth tells whether the function can be called
17612 interactively. The fifth argument tells what type of
17613 object---@code{autoload} can handle a keymap or macro as well as a
17614 function (the default is a function).
17615
17616 @need 800
17617 Here is a typical example:
17618
17619 @smallexample
17620 @group
17621 (autoload 'html-helper-mode
17622 "html-helper-mode" "Edit HTML documents" t)
17623 @end group
17624 @end smallexample
17625
17626 @noindent
17627 (@code{html-helper-mode} is an older alternative to @code{html-mode},
17628 which is a standard part of the distribution.)
17629
17630 @noindent
17631 This expression autoloads the @code{html-helper-mode} function. It
17632 takes it from the @file{html-helper-mode.el} file (or from the byte
17633 compiled version @file{html-helper-mode.elc}, if that exists.) The
17634 file must be located in a directory specified by @code{load-path}.
17635 The documentation says that this is a mode to help you edit documents
17636 written in the HyperText Markup Language. You can call this mode
17637 interactively by typing @kbd{M-x html-helper-mode}. (You need to
17638 duplicate the function's regular documentation in the autoload
17639 expression because the regular function is not yet loaded, so its
17640 documentation is not available.)
17641
17642 @xref{Autoload, , Autoload, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference
17643 Manual}, for more information.
17644
17645 @node Simple Extension
17646 @section A Simple Extension: @code{line-to-top-of-window}
17647 @findex line-to-top-of-window
17648 @cindex Simple extension in @file{.emacs} file
17649
17650 Here is a simple extension to Emacs that moves the line point is on to
17651 the top of the window. I use this all the time, to make text easier
17652 to read.
17653
17654 You can put the following code into a separate file and then load it
17655 from your @file{.emacs} file, or you can include it within your
17656 @file{.emacs} file.
17657
17658 @need 1250
17659 Here is the definition:
17660
17661 @smallexample
17662 @group
17663 ;;; Line to top of window;
17664 ;;; replace three keystroke sequence C-u 0 C-l
17665 (defun line-to-top-of-window ()
17666 "Move the line point is on to top of window."
17667 (interactive)
17668 (recenter 0))
17669 @end group
17670 @end smallexample
17671
17672 @need 1250
17673 Now for the keybinding.
17674
17675 Nowadays, function keys as well as mouse button events and
17676 non-@sc{ascii} characters are written within square brackets, without
17677 quotation marks. (In Emacs version 18 and before, you had to write
17678 different function key bindings for each different make of terminal.)
17679
17680 I bind @code{line-to-top-of-window} to my @key{F6} function key like
17681 this:
17682
17683 @smallexample
17684 (global-set-key [f6] 'line-to-top-of-window)
17685 @end smallexample
17686
17687 For more information, see @ref{Init Rebinding, , Rebinding Keys in
17688 Your Init File, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}.
17689
17690 @cindex Conditional 'twixt two versions of Emacs
17691 @cindex Version of Emacs, choosing
17692 @cindex Emacs version, choosing
17693 If you run two versions of GNU Emacs, such as versions 22 and 23, and
17694 use one @file{.emacs} file, you can select which code to evaluate with
17695 the following conditional:
17696
17697 @smallexample
17698 @group
17699 (cond
17700 ((= 22 emacs-major-version)
17701 ;; evaluate version 22 code
17702 ( @dots{} ))
17703 ((= 23 emacs-major-version)
17704 ;; evaluate version 23 code
17705 ( @dots{} )))
17706 @end group
17707 @end smallexample
17708
17709 For example, recent versions blink
17710 their cursors by default. I hate such blinking, as well as other
17711 features, so I placed the following in my @file{.emacs}
17712 file@footnote{When I start instances of Emacs that do not load my
17713 @file{.emacs} file or any site file, I also turn off blinking:
17714
17715 @smallexample
17716 emacs -q --no-site-file -eval '(blink-cursor-mode nil)'
17717
17718 @exdent Or nowadays, using an even more sophisticated set of options,
17719
17720 emacs -Q -D
17721 @end smallexample
17722 }:
17723
17724 @smallexample
17725 @group
17726 (when (>= emacs-major-version 21)
17727 (blink-cursor-mode 0)
17728 ;; Insert newline when you press `C-n' (next-line)
17729 ;; at the end of the buffer
17730 (setq next-line-add-newlines t)
17731 @end group
17732 @group
17733 ;; Turn on image viewing
17734 (auto-image-file-mode t)
17735 @end group
17736 @group
17737 ;; Turn on menu bar (this bar has text)
17738 ;; (Use numeric argument to turn on)
17739 (menu-bar-mode 1)
17740 @end group
17741 @group
17742 ;; Turn off tool bar (this bar has icons)
17743 ;; (Use numeric argument to turn on)
17744 (tool-bar-mode nil)
17745 @end group
17746 @group
17747 ;; Turn off tooltip mode for tool bar
17748 ;; (This mode causes icon explanations to pop up)
17749 ;; (Use numeric argument to turn on)
17750 (tooltip-mode nil)
17751 ;; If tooltips turned on, make tips appear promptly
17752 (setq tooltip-delay 0.1) ; default is 0.7 second
17753 )
17754 @end group
17755 @end smallexample
17756
17757 @node X11 Colors
17758 @section X11 Colors
17759
17760 You can specify colors when you use Emacs with the MIT X Windowing
17761 system.
17762
17763 I dislike the default colors and specify my own.
17764
17765 @need 1250
17766 Here are the expressions in my @file{.emacs}
17767 file that set values:
17768
17769 @smallexample
17770 @group
17771 ;; Set cursor color
17772 (set-cursor-color "white")
17773
17774 ;; Set mouse color
17775 (set-mouse-color "white")
17776
17777 ;; Set foreground and background
17778 (set-foreground-color "white")
17779 (set-background-color "darkblue")
17780 @end group
17781
17782 @group
17783 ;;; Set highlighting colors for isearch and drag
17784 (set-face-foreground 'highlight "white")
17785 (set-face-background 'highlight "blue")
17786 @end group
17787
17788 @group
17789 (set-face-foreground 'region "cyan")
17790 (set-face-background 'region "blue")
17791 @end group
17792
17793 @group
17794 (set-face-foreground 'secondary-selection "skyblue")
17795 (set-face-background 'secondary-selection "darkblue")
17796 @end group
17797
17798 @group
17799 ;; Set calendar highlighting colors
17800 (setq calendar-load-hook
17801 (lambda ()
17802 (set-face-foreground 'diary-face "skyblue")
17803 (set-face-background 'holiday-face "slate blue")
17804 (set-face-foreground 'holiday-face "white")))
17805 @end group
17806 @end smallexample
17807
17808 The various shades of blue soothe my eye and prevent me from seeing
17809 the screen flicker.
17810
17811 Alternatively, I could have set my specifications in various X
17812 initialization files. For example, I could set the foreground,
17813 background, cursor, and pointer (i.e., mouse) colors in my
17814 @file{~/.Xresources} file like this:
17815
17816 @smallexample
17817 @group
17818 Emacs*foreground: white
17819 Emacs*background: darkblue
17820 Emacs*cursorColor: white
17821 Emacs*pointerColor: white
17822 @end group
17823 @end smallexample
17824
17825 In any event, since it is not part of Emacs, I set the root color of
17826 my X window in my @file{~/.xinitrc} file, like this@footnote{I also
17827 run more modern window managers, such as Enlightenment, Gnome, or KDE;
17828 in those cases, I often specify an image rather than a plain color.}:
17829
17830 @smallexample
17831 xsetroot -solid Navy -fg white &
17832 @end smallexample
17833
17834 @need 1700
17835 @node Miscellaneous
17836 @section Miscellaneous Settings for a @file{.emacs} File
17837
17838 @need 1250
17839 Here are a few miscellaneous settings:
17840 @sp 1
17841
17842 @itemize @minus
17843 @item
17844 Set the shape and color of the mouse cursor:
17845
17846 @smallexample
17847 @group
17848 ; Cursor shapes are defined in
17849 ; `/usr/include/X11/cursorfont.h';
17850 ; for example, the `target' cursor is number 128;
17851 ; the `top_left_arrow' cursor is number 132.
17852 @end group
17853
17854 @group
17855 (let ((mpointer (x-get-resource "*mpointer"
17856 "*emacs*mpointer")))
17857 ;; If you have not set your mouse pointer
17858 ;; then set it, otherwise leave as is:
17859 (if (eq mpointer nil)
17860 (setq mpointer "132")) ; top_left_arrow
17861 @end group
17862 @group
17863 (setq x-pointer-shape (string-to-int mpointer))
17864 (set-mouse-color "white"))
17865 @end group
17866 @end smallexample
17867
17868 @item
17869 Or you can set the values of a variety of features in an alist, like
17870 this:
17871
17872 @smallexample
17873 @group
17874 (setq-default
17875 default-frame-alist
17876 '((cursor-color . "white")
17877 (mouse-color . "white")
17878 (foreground-color . "white")
17879 (background-color . "DodgerBlue4")
17880 ;; (cursor-type . bar)
17881 (cursor-type . box)
17882 @end group
17883 @group
17884 (tool-bar-lines . 0)
17885 (menu-bar-lines . 1)
17886 (width . 80)
17887 (height . 58)
17888 (font .
17889 "-Misc-Fixed-Medium-R-Normal--20-200-75-75-C-100-ISO8859-1")
17890 ))
17891 @end group
17892 @end smallexample
17893
17894 @item
17895 Convert @kbd{@key{CTRL}-h} into @key{DEL} and @key{DEL}
17896 into @kbd{@key{CTRL}-h}.@*
17897 (Some older keyboards needed this, although I have not seen the
17898 problem recently.)
17899
17900 @smallexample
17901 @group
17902 ;; Translate `C-h' to <DEL>.
17903 ; (keyboard-translate ?\C-h ?\C-?)
17904
17905 ;; Translate <DEL> to `C-h'.
17906 (keyboard-translate ?\C-? ?\C-h)
17907 @end group
17908 @end smallexample
17909
17910 @item Turn off a blinking cursor!
17911
17912 @smallexample
17913 @group
17914 (if (fboundp 'blink-cursor-mode)
17915 (blink-cursor-mode -1))
17916 @end group
17917 @end smallexample
17918
17919 @noindent
17920 or start GNU Emacs with the command @code{emacs -nbc}.
17921
17922 @need 1250
17923 @item When using `grep'@*
17924 @samp{-i}@w{ } Ignore case distinctions@*
17925 @samp{-n}@w{ } Prefix each line of output with line number@*
17926 @samp{-H}@w{ } Print the filename for each match.@*
17927 @samp{-e}@w{ } Protect patterns beginning with a hyphen character, @samp{-}
17928
17929 @smallexample
17930 (setq grep-command "grep -i -nH -e ")
17931 @end smallexample
17932
17933 @ignore
17934 @c Evidently, no longer needed in GNU Emacs 22
17935
17936 item Automatically uncompress compressed files when visiting them
17937
17938 smallexample
17939 (load "uncompress")
17940 end smallexample
17941
17942 @end ignore
17943
17944 @item Find an existing buffer, even if it has a different name@*
17945 This avoids problems with symbolic links.
17946
17947 @smallexample
17948 (setq find-file-existing-other-name t)
17949 @end smallexample
17950
17951 @item Set your language environment and default input method
17952
17953 @smallexample
17954 @group
17955 (set-language-environment "latin-1")
17956 ;; Remember you can enable or disable multilingual text input
17957 ;; with the @code{toggle-input-method'} (@kbd{C-\}) command
17958 (setq default-input-method "latin-1-prefix")
17959 @end group
17960 @end smallexample
17961
17962 If you want to write with Chinese `GB' characters, set this instead:
17963
17964 @smallexample
17965 @group
17966 (set-language-environment "Chinese-GB")
17967 (setq default-input-method "chinese-tonepy")
17968 @end group
17969 @end smallexample
17970 @end itemize
17971
17972 @subsubheading Fixing Unpleasant Key Bindings
17973 @cindex Key bindings, fixing
17974 @cindex Bindings, key, fixing unpleasant
17975
17976 Some systems bind keys unpleasantly. Sometimes, for example, the
17977 @key{CTRL} key appears in an awkward spot rather than at the far left
17978 of the home row.
17979
17980 Usually, when people fix these sorts of keybindings, they do not
17981 change their @file{~/.emacs} file. Instead, they bind the proper keys
17982 on their consoles with the @code{loadkeys} or @code{install-keymap}
17983 commands in their boot script and then include @code{xmodmap} commands
17984 in their @file{.xinitrc} or @file{.Xsession} file for X Windows.
17985
17986 @need 1250
17987 @noindent
17988 For a boot script:
17989
17990 @smallexample
17991 @group
17992 loadkeys /usr/share/keymaps/i386/qwerty/emacs2.kmap.gz
17993 @exdent or
17994 install-keymap emacs2
17995 @end group
17996 @end smallexample
17997
17998 @need 1250
17999 @noindent
18000 For a @file{.xinitrc} or @file{.Xsession} file when the @key{Caps
18001 Lock} key is at the far left of the home row:
18002
18003 @smallexample
18004 @group
18005 # Bind the key labeled `Caps Lock' to `Control'
18006 # (Such a broken user interface suggests that keyboard manufacturers
18007 # think that computers are typewriters from 1885.)
18008
18009 xmodmap -e "clear Lock"
18010 xmodmap -e "add Control = Caps_Lock"
18011 @end group
18012 @end smallexample
18013
18014 @need 1250
18015 @noindent
18016 In a @file{.xinitrc} or @file{.Xsession} file, to convert an @key{ALT}
18017 key to a @key{META} key:
18018
18019 @smallexample
18020 @group
18021 # Some ill designed keyboards have a key labeled ALT and no Meta
18022 xmodmap -e "keysym Alt_L = Meta_L Alt_L"
18023 @end group
18024 @end smallexample
18025
18026 @need 1700
18027 @node Mode Line
18028 @section A Modified Mode Line
18029 @vindex mode-line-format
18030 @cindex Mode line format
18031
18032 Finally, a feature I really like: a modified mode line.
18033
18034 When I work over a network, I forget which machine I am using. Also,
18035 I tend to I lose track of where I am, and which line point is on.
18036
18037 So I reset my mode line to look like this:
18038
18039 @smallexample
18040 -:-- foo.texi rattlesnake:/home/bob/ Line 1 (Texinfo Fill) Top
18041 @end smallexample
18042
18043 I am visiting a file called @file{foo.texi}, on my machine
18044 @file{rattlesnake} in my @file{/home/bob} buffer. I am on line 1, in
18045 Texinfo mode, and am at the top of the buffer.
18046
18047 @need 1200
18048 My @file{.emacs} file has a section that looks like this:
18049
18050 @smallexample
18051 @group
18052 ;; Set a Mode Line that tells me which machine, which directory,
18053 ;; and which line I am on, plus the other customary information.
18054 (setq-default mode-line-format
18055 (quote
18056 (#("-" 0 1
18057 (help-echo
18058 "mouse-1: select window, mouse-2: delete others ..."))
18059 mode-line-mule-info
18060 mode-line-modified
18061 mode-line-frame-identification
18062 " "
18063 @end group
18064 @group
18065 mode-line-buffer-identification
18066 " "
18067 (:eval (substring
18068 (system-name) 0 (string-match "\\..+" (system-name))))
18069 ":"
18070 default-directory
18071 #(" " 0 1
18072 (help-echo
18073 "mouse-1: select window, mouse-2: delete others ..."))
18074 (line-number-mode " Line %l ")
18075 global-mode-string
18076 @end group
18077 @group
18078 #(" %[(" 0 6
18079 (help-echo
18080 "mouse-1: select window, mouse-2: delete others ..."))
18081 (:eval (mode-line-mode-name))
18082 mode-line-process
18083 minor-mode-alist
18084 #("%n" 0 2 (help-echo "mouse-2: widen" local-map (keymap ...)))
18085 ")%] "
18086 (-3 . "%P")
18087 ;; "-%-"
18088 )))
18089 @end group
18090 @end smallexample
18091
18092 @noindent
18093 Here, I redefine the default mode line. Most of the parts are from
18094 the original; but I make a few changes. I set the @emph{default} mode
18095 line format so as to permit various modes, such as Info, to override
18096 it.
18097
18098 Many elements in the list are self-explanatory:
18099 @code{mode-line-modified} is a variable that tells whether the buffer
18100 has been modified, @code{mode-name} tells the name of the mode, and so
18101 on. However, the format looks complicated because of two features we
18102 have not discussed.
18103
18104 @cindex Properties, in mode line example
18105 The first string in the mode line is a dash or hyphen, @samp{-}. In
18106 the old days, it would have been specified simply as @code{"-"}. But
18107 nowadays, Emacs can add properties to a string, such as highlighting
18108 or, as in this case, a help feature. If you place your mouse cursor
18109 over the hyphen, some help information appears (By default, you must
18110 wait seven-tenths of a second before the information appears. You can
18111 change that timing by changing the value of @code{tooltip-delay}.)
18112
18113 @need 1000
18114 The new string format has a special syntax:
18115
18116 @smallexample
18117 #("-" 0 1 (help-echo "mouse-1: select window, ..."))
18118 @end smallexample
18119
18120 @noindent
18121 The @code{#(} begins a list. The first element of the list is the
18122 string itself, just one @samp{-}. The second and third
18123 elements specify the range over which the fourth element applies. A
18124 range starts @emph{after} a character, so a zero means the range
18125 starts just before the first character; a 1 means that the range ends
18126 just after the first character. The third element is the property for
18127 the range. It consists of a property list, a
18128 property name, in this case, @samp{help-echo}, followed by a value, in this
18129 case, a string. The second, third, and fourth elements of this new
18130 string format can be repeated.
18131
18132 @xref{Text Properties, , Text Properties, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
18133 Reference Manual}, and see @ref{Mode Line Format, , Mode Line Format,
18134 elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}, for more information.
18135
18136 @code{mode-line-buffer-identification}
18137 displays the current buffer name. It is a list
18138 beginning @code{(#("%12b" 0 4 @dots{}}.
18139 The @code{#(} begins the list.
18140
18141 The @samp{"%12b"} displays the current buffer name, using the
18142 @code{buffer-name} function with which we are familiar; the `12'
18143 specifies the maximum number of characters that will be displayed.
18144 When a name has fewer characters, whitespace is added to fill out to
18145 this number. (Buffer names can and often should be longer than 12
18146 characters; this length works well in a typical 80 column wide
18147 window.)
18148
18149 @code{:eval} says to evaluate the following form and use the result as
18150 a string to display. In this case, the expression displays the first
18151 component of the full system name. The end of the first component is
18152 a @samp{.} (`period'), so I use the @code{string-match} function to
18153 tell me the length of the first component. The substring from the
18154 zeroth character to that length is the name of the machine.
18155
18156 @need 1250
18157 This is the expression:
18158
18159 @smallexample
18160 @group
18161 (:eval (substring
18162 (system-name) 0 (string-match "\\..+" (system-name))))
18163 @end group
18164 @end smallexample
18165
18166 @samp{%[} and @samp{%]} cause a pair of square brackets
18167 to appear for each recursive editing level. @samp{%n} says `Narrow'
18168 when narrowing is in effect. @samp{%P} tells you the percentage of
18169 the buffer that is above the bottom of the window, or `Top', `Bottom',
18170 or `All'. (A lower case @samp{p} tell you the percentage above the
18171 @emph{top} of the window.) @samp{%-} inserts enough dashes to fill
18172 out the line.
18173
18174 Remember, ``You don't have to like Emacs to like it''---your own
18175 Emacs can have different colors, different commands, and different
18176 keys than a default Emacs.
18177
18178 On the other hand, if you want to bring up a plain `out of the box'
18179 Emacs, with no customization, type:
18180
18181 @smallexample
18182 emacs -q
18183 @end smallexample
18184
18185 @noindent
18186 This will start an Emacs that does @emph{not} load your
18187 @file{~/.emacs} initialization file. A plain, default Emacs. Nothing
18188 more.
18189
18190 @node Debugging
18191 @chapter Debugging
18192 @cindex debugging
18193
18194 GNU Emacs has two debuggers, @code{debug} and @code{edebug}. The
18195 first is built into the internals of Emacs and is always with you;
18196 the second requires that you instrument a function before you can use it.
18197
18198 Both debuggers are described extensively in @ref{Debugging, ,
18199 Debugging Lisp Programs, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}.
18200 In this chapter, I will walk through a short example of each.
18201
18202 @menu
18203 * debug:: How to use the built-in debugger.
18204 * debug-on-entry:: Start debugging when you call a function.
18205 * debug-on-quit:: Start debugging when you quit with @kbd{C-g}.
18206 * edebug:: How to use Edebug, a source level debugger.
18207 * Debugging Exercises::
18208 @end menu
18209
18210 @node debug
18211 @section @code{debug}
18212 @findex debug
18213
18214 Suppose you have written a function definition that is intended to
18215 return the sum of the numbers 1 through a given number. (This is the
18216 @code{triangle} function discussed earlier. @xref{Decrementing
18217 Example, , Example with Decrementing Counter}, for a discussion.)
18218 @c xref{Decrementing Loop,, Loop with a Decrementing Counter}, for a discussion.)
18219
18220 However, your function definition has a bug. You have mistyped
18221 @samp{1=} for @samp{1-}. Here is the broken definition:
18222
18223 @findex triangle-bugged
18224 @smallexample
18225 @group
18226 (defun triangle-bugged (number)
18227 "Return sum of numbers 1 through NUMBER inclusive."
18228 (let ((total 0))
18229 (while (> number 0)
18230 (setq total (+ total number))
18231 (setq number (1= number))) ; @r{Error here.}
18232 total))
18233 @end group
18234 @end smallexample
18235
18236 If you are reading this in Info, you can evaluate this definition in
18237 the normal fashion. You will see @code{triangle-bugged} appear in the
18238 echo area.
18239
18240 @need 1250
18241 Now evaluate the @code{triangle-bugged} function with an
18242 argument of 4:
18243
18244 @smallexample
18245 (triangle-bugged 4)
18246 @end smallexample
18247
18248 @noindent
18249 In a recent GNU Emacs, you will create and enter a @file{*Backtrace*}
18250 buffer that says:
18251
18252 @noindent
18253 @smallexample
18254 @group
18255 ---------- Buffer: *Backtrace* ----------
18256 Debugger entered--Lisp error: (void-function 1=)
18257 (1= number)
18258 (setq number (1= number))
18259 (while (> number 0) (setq total (+ total number))
18260 (setq number (1= number)))
18261 (let ((total 0)) (while (> number 0) (setq total ...)
18262 (setq number ...)) total)
18263 triangle-bugged(4)
18264 @end group
18265 @group
18266 eval((triangle-bugged 4))
18267 eval-last-sexp-1(nil)
18268 eval-last-sexp(nil)
18269 call-interactively(eval-last-sexp)
18270 ---------- Buffer: *Backtrace* ----------
18271 @end group
18272 @end smallexample
18273
18274 @noindent
18275 (I have reformatted this example slightly; the debugger does not fold
18276 long lines. As usual, you can quit the debugger by typing @kbd{q} in
18277 the @file{*Backtrace*} buffer.)
18278
18279 In practice, for a bug as simple as this, the `Lisp error' line will
18280 tell you what you need to know to correct the definition. The
18281 function @code{1=} is `void'.
18282
18283 @ignore
18284 @need 800
18285 In GNU Emacs 20 and before, you will see:
18286
18287 @smallexample
18288 Symbol's function definition is void:@: 1=
18289 @end smallexample
18290
18291 @noindent
18292 which has the same meaning as the @file{*Backtrace*} buffer line in
18293 version 21.
18294 @end ignore
18295
18296 However, suppose you are not quite certain what is going on?
18297 You can read the complete backtrace.
18298
18299 In this case, you need to run a recent GNU Emacs, which automatically
18300 starts the debugger that puts you in the @file{*Backtrace*} buffer; or
18301 else, you need to start the debugger manually as described below.
18302
18303 Read the @file{*Backtrace*} buffer from the bottom up; it tells you
18304 what Emacs did that led to the error. Emacs made an interactive call
18305 to @kbd{C-x C-e} (@code{eval-last-sexp}), which led to the evaluation
18306 of the @code{triangle-bugged} expression. Each line above tells you
18307 what the Lisp interpreter evaluated next.
18308
18309 @need 1250
18310 The third line from the top of the buffer is
18311
18312 @smallexample
18313 (setq number (1= number))
18314 @end smallexample
18315
18316 @noindent
18317 Emacs tried to evaluate this expression; in order to do so, it tried
18318 to evaluate the inner expression shown on the second line from the
18319 top:
18320
18321 @smallexample
18322 (1= number)
18323 @end smallexample
18324
18325 @need 1250
18326 @noindent
18327 This is where the error occurred; as the top line says:
18328
18329 @smallexample
18330 Debugger entered--Lisp error: (void-function 1=)
18331 @end smallexample
18332
18333 @noindent
18334 You can correct the mistake, re-evaluate the function definition, and
18335 then run your test again.
18336
18337 @node debug-on-entry
18338 @section @code{debug-on-entry}
18339 @findex debug-on-entry
18340
18341 A recent GNU Emacs starts the debugger automatically when your
18342 function has an error.
18343
18344 @ignore
18345 GNU Emacs version 20 and before did not; it simply
18346 presented you with an error message. You had to start the debugger
18347 manually.
18348 @end ignore
18349
18350 Incidentally, you can start the debugger manually for all versions of
18351 Emacs; the advantage is that the debugger runs even if you do not have
18352 a bug in your code. Sometimes your code will be free of bugs!
18353
18354 You can enter the debugger when you call the function by calling
18355 @code{debug-on-entry}.
18356
18357 @need 1250
18358 @noindent
18359 Type:
18360
18361 @smallexample
18362 M-x debug-on-entry RET triangle-bugged RET
18363 @end smallexample
18364
18365 @need 1250
18366 @noindent
18367 Now, evaluate the following:
18368
18369 @smallexample
18370 (triangle-bugged 5)
18371 @end smallexample
18372
18373 @noindent
18374 All versions of Emacs will create a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer and tell
18375 you that it is beginning to evaluate the @code{triangle-bugged}
18376 function:
18377
18378 @smallexample
18379 @group
18380 ---------- Buffer: *Backtrace* ----------
18381 Debugger entered--entering a function:
18382 * triangle-bugged(5)
18383 eval((triangle-bugged 5))
18384 @end group
18385 @group
18386 eval-last-sexp-1(nil)
18387 eval-last-sexp(nil)
18388 call-interactively(eval-last-sexp)
18389 ---------- Buffer: *Backtrace* ----------
18390 @end group
18391 @end smallexample
18392
18393 In the @file{*Backtrace*} buffer, type @kbd{d}. Emacs will evaluate
18394 the first expression in @code{triangle-bugged}; the buffer will look
18395 like this:
18396
18397 @smallexample
18398 @group
18399 ---------- Buffer: *Backtrace* ----------
18400 Debugger entered--beginning evaluation of function call form:
18401 * (let ((total 0)) (while (> number 0) (setq total ...)
18402 (setq number ...)) total)
18403 * triangle-bugged(5)
18404 eval((triangle-bugged 5))
18405 @end group
18406 @group
18407 eval-last-sexp-1(nil)
18408 eval-last-sexp(nil)
18409 call-interactively(eval-last-sexp)
18410 ---------- Buffer: *Backtrace* ----------
18411 @end group
18412 @end smallexample
18413
18414 @noindent
18415 Now, type @kbd{d} again, eight times, slowly. Each time you type
18416 @kbd{d}, Emacs will evaluate another expression in the function
18417 definition.
18418
18419 @need 1750
18420 Eventually, the buffer will look like this:
18421
18422 @smallexample
18423 @group
18424 ---------- Buffer: *Backtrace* ----------
18425 Debugger entered--beginning evaluation of function call form:
18426 * (setq number (1= number))
18427 * (while (> number 0) (setq total (+ total number))
18428 (setq number (1= number)))
18429 @group
18430 @end group
18431 * (let ((total 0)) (while (> number 0) (setq total ...)
18432 (setq number ...)) total)
18433 * triangle-bugged(5)
18434 eval((triangle-bugged 5))
18435 @group
18436 @end group
18437 eval-last-sexp-1(nil)
18438 eval-last-sexp(nil)
18439 call-interactively(eval-last-sexp)
18440 ---------- Buffer: *Backtrace* ----------
18441 @end group
18442 @end smallexample
18443
18444 @need 1500
18445 @noindent
18446 Finally, after you type @kbd{d} two more times, Emacs will reach the
18447 error, and the top two lines of the @file{*Backtrace*} buffer will look
18448 like this:
18449
18450 @smallexample
18451 @group
18452 ---------- Buffer: *Backtrace* ----------
18453 Debugger entered--Lisp error: (void-function 1=)
18454 * (1= number)
18455 @dots{}
18456 ---------- Buffer: *Backtrace* ----------
18457 @end group
18458 @end smallexample
18459
18460 By typing @kbd{d}, you were able to step through the function.
18461
18462 You can quit a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer by typing @kbd{q} in it; this
18463 quits the trace, but does not cancel @code{debug-on-entry}.
18464
18465 @findex cancel-debug-on-entry
18466 To cancel the effect of @code{debug-on-entry}, call
18467 @code{cancel-debug-on-entry} and the name of the function, like this:
18468
18469 @smallexample
18470 M-x cancel-debug-on-entry RET triangle-bugged RET
18471 @end smallexample
18472
18473 @noindent
18474 (If you are reading this in Info, cancel @code{debug-on-entry} now.)
18475
18476 @node debug-on-quit
18477 @section @code{debug-on-quit} and @code{(debug)}
18478
18479 In addition to setting @code{debug-on-error} or calling @code{debug-on-entry},
18480 there are two other ways to start @code{debug}.
18481
18482 @findex debug-on-quit
18483 You can start @code{debug} whenever you type @kbd{C-g}
18484 (@code{keyboard-quit}) by setting the variable @code{debug-on-quit} to
18485 @code{t}. This is useful for debugging infinite loops.
18486
18487 @need 1500
18488 @cindex @code{(debug)} in code
18489 Or, you can insert a line that says @code{(debug)} into your code
18490 where you want the debugger to start, like this:
18491
18492 @smallexample
18493 @group
18494 (defun triangle-bugged (number)
18495 "Return sum of numbers 1 through NUMBER inclusive."
18496 (let ((total 0))
18497 (while (> number 0)
18498 (setq total (+ total number))
18499 (debug) ; @r{Start debugger.}
18500 (setq number (1= number))) ; @r{Error here.}
18501 total))
18502 @end group
18503 @end smallexample
18504
18505 The @code{debug} function is described in detail in @ref{Debugger, ,
18506 The Lisp Debugger, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}.
18507
18508 @node edebug
18509 @section The @code{edebug} Source Level Debugger
18510 @cindex Source level debugger
18511 @findex edebug
18512
18513 Edebug is a source level debugger. Edebug normally displays the
18514 source of the code you are debugging, with an arrow at the left that
18515 shows which line you are currently executing.
18516
18517 You can walk through the execution of a function, line by line, or run
18518 quickly until reaching a @dfn{breakpoint} where execution stops.
18519
18520 Edebug is described in @ref{edebug, , Edebug, elisp, The GNU Emacs
18521 Lisp Reference Manual}.
18522
18523 @need 1250
18524 Here is a bugged function definition for @code{triangle-recursively}.
18525 @xref{Recursive triangle function, , Recursion in place of a counter},
18526 for a review of it.
18527
18528 @smallexample
18529 @group
18530 (defun triangle-recursively-bugged (number)
18531 "Return sum of numbers 1 through NUMBER inclusive.
18532 Uses recursion."
18533 (if (= number 1)
18534 1
18535 (+ number
18536 (triangle-recursively-bugged
18537 (1= number))))) ; @r{Error here.}
18538 @end group
18539 @end smallexample
18540
18541 @noindent
18542 Normally, you would install this definition by positioning your cursor
18543 after the function's closing parenthesis and typing @kbd{C-x C-e}
18544 (@code{eval-last-sexp}) or else by positioning your cursor within the
18545 definition and typing @kbd{C-M-x} (@code{eval-defun}). (By default,
18546 the @code{eval-defun} command works only in Emacs Lisp mode or in Lisp
18547 Interaction mode.)
18548
18549 @need 1500
18550 However, to prepare this function definition for Edebug, you must
18551 first @dfn{instrument} the code using a different command. You can do
18552 this by positioning your cursor within or just after the definition
18553 and typing
18554
18555 @smallexample
18556 M-x edebug-defun RET
18557 @end smallexample
18558
18559 @noindent
18560 This will cause Emacs to load Edebug automatically if it is not
18561 already loaded, and properly instrument the function.
18562
18563 After instrumenting the function, place your cursor after the
18564 following expression and type @kbd{C-x C-e} (@code{eval-last-sexp}):
18565
18566 @smallexample
18567 (triangle-recursively-bugged 3)
18568 @end smallexample
18569
18570 @noindent
18571 You will be jumped back to the source for
18572 @code{triangle-recursively-bugged} and the cursor positioned at the
18573 beginning of the @code{if} line of the function. Also, you will see
18574 an arrowhead at the left hand side of that line. The arrowhead marks
18575 the line where the function is executing. (In the following examples,
18576 we show the arrowhead with @samp{=>}; in a windowing system, you may
18577 see the arrowhead as a solid triangle in the window `fringe'.)
18578
18579 @smallexample
18580 =>@point{}(if (= number 1)
18581 @end smallexample
18582
18583 @noindent
18584 @iftex
18585 In the example, the location of point is displayed with a star,
18586 @samp{@point{}} (in Info, it is displayed as @samp{-!-}).
18587 @end iftex
18588 @ifnottex
18589 In the example, the location of point is displayed as @samp{@point{}}
18590 (in a printed book, it is displayed with a five pointed star).
18591 @end ifnottex
18592
18593 If you now press @key{SPC}, point will move to the next expression to
18594 be executed; the line will look like this:
18595
18596 @smallexample
18597 =>(if @point{}(= number 1)
18598 @end smallexample
18599
18600 @noindent
18601 As you continue to press @key{SPC}, point will move from expression to
18602 expression. At the same time, whenever an expression returns a value,
18603 that value will be displayed in the echo area. For example, after you
18604 move point past @code{number}, you will see the following:
18605
18606 @smallexample
18607 Result: 3 (#o3, #x3, ?\C-c)
18608 @end smallexample
18609
18610 @noindent
18611 This means the value of @code{number} is 3, which is octal three,
18612 hexadecimal three, and @sc{ascii} `control-c' (the third letter of the
18613 alphabet, in case you need to know this information).
18614
18615 You can continue moving through the code until you reach the line with
18616 the error. Before evaluation, that line looks like this:
18617
18618 @smallexample
18619 => @point{}(1= number))))) ; @r{Error here.}
18620 @end smallexample
18621
18622 @need 1250
18623 @noindent
18624 When you press @key{SPC} once again, you will produce an error message
18625 that says:
18626
18627 @smallexample
18628 Symbol's function definition is void:@: 1=
18629 @end smallexample
18630
18631 @noindent
18632 This is the bug.
18633
18634 Press @kbd{q} to quit Edebug.
18635
18636 To remove instrumentation from a function definition, simply
18637 re-evaluate it with a command that does not instrument it.
18638 For example, you could place your cursor after the definition's
18639 closing parenthesis and type @kbd{C-x C-e}.
18640
18641 Edebug does a great deal more than walk with you through a function.
18642 You can set it so it races through on its own, stopping only at an
18643 error or at specified stopping points; you can cause it to display the
18644 changing values of various expressions; you can find out how many
18645 times a function is called, and more.
18646
18647 Edebug is described in @ref{edebug, , Edebug, elisp, The GNU Emacs
18648 Lisp Reference Manual}.
18649
18650 @need 1500
18651 @node Debugging Exercises
18652 @section Debugging Exercises
18653
18654 @itemize @bullet
18655 @item
18656 Install the @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}} function and then cause it to
18657 enter the built-in debugger when you call it. Run the command on a
18658 region containing two words. You will need to press @kbd{d} a
18659 remarkable number of times. On your system, is a `hook' called after
18660 the command finishes? (For information on hooks, see @ref{Command
18661 Overview, , Command Loop Overview, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference
18662 Manual}.)
18663
18664 @item
18665 Copy @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}} into the @file{*scratch*} buffer,
18666 instrument the function for Edebug, and walk through its execution.
18667 The function does not need to have a bug, although you can introduce
18668 one if you wish. If the function lacks a bug, the walk-through
18669 completes without problems.
18670
18671 @item
18672 While running Edebug, type @kbd{?} to see a list of all the Edebug commands.
18673 (The @code{global-edebug-prefix} is usually @kbd{C-x X}, i.e.,
18674 @kbd{@key{CTRL}-x} followed by an upper case @kbd{X}; use this prefix
18675 for commands made outside of the Edebug debugging buffer.)
18676
18677 @item
18678 In the Edebug debugging buffer, use the @kbd{p}
18679 (@code{edebug-bounce-point}) command to see where in the region the
18680 @code{@value{COUNT-WORDS}} is working.
18681
18682 @item
18683 Move point to some spot further down the function and then type the
18684 @kbd{h} (@code{edebug-goto-here}) command to jump to that location.
18685
18686 @item
18687 Use the @kbd{t} (@code{edebug-trace-mode}) command to cause Edebug to
18688 walk through the function on its own; use an upper case @kbd{T} for
18689 @code{edebug-Trace-fast-mode}.
18690
18691 @item
18692 Set a breakpoint, then run Edebug in Trace mode until it reaches the
18693 stopping point.
18694 @end itemize
18695
18696 @node Conclusion
18697 @chapter Conclusion
18698
18699 We have now reached the end of this Introduction. You have now
18700 learned enough about programming in Emacs Lisp to set values, to write
18701 simple @file{.emacs} files for yourself and your friends, and write
18702 simple customizations and extensions to Emacs.
18703
18704 This is a place to stop. Or, if you wish, you can now go onward, and
18705 teach yourself.
18706
18707 You have learned some of the basic nuts and bolts of programming. But
18708 only some. There are a great many more brackets and hinges that are
18709 easy to use that we have not touched.
18710
18711 A path you can follow right now lies among the sources to GNU Emacs
18712 and in
18713 @ifnotinfo
18714 @cite{The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}.
18715 @end ifnotinfo
18716 @ifinfo
18717 @ref{Top, , The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual, elisp, The GNU
18718 Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}.
18719 @end ifinfo
18720
18721 The Emacs Lisp sources are an adventure. When you read the sources and
18722 come across a function or expression that is unfamiliar, you need to
18723 figure out or find out what it does.
18724
18725 Go to the Reference Manual. It is a thorough, complete, and fairly
18726 easy-to-read description of Emacs Lisp. It is written not only for
18727 experts, but for people who know what you know. (The @cite{Reference
18728 Manual} comes with the standard GNU Emacs distribution. Like this
18729 introduction, it comes as a Texinfo source file, so you can read it
18730 on-line and as a typeset, printed book.)
18731
18732 Go to the other on-line help that is part of GNU Emacs: the on-line
18733 documentation for all functions and variables, and @code{find-tag},
18734 the program that takes you to sources.
18735
18736 Here is an example of how I explore the sources. Because of its name,
18737 @file{simple.el} is the file I looked at first, a long time ago. As
18738 it happens some of the functions in @file{simple.el} are complicated,
18739 or at least look complicated at first sight. The @code{open-line}
18740 function, for example, looks complicated.
18741
18742 You may want to walk through this function slowly, as we did with the
18743 @code{forward-sentence} function. (@xref{forward-sentence, The
18744 @code{forward-sentence} function}.) Or you may want to skip that
18745 function and look at another, such as @code{split-line}. You don't
18746 need to read all the functions. According to
18747 @code{count-words-in-defun}, the @code{split-line} function contains
18748 102 words and symbols.
18749
18750 Even though it is short, @code{split-line} contains expressions
18751 we have not studied: @code{skip-chars-forward}, @code{indent-to},
18752 @code{current-column} and @code{insert-and-inherit}.
18753
18754 Consider the @code{skip-chars-forward} function. (It is part of the
18755 function definition for @code{back-to-indentation}, which is shown in
18756 @ref{Review, , Review}.)
18757
18758 In GNU Emacs, you can find out more about @code{skip-chars-forward} by
18759 typing @kbd{C-h f} (@code{describe-function}) and the name of the
18760 function. This gives you the function documentation.
18761
18762 You may be able to guess what is done by a well named function such as
18763 @code{indent-to}; or you can look it up, too. Incidentally, the
18764 @code{describe-function} function itself is in @file{help.el}; it is
18765 one of those long, but decipherable functions. You can look up
18766 @code{describe-function} using the @kbd{C-h f} command!
18767
18768 In this instance, since the code is Lisp, the @file{*Help*} buffer
18769 contains the name of the library containing the function's source.
18770 You can put point over the name of the library and press the RET key,
18771 which in this situation is bound to @code{help-follow}, and be taken
18772 directly to the source, in the same way as @kbd{M-.}
18773 (@code{find-tag}).
18774
18775 The definition for @code{describe-function} illustrates how to
18776 customize the @code{interactive} expression without using the standard
18777 character codes; and it shows how to create a temporary buffer.
18778
18779 (The @code{indent-to} function is written in C rather than Emacs Lisp;
18780 it is a `built-in' function. @code{help-follow} takes you to its
18781 source as does @code{find-tag}, when properly set up.)
18782
18783 You can look at a function's source using @code{find-tag}, which is
18784 bound to @kbd{M-.} Finally, you can find out what the Reference
18785 Manual has to say by visiting the manual in Info, and typing @kbd{i}
18786 (@code{Info-index}) and the name of the function, or by looking up the
18787 function in the index to a printed copy of the manual.
18788
18789 Similarly, you can find out what is meant by
18790 @code{insert-and-inherit}.
18791
18792 Other interesting source files include @file{paragraphs.el},
18793 @file{loaddefs.el}, and @file{loadup.el}. The @file{paragraphs.el}
18794 file includes short, easily understood functions as well as longer
18795 ones. The @file{loaddefs.el} file contains the many standard
18796 autoloads and many keymaps. I have never looked at it all; only at
18797 parts. @file{loadup.el} is the file that loads the standard parts of
18798 Emacs; it tells you a great deal about how Emacs is built.
18799 (@xref{Building Emacs, , Building Emacs, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
18800 Reference Manual}, for more about building.)
18801
18802 As I said, you have learned some nuts and bolts; however, and very
18803 importantly, we have hardly touched major aspects of programming; I
18804 have said nothing about how to sort information, except to use the
18805 predefined @code{sort} function; I have said nothing about how to store
18806 information, except to use variables and lists; I have said nothing
18807 about how to write programs that write programs. These are topics for
18808 another, and different kind of book, a different kind of learning.
18809
18810 What you have done is learn enough for much practical work with GNU
18811 Emacs. What you have done is get started. This is the end of a
18812 beginning.
18813
18814 @c ================ Appendix ================
18815
18816 @node the-the
18817 @appendix The @code{the-the} Function
18818 @findex the-the
18819 @cindex Duplicated words function
18820 @cindex Words, duplicated
18821
18822 Sometimes when you you write text, you duplicate words---as with ``you
18823 you'' near the beginning of this sentence. I find that most
18824 frequently, I duplicate ``the''; hence, I call the function for
18825 detecting duplicated words, @code{the-the}.
18826
18827 @need 1250
18828 As a first step, you could use the following regular expression to
18829 search for duplicates:
18830
18831 @smallexample
18832 \\(\\w+[ \t\n]+\\)\\1
18833 @end smallexample
18834
18835 @noindent
18836 This regexp matches one or more word-constituent characters followed
18837 by one or more spaces, tabs, or newlines. However, it does not detect
18838 duplicated words on different lines, since the ending of the first
18839 word, the end of the line, is different from the ending of the second
18840 word, a space. (For more information about regular expressions, see
18841 @ref{Regexp Search, , Regular Expression Searches}, as well as
18842 @ref{Regexps, , Syntax of Regular Expressions, emacs, The GNU Emacs
18843 Manual}, and @ref{Regular Expressions, , Regular Expressions, elisp,
18844 The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}.)
18845
18846 You might try searching just for duplicated word-constituent
18847 characters but that does not work since the pattern detects doubles
18848 such as the two occurrences of `th' in `with the'.
18849
18850 Another possible regexp searches for word-constituent characters
18851 followed by non-word-constituent characters, reduplicated. Here,
18852 @w{@samp{\\w+}} matches one or more word-constituent characters and
18853 @w{@samp{\\W*}} matches zero or more non-word-constituent characters.
18854
18855 @smallexample
18856 \\(\\(\\w+\\)\\W*\\)\\1
18857 @end smallexample
18858
18859 @noindent
18860 Again, not useful.
18861
18862 Here is the pattern that I use. It is not perfect, but good enough.
18863 @w{@samp{\\b}} matches the empty string, provided it is at the beginning
18864 or end of a word; @w{@samp{[^@@ \n\t]+}} matches one or more occurrences of
18865 any characters that are @emph{not} an @@-sign, space, newline, or tab.
18866
18867 @smallexample
18868 \\b\\([^@@ \n\t]+\\)[ \n\t]+\\1\\b
18869 @end smallexample
18870
18871 One can write more complicated expressions, but I found that this
18872 expression is good enough, so I use it.
18873
18874 Here is the @code{the-the} function, as I include it in my
18875 @file{.emacs} file, along with a handy global key binding:
18876
18877 @smallexample
18878 @group
18879 (defun the-the ()
18880 "Search forward for for a duplicated word."
18881 (interactive)
18882 (message "Searching for for duplicated words ...")
18883 (push-mark)
18884 @end group
18885 @group
18886 ;; This regexp is not perfect
18887 ;; but is fairly good over all:
18888 (if (re-search-forward
18889 "\\b\\([^@@ \n\t]+\\)[ \n\t]+\\1\\b" nil 'move)
18890 (message "Found duplicated word.")
18891 (message "End of buffer")))
18892 @end group
18893
18894 @group
18895 ;; Bind `the-the' to C-c \
18896 (global-set-key "\C-c\\" 'the-the)
18897 @end group
18898 @end smallexample
18899
18900 @sp 1
18901 Here is test text:
18902
18903 @smallexample
18904 @group
18905 one two two three four five
18906 five six seven
18907 @end group
18908 @end smallexample
18909
18910 You can substitute the other regular expressions shown above in the
18911 function definition and try each of them on this list.
18912
18913 @node Kill Ring
18914 @appendix Handling the Kill Ring
18915 @cindex Kill ring handling
18916 @cindex Handling the kill ring
18917 @cindex Ring, making a list like a
18918
18919 The kill ring is a list that is transformed into a ring by the
18920 workings of the @code{current-kill} function. The @code{yank} and
18921 @code{yank-pop} commands use the @code{current-kill} function.
18922
18923 This appendix describes the @code{current-kill} function as well as
18924 both the @code{yank} and the @code{yank-pop} commands, but first,
18925 consider the workings of the kill ring.
18926
18927 @menu
18928 * What the Kill Ring Does::
18929 * current-kill::
18930 * yank:: Paste a copy of a clipped element.
18931 * yank-pop:: Insert element pointed to.
18932 * ring file::
18933 @end menu
18934
18935 @ifnottex
18936 @node What the Kill Ring Does
18937 @unnumberedsec What the Kill Ring Does
18938 @end ifnottex
18939
18940 @need 1250
18941 The kill ring has a default maximum length of sixty items; this number
18942 is too large for an explanation. Instead, set it to four. Please
18943 evaluate the following:
18944
18945 @smallexample
18946 @group
18947 (setq old-kill-ring-max kill-ring-max)
18948 (setq kill-ring-max 4)
18949 @end group
18950 @end smallexample
18951
18952 @noindent
18953 Then, please copy each line of the following indented example into the
18954 kill ring. You may kill each line with @kbd{C-k} or mark it and copy
18955 it with @kbd{M-w}.
18956
18957 @noindent
18958 (In a read-only buffer, such as the @file{*info*} buffer, the kill
18959 command, @kbd{C-k} (@code{kill-line}), will not remove the text,
18960 merely copy it to the kill ring. However, your machine may beep at
18961 you. Alternatively, for silence, you may copy the region of each line
18962 with the @kbd{M-w} (@code{kill-ring-save}) command. You must mark
18963 each line for this command to succeed, but it does not matter at which
18964 end you put point or mark.)
18965
18966 @need 1250
18967 @noindent
18968 Please invoke the calls in order, so that five elements attempt to
18969 fill the kill ring:
18970
18971 @smallexample
18972 @group
18973 first some text
18974 second piece of text
18975 third line
18976 fourth line of text
18977 fifth bit of text
18978 @end group
18979 @end smallexample
18980
18981 @need 1250
18982 @noindent
18983 Then find the value of @code{kill-ring} by evaluating
18984
18985 @smallexample
18986 kill-ring
18987 @end smallexample
18988
18989 @need 800
18990 @noindent
18991 It is:
18992
18993 @smallexample
18994 @group
18995 ("fifth bit of text" "fourth line of text"
18996 "third line" "second piece of text")
18997 @end group
18998 @end smallexample
18999
19000 @noindent
19001 The first element, @samp{first some text}, was dropped.
19002
19003 @need 1250
19004 To return to the old value for the length of the kill ring, evaluate:
19005
19006 @smallexample
19007 (setq kill-ring-max old-kill-ring-max)
19008 @end smallexample
19009
19010 @node current-kill
19011 @appendixsec The @code{current-kill} Function
19012 @findex current-kill
19013
19014 The @code{current-kill} function changes the element in the kill ring
19015 to which @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} points. (Also, the
19016 @code{kill-new} function sets @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} to point
19017 to the latest element of the kill ring. The @code{kill-new}
19018 function is used directly or indirectly by @code{kill-append},
19019 @code{copy-region-as-kill}, @code{kill-ring-save}, @code{kill-line},
19020 and @code{kill-region}.)
19021
19022 @menu
19023 * Code for current-kill::
19024 * Understanding current-kill::
19025 @end menu
19026
19027 @ifnottex
19028 @node Code for current-kill
19029 @unnumberedsubsec The code for @code{current-kill}
19030 @end ifnottex
19031
19032
19033 @need 1500
19034 The @code{current-kill} function is used by @code{yank} and by
19035 @code{yank-pop}. Here is the code for @code{current-kill}:
19036
19037 @smallexample
19038 @group
19039 (defun current-kill (n &optional do-not-move)
19040 "Rotate the yanking point by N places, and then return that kill.
19041 If N is zero, `interprogram-paste-function' is set, and calling it
19042 returns a string, then that string is added to the front of the
19043 kill ring and returned as the latest kill.
19044 @end group
19045 @group
19046 If optional arg DO-NOT-MOVE is non-nil, then don't actually move the
19047 yanking point; just return the Nth kill forward."
19048 (let ((interprogram-paste (and (= n 0)
19049 interprogram-paste-function
19050 (funcall interprogram-paste-function))))
19051 @end group
19052 @group
19053 (if interprogram-paste
19054 (progn
19055 ;; Disable the interprogram cut function when we add the new
19056 ;; text to the kill ring, so Emacs doesn't try to own the
19057 ;; selection, with identical text.
19058 (let ((interprogram-cut-function nil))
19059 (kill-new interprogram-paste))
19060 interprogram-paste)
19061 @end group
19062 @group
19063 (or kill-ring (error "Kill ring is empty"))
19064 (let ((ARGth-kill-element
19065 (nthcdr (mod (- n (length kill-ring-yank-pointer))
19066 (length kill-ring))
19067 kill-ring)))
19068 (or do-not-move
19069 (setq kill-ring-yank-pointer ARGth-kill-element))
19070 (car ARGth-kill-element)))))
19071 @end group
19072 @end smallexample
19073
19074 Remember also that the @code{kill-new} function sets
19075 @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} to the latest element of the kill
19076 ring, which means that all the functions that call it set the value
19077 indirectly: @code{kill-append}, @code{copy-region-as-kill},
19078 @code{kill-ring-save}, @code{kill-line}, and @code{kill-region}.
19079
19080 @need 1500
19081 Here is the line in @code{kill-new}, which is explained in
19082 @ref{kill-new function, , The @code{kill-new} function}.
19083
19084 @smallexample
19085 (setq kill-ring-yank-pointer kill-ring)
19086 @end smallexample
19087
19088 @ifnottex
19089 @node Understanding current-kill
19090 @unnumberedsubsec @code{current-kill} in Outline
19091 @end ifnottex
19092
19093 The @code{current-kill} function looks complex, but as usual, it can
19094 be understood by taking it apart piece by piece. First look at it in
19095 skeletal form:
19096
19097 @smallexample
19098 @group
19099 (defun current-kill (n &optional do-not-move)
19100 "Rotate the yanking point by N places, and then return that kill."
19101 (let @var{varlist}
19102 @var{body}@dots{})
19103 @end group
19104 @end smallexample
19105
19106 This function takes two arguments, one of which is optional. It has a
19107 documentation string. It is @emph{not} interactive.
19108
19109 @menu
19110 * Body of current-kill::
19111 * Digression concerning error:: How to mislead humans, but not computers.
19112 * Determining the Element::
19113 @end menu
19114
19115 @ifnottex
19116 @node Body of current-kill
19117 @unnumberedsubsubsec The Body of @code{current-kill}
19118 @end ifnottex
19119
19120 The body of the function definition is a @code{let} expression, which
19121 itself has a body as well as a @var{varlist}.
19122
19123 The @code{let} expression declares a variable that will be only usable
19124 within the bounds of this function. This variable is called
19125 @code{interprogram-paste} and is for copying to another program. It
19126 is not for copying within this instance of GNU Emacs. Most window
19127 systems provide a facility for interprogram pasting. Sadly, that
19128 facility usually provides only for the last element. Most windowing
19129 systems have not adopted a ring of many possibilities, even though
19130 Emacs has provided it for decades.
19131
19132 The @code{if} expression has two parts, one if there exists
19133 @code{interprogram-paste} and one if not.
19134
19135 @need 2000
19136 Let us consider the `if not' or else-part of the @code{current-kill}
19137 function. (The then-part uses the @code{kill-new} function, which
19138 we have already described. @xref{kill-new function, , The
19139 @code{kill-new} function}.)
19140
19141 @smallexample
19142 @group
19143 (or kill-ring (error "Kill ring is empty"))
19144 (let ((ARGth-kill-element
19145 (nthcdr (mod (- n (length kill-ring-yank-pointer))
19146 (length kill-ring))
19147 kill-ring)))
19148 (or do-not-move
19149 (setq kill-ring-yank-pointer ARGth-kill-element))
19150 (car ARGth-kill-element))
19151 @end group
19152 @end smallexample
19153
19154 @noindent
19155 The code first checks whether the kill ring has content; otherwise it
19156 signals an error.
19157
19158 @need 1000
19159 Note that the @code{or} expression is very similar to testing length
19160 with an @code{if}:
19161
19162 @findex zerop
19163 @findex error
19164 @smallexample
19165 @group
19166 (if (zerop (length kill-ring)) ; @r{if-part}
19167 (error "Kill ring is empty")) ; @r{then-part}
19168 ;; No else-part
19169 @end group
19170 @end smallexample
19171
19172 @noindent
19173 If there is not anything in the kill ring, its length must be zero and
19174 an error message sent to the user: @samp{Kill ring is empty}. The
19175 @code{current-kill} function uses an @code{or} expression which is
19176 simpler. But an @code{if} expression reminds us what goes on.
19177
19178 This @code{if} expression uses the function @code{zerop} which returns
19179 true if the value it is testing is zero. When @code{zerop} tests
19180 true, the then-part of the @code{if} is evaluated. The then-part is a
19181 list starting with the function @code{error}, which is a function that
19182 is similar to the @code{message} function
19183 (@pxref{message, , The @code{message} Function}) in that
19184 it prints a one-line message in the echo area. However, in addition
19185 to printing a message, @code{error} also stops evaluation of the
19186 function within which it is embedded. This means that the rest of the
19187 function will not be evaluated if the length of the kill ring is zero.
19188
19189 Then the @code{current-kill} function selects the element to return.
19190 The selection depends on the number of places that @code{current-kill}
19191 rotates and on where @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} points.
19192
19193 Next, either the optional @code{do-not-move} argument is true or the
19194 current value of @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} is set to point to the
19195 list. Finally, another expression returns the first element of the
19196 list even if the @code{do-not-move} argument is true.
19197
19198 @ifnottex
19199 @node Digression concerning error
19200 @unnumberedsubsubsec Digression about the word `error'
19201 @end ifnottex
19202
19203 In my opinion, it is slightly misleading, at least to humans, to use
19204 the term `error' as the name of the @code{error} function. A better
19205 term would be `cancel'. Strictly speaking, of course, you cannot
19206 point to, much less rotate a pointer to a list that has no length, so
19207 from the point of view of the computer, the word `error' is correct.
19208 But a human expects to attempt this sort of thing, if only to find out
19209 whether the kill ring is full or empty. This is an act of
19210 exploration.
19211
19212 From the human point of view, the act of exploration and discovery is
19213 not necessarily an error, and therefore should not be labeled as one,
19214 even in the bowels of a computer. As it is, the code in Emacs implies
19215 that a human who is acting virtuously, by exploring his or her
19216 environment, is making an error. This is bad. Even though the computer
19217 takes the same steps as it does when there is an `error', a term such as
19218 `cancel' would have a clearer connotation.
19219
19220 @ifnottex
19221 @node Determining the Element
19222 @unnumberedsubsubsec Determining the Element
19223 @end ifnottex
19224
19225 Among other actions, the else-part of the @code{if} expression sets
19226 the value of @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} to
19227 @code{ARGth-kill-element} when the kill ring has something in it and
19228 the value of @code{do-not-move} is @code{nil}.
19229
19230 @need 800
19231 The code looks like this:
19232
19233 @smallexample
19234 @group
19235 (nthcdr (mod (- n (length kill-ring-yank-pointer))
19236 (length kill-ring))
19237 kill-ring)))
19238 @end group
19239 @end smallexample
19240
19241 This needs some examination. Unless it is not supposed to move the
19242 pointer, the @code{current-kill} function changes where
19243 @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} points.
19244 That is what the
19245 @w{@code{(setq kill-ring-yank-pointer ARGth-kill-element))}}
19246 expression does. Also, clearly, @code{ARGth-kill-element} is being
19247 set to be equal to some @sc{cdr} of the kill ring, using the
19248 @code{nthcdr} function that is described in an earlier section.
19249 (@xref{copy-region-as-kill}.) How does it do this?
19250
19251 As we have seen before (@pxref{nthcdr}), the @code{nthcdr} function
19252 works by repeatedly taking the @sc{cdr} of a list---it takes the
19253 @sc{cdr} of the @sc{cdr} of the @sc{cdr} @dots{}
19254
19255 @need 800
19256 The two following expressions produce the same result:
19257
19258 @smallexample
19259 @group
19260 (setq kill-ring-yank-pointer (cdr kill-ring))
19261
19262 (setq kill-ring-yank-pointer (nthcdr 1 kill-ring))
19263 @end group
19264 @end smallexample
19265
19266 However, the @code{nthcdr} expression is more complicated. It uses
19267 the @code{mod} function to determine which @sc{cdr} to select.
19268
19269 (You will remember to look at inner functions first; indeed, we will
19270 have to go inside the @code{mod}.)
19271
19272 The @code{mod} function returns the value of its first argument modulo
19273 the second; that is to say, it returns the remainder after dividing
19274 the first argument by the second. The value returned has the same
19275 sign as the second argument.
19276
19277 @need 800
19278 Thus,
19279
19280 @smallexample
19281 @group
19282 (mod 12 4)
19283 @result{} 0 ;; @r{because there is no remainder}
19284 (mod 13 4)
19285 @result{} 1
19286 @end group
19287 @end smallexample
19288
19289 @need 1250
19290 In this case, the first argument is often smaller than the second.
19291 That is fine.
19292
19293 @smallexample
19294 @group
19295 (mod 0 4)
19296 @result{} 0
19297 (mod 1 4)
19298 @result{} 1
19299 @end group
19300 @end smallexample
19301
19302 We can guess what the @code{-} function does. It is like @code{+} but
19303 subtracts instead of adds; the @code{-} function subtracts its second
19304 argument from its first. Also, we already know what the @code{length}
19305 function does (@pxref{length}). It returns the length of a list.
19306
19307 And @code{n} is the name of the required argument to the
19308 @code{current-kill} function.
19309
19310 @need 1250
19311 So when the first argument to @code{nthcdr} is zero, the @code{nthcdr}
19312 expression returns the whole list, as you can see by evaluating the
19313 following:
19314
19315 @smallexample
19316 @group
19317 ;; kill-ring-yank-pointer @r{and} kill-ring @r{have a length of four}
19318 ;; @r{and} (mod (- 0 4) 4) @result{} 0
19319 (nthcdr (mod (- 0 4) 4)
19320 '("fourth line of text"
19321 "third line"
19322 "second piece of text"
19323 "first some text"))
19324 @end group
19325 @end smallexample
19326
19327 @need 1250
19328 When the first argument to the @code{current-kill} function is one,
19329 the @code{nthcdr} expression returns the list without its first
19330 element.
19331
19332 @smallexample
19333 @group
19334 (nthcdr (mod (- 1 4) 4)
19335 '("fourth line of text"
19336 "third line"
19337 "second piece of text"
19338 "first some text"))
19339 @end group
19340 @end smallexample
19341
19342 @cindex @samp{global variable} defined
19343 @cindex @samp{variable, global}, defined
19344 Incidentally, both @code{kill-ring} and @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer}
19345 are @dfn{global variables}. That means that any expression in Emacs
19346 Lisp can access them. They are not like the local variables set by
19347 @code{let} or like the symbols in an argument list.
19348 Local variables can only be accessed
19349 within the @code{let} that defines them or the function that specifies
19350 them in an argument list (and within expressions called by them).
19351
19352 @ignore
19353 @c texi2dvi fails when the name of the section is within ifnottex ...
19354 (@xref{Prevent confusion, , @code{let} Prevents Confusion}, and
19355 @ref{defun, , The @code{defun} Macro}.)
19356 @end ignore
19357
19358 @node yank
19359 @appendixsec @code{yank}
19360 @findex yank
19361
19362 After learning about @code{current-kill}, the code for the
19363 @code{yank} function is almost easy.
19364
19365 The @code{yank} function does not use the
19366 @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} variable directly. It calls
19367 @code{insert-for-yank} which calls @code{current-kill} which sets the
19368 @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} variable.
19369
19370 @need 1250
19371 The code looks like this:
19372
19373 @c in GNU Emacs 22
19374 @smallexample
19375 @group
19376 (defun yank (&optional arg)
19377 "Reinsert (\"paste\") the last stretch of killed text.
19378 More precisely, reinsert the stretch of killed text most recently
19379 killed OR yanked. Put point at end, and set mark at beginning.
19380 With just \\[universal-argument] as argument, same but put point at
19381 beginning (and mark at end). With argument N, reinsert the Nth most
19382 recently killed stretch of killed text.
19383
19384 When this command inserts killed text into the buffer, it honors
19385 `yank-excluded-properties' and `yank-handler' as described in the
19386 doc string for `insert-for-yank-1', which see.
19387
19388 See also the command \\[yank-pop]."
19389 @end group
19390 @group
19391 (interactive "*P")
19392 (setq yank-window-start (window-start))
19393 ;; If we don't get all the way thru, make last-command indicate that
19394 ;; for the following command.
19395 (setq this-command t)
19396 (push-mark (point))
19397 @end group
19398 @group
19399 (insert-for-yank (current-kill (cond
19400 ((listp arg) 0)
19401 ((eq arg '-) -2)
19402 (t (1- arg)))))
19403 (if (consp arg)
19404 ;; This is like exchange-point-and-mark,
19405 ;; but doesn't activate the mark.
19406 ;; It is cleaner to avoid activation, even though the command
19407 ;; loop would deactivate the mark because we inserted text.
19408 (goto-char (prog1 (mark t)
19409 (set-marker (mark-marker) (point) (current-buffer)))))
19410 @end group
19411 @group
19412 ;; If we do get all the way thru, make this-command indicate that.
19413 (if (eq this-command t)
19414 (setq this-command 'yank))
19415 nil)
19416 @end group
19417 @end smallexample
19418
19419 The key expression is @code{insert-for-yank}, which inserts the string
19420 returned by @code{current-kill}, but removes some text properties from
19421 it.
19422
19423 However, before getting to that expression, the function sets the value
19424 of @code{yank-window-start} to the position returned by the
19425 @code{(window-start)} expression, the position at which the display
19426 currently starts. The @code{yank} function also sets
19427 @code{this-command} and pushes the mark.
19428
19429 After it yanks the appropriate element, if the optional argument is a
19430 @sc{cons} rather than a number or nothing, it puts point at beginning
19431 of the yanked text and mark at its end.
19432
19433 (The @code{prog1} function is like @code{progn} but returns the value
19434 of its first argument rather than the value of its last argument. Its
19435 first argument is forced to return the buffer's mark as an integer.
19436 You can see the documentation for these functions by placing point
19437 over them in this buffer and then typing @kbd{C-h f}
19438 (@code{describe-function}) followed by a @kbd{RET}; the default is the
19439 function.)
19440
19441 The last part of the function tells what to do when it succeeds.
19442
19443 @node yank-pop
19444 @appendixsec @code{yank-pop}
19445 @findex yank-pop
19446
19447 After understanding @code{yank} and @code{current-kill}, you know how
19448 to approach the @code{yank-pop} function. Leaving out the
19449 documentation to save space, it looks like this:
19450
19451 @c GNU Emacs 22
19452 @smallexample
19453 @group
19454 (defun yank-pop (&optional arg)
19455 "@dots{}"
19456 (interactive "*p")
19457 (if (not (eq last-command 'yank))
19458 (error "Previous command was not a yank"))
19459 @end group
19460 @group
19461 (setq this-command 'yank)
19462 (unless arg (setq arg 1))
19463 (let ((inhibit-read-only t)
19464 (before (< (point) (mark t))))
19465 @end group
19466 @group
19467 (if before
19468 (funcall (or yank-undo-function 'delete-region) (point) (mark t))
19469 (funcall (or yank-undo-function 'delete-region) (mark t) (point)))
19470 (setq yank-undo-function nil)
19471 @end group
19472 @group
19473 (set-marker (mark-marker) (point) (current-buffer))
19474 (insert-for-yank (current-kill arg))
19475 ;; Set the window start back where it was in the yank command,
19476 ;; if possible.
19477 (set-window-start (selected-window) yank-window-start t)
19478 @end group
19479 @group
19480 (if before
19481 ;; This is like exchange-point-and-mark,
19482 ;; but doesn't activate the mark.
19483 ;; It is cleaner to avoid activation, even though the command
19484 ;; loop would deactivate the mark because we inserted text.
19485 (goto-char (prog1 (mark t)
19486 (set-marker (mark-marker)
19487 (point)
19488 (current-buffer))))))
19489 nil)
19490 @end group
19491 @end smallexample
19492
19493 The function is interactive with a small @samp{p} so the prefix
19494 argument is processed and passed to the function. The command can
19495 only be used after a previous yank; otherwise an error message is
19496 sent. This check uses the variable @code{last-command} which is set
19497 by @code{yank} and is discussed elsewhere.
19498 (@xref{copy-region-as-kill}.)
19499
19500 The @code{let} clause sets the variable @code{before} to true or false
19501 depending whether point is before or after mark and then the region
19502 between point and mark is deleted. This is the region that was just
19503 inserted by the previous yank and it is this text that will be
19504 replaced.
19505
19506 @code{funcall} calls its first argument as a function, passing
19507 remaining arguments to it. The first argument is whatever the
19508 @code{or} expression returns. The two remaining arguments are the
19509 positions of point and mark set by the preceding @code{yank} command.
19510
19511 There is more, but that is the hardest part.
19512
19513 @node ring file
19514 @appendixsec The @file{ring.el} File
19515 @cindex @file{ring.el} file
19516
19517 Interestingly, GNU Emacs posses a file called @file{ring.el} that
19518 provides many of the features we just discussed. But functions such
19519 as @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} do not use this library, possibly
19520 because they were written earlier.
19521
19522 @node Full Graph
19523 @appendix A Graph with Labeled Axes
19524
19525 Printed axes help you understand a graph. They convey scale. In an
19526 earlier chapter (@pxref{Readying a Graph, , Readying a Graph}), we
19527 wrote the code to print the body of a graph. Here we write the code
19528 for printing and labeling vertical and horizontal axes, along with the
19529 body itself.
19530
19531 @menu
19532 * Labeled Example::
19533 * print-graph Varlist:: @code{let} expression in @code{print-graph}.
19534 * print-Y-axis:: Print a label for the vertical axis.
19535 * print-X-axis:: Print a horizontal label.
19536 * Print Whole Graph:: The function to print a complete graph.
19537 @end menu
19538
19539 @ifnottex
19540 @node Labeled Example
19541 @unnumberedsec Labeled Example Graph
19542 @end ifnottex
19543
19544 Since insertions fill a buffer to the right and below point, the new
19545 graph printing function should first print the Y or vertical axis,
19546 then the body of the graph, and finally the X or horizontal axis.
19547 This sequence lays out for us the contents of the function:
19548
19549 @enumerate
19550 @item
19551 Set up code.
19552
19553 @item
19554 Print Y axis.
19555
19556 @item
19557 Print body of graph.
19558
19559 @item
19560 Print X axis.
19561 @end enumerate
19562
19563 @need 800
19564 Here is an example of how a finished graph should look:
19565
19566 @smallexample
19567 @group
19568 10 -
19569 *
19570 * *
19571 * **
19572 * ***
19573 5 - * *******
19574 * *** *******
19575 *************
19576 ***************
19577 1 - ****************
19578 | | | |
19579 1 5 10 15
19580 @end group
19581 @end smallexample
19582
19583 @noindent
19584 In this graph, both the vertical and the horizontal axes are labeled
19585 with numbers. However, in some graphs, the horizontal axis is time
19586 and would be better labeled with months, like this:
19587
19588 @smallexample
19589 @group
19590 5 - *
19591 * ** *
19592 *******
19593 ********** **
19594 1 - **************
19595 | ^ |
19596 Jan June Jan
19597 @end group
19598 @end smallexample
19599
19600 Indeed, with a little thought, we can easily come up with a variety of
19601 vertical and horizontal labeling schemes. Our task could become
19602 complicated. But complications breed confusion. Rather than permit
19603 this, it is better choose a simple labeling scheme for our first
19604 effort, and to modify or replace it later.
19605
19606 @need 1200
19607 These considerations suggest the following outline for the
19608 @code{print-graph} function:
19609
19610 @smallexample
19611 @group
19612 (defun print-graph (numbers-list)
19613 "@var{documentation}@dots{}"
19614 (let ((height @dots{}
19615 @dots{}))
19616 @end group
19617 @group
19618 (print-Y-axis height @dots{} )
19619 (graph-body-print numbers-list)
19620 (print-X-axis @dots{} )))
19621 @end group
19622 @end smallexample
19623
19624 We can work on each part of the @code{print-graph} function definition
19625 in turn.
19626
19627 @node print-graph Varlist
19628 @appendixsec The @code{print-graph} Varlist
19629 @cindex @code{print-graph} varlist
19630
19631 In writing the @code{print-graph} function, the first task is to write
19632 the varlist in the @code{let} expression. (We will leave aside for the
19633 moment any thoughts about making the function interactive or about the
19634 contents of its documentation string.)
19635
19636 The varlist should set several values. Clearly, the top of the label
19637 for the vertical axis must be at least the height of the graph, which
19638 means that we must obtain this information here. Note that the
19639 @code{print-graph-body} function also requires this information. There
19640 is no reason to calculate the height of the graph in two different
19641 places, so we should change @code{print-graph-body} from the way we
19642 defined it earlier to take advantage of the calculation.
19643
19644 Similarly, both the function for printing the X axis labels and the
19645 @code{print-graph-body} function need to learn the value of the width of
19646 each symbol. We can perform the calculation here and change the
19647 definition for @code{print-graph-body} from the way we defined it in the
19648 previous chapter.
19649
19650 The length of the label for the horizontal axis must be at least as long
19651 as the graph. However, this information is used only in the function
19652 that prints the horizontal axis, so it does not need to be calculated here.
19653
19654 These thoughts lead us directly to the following form for the varlist
19655 in the @code{let} for @code{print-graph}:
19656
19657 @smallexample
19658 @group
19659 (let ((height (apply 'max numbers-list)) ; @r{First version.}
19660 (symbol-width (length graph-blank)))
19661 @end group
19662 @end smallexample
19663
19664 @noindent
19665 As we shall see, this expression is not quite right.
19666
19667 @need 2000
19668 @node print-Y-axis
19669 @appendixsec The @code{print-Y-axis} Function
19670 @cindex Axis, print vertical
19671 @cindex Y axis printing
19672 @cindex Vertical axis printing
19673 @cindex Print vertical axis
19674
19675 The job of the @code{print-Y-axis} function is to print a label for
19676 the vertical axis that looks like this:
19677
19678 @smallexample
19679 @group
19680 10 -
19681
19682
19683
19684
19685 5 -
19686
19687
19688
19689 1 -
19690 @end group
19691 @end smallexample
19692
19693 @noindent
19694 The function should be passed the height of the graph, and then should
19695 construct and insert the appropriate numbers and marks.
19696
19697 @menu
19698 * print-Y-axis in Detail::
19699 * Height of label:: What height for the Y axis?
19700 * Compute a Remainder:: How to compute the remainder of a division.
19701 * Y Axis Element:: Construct a line for the Y axis.
19702 * Y-axis-column:: Generate a list of Y axis labels.
19703 * print-Y-axis Penultimate:: A not quite final version.
19704 @end menu
19705
19706 @ifnottex
19707 @node print-Y-axis in Detail
19708 @unnumberedsubsec The @code{print-Y-axis} Function in Detail
19709 @end ifnottex
19710
19711 It is easy enough to see in the figure what the Y axis label should
19712 look like; but to say in words, and then to write a function
19713 definition to do the job is another matter. It is not quite true to
19714 say that we want a number and a tic every five lines: there are only
19715 three lines between the @samp{1} and the @samp{5} (lines 2, 3, and 4),
19716 but four lines between the @samp{5} and the @samp{10} (lines 6, 7, 8,
19717 and 9). It is better to say that we want a number and a tic mark on
19718 the base line (number 1) and then that we want a number and a tic on
19719 the fifth line from the bottom and on every line that is a multiple of
19720 five.
19721
19722 @ifnottex
19723 @node Height of label
19724 @unnumberedsubsec What height should the label be?
19725 @end ifnottex
19726
19727 The next issue is what height the label should be? Suppose the maximum
19728 height of tallest column of the graph is seven. Should the highest
19729 label on the Y axis be @samp{5 -}, and should the graph stick up above
19730 the label? Or should the highest label be @samp{7 -}, and mark the peak
19731 of the graph? Or should the highest label be @code{10 -}, which is a
19732 multiple of five, and be higher than the topmost value of the graph?
19733
19734 The latter form is preferred. Most graphs are drawn within rectangles
19735 whose sides are an integral number of steps long---5, 10, 15, and so
19736 on for a step distance of five. But as soon as we decide to use a
19737 step height for the vertical axis, we discover that the simple
19738 expression in the varlist for computing the height is wrong. The
19739 expression is @code{(apply 'max numbers-list)}. This returns the
19740 precise height, not the maximum height plus whatever is necessary to
19741 round up to the nearest multiple of five. A more complex expression
19742 is required.
19743
19744 As usual in cases like this, a complex problem becomes simpler if it is
19745 divided into several smaller problems.
19746
19747 First, consider the case when the highest value of the graph is an
19748 integral multiple of five---when it is 5, 10, 15, or some higher
19749 multiple of five. We can use this value as the Y axis height.
19750
19751 A fairly simply way to determine whether a number is a multiple of
19752 five is to divide it by five and see if the division results in a
19753 remainder. If there is no remainder, the number is a multiple of
19754 five. Thus, seven divided by five has a remainder of two, and seven
19755 is not an integral multiple of five. Put in slightly different
19756 language, more reminiscent of the classroom, five goes into seven
19757 once, with a remainder of two. However, five goes into ten twice,
19758 with no remainder: ten is an integral multiple of five.
19759
19760 @node Compute a Remainder
19761 @appendixsubsec Side Trip: Compute a Remainder
19762
19763 @findex % @r{(remainder function)}
19764 @cindex Remainder function, @code{%}
19765 In Lisp, the function for computing a remainder is @code{%}. The
19766 function returns the remainder of its first argument divided by its
19767 second argument. As it happens, @code{%} is a function in Emacs Lisp
19768 that you cannot discover using @code{apropos}: you find nothing if you
19769 type @kbd{M-x apropos @key{RET} remainder @key{RET}}. The only way to
19770 learn of the existence of @code{%} is to read about it in a book such
19771 as this or in the Emacs Lisp sources.
19772
19773 You can try the @code{%} function by evaluating the following two
19774 expressions:
19775
19776 @smallexample
19777 @group
19778 (% 7 5)
19779
19780 (% 10 5)
19781 @end group
19782 @end smallexample
19783
19784 @noindent
19785 The first expression returns 2 and the second expression returns 0.
19786
19787 To test whether the returned value is zero or some other number, we
19788 can use the @code{zerop} function. This function returns @code{t} if
19789 its argument, which must be a number, is zero.
19790
19791 @smallexample
19792 @group
19793 (zerop (% 7 5))
19794 @result{} nil
19795
19796 (zerop (% 10 5))
19797 @result{} t
19798 @end group
19799 @end smallexample
19800
19801 Thus, the following expression will return @code{t} if the height
19802 of the graph is evenly divisible by five:
19803
19804 @smallexample
19805 (zerop (% height 5))
19806 @end smallexample
19807
19808 @noindent
19809 (The value of @code{height}, of course, can be found from @code{(apply
19810 'max numbers-list)}.)
19811
19812 On the other hand, if the value of @code{height} is not a multiple of
19813 five, we want to reset the value to the next higher multiple of five.
19814 This is straightforward arithmetic using functions with which we are
19815 already familiar. First, we divide the value of @code{height} by five
19816 to determine how many times five goes into the number. Thus, five
19817 goes into twelve twice. If we add one to this quotient and multiply by
19818 five, we will obtain the value of the next multiple of five that is
19819 larger than the height. Five goes into twelve twice. Add one to two,
19820 and multiply by five; the result is fifteen, which is the next multiple
19821 of five that is higher than twelve. The Lisp expression for this is:
19822
19823 @smallexample
19824 (* (1+ (/ height 5)) 5)
19825 @end smallexample
19826
19827 @noindent
19828 For example, if you evaluate the following, the result is 15:
19829
19830 @smallexample
19831 (* (1+ (/ 12 5)) 5)
19832 @end smallexample
19833
19834 All through this discussion, we have been using `five' as the value
19835 for spacing labels on the Y axis; but we may want to use some other
19836 value. For generality, we should replace `five' with a variable to
19837 which we can assign a value. The best name I can think of for this
19838 variable is @code{Y-axis-label-spacing}.
19839
19840 @need 1250
19841 Using this term, and an @code{if} expression, we produce the
19842 following:
19843
19844 @smallexample
19845 @group
19846 (if (zerop (% height Y-axis-label-spacing))
19847 height
19848 ;; @r{else}
19849 (* (1+ (/ height Y-axis-label-spacing))
19850 Y-axis-label-spacing))
19851 @end group
19852 @end smallexample
19853
19854 @noindent
19855 This expression returns the value of @code{height} itself if the height
19856 is an even multiple of the value of the @code{Y-axis-label-spacing} or
19857 else it computes and returns a value of @code{height} that is equal to
19858 the next higher multiple of the value of the @code{Y-axis-label-spacing}.
19859
19860 We can now include this expression in the @code{let} expression of the
19861 @code{print-graph} function (after first setting the value of
19862 @code{Y-axis-label-spacing}):
19863 @vindex Y-axis-label-spacing
19864
19865 @smallexample
19866 @group
19867 (defvar Y-axis-label-spacing 5
19868 "Number of lines from one Y axis label to next.")
19869 @end group
19870
19871 @group
19872 @dots{}
19873 (let* ((height (apply 'max numbers-list))
19874 (height-of-top-line
19875 (if (zerop (% height Y-axis-label-spacing))
19876 height
19877 @end group
19878 @group
19879 ;; @r{else}
19880 (* (1+ (/ height Y-axis-label-spacing))
19881 Y-axis-label-spacing)))
19882 (symbol-width (length graph-blank))))
19883 @dots{}
19884 @end group
19885 @end smallexample
19886
19887 @noindent
19888 (Note use of the @code{let*} function: the initial value of height is
19889 computed once by the @code{(apply 'max numbers-list)} expression and
19890 then the resulting value of @code{height} is used to compute its
19891 final value. @xref{fwd-para let, , The @code{let*} expression}, for
19892 more about @code{let*}.)
19893
19894 @node Y Axis Element
19895 @appendixsubsec Construct a Y Axis Element
19896
19897 When we print the vertical axis, we want to insert strings such as
19898 @w{@samp{5 -}} and @w{@samp{10 - }} every five lines.
19899 Moreover, we want the numbers and dashes to line up, so shorter
19900 numbers must be padded with leading spaces. If some of the strings
19901 use two digit numbers, the strings with single digit numbers must
19902 include a leading blank space before the number.
19903
19904 @findex number-to-string
19905 To figure out the length of the number, the @code{length} function is
19906 used. But the @code{length} function works only with a string, not with
19907 a number. So the number has to be converted from being a number to
19908 being a string. This is done with the @code{number-to-string} function.
19909 For example,
19910
19911 @smallexample
19912 @group
19913 (length (number-to-string 35))
19914 @result{} 2
19915
19916 (length (number-to-string 100))
19917 @result{} 3
19918 @end group
19919 @end smallexample
19920
19921 @noindent
19922 (@code{number-to-string} is also called @code{int-to-string}; you will
19923 see this alternative name in various sources.)
19924
19925 In addition, in each label, each number is followed by a string such
19926 as @w{@samp{ - }}, which we will call the @code{Y-axis-tic} marker.
19927 This variable is defined with @code{defvar}:
19928
19929 @vindex Y-axis-tic
19930 @smallexample
19931 @group
19932 (defvar Y-axis-tic " - "
19933 "String that follows number in a Y axis label.")
19934 @end group
19935 @end smallexample
19936
19937 The length of the Y label is the sum of the length of the Y axis tic
19938 mark and the length of the number of the top of the graph.
19939
19940 @smallexample
19941 (length (concat (number-to-string height) Y-axis-tic)))
19942 @end smallexample
19943
19944 This value will be calculated by the @code{print-graph} function in
19945 its varlist as @code{full-Y-label-width} and passed on. (Note that we
19946 did not think to include this in the varlist when we first proposed it.)
19947
19948 To make a complete vertical axis label, a tic mark is concatenated
19949 with a number; and the two together may be preceded by one or more
19950 spaces depending on how long the number is. The label consists of
19951 three parts: the (optional) leading spaces, the number, and the tic
19952 mark. The function is passed the value of the number for the specific
19953 row, and the value of the width of the top line, which is calculated
19954 (just once) by @code{print-graph}.
19955
19956 @smallexample
19957 @group
19958 (defun Y-axis-element (number full-Y-label-width)
19959 "Construct a NUMBERed label element.
19960 A numbered element looks like this ` 5 - ',
19961 and is padded as needed so all line up with
19962 the element for the largest number."
19963 @end group
19964 @group
19965 (let* ((leading-spaces
19966 (- full-Y-label-width
19967 (length
19968 (concat (number-to-string number)
19969 Y-axis-tic)))))
19970 @end group
19971 @group
19972 (concat
19973 (make-string leading-spaces ? )
19974 (number-to-string number)
19975 Y-axis-tic)))
19976 @end group
19977 @end smallexample
19978
19979 The @code{Y-axis-element} function concatenates together the leading
19980 spaces, if any; the number, as a string; and the tic mark.
19981
19982 To figure out how many leading spaces the label will need, the
19983 function subtracts the actual length of the label---the length of the
19984 number plus the length of the tic mark---from the desired label width.
19985
19986 @findex make-string
19987 Blank spaces are inserted using the @code{make-string} function. This
19988 function takes two arguments: the first tells it how long the string
19989 will be and the second is a symbol for the character to insert, in a
19990 special format. The format is a question mark followed by a blank
19991 space, like this, @samp{? }. @xref{Character Type, , Character Type,
19992 elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}, for a description of the
19993 syntax for characters. (Of course, you might want to replace the
19994 blank space by some other character @dots{} You know what to do.)
19995
19996 The @code{number-to-string} function is used in the concatenation
19997 expression, to convert the number to a string that is concatenated
19998 with the leading spaces and the tic mark.
19999
20000 @node Y-axis-column
20001 @appendixsubsec Create a Y Axis Column
20002
20003 The preceding functions provide all the tools needed to construct a
20004 function that generates a list of numbered and blank strings to insert
20005 as the label for the vertical axis:
20006
20007 @findex Y-axis-column
20008 @smallexample
20009 @group
20010 (defun Y-axis-column (height width-of-label)
20011 "Construct list of Y axis labels and blank strings.
20012 For HEIGHT of line above base and WIDTH-OF-LABEL."
20013 (let (Y-axis)
20014 @group
20015 @end group
20016 (while (> height 1)
20017 (if (zerop (% height Y-axis-label-spacing))
20018 ;; @r{Insert label.}
20019 (setq Y-axis
20020 (cons
20021 (Y-axis-element height width-of-label)
20022 Y-axis))
20023 @group
20024 @end group
20025 ;; @r{Else, insert blanks.}
20026 (setq Y-axis
20027 (cons
20028 (make-string width-of-label ? )
20029 Y-axis)))
20030 (setq height (1- height)))
20031 ;; @r{Insert base line.}
20032 (setq Y-axis
20033 (cons (Y-axis-element 1 width-of-label) Y-axis))
20034 (nreverse Y-axis)))
20035 @end group
20036 @end smallexample
20037
20038 In this function, we start with the value of @code{height} and
20039 repetitively subtract one from its value. After each subtraction, we
20040 test to see whether the value is an integral multiple of the
20041 @code{Y-axis-label-spacing}. If it is, we construct a numbered label
20042 using the @code{Y-axis-element} function; if not, we construct a
20043 blank label using the @code{make-string} function. The base line
20044 consists of the number one followed by a tic mark.
20045
20046 @need 2000
20047 @node print-Y-axis Penultimate
20048 @appendixsubsec The Not Quite Final Version of @code{print-Y-axis}
20049
20050 The list constructed by the @code{Y-axis-column} function is passed to
20051 the @code{print-Y-axis} function, which inserts the list as a column.
20052
20053 @findex print-Y-axis
20054 @smallexample
20055 @group
20056 (defun print-Y-axis (height full-Y-label-width)
20057 "Insert Y axis using HEIGHT and FULL-Y-LABEL-WIDTH.
20058 Height must be the maximum height of the graph.
20059 Full width is the width of the highest label element."
20060 ;; Value of height and full-Y-label-width
20061 ;; are passed by `print-graph'.
20062 @end group
20063 @group
20064 (let ((start (point)))
20065 (insert-rectangle
20066 (Y-axis-column height full-Y-label-width))
20067 ;; @r{Place point ready for inserting graph.}
20068 (goto-char start)
20069 ;; @r{Move point forward by value of} full-Y-label-width
20070 (forward-char full-Y-label-width)))
20071 @end group
20072 @end smallexample
20073
20074 The @code{print-Y-axis} uses the @code{insert-rectangle} function to
20075 insert the Y axis labels created by the @code{Y-axis-column} function.
20076 In addition, it places point at the correct position for printing the body of
20077 the graph.
20078
20079 You can test @code{print-Y-axis}:
20080
20081 @enumerate
20082 @item
20083 Install
20084
20085 @smallexample
20086 @group
20087 Y-axis-label-spacing
20088 Y-axis-tic
20089 Y-axis-element
20090 Y-axis-column
20091 print-Y-axis
20092 @end group
20093 @end smallexample
20094
20095 @item
20096 Copy the following expression:
20097
20098 @smallexample
20099 (print-Y-axis 12 5)
20100 @end smallexample
20101
20102 @item
20103 Switch to the @file{*scratch*} buffer and place the cursor where you
20104 want the axis labels to start.
20105
20106 @item
20107 Type @kbd{M-:} (@code{eval-expression}).
20108
20109 @item
20110 Yank the @code{graph-body-print} expression into the minibuffer
20111 with @kbd{C-y} (@code{yank)}.
20112
20113 @item
20114 Press @key{RET} to evaluate the expression.
20115 @end enumerate
20116
20117 Emacs will print labels vertically, the top one being @w{@samp{10 -@w{
20118 }}}. (The @code{print-graph} function will pass the value of
20119 @code{height-of-top-line}, which in this case will end up as 15,
20120 thereby getting rid of what might appear as a bug.)
20121
20122 @need 2000
20123 @node print-X-axis
20124 @appendixsec The @code{print-X-axis} Function
20125 @cindex Axis, print horizontal
20126 @cindex X axis printing
20127 @cindex Print horizontal axis
20128 @cindex Horizontal axis printing
20129
20130 X axis labels are much like Y axis labels, except that the ticks are on a
20131 line above the numbers. Labels should look like this:
20132
20133 @smallexample
20134 @group
20135 | | | |
20136 1 5 10 15
20137 @end group
20138 @end smallexample
20139
20140 The first tic is under the first column of the graph and is preceded by
20141 several blank spaces. These spaces provide room in rows above for the Y
20142 axis labels. The second, third, fourth, and subsequent ticks are all
20143 spaced equally, according to the value of @code{X-axis-label-spacing}.
20144
20145 The second row of the X axis consists of numbers, preceded by several
20146 blank spaces and also separated according to the value of the variable
20147 @code{X-axis-label-spacing}.
20148
20149 The value of the variable @code{X-axis-label-spacing} should itself be
20150 measured in units of @code{symbol-width}, since you may want to change
20151 the width of the symbols that you are using to print the body of the
20152 graph without changing the ways the graph is labeled.
20153
20154 @menu
20155 * Similarities differences:: Much like @code{print-Y-axis}, but not exactly.
20156 * X Axis Tic Marks:: Create tic marks for the horizontal axis.
20157 @end menu
20158
20159 @ifnottex
20160 @node Similarities differences
20161 @unnumberedsubsec Similarities and differences
20162 @end ifnottex
20163
20164 The @code{print-X-axis} function is constructed in more or less the
20165 same fashion as the @code{print-Y-axis} function except that it has
20166 two lines: the line of tic marks and the numbers. We will write a
20167 separate function to print each line and then combine them within the
20168 @code{print-X-axis} function.
20169
20170 This is a three step process:
20171
20172 @enumerate
20173 @item
20174 Write a function to print the X axis tic marks, @code{print-X-axis-tic-line}.
20175
20176 @item
20177 Write a function to print the X numbers, @code{print-X-axis-numbered-line}.
20178
20179 @item
20180 Write a function to print both lines, the @code{print-X-axis} function,
20181 using @code{print-X-axis-tic-line} and
20182 @code{print-X-axis-numbered-line}.
20183 @end enumerate
20184
20185 @node X Axis Tic Marks
20186 @appendixsubsec X Axis Tic Marks
20187
20188 The first function should print the X axis tic marks. We must specify
20189 the tic marks themselves and their spacing:
20190
20191 @smallexample
20192 @group
20193 (defvar X-axis-label-spacing
20194 (if (boundp 'graph-blank)
20195 (* 5 (length graph-blank)) 5)
20196 "Number of units from one X axis label to next.")
20197 @end group
20198 @end smallexample
20199
20200 @noindent
20201 (Note that the value of @code{graph-blank} is set by another
20202 @code{defvar}. The @code{boundp} predicate checks whether it has
20203 already been set; @code{boundp} returns @code{nil} if it has not. If
20204 @code{graph-blank} were unbound and we did not use this conditional
20205 construction, in a recent GNU Emacs, we would enter the debugger and
20206 see an error message saying @samp{@w{Debugger entered--Lisp error:}
20207 @w{(void-variable graph-blank)}}.)
20208
20209 @need 1200
20210 Here is the @code{defvar} for @code{X-axis-tic-symbol}:
20211
20212 @smallexample
20213 @group
20214 (defvar X-axis-tic-symbol "|"
20215 "String to insert to point to a column in X axis.")
20216 @end group
20217 @end smallexample
20218
20219 @need 1250
20220 The goal is to make a line that looks like this:
20221
20222 @smallexample
20223 | | | |
20224 @end smallexample
20225
20226 The first tic is indented so that it is under the first column, which is
20227 indented to provide space for the Y axis labels.
20228
20229 A tic element consists of the blank spaces that stretch from one tic to
20230 the next plus a tic symbol. The number of blanks is determined by the
20231 width of the tic symbol and the @code{X-axis-label-spacing}.
20232
20233 @need 1250
20234 The code looks like this:
20235
20236 @smallexample
20237 @group
20238 ;;; X-axis-tic-element
20239 @dots{}
20240 (concat
20241 (make-string
20242 ;; @r{Make a string of blanks.}
20243 (- (* symbol-width X-axis-label-spacing)
20244 (length X-axis-tic-symbol))
20245 ? )
20246 ;; @r{Concatenate blanks with tic symbol.}
20247 X-axis-tic-symbol)
20248 @dots{}
20249 @end group
20250 @end smallexample
20251
20252 Next, we determine how many blanks are needed to indent the first tic
20253 mark to the first column of the graph. This uses the value of
20254 @code{full-Y-label-width} passed it by the @code{print-graph} function.
20255
20256 @need 1250
20257 The code to make @code{X-axis-leading-spaces}
20258 looks like this:
20259
20260 @smallexample
20261 @group
20262 ;; X-axis-leading-spaces
20263 @dots{}
20264 (make-string full-Y-label-width ? )
20265 @dots{}
20266 @end group
20267 @end smallexample
20268
20269 We also need to determine the length of the horizontal axis, which is
20270 the length of the numbers list, and the number of ticks in the horizontal
20271 axis:
20272
20273 @smallexample
20274 @group
20275 ;; X-length
20276 @dots{}
20277 (length numbers-list)
20278 @end group
20279
20280 @group
20281 ;; tic-width
20282 @dots{}
20283 (* symbol-width X-axis-label-spacing)
20284 @end group
20285
20286 @group
20287 ;; number-of-X-ticks
20288 (if (zerop (% (X-length tic-width)))
20289 (/ (X-length tic-width))
20290 (1+ (/ (X-length tic-width))))
20291 @end group
20292 @end smallexample
20293
20294 @need 1250
20295 All this leads us directly to the function for printing the X axis tic line:
20296
20297 @findex print-X-axis-tic-line
20298 @smallexample
20299 @group
20300 (defun print-X-axis-tic-line
20301 (number-of-X-tics X-axis-leading-spaces X-axis-tic-element)
20302 "Print ticks for X axis."
20303 (insert X-axis-leading-spaces)
20304 (insert X-axis-tic-symbol) ; @r{Under first column.}
20305 @end group
20306 @group
20307 ;; @r{Insert second tic in the right spot.}
20308 (insert (concat
20309 (make-string
20310 (- (* symbol-width X-axis-label-spacing)
20311 ;; @r{Insert white space up to second tic symbol.}
20312 (* 2 (length X-axis-tic-symbol)))
20313 ? )
20314 X-axis-tic-symbol))
20315 @end group
20316 @group
20317 ;; @r{Insert remaining ticks.}
20318 (while (> number-of-X-tics 1)
20319 (insert X-axis-tic-element)
20320 (setq number-of-X-tics (1- number-of-X-tics))))
20321 @end group
20322 @end smallexample
20323
20324 The line of numbers is equally straightforward:
20325
20326 @need 1250
20327 First, we create a numbered element with blank spaces before each number:
20328
20329 @findex X-axis-element
20330 @smallexample
20331 @group
20332 (defun X-axis-element (number)
20333 "Construct a numbered X axis element."
20334 (let ((leading-spaces
20335 (- (* symbol-width X-axis-label-spacing)
20336 (length (number-to-string number)))))
20337 (concat (make-string leading-spaces ? )
20338 (number-to-string number))))
20339 @end group
20340 @end smallexample
20341
20342 Next, we create the function to print the numbered line, starting with
20343 the number ``1'' under the first column:
20344
20345 @findex print-X-axis-numbered-line
20346 @smallexample
20347 @group
20348 (defun print-X-axis-numbered-line
20349 (number-of-X-tics X-axis-leading-spaces)
20350 "Print line of X-axis numbers"
20351 (let ((number X-axis-label-spacing))
20352 (insert X-axis-leading-spaces)
20353 (insert "1")
20354 @end group
20355 @group
20356 (insert (concat
20357 (make-string
20358 ;; @r{Insert white space up to next number.}
20359 (- (* symbol-width X-axis-label-spacing) 2)
20360 ? )
20361 (number-to-string number)))
20362 @end group
20363 @group
20364 ;; @r{Insert remaining numbers.}
20365 (setq number (+ number X-axis-label-spacing))
20366 (while (> number-of-X-tics 1)
20367 (insert (X-axis-element number))
20368 (setq number (+ number X-axis-label-spacing))
20369 (setq number-of-X-tics (1- number-of-X-tics)))))
20370 @end group
20371 @end smallexample
20372
20373 Finally, we need to write the @code{print-X-axis} that uses
20374 @code{print-X-axis-tic-line} and
20375 @code{print-X-axis-numbered-line}.
20376
20377 The function must determine the local values of the variables used by both
20378 @code{print-X-axis-tic-line} and @code{print-X-axis-numbered-line}, and
20379 then it must call them. Also, it must print the carriage return that
20380 separates the two lines.
20381
20382 The function consists of a varlist that specifies five local variables,
20383 and calls to each of the two line printing functions:
20384
20385 @findex print-X-axis
20386 @smallexample
20387 @group
20388 (defun print-X-axis (numbers-list)
20389 "Print X axis labels to length of NUMBERS-LIST."
20390 (let* ((leading-spaces
20391 (make-string full-Y-label-width ? ))
20392 @end group
20393 @group
20394 ;; symbol-width @r{is provided by} graph-body-print
20395 (tic-width (* symbol-width X-axis-label-spacing))
20396 (X-length (length numbers-list))
20397 @end group
20398 @group
20399 (X-tic
20400 (concat
20401 (make-string
20402 @end group
20403 @group
20404 ;; @r{Make a string of blanks.}
20405 (- (* symbol-width X-axis-label-spacing)
20406 (length X-axis-tic-symbol))
20407 ? )
20408 @end group
20409 @group
20410 ;; @r{Concatenate blanks with tic symbol.}
20411 X-axis-tic-symbol))
20412 @end group
20413 @group
20414 (tic-number
20415 (if (zerop (% X-length tic-width))
20416 (/ X-length tic-width)
20417 (1+ (/ X-length tic-width)))))
20418 @end group
20419 @group
20420 (print-X-axis-tic-line tic-number leading-spaces X-tic)
20421 (insert "\n")
20422 (print-X-axis-numbered-line tic-number leading-spaces)))
20423 @end group
20424 @end smallexample
20425
20426 @need 1250
20427 You can test @code{print-X-axis}:
20428
20429 @enumerate
20430 @item
20431 Install @code{X-axis-tic-symbol}, @code{X-axis-label-spacing},
20432 @code{print-X-axis-tic-line}, as well as @code{X-axis-element},
20433 @code{print-X-axis-numbered-line}, and @code{print-X-axis}.
20434
20435 @item
20436 Copy the following expression:
20437
20438 @smallexample
20439 @group
20440 (progn
20441 (let ((full-Y-label-width 5)
20442 (symbol-width 1))
20443 (print-X-axis
20444 '(1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16))))
20445 @end group
20446 @end smallexample
20447
20448 @item
20449 Switch to the @file{*scratch*} buffer and place the cursor where you
20450 want the axis labels to start.
20451
20452 @item
20453 Type @kbd{M-:} (@code{eval-expression}).
20454
20455 @item
20456 Yank the test expression into the minibuffer
20457 with @kbd{C-y} (@code{yank)}.
20458
20459 @item
20460 Press @key{RET} to evaluate the expression.
20461 @end enumerate
20462
20463 @need 1250
20464 Emacs will print the horizontal axis like this:
20465 @sp 1
20466
20467 @smallexample
20468 @group
20469 | | | | |
20470 1 5 10 15 20
20471 @end group
20472 @end smallexample
20473
20474 @node Print Whole Graph
20475 @appendixsec Printing the Whole Graph
20476 @cindex Printing the whole graph
20477 @cindex Whole graph printing
20478 @cindex Graph, printing all
20479
20480 Now we are nearly ready to print the whole graph.
20481
20482 The function to print the graph with the proper labels follows the
20483 outline we created earlier (@pxref{Full Graph, , A Graph with Labeled
20484 Axes}), but with additions.
20485
20486 @need 1250
20487 Here is the outline:
20488
20489 @smallexample
20490 @group
20491 (defun print-graph (numbers-list)
20492 "@var{documentation}@dots{}"
20493 (let ((height @dots{}
20494 @dots{}))
20495 @end group
20496 @group
20497 (print-Y-axis height @dots{} )
20498 (graph-body-print numbers-list)
20499 (print-X-axis @dots{} )))
20500 @end group
20501 @end smallexample
20502
20503 @menu
20504 * The final version:: A few changes.
20505 * Test print-graph:: Run a short test.
20506 * Graphing words in defuns:: Executing the final code.
20507 * lambda:: How to write an anonymous function.
20508 * mapcar:: Apply a function to elements of a list.
20509 * Another Bug:: Yet another bug @dots{} most insidious.
20510 * Final printed graph:: The graph itself!
20511 @end menu
20512
20513 @ifnottex
20514 @node The final version
20515 @unnumberedsubsec Changes for the Final Version
20516 @end ifnottex
20517
20518 The final version is different from what we planned in two ways:
20519 first, it contains additional values calculated once in the varlist;
20520 second, it carries an option to specify the labels' increment per row.
20521 This latter feature turns out to be essential; otherwise, a graph may
20522 have more rows than fit on a display or on a sheet of paper.
20523
20524 @need 1500
20525 This new feature requires a change to the @code{Y-axis-column}
20526 function, to add @code{vertical-step} to it. The function looks like
20527 this:
20528
20529 @findex Y-axis-column @r{Final version.}
20530 @smallexample
20531 @group
20532 ;;; @r{Final version.}
20533 (defun Y-axis-column
20534 (height width-of-label &optional vertical-step)
20535 "Construct list of labels for Y axis.
20536 HEIGHT is maximum height of graph.
20537 WIDTH-OF-LABEL is maximum width of label.
20538 VERTICAL-STEP, an option, is a positive integer
20539 that specifies how much a Y axis label increments
20540 for each line. For example, a step of 5 means
20541 that each line is five units of the graph."
20542 @end group
20543 @group
20544 (let (Y-axis
20545 (number-per-line (or vertical-step 1)))
20546 (while (> height 1)
20547 (if (zerop (% height Y-axis-label-spacing))
20548 @end group
20549 @group
20550 ;; @r{Insert label.}
20551 (setq Y-axis
20552 (cons
20553 (Y-axis-element
20554 (* height number-per-line)
20555 width-of-label)
20556 Y-axis))
20557 @end group
20558 @group
20559 ;; @r{Else, insert blanks.}
20560 (setq Y-axis
20561 (cons
20562 (make-string width-of-label ? )
20563 Y-axis)))
20564 (setq height (1- height)))
20565 @end group
20566 @group
20567 ;; @r{Insert base line.}
20568 (setq Y-axis (cons (Y-axis-element
20569 (or vertical-step 1)
20570 width-of-label)
20571 Y-axis))
20572 (nreverse Y-axis)))
20573 @end group
20574 @end smallexample
20575
20576 The values for the maximum height of graph and the width of a symbol
20577 are computed by @code{print-graph} in its @code{let} expression; so
20578 @code{graph-body-print} must be changed to accept them.
20579
20580 @findex graph-body-print @r{Final version.}
20581 @smallexample
20582 @group
20583 ;;; @r{Final version.}
20584 (defun graph-body-print (numbers-list height symbol-width)
20585 "Print a bar graph of the NUMBERS-LIST.
20586 The numbers-list consists of the Y-axis values.
20587 HEIGHT is maximum height of graph.
20588 SYMBOL-WIDTH is number of each column."
20589 @end group
20590 @group
20591 (let (from-position)
20592 (while numbers-list
20593 (setq from-position (point))
20594 (insert-rectangle
20595 (column-of-graph height (car numbers-list)))
20596 (goto-char from-position)
20597 (forward-char symbol-width)
20598 @end group
20599 @group
20600 ;; @r{Draw graph column by column.}
20601 (sit-for 0)
20602 (setq numbers-list (cdr numbers-list)))
20603 ;; @r{Place point for X axis labels.}
20604 (forward-line height)
20605 (insert "\n")))
20606 @end group
20607 @end smallexample
20608
20609 @need 1250
20610 Finally, the code for the @code{print-graph} function:
20611
20612 @findex print-graph @r{Final version.}
20613 @smallexample
20614 @group
20615 ;;; @r{Final version.}
20616 (defun print-graph
20617 (numbers-list &optional vertical-step)
20618 "Print labeled bar graph of the NUMBERS-LIST.
20619 The numbers-list consists of the Y-axis values.
20620 @end group
20621
20622 @group
20623 Optionally, VERTICAL-STEP, a positive integer,
20624 specifies how much a Y axis label increments for
20625 each line. For example, a step of 5 means that
20626 each row is five units."
20627 @end group
20628 @group
20629 (let* ((symbol-width (length graph-blank))
20630 ;; @code{height} @r{is both the largest number}
20631 ;; @r{and the number with the most digits.}
20632 (height (apply 'max numbers-list))
20633 @end group
20634 @group
20635 (height-of-top-line
20636 (if (zerop (% height Y-axis-label-spacing))
20637 height
20638 ;; @r{else}
20639 (* (1+ (/ height Y-axis-label-spacing))
20640 Y-axis-label-spacing)))
20641 @end group
20642 @group
20643 (vertical-step (or vertical-step 1))
20644 (full-Y-label-width
20645 (length
20646 @end group
20647 @group
20648 (concat
20649 (number-to-string
20650 (* height-of-top-line vertical-step))
20651 Y-axis-tic))))
20652 @end group
20653
20654 @group
20655 (print-Y-axis
20656 height-of-top-line full-Y-label-width vertical-step)
20657 @end group
20658 @group
20659 (graph-body-print
20660 numbers-list height-of-top-line symbol-width)
20661 (print-X-axis numbers-list)))
20662 @end group
20663 @end smallexample
20664
20665 @node Test print-graph
20666 @appendixsubsec Testing @code{print-graph}
20667
20668 @need 1250
20669 We can test the @code{print-graph} function with a short list of numbers:
20670
20671 @enumerate
20672 @item
20673 Install the final versions of @code{Y-axis-column},
20674 @code{graph-body-print}, and @code{print-graph} (in addition to the
20675 rest of the code.)
20676
20677 @item
20678 Copy the following expression:
20679
20680 @smallexample
20681 (print-graph '(3 2 5 6 7 5 3 4 6 4 3 2 1))
20682 @end smallexample
20683
20684 @item
20685 Switch to the @file{*scratch*} buffer and place the cursor where you
20686 want the axis labels to start.
20687
20688 @item
20689 Type @kbd{M-:} (@code{eval-expression}).
20690
20691 @item
20692 Yank the test expression into the minibuffer
20693 with @kbd{C-y} (@code{yank)}.
20694
20695 @item
20696 Press @key{RET} to evaluate the expression.
20697 @end enumerate
20698
20699 @need 1250
20700 Emacs will print a graph that looks like this:
20701
20702 @smallexample
20703 @group
20704 10 -
20705
20706
20707 *
20708 ** *
20709 5 - **** *
20710 **** ***
20711 * *********
20712 ************
20713 1 - *************
20714
20715 | | | |
20716 1 5 10 15
20717 @end group
20718 @end smallexample
20719
20720 @need 1200
20721 On the other hand, if you pass @code{print-graph} a
20722 @code{vertical-step} value of 2, by evaluating this expression:
20723
20724 @smallexample
20725 (print-graph '(3 2 5 6 7 5 3 4 6 4 3 2 1) 2)
20726 @end smallexample
20727
20728 @need 1250
20729 @noindent
20730 The graph looks like this:
20731
20732 @smallexample
20733 @group
20734 20 -
20735
20736
20737 *
20738 ** *
20739 10 - **** *
20740 **** ***
20741 * *********
20742 ************
20743 2 - *************
20744
20745 | | | |
20746 1 5 10 15
20747 @end group
20748 @end smallexample
20749
20750 @noindent
20751 (A question: is the `2' on the bottom of the vertical axis a bug or a
20752 feature? If you think it is a bug, and should be a `1' instead, (or
20753 even a `0'), you can modify the sources.)
20754
20755 @node Graphing words in defuns
20756 @appendixsubsec Graphing Numbers of Words and Symbols
20757
20758 Now for the graph for which all this code was written: a graph that
20759 shows how many function definitions contain fewer than 10 words and
20760 symbols, how many contain between 10 and 19 words and symbols, how
20761 many contain between 20 and 29 words and symbols, and so on.
20762
20763 This is a multi-step process. First make sure you have loaded all the
20764 requisite code.
20765
20766 @need 1500
20767 It is a good idea to reset the value of @code{top-of-ranges} in case
20768 you have set it to some different value. You can evaluate the
20769 following:
20770
20771 @smallexample
20772 @group
20773 (setq top-of-ranges
20774 '(10 20 30 40 50
20775 60 70 80 90 100
20776 110 120 130 140 150
20777 160 170 180 190 200
20778 210 220 230 240 250
20779 260 270 280 290 300)
20780 @end group
20781 @end smallexample
20782
20783 @noindent
20784 Next create a list of the number of words and symbols in each range.
20785
20786 @need 1500
20787 @noindent
20788 Evaluate the following:
20789
20790 @smallexample
20791 @group
20792 (setq list-for-graph
20793 (defuns-per-range
20794 (sort
20795 (recursive-lengths-list-many-files
20796 (directory-files "/usr/local/emacs/lisp"
20797 t ".+el$"))
20798 '<)
20799 top-of-ranges))
20800 @end group
20801 @end smallexample
20802
20803 @noindent
20804 On my old machine, this took about an hour. It looked though 303 Lisp
20805 files in my copy of Emacs version 19.23. After all that computing,
20806 the @code{list-for-graph} had this value:
20807
20808 @smallexample
20809 @group
20810 (537 1027 955 785 594 483 349 292 224 199 166 120 116 99
20811 90 80 67 48 52 45 41 33 28 26 25 20 12 28 11 13 220)
20812 @end group
20813 @end smallexample
20814
20815 @noindent
20816 This means that my copy of Emacs had 537 function definitions with
20817 fewer than 10 words or symbols in them, 1,027 function definitions
20818 with 10 to 19 words or symbols in them, 955 function definitions with
20819 20 to 29 words or symbols in them, and so on.
20820
20821 Clearly, just by looking at this list we can see that most function
20822 definitions contain ten to thirty words and symbols.
20823
20824 Now for printing. We do @emph{not} want to print a graph that is
20825 1,030 lines high @dots{} Instead, we should print a graph that is
20826 fewer than twenty-five lines high. A graph that height can be
20827 displayed on almost any monitor, and easily printed on a sheet of paper.
20828
20829 This means that each value in @code{list-for-graph} must be reduced to
20830 one-fiftieth its present value.
20831
20832 Here is a short function to do just that, using two functions we have
20833 not yet seen, @code{mapcar} and @code{lambda}.
20834
20835 @smallexample
20836 @group
20837 (defun one-fiftieth (full-range)
20838 "Return list, each number one-fiftieth of previous."
20839 (mapcar (lambda (arg) (/ arg 50)) full-range))
20840 @end group
20841 @end smallexample
20842
20843 @node lambda
20844 @appendixsubsec A @code{lambda} Expression: Useful Anonymity
20845 @cindex Anonymous function
20846 @findex lambda
20847
20848 @code{lambda} is the symbol for an anonymous function, a function
20849 without a name. Every time you use an anonymous function, you need to
20850 include its whole body.
20851
20852 @need 1250
20853 @noindent
20854 Thus,
20855
20856 @smallexample
20857 (lambda (arg) (/ arg 50))
20858 @end smallexample
20859
20860 @noindent
20861 is a function definition that says `return the value resulting from
20862 dividing whatever is passed to me as @code{arg} by 50'.
20863
20864 @need 1200
20865 Earlier, for example, we had a function @code{multiply-by-seven}; it
20866 multiplied its argument by 7. This function is similar, except it
20867 divides its argument by 50; and, it has no name. The anonymous
20868 equivalent of @code{multiply-by-seven} is:
20869
20870 @smallexample
20871 (lambda (number) (* 7 number))
20872 @end smallexample
20873
20874 @noindent
20875 (@xref{defun, , The @code{defun} Macro}.)
20876
20877 @need 1250
20878 @noindent
20879 If we want to multiply 3 by 7, we can write:
20880
20881 @c !!! Clear print-postscript-figures if the computer formatting this
20882 @c document is too small and cannot handle all the diagrams and figures.
20883 @c clear print-postscript-figures
20884 @c set print-postscript-figures
20885 @c lambda example diagram #1
20886 @ifnottex
20887 @smallexample
20888 @group
20889 (multiply-by-seven 3)
20890 \_______________/ ^
20891 | |
20892 function argument
20893 @end group
20894 @end smallexample
20895 @end ifnottex
20896 @ifset print-postscript-figures
20897 @sp 1
20898 @tex
20899 @center @image{lambda-1}
20900 %%%% old method of including an image
20901 % \input /usr/local/lib/tex/inputs/psfig.tex
20902 % \centerline{\psfig{figure=/usr/local/lib/emacs/man/lambda-1.eps}}
20903 % \catcode`\@=0 %
20904 @end tex
20905 @sp 1
20906 @end ifset
20907 @ifclear print-postscript-figures
20908 @iftex
20909 @smallexample
20910 @group
20911 (multiply-by-seven 3)
20912 \_______________/ ^
20913 | |
20914 function argument
20915 @end group
20916 @end smallexample
20917 @end iftex
20918 @end ifclear
20919
20920 @noindent
20921 This expression returns 21.
20922
20923 @need 1250
20924 @noindent
20925 Similarly, we can write:
20926
20927 @c lambda example diagram #2
20928 @ifnottex
20929 @smallexample
20930 @group
20931 ((lambda (number) (* 7 number)) 3)
20932 \____________________________/ ^
20933 | |
20934 anonymous function argument
20935 @end group
20936 @end smallexample
20937 @end ifnottex
20938 @ifset print-postscript-figures
20939 @sp 1
20940 @tex
20941 @center @image{lambda-2}
20942 %%%% old method of including an image
20943 % \input /usr/local/lib/tex/inputs/psfig.tex
20944 % \centerline{\psfig{figure=/usr/local/lib/emacs/man/lambda-2.eps}}
20945 % \catcode`\@=0 %
20946 @end tex
20947 @sp 1
20948 @end ifset
20949 @ifclear print-postscript-figures
20950 @iftex
20951 @smallexample
20952 @group
20953 ((lambda (number) (* 7 number)) 3)
20954 \____________________________/ ^
20955 | |
20956 anonymous function argument
20957 @end group
20958 @end smallexample
20959 @end iftex
20960 @end ifclear
20961
20962 @need 1250
20963 @noindent
20964 If we want to divide 100 by 50, we can write:
20965
20966 @c lambda example diagram #3
20967 @ifnottex
20968 @smallexample
20969 @group
20970 ((lambda (arg) (/ arg 50)) 100)
20971 \______________________/ \_/
20972 | |
20973 anonymous function argument
20974 @end group
20975 @end smallexample
20976 @end ifnottex
20977 @ifset print-postscript-figures
20978 @sp 1
20979 @tex
20980 @center @image{lambda-3}
20981 %%%% old method of including an image
20982 % \input /usr/local/lib/tex/inputs/psfig.tex
20983 % \centerline{\psfig{figure=/usr/local/lib/emacs/man/lambda-3.eps}}
20984 % \catcode`\@=0 %
20985 @end tex
20986 @sp 1
20987 @end ifset
20988 @ifclear print-postscript-figures
20989 @iftex
20990 @smallexample
20991 @group
20992 ((lambda (arg) (/ arg 50)) 100)
20993 \______________________/ \_/
20994 | |
20995 anonymous function argument
20996 @end group
20997 @end smallexample
20998 @end iftex
20999 @end ifclear
21000
21001 @noindent
21002 This expression returns 2. The 100 is passed to the function, which
21003 divides that number by 50.
21004
21005 @xref{Lambda Expressions, , Lambda Expressions, elisp, The GNU Emacs
21006 Lisp Reference Manual}, for more about @code{lambda}. Lisp and lambda
21007 expressions derive from the Lambda Calculus.
21008
21009 @node mapcar
21010 @appendixsubsec The @code{mapcar} Function
21011 @findex mapcar
21012
21013 @code{mapcar} is a function that calls its first argument with each
21014 element of its second argument, in turn. The second argument must be
21015 a sequence.
21016
21017 The @samp{map} part of the name comes from the mathematical phrase,
21018 `mapping over a domain', meaning to apply a function to each of the
21019 elements in a domain. The mathematical phrase is based on the
21020 metaphor of a surveyor walking, one step at a time, over an area he is
21021 mapping. And @samp{car}, of course, comes from the Lisp notion of the
21022 first of a list.
21023
21024 @need 1250
21025 @noindent
21026 For example,
21027
21028 @smallexample
21029 @group
21030 (mapcar '1+ '(2 4 6))
21031 @result{} (3 5 7)
21032 @end group
21033 @end smallexample
21034
21035 @noindent
21036 The function @code{1+} which adds one to its argument, is executed on
21037 @emph{each} element of the list, and a new list is returned.
21038
21039 Contrast this with @code{apply}, which applies its first argument to
21040 all the remaining.
21041 (@xref{Readying a Graph, , Readying a Graph}, for a explanation of
21042 @code{apply}.)
21043
21044 @need 1250
21045 In the definition of @code{one-fiftieth}, the first argument is the
21046 anonymous function:
21047
21048 @smallexample
21049 (lambda (arg) (/ arg 50))
21050 @end smallexample
21051
21052 @noindent
21053 and the second argument is @code{full-range}, which will be bound to
21054 @code{list-for-graph}.
21055
21056 @need 1250
21057 The whole expression looks like this:
21058
21059 @smallexample
21060 (mapcar (lambda (arg) (/ arg 50)) full-range))
21061 @end smallexample
21062
21063 @xref{Mapping Functions, , Mapping Functions, elisp, The GNU Emacs
21064 Lisp Reference Manual}, for more about @code{mapcar}.
21065
21066 Using the @code{one-fiftieth} function, we can generate a list in
21067 which each element is one-fiftieth the size of the corresponding
21068 element in @code{list-for-graph}.
21069
21070 @smallexample
21071 @group
21072 (setq fiftieth-list-for-graph
21073 (one-fiftieth list-for-graph))
21074 @end group
21075 @end smallexample
21076
21077 @need 1250
21078 The resulting list looks like this:
21079
21080 @smallexample
21081 @group
21082 (10 20 19 15 11 9 6 5 4 3 3 2 2
21083 1 1 1 1 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 4)
21084 @end group
21085 @end smallexample
21086
21087 @noindent
21088 This, we are almost ready to print! (We also notice the loss of
21089 information: many of the higher ranges are 0, meaning that fewer than
21090 50 defuns had that many words or symbols---but not necessarily meaning
21091 that none had that many words or symbols.)
21092
21093 @node Another Bug
21094 @appendixsubsec Another Bug @dots{} Most Insidious
21095 @cindex Bug, most insidious type
21096 @cindex Insidious type of bug
21097
21098 I said `almost ready to print'! Of course, there is a bug in the
21099 @code{print-graph} function @dots{} It has a @code{vertical-step}
21100 option, but not a @code{horizontal-step} option. The
21101 @code{top-of-range} scale goes from 10 to 300 by tens. But the
21102 @code{print-graph} function will print only by ones.
21103
21104 This is a classic example of what some consider the most insidious
21105 type of bug, the bug of omission. This is not the kind of bug you can
21106 find by studying the code, for it is not in the code; it is an omitted
21107 feature. Your best actions are to try your program early and often;
21108 and try to arrange, as much as you can, to write code that is easy to
21109 understand and easy to change. Try to be aware, whenever you can,
21110 that whatever you have written, @emph{will} be rewritten, if not soon,
21111 eventually. A hard maxim to follow.
21112
21113 It is the @code{print-X-axis-numbered-line} function that needs the
21114 work; and then the @code{print-X-axis} and the @code{print-graph}
21115 functions need to be adapted. Not much needs to be done; there is one
21116 nicety: the numbers ought to line up under the tic marks. This takes
21117 a little thought.
21118
21119 @need 1250
21120 Here is the corrected @code{print-X-axis-numbered-line}:
21121
21122 @smallexample
21123 @group
21124 (defun print-X-axis-numbered-line
21125 (number-of-X-tics X-axis-leading-spaces
21126 &optional horizontal-step)
21127 "Print line of X-axis numbers"
21128 (let ((number X-axis-label-spacing)
21129 (horizontal-step (or horizontal-step 1)))
21130 @end group
21131 @group
21132 (insert X-axis-leading-spaces)
21133 ;; @r{Delete extra leading spaces.}
21134 (delete-char
21135 (- (1-
21136 (length (number-to-string horizontal-step)))))
21137 (insert (concat
21138 (make-string
21139 @end group
21140 @group
21141 ;; @r{Insert white space.}
21142 (- (* symbol-width
21143 X-axis-label-spacing)
21144 (1-
21145 (length
21146 (number-to-string horizontal-step)))
21147 2)
21148 ? )
21149 (number-to-string
21150 (* number horizontal-step))))
21151 @end group
21152 @group
21153 ;; @r{Insert remaining numbers.}
21154 (setq number (+ number X-axis-label-spacing))
21155 (while (> number-of-X-tics 1)
21156 (insert (X-axis-element
21157 (* number horizontal-step)))
21158 (setq number (+ number X-axis-label-spacing))
21159 (setq number-of-X-tics (1- number-of-X-tics)))))
21160 @end group
21161 @end smallexample
21162
21163 @need 1500
21164 If you are reading this in Info, you can see the new versions of
21165 @code{print-X-axis} @code{print-graph} and evaluate them. If you are
21166 reading this in a printed book, you can see the changed lines here
21167 (the full text is too much to print).
21168
21169 @iftex
21170 @smallexample
21171 @group
21172 (defun print-X-axis (numbers-list horizontal-step)
21173 @dots{}
21174 (print-X-axis-numbered-line
21175 tic-number leading-spaces horizontal-step))
21176 @end group
21177 @end smallexample
21178
21179 @smallexample
21180 @group
21181 (defun print-graph
21182 (numbers-list
21183 &optional vertical-step horizontal-step)
21184 @dots{}
21185 (print-X-axis numbers-list horizontal-step))
21186 @end group
21187 @end smallexample
21188 @end iftex
21189
21190 @ifnottex
21191 @smallexample
21192 @group
21193 (defun print-X-axis (numbers-list horizontal-step)
21194 "Print X axis labels to length of NUMBERS-LIST.
21195 Optionally, HORIZONTAL-STEP, a positive integer,
21196 specifies how much an X axis label increments for
21197 each column."
21198 @end group
21199 @group
21200 ;; Value of symbol-width and full-Y-label-width
21201 ;; are passed by `print-graph'.
21202 (let* ((leading-spaces
21203 (make-string full-Y-label-width ? ))
21204 ;; symbol-width @r{is provided by} graph-body-print
21205 (tic-width (* symbol-width X-axis-label-spacing))
21206 (X-length (length numbers-list))
21207 @end group
21208 @group
21209 (X-tic
21210 (concat
21211 (make-string
21212 ;; @r{Make a string of blanks.}
21213 (- (* symbol-width X-axis-label-spacing)
21214 (length X-axis-tic-symbol))
21215 ? )
21216 @end group
21217 @group
21218 ;; @r{Concatenate blanks with tic symbol.}
21219 X-axis-tic-symbol))
21220 (tic-number
21221 (if (zerop (% X-length tic-width))
21222 (/ X-length tic-width)
21223 (1+ (/ X-length tic-width)))))
21224 @end group
21225
21226 @group
21227 (print-X-axis-tic-line
21228 tic-number leading-spaces X-tic)
21229 (insert "\n")
21230 (print-X-axis-numbered-line
21231 tic-number leading-spaces horizontal-step)))
21232 @end group
21233 @end smallexample
21234
21235 @smallexample
21236 @group
21237 (defun print-graph
21238 (numbers-list &optional vertical-step horizontal-step)
21239 "Print labeled bar graph of the NUMBERS-LIST.
21240 The numbers-list consists of the Y-axis values.
21241 @end group
21242
21243 @group
21244 Optionally, VERTICAL-STEP, a positive integer,
21245 specifies how much a Y axis label increments for
21246 each line. For example, a step of 5 means that
21247 each row is five units.
21248 @end group
21249
21250 @group
21251 Optionally, HORIZONTAL-STEP, a positive integer,
21252 specifies how much an X axis label increments for
21253 each column."
21254 (let* ((symbol-width (length graph-blank))
21255 ;; @code{height} @r{is both the largest number}
21256 ;; @r{and the number with the most digits.}
21257 (height (apply 'max numbers-list))
21258 @end group
21259 @group
21260 (height-of-top-line
21261 (if (zerop (% height Y-axis-label-spacing))
21262 height
21263 ;; @r{else}
21264 (* (1+ (/ height Y-axis-label-spacing))
21265 Y-axis-label-spacing)))
21266 @end group
21267 @group
21268 (vertical-step (or vertical-step 1))
21269 (full-Y-label-width
21270 (length
21271 (concat
21272 (number-to-string
21273 (* height-of-top-line vertical-step))
21274 Y-axis-tic))))
21275 @end group
21276 @group
21277 (print-Y-axis
21278 height-of-top-line full-Y-label-width vertical-step)
21279 (graph-body-print
21280 numbers-list height-of-top-line symbol-width)
21281 (print-X-axis numbers-list horizontal-step)))
21282 @end group
21283 @end smallexample
21284 @end ifnottex
21285
21286 @c qqq
21287 @ignore
21288 Graphing Definitions Re-listed
21289
21290 @need 1250
21291 Here are all the graphing definitions in their final form:
21292
21293 @smallexample
21294 @group
21295 (defvar top-of-ranges
21296 '(10 20 30 40 50
21297 60 70 80 90 100
21298 110 120 130 140 150
21299 160 170 180 190 200
21300 210 220 230 240 250)
21301 "List specifying ranges for `defuns-per-range'.")
21302 @end group
21303
21304 @group
21305 (defvar graph-symbol "*"
21306 "String used as symbol in graph, usually an asterisk.")
21307 @end group
21308
21309 @group
21310 (defvar graph-blank " "
21311 "String used as blank in graph, usually a blank space.
21312 graph-blank must be the same number of columns wide
21313 as graph-symbol.")
21314 @end group
21315
21316 @group
21317 (defvar Y-axis-tic " - "
21318 "String that follows number in a Y axis label.")
21319 @end group
21320
21321 @group
21322 (defvar Y-axis-label-spacing 5
21323 "Number of lines from one Y axis label to next.")
21324 @end group
21325
21326 @group
21327 (defvar X-axis-tic-symbol "|"
21328 "String to insert to point to a column in X axis.")
21329 @end group
21330
21331 @group
21332 (defvar X-axis-label-spacing
21333 (if (boundp 'graph-blank)
21334 (* 5 (length graph-blank)) 5)
21335 "Number of units from one X axis label to next.")
21336 @end group
21337 @end smallexample
21338
21339 @smallexample
21340 @group
21341 (defun count-words-in-defun ()
21342 "Return the number of words and symbols in a defun."
21343 (beginning-of-defun)
21344 (let ((count 0)
21345 (end (save-excursion (end-of-defun) (point))))
21346 @end group
21347
21348 @group
21349 (while
21350 (and (< (point) end)
21351 (re-search-forward
21352 "\\(\\w\\|\\s_\\)+[^ \t\n]*[ \t\n]*"
21353 end t))
21354 (setq count (1+ count)))
21355 count))
21356 @end group
21357 @end smallexample
21358
21359 @smallexample
21360 @group
21361 (defun lengths-list-file (filename)
21362 "Return list of definitions' lengths within FILE.
21363 The returned list is a list of numbers.
21364 Each number is the number of words or
21365 symbols in one function definition."
21366 @end group
21367
21368 @group
21369 (message "Working on `%s' ... " filename)
21370 (save-excursion
21371 (let ((buffer (find-file-noselect filename))
21372 (lengths-list))
21373 (set-buffer buffer)
21374 (setq buffer-read-only t)
21375 (widen)
21376 (goto-char (point-min))
21377 @end group
21378
21379 @group
21380 (while (re-search-forward "^(defun" nil t)
21381 (setq lengths-list
21382 (cons (count-words-in-defun) lengths-list)))
21383 (kill-buffer buffer)
21384 lengths-list)))
21385 @end group
21386 @end smallexample
21387
21388 @smallexample
21389 @group
21390 (defun lengths-list-many-files (list-of-files)
21391 "Return list of lengths of defuns in LIST-OF-FILES."
21392 (let (lengths-list)
21393 ;;; @r{true-or-false-test}
21394 (while list-of-files
21395 (setq lengths-list
21396 (append
21397 lengths-list
21398 @end group
21399 @group
21400 ;;; @r{Generate a lengths' list.}
21401 (lengths-list-file
21402 (expand-file-name (car list-of-files)))))
21403 ;;; @r{Make files' list shorter.}
21404 (setq list-of-files (cdr list-of-files)))
21405 ;;; @r{Return final value of lengths' list.}
21406 lengths-list))
21407 @end group
21408 @end smallexample
21409
21410 @smallexample
21411 @group
21412 (defun defuns-per-range (sorted-lengths top-of-ranges)
21413 "SORTED-LENGTHS defuns in each TOP-OF-RANGES range."
21414 (let ((top-of-range (car top-of-ranges))
21415 (number-within-range 0)
21416 defuns-per-range-list)
21417 @end group
21418
21419 @group
21420 ;; @r{Outer loop.}
21421 (while top-of-ranges
21422
21423 ;; @r{Inner loop.}
21424 (while (and
21425 ;; @r{Need number for numeric test.}
21426 (car sorted-lengths)
21427 (< (car sorted-lengths) top-of-range))
21428
21429 ;; @r{Count number of definitions within current range.}
21430 (setq number-within-range (1+ number-within-range))
21431 (setq sorted-lengths (cdr sorted-lengths)))
21432 @end group
21433
21434 @group
21435 ;; @r{Exit inner loop but remain within outer loop.}
21436
21437 (setq defuns-per-range-list
21438 (cons number-within-range defuns-per-range-list))
21439 (setq number-within-range 0) ; @r{Reset count to zero.}
21440
21441 ;; @r{Move to next range.}
21442 (setq top-of-ranges (cdr top-of-ranges))
21443 ;; @r{Specify next top of range value.}
21444 (setq top-of-range (car top-of-ranges)))
21445 @end group
21446
21447 @group
21448 ;; @r{Exit outer loop and count the number of defuns larger than}
21449 ;; @r{ the largest top-of-range value.}
21450 (setq defuns-per-range-list
21451 (cons
21452 (length sorted-lengths)
21453 defuns-per-range-list))
21454
21455 ;; @r{Return a list of the number of definitions within each range,}
21456 ;; @r{ smallest to largest.}
21457 (nreverse defuns-per-range-list)))
21458 @end group
21459 @end smallexample
21460
21461 @smallexample
21462 @group
21463 (defun column-of-graph (max-graph-height actual-height)
21464 "Return list of MAX-GRAPH-HEIGHT strings;
21465 ACTUAL-HEIGHT are graph-symbols.
21466 The graph-symbols are contiguous entries at the end
21467 of the list.
21468 The list will be inserted as one column of a graph.
21469 The strings are either graph-blank or graph-symbol."
21470 @end group
21471
21472 @group
21473 (let ((insert-list nil)
21474 (number-of-top-blanks
21475 (- max-graph-height actual-height)))
21476
21477 ;; @r{Fill in @code{graph-symbols}.}
21478 (while (> actual-height 0)
21479 (setq insert-list (cons graph-symbol insert-list))
21480 (setq actual-height (1- actual-height)))
21481 @end group
21482
21483 @group
21484 ;; @r{Fill in @code{graph-blanks}.}
21485 (while (> number-of-top-blanks 0)
21486 (setq insert-list (cons graph-blank insert-list))
21487 (setq number-of-top-blanks
21488 (1- number-of-top-blanks)))
21489
21490 ;; @r{Return whole list.}
21491 insert-list))
21492 @end group
21493 @end smallexample
21494
21495 @smallexample
21496 @group
21497 (defun Y-axis-element (number full-Y-label-width)
21498 "Construct a NUMBERed label element.
21499 A numbered element looks like this ` 5 - ',
21500 and is padded as needed so all line up with
21501 the element for the largest number."
21502 @end group
21503 @group
21504 (let* ((leading-spaces
21505 (- full-Y-label-width
21506 (length
21507 (concat (number-to-string number)
21508 Y-axis-tic)))))
21509 @end group
21510 @group
21511 (concat
21512 (make-string leading-spaces ? )
21513 (number-to-string number)
21514 Y-axis-tic)))
21515 @end group
21516 @end smallexample
21517
21518 @smallexample
21519 @group
21520 (defun print-Y-axis
21521 (height full-Y-label-width &optional vertical-step)
21522 "Insert Y axis by HEIGHT and FULL-Y-LABEL-WIDTH.
21523 Height must be the maximum height of the graph.
21524 Full width is the width of the highest label element.
21525 Optionally, print according to VERTICAL-STEP."
21526 @end group
21527 @group
21528 ;; Value of height and full-Y-label-width
21529 ;; are passed by `print-graph'.
21530 (let ((start (point)))
21531 (insert-rectangle
21532 (Y-axis-column height full-Y-label-width vertical-step))
21533 @end group
21534 @group
21535 ;; @r{Place point ready for inserting graph.}
21536 (goto-char start)
21537 ;; @r{Move point forward by value of} full-Y-label-width
21538 (forward-char full-Y-label-width)))
21539 @end group
21540 @end smallexample
21541
21542 @smallexample
21543 @group
21544 (defun print-X-axis-tic-line
21545 (number-of-X-tics X-axis-leading-spaces X-axis-tic-element)
21546 "Print ticks for X axis."
21547 (insert X-axis-leading-spaces)
21548 (insert X-axis-tic-symbol) ; @r{Under first column.}
21549 @end group
21550 @group
21551 ;; @r{Insert second tic in the right spot.}
21552 (insert (concat
21553 (make-string
21554 (- (* symbol-width X-axis-label-spacing)
21555 ;; @r{Insert white space up to second tic symbol.}
21556 (* 2 (length X-axis-tic-symbol)))
21557 ? )
21558 X-axis-tic-symbol))
21559 @end group
21560 @group
21561 ;; @r{Insert remaining ticks.}
21562 (while (> number-of-X-tics 1)
21563 (insert X-axis-tic-element)
21564 (setq number-of-X-tics (1- number-of-X-tics))))
21565 @end group
21566 @end smallexample
21567
21568 @smallexample
21569 @group
21570 (defun X-axis-element (number)
21571 "Construct a numbered X axis element."
21572 (let ((leading-spaces
21573 (- (* symbol-width X-axis-label-spacing)
21574 (length (number-to-string number)))))
21575 (concat (make-string leading-spaces ? )
21576 (number-to-string number))))
21577 @end group
21578 @end smallexample
21579
21580 @smallexample
21581 @group
21582 (defun graph-body-print (numbers-list height symbol-width)
21583 "Print a bar graph of the NUMBERS-LIST.
21584 The numbers-list consists of the Y-axis values.
21585 HEIGHT is maximum height of graph.
21586 SYMBOL-WIDTH is number of each column."
21587 @end group
21588 @group
21589 (let (from-position)
21590 (while numbers-list
21591 (setq from-position (point))
21592 (insert-rectangle
21593 (column-of-graph height (car numbers-list)))
21594 (goto-char from-position)
21595 (forward-char symbol-width)
21596 @end group
21597 @group
21598 ;; @r{Draw graph column by column.}
21599 (sit-for 0)
21600 (setq numbers-list (cdr numbers-list)))
21601 ;; @r{Place point for X axis labels.}
21602 (forward-line height)
21603 (insert "\n")))
21604 @end group
21605 @end smallexample
21606
21607 @smallexample
21608 @group
21609 (defun Y-axis-column
21610 (height width-of-label &optional vertical-step)
21611 "Construct list of labels for Y axis.
21612 HEIGHT is maximum height of graph.
21613 WIDTH-OF-LABEL is maximum width of label.
21614 @end group
21615 @group
21616 VERTICAL-STEP, an option, is a positive integer
21617 that specifies how much a Y axis label increments
21618 for each line. For example, a step of 5 means
21619 that each line is five units of the graph."
21620 (let (Y-axis
21621 (number-per-line (or vertical-step 1)))
21622 @end group
21623 @group
21624 (while (> height 1)
21625 (if (zerop (% height Y-axis-label-spacing))
21626 ;; @r{Insert label.}
21627 (setq Y-axis
21628 (cons
21629 (Y-axis-element
21630 (* height number-per-line)
21631 width-of-label)
21632 Y-axis))
21633 @end group
21634 @group
21635 ;; @r{Else, insert blanks.}
21636 (setq Y-axis
21637 (cons
21638 (make-string width-of-label ? )
21639 Y-axis)))
21640 (setq height (1- height)))
21641 @end group
21642 @group
21643 ;; @r{Insert base line.}
21644 (setq Y-axis (cons (Y-axis-element
21645 (or vertical-step 1)
21646 width-of-label)
21647 Y-axis))
21648 (nreverse Y-axis)))
21649 @end group
21650 @end smallexample
21651
21652 @smallexample
21653 @group
21654 (defun print-X-axis-numbered-line
21655 (number-of-X-tics X-axis-leading-spaces
21656 &optional horizontal-step)
21657 "Print line of X-axis numbers"
21658 (let ((number X-axis-label-spacing)
21659 (horizontal-step (or horizontal-step 1)))
21660 @end group
21661 @group
21662 (insert X-axis-leading-spaces)
21663 ;; line up number
21664 (delete-char (- (1- (length (number-to-string horizontal-step)))))
21665 (insert (concat
21666 (make-string
21667 ;; @r{Insert white space up to next number.}
21668 (- (* symbol-width X-axis-label-spacing)
21669 (1- (length (number-to-string horizontal-step)))
21670 2)
21671 ? )
21672 (number-to-string (* number horizontal-step))))
21673 @end group
21674 @group
21675 ;; @r{Insert remaining numbers.}
21676 (setq number (+ number X-axis-label-spacing))
21677 (while (> number-of-X-tics 1)
21678 (insert (X-axis-element (* number horizontal-step)))
21679 (setq number (+ number X-axis-label-spacing))
21680 (setq number-of-X-tics (1- number-of-X-tics)))))
21681 @end group
21682 @end smallexample
21683
21684 @smallexample
21685 @group
21686 (defun print-X-axis (numbers-list horizontal-step)
21687 "Print X axis labels to length of NUMBERS-LIST.
21688 Optionally, HORIZONTAL-STEP, a positive integer,
21689 specifies how much an X axis label increments for
21690 each column."
21691 @end group
21692 @group
21693 ;; Value of symbol-width and full-Y-label-width
21694 ;; are passed by `print-graph'.
21695 (let* ((leading-spaces
21696 (make-string full-Y-label-width ? ))
21697 ;; symbol-width @r{is provided by} graph-body-print
21698 (tic-width (* symbol-width X-axis-label-spacing))
21699 (X-length (length numbers-list))
21700 @end group
21701 @group
21702 (X-tic
21703 (concat
21704 (make-string
21705 ;; @r{Make a string of blanks.}
21706 (- (* symbol-width X-axis-label-spacing)
21707 (length X-axis-tic-symbol))
21708 ? )
21709 @end group
21710 @group
21711 ;; @r{Concatenate blanks with tic symbol.}
21712 X-axis-tic-symbol))
21713 (tic-number
21714 (if (zerop (% X-length tic-width))
21715 (/ X-length tic-width)
21716 (1+ (/ X-length tic-width)))))
21717 @end group
21718
21719 @group
21720 (print-X-axis-tic-line
21721 tic-number leading-spaces X-tic)
21722 (insert "\n")
21723 (print-X-axis-numbered-line
21724 tic-number leading-spaces horizontal-step)))
21725 @end group
21726 @end smallexample
21727
21728 @smallexample
21729 @group
21730 (defun one-fiftieth (full-range)
21731 "Return list, each number of which is 1/50th previous."
21732 (mapcar (lambda (arg) (/ arg 50)) full-range))
21733 @end group
21734 @end smallexample
21735
21736 @smallexample
21737 @group
21738 (defun print-graph
21739 (numbers-list &optional vertical-step horizontal-step)
21740 "Print labeled bar graph of the NUMBERS-LIST.
21741 The numbers-list consists of the Y-axis values.
21742 @end group
21743
21744 @group
21745 Optionally, VERTICAL-STEP, a positive integer,
21746 specifies how much a Y axis label increments for
21747 each line. For example, a step of 5 means that
21748 each row is five units.
21749 @end group
21750
21751 @group
21752 Optionally, HORIZONTAL-STEP, a positive integer,
21753 specifies how much an X axis label increments for
21754 each column."
21755 (let* ((symbol-width (length graph-blank))
21756 ;; @code{height} @r{is both the largest number}
21757 ;; @r{and the number with the most digits.}
21758 (height (apply 'max numbers-list))
21759 @end group
21760 @group
21761 (height-of-top-line
21762 (if (zerop (% height Y-axis-label-spacing))
21763 height
21764 ;; @r{else}
21765 (* (1+ (/ height Y-axis-label-spacing))
21766 Y-axis-label-spacing)))
21767 @end group
21768 @group
21769 (vertical-step (or vertical-step 1))
21770 (full-Y-label-width
21771 (length
21772 (concat
21773 (number-to-string
21774 (* height-of-top-line vertical-step))
21775 Y-axis-tic))))
21776 @end group
21777 @group
21778
21779 (print-Y-axis
21780 height-of-top-line full-Y-label-width vertical-step)
21781 (graph-body-print
21782 numbers-list height-of-top-line symbol-width)
21783 (print-X-axis numbers-list horizontal-step)))
21784 @end group
21785 @end smallexample
21786 @c qqq
21787 @end ignore
21788
21789 @page
21790 @node Final printed graph
21791 @appendixsubsec The Printed Graph
21792
21793 When made and installed, you can call the @code{print-graph} command
21794 like this:
21795 @sp 1
21796
21797 @smallexample
21798 @group
21799 (print-graph fiftieth-list-for-graph 50 10)
21800 @end group
21801 @end smallexample
21802 @sp 1
21803
21804 @noindent
21805 Here is the graph:
21806 @sp 2
21807
21808 @smallexample
21809 @group
21810 1000 - *
21811 **
21812 **
21813 **
21814 **
21815 750 - ***
21816 ***
21817 ***
21818 ***
21819 ****
21820 500 - *****
21821 ******
21822 ******
21823 ******
21824 *******
21825 250 - ********
21826 ********* *
21827 *********** *
21828 ************* *
21829 50 - ***************** * *
21830 | | | | | | | |
21831 10 50 100 150 200 250 300 350
21832 @end group
21833 @end smallexample
21834
21835 @sp 2
21836
21837 @noindent
21838 The largest group of functions contain 10--19 words and symbols each.
21839
21840 @node Free Software and Free Manuals
21841 @appendix Free Software and Free Manuals
21842
21843 @strong{by Richard M. Stallman}
21844 @sp 1
21845
21846 The biggest deficiency in free operating systems is not in the
21847 software---it is the lack of good free manuals that we can include in
21848 these systems. Many of our most important programs do not come with
21849 full manuals. Documentation is an essential part of any software
21850 package; when an important free software package does not come with a
21851 free manual, that is a major gap. We have many such gaps today.
21852
21853 Once upon a time, many years ago, I thought I would learn Perl. I got
21854 a copy of a free manual, but I found it hard to read. When I asked
21855 Perl users about alternatives, they told me that there were better
21856 introductory manuals---but those were not free.
21857
21858 Why was this? The authors of the good manuals had written them for
21859 O'Reilly Associates, which published them with restrictive terms---no
21860 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
21861 them from the free software community.
21862
21863 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing has happened, and (to
21864 our community's great loss) it was far from the last. Proprietary
21865 manual publishers have enticed a great many authors to restrict their
21866 manuals since then. Many times I have heard a GNU user eagerly tell me
21867 about a manual that he is writing, with which he expects to help the
21868 GNU project---and then had my hopes dashed, as he proceeded to explain
21869 that he had signed a contract with a publisher that would restrict it
21870 so that we cannot use it.
21871
21872 Given that writing good English is a rare skill among programmers, we
21873 can ill afford to lose manuals this way.
21874
21875 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
21876 price. The problem with these manuals was not that O'Reilly Associates
21877 charged a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. The Free
21878 Software Foundation @uref{http://shop.fsf.org, sells printed copies} of
21879 free @uref{http://www.gnu.org/doc/doc.html, GNU manuals}, too.
21880 But GNU manuals are available in source code form, while these manuals
21881 are available only on paper. GNU manuals come with permission to copy
21882 and modify; the Perl manuals do not. These restrictions are the
21883 problems.
21884
21885 The criterion for a free manual is pretty much the same as for free
21886 software: it is a matter of giving all users certain
21887 freedoms. Redistribution (including commercial redistribution) must be
21888 permitted, so that the manual can accompany every copy of the program,
21889 on-line or on paper. Permission for modification is crucial too.
21890
21891 As a general rule, I don't believe that it is essential for people to
21892 have permission to modify all sorts of articles and books. The issues
21893 for writings are not necessarily the same as those for software. For
21894 example, I don't think you or I are obliged to give permission to
21895 modify articles like this one, which describe our actions and our
21896 views.
21897
21898 But there is a particular reason why the freedom to modify is crucial
21899 for documentation for free software. When people exercise their right
21900 to modify the software, and add or change its features, if they are
21901 conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can provide
21902 accurate and usable documentation with the modified program. A manual
21903 which forbids programmers to be conscientious and finish the job, or
21904 more precisely requires them to write a new manual from scratch if
21905 they change the program, does not fill our community's needs.
21906
21907 While a blanket prohibition on modification is unacceptable, some
21908 kinds of limits on the method of modification pose no problem. For
21909 example, requirements to preserve the original author's copyright
21910 notice, the distribution terms, or the list of authors, are ok. It is
21911 also no problem to require modified versions to include notice that
21912 they were modified, even to have entire sections that may not be
21913 deleted or changed, as long as these sections deal with nontechnical
21914 topics. (Some GNU manuals have them.)
21915
21916 These kinds of restrictions are not a problem because, as a practical
21917 matter, they don't stop the conscientious programmer from adapting the
21918 manual to fit the modified program. In other words, they don't block
21919 the free software community from making full use of the manual.
21920
21921 However, it must be possible to modify all the technical content of
21922 the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual media,
21923 through all the usual channels; otherwise, the restrictions do block
21924 the community, the manual is not free, and so we need another manual.
21925
21926 Unfortunately, it is often hard to find someone to write another
21927 manual when a proprietary manual exists. The obstacle is that many
21928 users think that a proprietary manual is good enough---so they don't
21929 see the need to write a free manual. They do not see that the free
21930 operating system has a gap that needs filling.
21931
21932 Why do users think that proprietary manuals are good enough? Some have
21933 not considered the issue. I hope this article will do something to
21934 change that.
21935
21936 Other users consider proprietary manuals acceptable for the same
21937 reason so many people consider proprietary software acceptable: they
21938 judge in purely practical terms, not using freedom as a
21939 criterion. These people are entitled to their opinions, but since
21940 those opinions spring from values which do not include freedom, they
21941 are no guide for those of us who do value freedom.
21942
21943 Please spread the word about this issue. We continue to lose manuals
21944 to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that proprietary
21945 manuals are not sufficient, perhaps the next person who wants to help
21946 GNU by writing documentation will realize, before it is too late, that
21947 he must above all make it free.
21948
21949 We can also encourage commercial publishers to sell free, copylefted
21950 manuals instead of proprietary ones. One way you can help this is to
21951 check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it, and prefer
21952 copylefted manuals to non-copylefted ones.
21953
21954 @sp 2
21955 @noindent
21956 Note: The Free Software Foundation maintains a page on its Web site
21957 that lists free books available from other publishers:@*
21958 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/doc/other-free-books.html}
21959
21960 @node GNU Free Documentation License
21961 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
21962
21963 @cindex FDL, GNU Free Documentation License
21964 @include doclicense.texi
21965
21966 @node Index
21967 @unnumbered Index
21968
21969 @ignore
21970 MENU ENTRY: NODE NAME.
21971 @end ignore
21972
21973 @printindex cp
21974
21975 @iftex
21976 @c Place biographical information on right-hand (verso) page
21977
21978 @tex
21979 \par\vfill\supereject
21980 \ifodd\pageno
21981 \global\evenheadline={\hfil} \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
21982 \global\oddheadline={\hfil} \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
21983 %\page\hbox{}\page
21984 \else
21985 % \par\vfill\supereject
21986 \global\evenheadline={\hfil} \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
21987 \global\oddheadline={\hfil} \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
21988 %\page\hbox{}%\page
21989 %\page\hbox{}%\page
21990 \fi
21991 @end tex
21992
21993 @c page
21994 @w{ }
21995
21996 @c ================ Biographical information ================
21997
21998 @w{ }
21999 @sp 8
22000 @center About the Author
22001 @sp 1
22002 @end iftex
22003
22004 @ifnottex
22005 @node About the Author
22006 @unnumbered About the Author
22007 @end ifnottex
22008
22009 @quotation
22010 Robert J. Chassell has worked with GNU Emacs since 1985. He writes
22011 and edits, teaches Emacs and Emacs Lisp, and speaks throughout the
22012 world on software freedom. Chassell was a founding Director and
22013 Treasurer of the Free Software Foundation, Inc. He is co-author of
22014 the @cite{Texinfo} manual, and has edited more than a dozen other
22015 books. He graduated from Cambridge University, in England. He has an
22016 abiding interest in social and economic history and flies his own
22017 airplane.
22018 @end quotation
22019
22020 @c @page
22021 @c @w{ }
22022 @c
22023 @c @c Prevent page number on blank verso, so eject it first.
22024 @c @tex
22025 @c \par\vfill\supereject
22026 @c @end tex
22027
22028 @c @iftex
22029 @c @headings off
22030 @c @evenheading @thispage @| @| @thistitle
22031 @c @oddheading @| @| @thispage
22032 @c @end iftex
22033
22034 @bye